DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORP
10-K, 1996-03-29
COMPUTER PROGRAMMING, DATA PROCESSING, ETC.
Previous: PROPERTY SECURED INVESTMENTS INC, 10KSB, 1996-03-29
Next: INLAND STEEL INDUSTRIES INC /DE/, 10-K, 1996-03-29




                      SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                             Washington, D.C. 20549

                                    FORM 10-K



(X)  ANNUAL REPORT  PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE  SECURITIES  EXCHANGE
     ACT OF 1934

                  For the Fiscal Year Ended December 31, 1995.

                                       OR

( )  TRANSITION  REPORT  PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE  SECURITIES
     EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

                         Commission file number 0-15405.

                      DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION
             ------------------------------------------------------
             (Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)


                    Delaware                    47-0669375
            ------------------------     --------------------------
            (State of Incorporation)     (I.R.S. Employer ID Number)


         9110 West Dodge Road, Suite 200, Omaha, Nebraska      68114
         ------------------------------------------------   ----------
              (Address of principal executive office)       (Zip Code)


         Registrant's telephone number, including area code:  (402) 390-2328

         Securities Registered Pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:  None

         Securities Registered Pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:


                       Common Stock, $.001 Par Value
                       -----------------------------
                              (Title of Class)

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required
to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during
the preceding 12 months and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for
the past 90 days. Yes X    No
                      ---      ---

                                       1
<PAGE>
Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent  filers  pursuant to Item 405
of Regulation  S-K is not contained  herein,  and will not be contained,  to the
best of registrant's  knowledge,  in definitive proxy or information  statements
incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this
Form 10-K [ ].

The aggregate market value of voting stock (based upon the "bid" price as quoted
on  NASDAQ)  of the  registrant  held by  non-affiliates  on March  1,  1996 was
approximately $116,000.000.

At March 1, 1996, the registrant had outstanding  3,327,530 shares of its common
stock.
                       DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE

1.    Portions of the Registrant's  Annual Report to Stockholders for the fiscal
      year ended December 31, 1995 are  incorporated  by reference into Parts I,
      II, and IV.

2.    Portions of the  Registrant's  definitive  Proxy  Statement  filed for the
      Registrant's Annual Meeting of Stockholders to be held April 24, 1996, are
      incorporated by reference into Part III.

                                     PART I

ITEM 1.  BUSINESS.

(a)     General Development of Business:

        Data  Transmission  Network  Corporation  (the  "company",   "DTN")  was
incorporated on September 17, 1987 to change the name and state of incorporation
of its predecessor company, Dataline, Inc. from Nebraska to Delaware pursuant to
an  Agreement  and Plan of  Merger  dated  October  8,  1987.  The  company  was
originally  incorporated  in Nebraska on April 9, 1984,  as Scoular  Information
Services,  Inc., a subsidiary of a regional  grain  company,  later changing its
name to Dataline, Inc.

        On December  19, 1985 and January  31,  1986,  in related  transactions,
certain  employees of the company  purchased all of the outstanding stock of the
company from the regional grain company.

        In January,  1987, the company  completed an initial public  offering of
common stock selling 698,085 shares at $5.40 per share.

(b)     Financial Information About Industry Segments:

        Not Applicable

(c)     Narrative Description of Business:

        Data Transmission  Network  Corporation (DTN) began operations in April,
1984. The company is in the business of providing  information and communication
services.  During 1995, four new services were released: DTN Weather Center, DTN
SPECTRUM,  DTN GovRate and a joint  venture  DAT  (Dial-a-Truck)  Transportation
Terminal. DTN's services reach 95,900 subscribers in the U.S. and Canada. All of
these services are discussed in this report.

                                       2
<PAGE>
        The  company's  subscription  services  are  targeted at niche  business
markets  and  designed to be timely  (NEWS...NOT  HISTORY),  simple to use,  and
convenient.  The  company's  information  distribution  technology  provides  an
efficient means of sending data and information from point to multi-point.

        The  development  of  a  cost-effective  electronic  satellite  delivery
system, plus a total commitment to customer service and information quality, has
enabled the company to become a major player in the communication  industry. The
company  continues  to  make a large  investment  to  develop  and  enhance  its
information distribution technology.  This investment has allowed the company to
take advantage of many engineering and software  advancements in an exciting and
growing industry.

                       INFORMATION DISTRIBUTION TECHNOLOGY

        The  company  is  committed  to  research  and  to  develop  information
distribution  technologies to cost  effectively  deliver the timely  information
(NEWS...NOT HISTORY) that the company's subscribers demand. DTN supports several
information distribution  technologies allowing the distribution  (transmission)
and  receiving  (capture,   manipulation  and  display)  of  information.  These
technologies  include,  FM radio  side-band  channels  (FM),  small dish Ku-band
satellite (Ku), FAX, E-Mail, TV cable (VBI) (VBI-vertical blanking interval) and
the Internet.

        The first  technology  used by the company was FM. The Ku technology was
added in 1989,  providing the ability to reach customers  outside the geographic
territory of the signal of the FM stations.  FAX, TV cable (VBI), E-Mail and the
Internet have since been added to further expand our distribution network.

        The company  provides all of the equipment  necessary for subscribers to
receive their  service based on FM, Ku, TV cable (VBI) and E-Mail  technologies.
This equipment includes a receiver,  specifically built for the company, a video
monitor, an FM antenna or a small 30" Ku-band satellite dish. A keyboard,  mouse
and printer may be provided depending on the service. DTN is responsible for the
normal maintenance and repair of the subscriber equipment.

        Prior  to  1992,  the  company  utilized  a  "page-based"  receiver  and
monochrome  system.  The monochrome  system translates the company's data stream
into text and has the capability,  depending on capacity, to receive and display
from 126 to 246 different pages of information.  The monochrome receiver has the
capability to download information to a printer or computer.

        In 1992,  the company  introduced the Advanced  Communications  EngineSM
(ACE) receiver,  a color graphics receiver system,  that expanded the ability to
provide  information  and  communications  services.  This receiver has multiple
processors that capture,  manipulate and display high resolution color pictures,
graphics,  and text.  A separate  processor  provides  the ability to play audio
clips such as weather forecasts,  voice advertisements or audio alarms used when
a futures contract reaches a pre-set price. In addition, this processor may send
and retrieve information by using an internal modem.

        The  receiver  has the ability to download  information  to a printer or
computer.  This  receiver  is equipped  with an internal  hard drive that allows
processed  information to be stored,  archived (versus frequent  rebroadcasting)
and then displayed using the receivers  built-in  control panel, a keyboard or a
mouse at the subscribers convenience.

                                       3
<PAGE>
        One of the unique  aspects  of the  company's  information  distribution
technology is the computer  software  developed by the company  specifically for
use with the DTN receivers.  This software manages information from a wide array
of  input   sources,   runs  routines,   sets   priorities  and  then  initiates
transmissions  to  the  satellite.  The  software  provides  the  capability  to
individually address each receiver unit placed with a subscriber, permitting the
company to transmit specific information to a specific subscriber(s).

        The company leases FM radio side-band  channels,  satellite channels and
TV cable (VBI) to deliver the information to the company's receivers used by its
subscribers.  All  information is up-linked from Omaha to satellite  (except FAX
and other telephone  delivery  technology) and down-linked from the satellite to
the subscriber based on the distribution technology.

        The FM  monochrome  subscribers  receive their  information  using an FM
antenna that receives the information via the side-band signal  transmitted from
the radio stations.

        On December 31, 1995,  19,000  subscribers  were receiving the companies
services via FM distribution technology.

        The Ku subscribers utilize a 30" satellite dish, a direct down-link,  to
receive  their  information.  On December  31,  1995,  74,400  subscribers  were
receiving the companies services via Ku distribution technology.

        Early in  1994,  the  company  began  using a new TV cable  distribution
technology   involving  vertical  blanking  intervals  (VBI).  The  company  has
contracted with a major cable TV superstation to transmit information along with
the station's TV signal.  This technology  eliminates the need for an FM antenna
or satellite  dish and is available to businesses  or residences  that are wired
for cable TV and receive the superstation's service. On December 31, 1995, 2,500
subscribers   were  receiving  the  companies   services  by  VBI   distribution
technology.

        The company has approximately 8,000 FAX customers receiving  information
using FAX  technology.  The E-Mail business is primarily a subscriber (an E-Mail
source)  communicating  specific messages to a group of subscribers.  Currently,
there are over 200 E-Mail sources  delivering over 1,000 pages of information to
subscribers.  The company began to deliver  services on the Internet in 1995 and
plans to continue researching this information distribution technology.

                                SERVICES OFFERED

        The  company's  revenue  is derived  mainly  from five  categories:  (1)
monthly, quarterly or annual subscriptions,  (2) optional service subscriptions,
(3) communication services, (4) advertising and (5) service initiation fees.

        The  percentage  of total  revenue for each category over the last three
fiscal years was:

                                       4
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                     1995                1994               1993
                                                     ----                ----               ----
<S>                                                   <C>                 <C>                <C>
Subscriptions                                         74%                 73%                72%
Optional services                                      6%                  8%                 7%
Communication services                                11%                 10%                 9%
Advertising                                            3%                  5%                 7%
Service Initiation Fees                                6%                  4%                 5%
</TABLE>

         The subscription  revenue is monthly,  quarterly or annual subscription
fees for one of the company's  services.  A more detailed review of each service
is found later in this report.

         Optional  services are offered to subscribers on an "a la carte basis",
similar to premium  channels on cable TV. The  information for these services is
primarily  provided  by a  third  party  with  DTN  receiving  a  share  of  the
subscription revenue paid by the subscriber. Optional services revenue continues
to grow but has decreased as a percentage of total revenue  primarily due to the
growth in subscriptions revenue.

         The  company  sells  communication  services  that allow  companies  to
cost-effectively  communicate  a  large  amount  of  time-sensitive  information
(NEWS...NOT HISTORY) to their customers or field offices. This category includes
revenue generated from FAX and E-Mail services.

         The company sells  advertising  space  interspersed  among the pages of
news and  information,  similar to a newspaper or magazine.  The advantage of an
electronic   advertisement  over  typical  print  media  is  the  time-sensitive
(NEWS...NOT  HISTORY)  delivery  of the ad, as well as the ability to change the
advertising  message  quickly  and as  frequent  as market  conditions  dictate.
Advertising revenue continues to grow but has decreased as a percentage of total
revenue primarily due to the growth in subscriptions revenue.

         Service  initiation  fees  are  one-time  charges  to  new  subscribers
depending on the service and the information distribution  technology.  DTN also
charges an initiation fee for those  subscribers  who convert to another service
(ie: from a monochrome FM to a Ku color service)

DTN Agricultural Services

         The  DTN   Agricultural   related   services  include  DTN  AgDaily(R),
DTNstant(R)/Knight-Ridder,  DTNironSM,  DTN Pro Series,  DTN  PROduceSM  and DTN
Weather CenterSM.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                              1995                      1994                      1993
                                          -----------               -----------               --------
<S>                                       <C>                       <C>                       <C>
Revenues                                  $45,000,000               $33,700,000               $27,000,000
Subscribers at year end                        77,400                    67,100                    61,700
</TABLE>

                                       5
<PAGE>
DTN AGDAILY SERVICE

SERVICE REVIEW
         The company's first service,  DTN AgDaily,  is an  agricultural  market
information and quotes service.  Monochrome (FM and Ku) DTN AgDaily  subscribers
receive  delayed  commodity  futures  and options  quotes;  local cash grain and
livestock prices;  selected regional and world weather updates; and a variety of
daily analysis, commentary and news that affects grain and livestock prices.

         The DTN AgDaily color Ku graphics system  includes an advanced  weather
segment  with  national  and  regional  radar maps  (updated  every 15 minutes),
satellite cloud cover maps,  precipitation  and temperature  maps and much more.
The  subscriber  can custom design high  resolution  charts and/or select from a
library that holds over 1,000 charts. Subscribers can custom program the futures
quotes pages to display only the quotes they desire.  The service also  includes
information segments for specific crop and livestock enterprises.

         Subscribers can select from more than 100 different  optional services.
The majority of these  services have  information  provided by third parties and
range from more advanced weather  information to advisory  services for specific
commodities.

         Approximately 80% of the services  subscribers are farmers or livestock
producers   with  the  balance   consisting   primarily   of  grain   elevators,
agribusinesses,  and financial  institutions.  DTN AgDaily  subscribers farm one
quarter of the nation's total cropland and market 50% of the nation's cattle and
hogs. This service has approximately  70% of the market for  satellite-delivered
agricultural news and information services.  Subscribers can be found all across
the U.S and Canada.

         The  biggest  competitors  to this  service  are  considered  to be the
combination of printed advisory services,  radio, television,  telephone,  other
satellite  information  services,  on-line  services  and  the  changing  of old
information  gathering  habits.  The  company  believes  it  provides a superior
service compared to the services available by its leading competitors.

         New  subscriptions  are  primarily  sold by a sales  force of  employee
district sales representatives as well as by independent,  commission-only sales
representatives.   The  company  obtains  leads  for  the  sales  force  through
telemarketing,  direct mail, print media advertising and customer referrals. The
price of the  monochrome  FM service  is $25.99 per month,  $32.99 per month for
monochrome  Ku service  and $45.99 per month for color Ku  service.  The company
offers a discount to subscribers who pre-pay their subscriptions annually.

DTNSTANT/KNIGHT-RIDDER SERVICE

SERVICE REVIEW
         DTNstant/Knight-Ridder(formerly  DTNstant)  is  a  color  service  that
provides a selection  of  real-time  futures  and options  quotes from the major
commodity  exchanges.  The service also provides headline commodity news, market
leading  cash  information,   in-depth   charting   capabilities  plus  all  the
information  available on the DTN AgDaily color service. The primary subscribers
are commercial grain companies and elevators,  feedlots,  commodity  brokers and
commodity  speculators.  Due to the  character  of this  industry,  the  company
provides on-site service and installation by professional service technicians.

                                       6
<PAGE>
         DTNstant/Knight-Ridder  operates  in a  very  competitive  market  with
numerous  national and  regional  providers of instant  commodity  quotes.  This
service is the leader in the satellite  delivery of instant  futures and options
quotes.

         New  subscriptions are primarily sold by the district sales force which
is  supported  by  telemarketing  and direct  mail  campaigns.  This  service is
available only by color Ku-band satellite  transmission and is priced at $160.00
a month.

DTNIRON SERVICE

SERVICE REVIEW
         DTNiron is a color  service  providing a  cost-effective  communication
resource for the farm implement  industry.  DTNiron is an equipment  locator and
inventory  management  service  providing  a  communication  tool  for the  farm
implement dealers  throughout the U.S and Canada.  The service allows dealers of
all makes of farm implement equipment to work together to manage their inventory
resulting in increased sales and  profitability.  This service provides valuable
information on the national outlook for farm equipment sales.

         DTNiron provides detailed listings of farm implement equipment for sale
by dealers as well as equipment  needed by other  dealers.  Subscribers  receive
industry news, financial  information,  economic indicators and information from
the DTN AgDaily color service.

         This service is only available by color Ku-band satellite  transmission
and costs $94.50 a month.

DTN PRO SERIES SERVICE

SERVICE REVIEW
         The DTN Pro Series services are an advanced information source designed
for agricultural  subscribers who require more extensive information that can be
customized for their specific needs and operations. The Pro Series includes five
services: Weather Pro, News Pro, Chart Pro, Intraday Pro and Stock Pro.

         Weather Pro is the  "meteorological  connection"  to the most  complete
array of current weather, forecast and satellite radar information. This service
allows the subscriber to choose from over 70 new weather maps including detailed
regional, state and zone forecasts. The Weather Pro service gives the subscriber
32 programmable pages to create their own unique weather information chapter.

         News Pro is the "broadcast  connection" to the most timely  (NEWS...NOT
HISTORY) business,  sports,  entertainment,  financial,  and general news of the
day. The service also provides an audio summary of the day's  agricultural news.
New Pro subscribers  receive AP Online, a service of the Associated  Press, as a
news source.

                                       7
<PAGE>
         Chart Pro is the "graphic connection" bringing a variety of information
to the screen in an organized  format to allow the subscriber to analyze trends,
patterns and cycles.  This  service  includes 40 pages for  programmable  charts
allowing the subscriber to create an extensive "chart book".

         Intraday Pro is the "trading  connection" to the first low-cost  system
with the ability to chart market  sessions  minute-by-minute  during the trading
day. This service allows the subscriber to choose the time intervals they desire
to chart and keep them abreast of the markets.

         Stock Pro is the  "market  connection"  providing  access to prices for
over 50,000  issues of stocks,  bonds and funds.  This  service  includes  stock
quotes using either the quick quote  feature or the  programmable  quotes pages.
Additional  features are the personal library used to store news and information
and the high interest  windows that allows the subscriber to constantly  monitor
up to six futures, options, stock or bond quotes.

         The individual Pro Series services are bundled with DTN Ag Daily.  Each
individual  Pro Series service is $58.99 per month except the Stock Pro which is
$66.00 a month.  DTN Premier is the package of Weather Pro, News Pro,  Chart Pro
and Intraday  Pro,  priced at $73.99 per month.  DTN Premier Plus is the package
DTN  Premier  and Stock  Pro,  priced at $78.00 a month.  This  service  is only
available by color Ku-band satellite transmission.

DTN PRODUCE SERVICE

SERVICE REVIEW
         DTN PROduce is the authority in providing the produce industry with the
most timely weather,  prices,  transportation  and news  information  available.
There are four major  components  to the DTN PROduce  service.  First is weather
information, providing the single most important piece of information for anyone
in the produce  business.  Second is pricing  information,  providing  immediate
updates upon release  formatted by commodity,  growing area and terminal market.
Third is  transportation  information,  providing  freight rates and daily truck
availability  by  the  major  growing  areas.   Finally,  the  service  provides
comprehensive industry specific and general news.

         The market for the service is the entire produce food chain of growers,
shippers,  packers,  brokers,  retailers and institutions.  This service is only
available via color Ku-band satellite and is priced at $84.50 per month.

DTN WEATHER CENTER (New Service)

SERVICE REVIEW
         DTN Weather  Center was unveiled at the  corporation's  annual  meeting
held in April 1995.  This service  combines  many of DTN's most popular  weather
features  with several new  features  that allow the service to be marketed to a
variety of industries, such as golf course management,  construction,  emergency
management, aviation and public works. This service can be sold to virtually any
industry  where  timely  (NEWS...NOT  HISTORY),  accurate,   accessible  weather
information  would  cause a decision to be made  concerning  the  deployment  of
manpower.

                                       8
<PAGE>

         DTN Weather Center provides 80 weather maps, 20 regional radar maps and
four satellite maps. The service provides  short-range  (24-48 hours) forecasts,
long-range  (3-10 day)  outlooks,  and  five-day  city  forecasts  in three hour
intervals for 223 different  cities in the U.S. and Canada.  DTN Weather  Center
features  the new  Insta-Rad  radar  maps that  allow the  company  to send this
information within five minutes to the subscriber.

         This service is available only via color Ku-band satellite transmission
and is priced at $68.00 per month.

OPTIONAL SERVICES

SERVICE REVIEW
         Optional Services include advisory, educational and other informational
services  offered  to  DTN  subscribers  on an "a la  carte"  basis.  Additional
Services are  marketed by  advertising  on DTN  services,  direct mail,  invoice
stuffers and free trials.  An Additional  Service is featured on a regular basis
providing all  subscribers a three-day free trial.  Subscribers  can request and
receive a two-week free trial of any Additional Service.

         New  Additional  Services  are  developed  and  added to meet  customer
requests for information. Additional Services range in price from $6 to $300 per
quarter depending on the service.

DTN FINANCIAL SERVICES

         DTN  Financial  Services has grown from a single  service in 1989,  DTN
Wall  Street(R),  to  four  services,  DTN  Wall  Street,  DTN  SPECTRUMSM,  DTN
FirstRateSM and DTN GovRateSM. DTN Financial Services also includes a variety of
optional advisory and fundamental market information services.

         The  financial  services  compounded  revenue  growth for the past five
years was a very bullish 41%. The financial  services  objective is to provide a
comprehensive  in-depth  service at an affordable cost to the  subscriber.  This
objective  will remain very  important due to the highly  competitive  nature of
this business.  The "a la carte" optional services are offered to the subscriber
to give them an even  larger  variety of  information.  The  contents of all DTN
Financial  Services  are  broader  in scope  and cost  less per  month  than the
services  offered  by  competitors.  This  combination  allows the  services  to
maintain a competitive advantage.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                              1995                      1994                      1993
                                          -----------               -----------               --------

<S>                                        <C>                       <C>                       <C>       
Revenues                                   $6,100,000                $5,100,000                $4,100,000
Subscribers at year end                         9,600                     8,800                     7,700
</TABLE>

DTN WALL STREET SERVICE

                                       9
<PAGE>
SERVICE REVIEW
         DTN Wall Street  provides  exchange  delayed  quotes on stocks,  bonds,
mutual and money market funds, futures, interest rates, currencies and real-time
index  quotes.  This service also  provides  in-depth  economic,  financial  and
business news and other  time-sensitive  (NEWS...NOT  HISTORY)  financial market
information  such as  company-specific  news and  earnings.  The service  allows
subscribers to custom  program the system to track their  selection of financial
quotes.

         The subscribers to DTN Wall Street have a variety of optional  services
from which to choose providing stock selection and timing advice, U.S. Treasury,
Agency, mortgage-backed securities quotes and other financial related services.

         The  majority of  subscribers  are  individual  investors,  independent
brokers, financial advisors and financial institutions.  The primary competition
for DTN Wall Street are  satellite,  TV cable (VBI) and dial-up quote  services.
New subscribers to this service are obtained through direct response  marketing,
primarily print media, television advertising and telemarketing.

         This service is available by monochrome  Ku-band satellite and TV cable
(VBI) and is priced at $41.95 per month.

DTN SPECTRUM (New Service)

SERVICE REVIEW
         DTN SPECTRUM was an important focus of the new service development team
at DTN during 1995. This service was released during  November,  1995, and is an
enhanced  version of DTN Wall Street  utilizing the ACE technology.  The service
provides many  additional  features and functions that appeal to a wider market.
This service provides advanced quote selection and custom programming along with
alarms and charting capability.  The service will continue to be enhanced during
1996.

         This  service  was well  received  in the short  time it was  available
during 1995. All indications are that subscription sales will be strong in 1996.

         An extension  of DTN  SPECTRUM is the DTN  SPECTRUM  R-T service.  This
marks the entry by the DTN Financial  Services into the real-time quotes market.
The  service  will  provide  a mix of  exchange-delayed  quotes  along  with the
subscriber's choice of real-time commodities and futures quotes. This service is
expected to be well received by the market in 1996.

         The DTN SPECTRUM  and DTN  SPECTRUM R-T services are only  available by
color  Ku-band  satellite  and are  priced  at $68.00  and  $118.00  per  month,
respectively.  These  services  will become  available  by TV cable (VBI) during
1996.

DTN FIRSTRATE SERVICE

SERVICE REVIEW
         DTN  FirstRate  is  a  service  for  the  mortgage  industry  providing
wholesale  price  information  in an  easy-to-use  standard  format and intraday
interest rate  information to indicate the direction of wholesale  prices.  This
service also provides  subscribers  with business,  economic and financial news,
analysis, and commentary including leading economic indicators, employment rates
and government economic reports and trend analysis.

                                       10
<PAGE>
         Sales for DTN FirstRate are slow.  Company research  suggests we should
expect modest success with this service;  however, the company is continuing the
search for more cost effective sales and marketing programs.

         This service is available by monochrome  Ku-band  satellite or TV cable
(VBI) and is priced at $111.95 per month.

DTN GOVRATE (New Service)

SERVICE REVIEW
         DTN GovRate provides  executable U.S.  government  security quotes from
Zions First  National  Bank.  The  real-time  prices are provided from a primary
dealer,  the former Discount  Corporation of New York (DCNY), now operating as a
division of Zions First National Bank.

         The  company  views  this  service  as  an  important  development  for
financial institutions.  The service will provide the ability for more than just
large, money-center banks and institutions to have access to competitive pricing
of U.S. government securities.

         DTN GovRate will open  opportunities  for smaller to  mid-sized  banks,
public and corporate treasurers,  and independent brokerage firms to participate
in the trading of U.S.  government  securities.  Zions First  National Bank will
facilitate this by offering odd lot trading and repurchase agreements.

         This service is available by monochrome  Ku-band  satellite or TV cable
(VBI) transmission for $34.95 per month. The service is also currently available
on color Ku-band satellite for $68.00 per month.

DTN ENERGY SERVICES

The energy related services include DTNergy(R) for the refined fuels and natural
gas industries.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                              1995                      1994                      1993
                                          -----------               -----------               --------
<S>                                       <C>                        <C>                       <C>       
Revenues                                  $10,000,000                $7,200,000                $4,900,000
Subscribers at year end                         7,100                     6,700                     5,800
</TABLE>

DTNERGY SERVICE

SERVICE REVIEW
         DTNergy is a service providing pricing  information and  communications
services for the petroleum  industry.  This service consists of several pages of
delayed  energy  futures and options  quotes plus  selected  news and  financial
information.  DTNergy is  designed  to connect  refiners  (producers  of refined
fuels) to wholesalers  (distributor of refined fuels). The refiner sends refined
fuel prices to wholesalers they have authorized to receive this information. The
refiner  also has the  capability  to send  terminal  alerts,  electronic  funds
transfer  notifications,  invoices,  and other communications to the wholesaler.
DTNergy  subscribers can select from a variety of optional services to give them
even more prices or news related to the petroleum industry.

                                       11
<PAGE>
         The strength of the DTNergy  service is the ability to deliver,  within
seconds,  accurate refiner terminal prices and other vital communications to the
wholesalers.  This service is more reliable,  timely and less expensive than the
competition,  which utilize  telephone  delivered  printer-only  systems and FAX
services.

         DTNergy generates revenue from two primary sources,  the wholesaler and
the refiner.  The wholesaler pays a monthly  subscription  fee of $36.00 for the
monochrome  Ku-band  satellite  service.  The  refiner  pays fees based upon the
number and length of communications sent to wholesalers.

         DTNergy  developed a service for the natural gas industry.  Subscribers
receive  natural  gas flow data,  instant or delayed  NYMEX  energy  options and
futures  quotes,  weather and  industry  specific  information.  This service is
marketed to natural gas producers, distributors and large consumers. The service
is only  available by color Ku-band  satellite and is priced at $129 a month for
30-minute delayed quotes and $160 a month for real-time quotes.

DTN AUTO SERVICES

SERVICE REVIEW
         DTNautoSM is a communication and information service for the automobile
industry.  This service offers automobile dealers precision information to value
trade-ins,  locate  used  car  inventory  plus a host of other  information  and
convenient features.  Automobile auction companies and manufacturers are able to
communicate directly with the dealers.

         DTNauto  provides  information  on  pre-auction   automobile  listings,
results of past  auctions,  new and used car  industry  news,  weather and other
news.  The  service  allows  subscribers  to  perform  searches  of the  auction
listings, upcoming and past, for specific automobile information.

         The service offers a variety of optional services providing information
on credit reporting (CREDCO),  vehicle histories (CARFAX),  warranty information
(The Warranty Guide) and residual value of leased  vehicles  (Lease Guide).  The
CARFAX and CREDCO optional  services  extensively  utilize the internal modem to
send  and  receive  information.  These  services  create  a more  comprehensive
information service that puts the subscriber in the drivers seat.

         This service is being marketed by the DTNauto sales force to automobile
dealers  across the United  States.  This  service  is only  available  by color
Ku-band satellite transmission and is priced at $98.00 per month.

JOINT VENTURE SERVICES

         DTN has joined  forces with other  companies to market  their  services
using the company's technology.  These services are TracElectric,  a service for
the electric equipment industry, and DAT Transportation  Terminal, a service for
the trucking industry.

TRACELECTRIC SERVICE

                                       12
<PAGE>
SERVICE REVIEW
         TracElectric  is  an  equipment  locator  service  for  the  electrical
equipment industry. This service provides over 100 pages of new, remanufactured,
surplus and used electrical equipment listings.  The service connects buyers and
sellers throughout the U.S. and Canada.

         This service is available only by monochrome  Ku-band satellite and DTN
receives a percentage of the revenue.

DAT Transportation Terminal (New Service)

SERVICE REVIEW
         The  DAT  (Dial-A-Truck)  Transportation  Terminal  (DAT)  service  was
introduced  in the fourth  quarter of 1995 and is an  information  communication
system for the trucking  industry.  This service is a joint  venture with DAT in
Beaverton, OR and DTN. The service provides load and truck matching performed on
a database of 25,000 listings updated daily.

         DAT service allows subscribers to input their own listings into the ACE
receiver and send this  information  to the database  using the internal  modem.
This service provides the subscriber the ability to perform  extensive  searches
to locate  loads and  trucks  and set  alarms to alert the user that a match has
occurred.  The service also provides  regional  radar maps of major highways and
interstates,  transportation  news,  diesel  fuel  prices  and  other  financial
information related to the trucking industry.

         The target market includes all freight brokers and carriers  throughout
U.S. and Canada.  This service is only available by color Ku-band  satellite and
DTN receives a monthly fee per receiver.

EMPLOYEE DATA

         At  December  31,  1995  the  company  had  approximately  725 full and
part-time employees.

(d)      Financial Information about Foreign and Domestic Operations and Export
         Sales:

         Not applicable

ITEM 2. PROPERTIES.

         The company leases its executive and  administrative  offices in Omaha,
Nebraska and has outside sales offices in Arizona,  Colorado,  Florida, Illinois
and Utah.  Approximately  75,000 square feet of office space is leased for these
offices for various periods up through May 2005.

         In  addition,  the  company  leases two  distribution  centers  for the
purpose  of  storing  and  distributing  the  electronic   equipment  needed  by
subscribers to receive the company's  services.  The main distribution center is
located in Omaha,  Nebraska and occupies  approximately  28,000 square feet. The
company  also  serves  its  Canadian   subscribers  with  a  2,500  square  foot
distribution center located in Winnipeg,  Manitoba.  The leases related to these
distribution centers are for various periods up through December, 2003.

                                       13
<PAGE>
         The  information  set forth in Footnote 9 "Leases" on page 29-30 of the
company's  1995  Annual  Report  to  Stockholders  is  incorporated   herein  by
reference.

ITEM 3. LEGAL PROCEEDINGS.

         The  company  is not a  party  to nor is its  property  subject  to any
material  pending  legal  proceedings,  other than ordinary  routine  litigation
incidental to its business.

ITEM 4. SUBMISSION OF MATTERS TO A VOTE OF SECURITY HOLDERS.

         No  matter  was  submitted  to a vote of the  security  holders  of the
company during the fourth quarter of the fiscal year ended December 31, 1995.

                                      * * *

                                       14
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                      EXECUTIVE OFFICERS OF THE REGISTRANT

         Information  on the  current  executive  officers  of the company is as
follows:

                                                                    Year Joined
      Name                      Title                    Age        the Company
- -------------------    ---------------------------       ---        -----------
<S>                    <C>                                <C>           <C>
Roger R. Brodersen     Chairman of the Board and          50            1984
                       Chief Executive Officer

Greg T. Sloma          President and Chief                44            1993
                       Operating Officer

Robert S. Herman       Senior Vice President              43            1984
                       Research and Technology

Roger W. Wallace       Senior Vice President and          39            1984
                       Co-President, Ag Services

James J. Marquiss      Senior Vice President and          51            1986
                       Co-President, Ag Services

Charles R. Wood        Senior Vice President and          55            1989
                       President, Financial Services

Keith A. Cook          Vice President and                 57            1986
                       President, Auto Services

H. Wade German         Vice President,                    54            1992
                       Business Research

Brian L. Larson        Vice President, Chief Financial    35            1993
                       Officer, Secretary and Treasurer

Gordon R. Lundy        Vice President and                 57            1990
                       President, Energy Services

Charles E. McQuinn     Vice President and President,      55            1995
                       West Financial Services

James G. Payne         Vice President, Administrative     40            1990
                       Operations Manager
</TABLE>


         The executive officers serve annual terms, and are elected by the board
of directors at their annual board of directors meeting in April of each year.




                                       15
<PAGE>
                                     PART II

ITEM 5.           MARKET FOR THE REGISTRANT'S COMMON STOCK AND RELATED
                  STOCKHOLDER MATTERS.

         Information  concerning the market for the company's  common stock, the
number of stockholders of record and the company's  dividend history is on pages
31  and  32  of  the  company's  1995  Annual  Report  to  Stockholders  and  is
incorporated herein by reference.

         Over-the-counter market quotations reflect inter-dealer prices, without
retail  mark-up,  mark-down or  commissions  and may not  necessarily  represent
actual transactions.

         The company's most  restrictive  loan covenant  restricts cash dividend
payments to 25% of net income after taxes.

ITEM 6.           SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA.

         Selected  financial data for the company is on page 16 of the company's
1995 Annual Report to Stockholders and is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 7.           MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL
                  CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.

         Management's discussion and analysis of financial condition and results
of operations  is on pages 17 through 20 of the company's  1995 Annual Report to
Stockholders and is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 8.           FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA.

         The financial statements of the company,  together with the Independent
Auditors' Report, are on pages 21 through 30 of the company's 1995 Annual Report
to Stockholders and are incorporated herein by reference.

         Supplementary  quarterly  financial  information  is on  page 31 of the
company's  1995 Annual  Report to  Stockholders  and is  incorporated  herein by
reference.

ITEM 9.           CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON
                  ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE.

         None

                                       16
<PAGE>

                                    PART III

ITEM 10.          DIRECTORS OF THE REGISTRANT.

         Information  concerning  the present  directors  of the company and all
persons  nominated to become  directors at the Annual Meeting of Stockholders of
the company to be held April 24, 1996,  is  contained  in the section  captioned
"Election of Directors" of the Proxy  Statement  for such annual  meeting.  Such
section is on pages 2 through 3 of such  Proxy  Statement,  and is  incorporated
herein by reference.  Information concerning the registrant's executive officers
is furnished in a separate item captioned  "Executive  Officers of the Company",
included in Part I of this Form 10-K.

Compliance With Section 16(a) Of The Exchange Act

        Section  16(a) of the  Securities  Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the
"Exchange  Act"),  requires  the  Company's  directors,  executive  officers and
holders  of more  than  10% of the  Company's  common  stock  to file  with  the
Securities and Exchange  Commission  initial reports of ownership and reports of
changes in ownership of common stock and other equity securities of the Company.
The Company  believes that during the fiscal year ended  December 31, 1995,  its
officers,  directors and holders of more than 10% of the Company's  common stock
complied  with  all  Section  16(a)  filing  requirements,  with  the  following
exception.  Jay E.  Ricks,  a director  or the  Company,  filed late his initial
report on Form 3 due upon his  becomming  a director of the  Company.  In making
these  statements,  the Company has relied solely upon a review of Forms 3 and 4
furnished to the Company  during its most recent fiscal year,  Forms 5 furnished
to the  Company  with  respect  to its most  recent  fiscal  year,  and  written
representations from reporting persons that no Form 5 was required.

ITEM 11.       EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION.

        Information  concerning  executive  compensation  paid by the company is
contained in the sections captioned  "Executive  Compensation" and "Compensation
Committee  Report on Executive  Compensation" on pages 6 through 10 of the Proxy
Statement for the Annual Meeting of Stockholders of the company to be held April
24, 1996, and is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 12.       SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND
               MANAGEMENT.

        Information concerning the ownership of equity securities of the company
by certain  beneficial  owners  and  management  is  contained  in the  sections
captioned  "Ownership By Certain  Beneficial Owners" and "Election of Directors"
on  pages  2  through  6 of the  Proxy  Statement  for  the  Annual  Meeting  of
Stockholders  of the  company to be held  April 24,  1996,  and is  incorporated
herein by reference.

ITEM 13.       CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS.

        Information  concerning  transactions  with  management  and  others and
indebtedness of management is contained in the section  captioned  "Transactions
with  Management"  on page 11 of the Proxy  Statement for the Annual  Meeting of
Stockholders of the company to be held April 24, 1996 and is incorporated herein
by reference.

                                       17
<PAGE>
                                     PART IV

ITEM 14.       EXHIBITS, FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES AND REPORTS
               ON FORM 8-K.

(a)     1.  Financial Statements:

        The  Registrant's  financial  statements,  together with the Independent
Auditors' Report, are incorporated herein by reference to the 1995 Annual Report
to Stockholders,  pages 21 through 30. With the exception of the  aforementioned
information and the information incorporated by reference into Items 2,5,6,7 and
8 of this report,  the Annual Report to Stockholders for the year ended December
31, 1995, is not to be deemed filed as a part of this report.  The  supplemental
financial  information  listed  below  should  be read in  conjunction  with the
financial  statements  in the Annual Report to  Stockholders  for the year ended
December 31, 1995.

(a)     2.     Financial Statement Schedules:                             Page
                                                                          ----
               Auditors' Report on Financial Statement Schedules           26

               Schedule
                Number            Description of Schedule
               ---------     ----------------------------------
                  II          Valuation and Qualifying Accounts            27

All other schedules are omitted because they are not applicable or not required,
or because the required  information is included in the financial  statements or
notes thereto.

(a)     3.     Exhibits:

               (3)       (a)      Certificate of Incorporation of Registrant.

                         (b)      By-Laws of Registrant.
               (These documents are filed as exhibits to the Registrant's
               Registration Statement on Form S-1 as filed December 4, 1987.)

               (4)       (a)      Specimen certificate representing shares of
                                  Common Stock $.001 par value, of Registrant.
               (This  document  is  filed  as an  exhibit  to  the  Registrant's
               Registration Statement on Form S-1 as filed November 4, 1988.)

                         (b)      Certificate of Incorporation of Registrant.
               (This  document  is  filed  as an  exhibit  to  the  Registrant's
               Registration Statement on Form S-1 as filed December 4, 1987.)

               (10)      (a)      Lease Agreement between the Registrant and
                                  Embassy Plaza Limited Partnership.
               (This document is filed as an exhibit to the Registrant's  Annual
               Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 1990.)

                         (b)      Registrant's Stock Option Plan of 1989.
               (This  document  is  included  as an exhibit to the  Registrant's
               Proxy  Statement for the Annual Meeting of  Shareholders  held on
               April 26, 1989.)

                                       18
<PAGE>
                         (c)      Registrant's Non-employee Directors Stock
                                  Option Plan.
               (This  document  is  included  as an exhibit to the  Registrant's
               Proxy  Statement for the Annual Meeting of  Shareholders  held on
               April 26, 1989.)

                         (d)      Form of indemnification agreement between the
                                  Registrant and the Officers and Directors of
                                  the Registrant.
               (This  document  is  filed  as an  exhibit  to  the  Registrant's
               Registration Statement on Form S-1 as filed May 22, 1989.)

                         (e)      First Amendment to Registrant's Employee Stock
                                  Option Plan of 1989 (amends Exhibit 10(b)).

                         (f)      First Amendment to Registrant's Non-employee
                                  Directors Stock Option Plan
                                  (amends Exhibit 10(c)).
               (These  documents  are  included as exhibits to the  Registrant's
               Proxy  Statement for the Annual Meeting of  Stockholders  held on
               April 25, 1990.)

                         (g)      Second Amendment to Registrant's Employee
                                  Stock Option Plan of 1989
                                  (amends Exhibit 10(b)).

                         (h)      Second Amendment to Registrant's Non-employee
                                  Directors Stock Option Plan
                                  (amends Exhibit 10(c)).
               (These  documents  are  included as exhibits to the  Registrant's
               Proxy  Statement for the Annual Meeting of  Stockholders  held on
               April 24, 1991.)

                         (i)      Loan Agreement dated October 9, 1992 among the
                                  Registrant, First National Bank of Omaha,
                                  FirsTier Bank Lincoln and First National Bank
                                  of Wahoo.

                         (j)      First   Amendment  to  Loan  Agreement   dated
                                  October  9, 1992 among the  Registrant,  First
                                  National  Bank  of  Omaha,  FirsTier  Bank  of
                                  Lincoln and First National Bank of Wahoo.

                         (k)      Independent Sales Representative Agreement
                                  dated March 28, 1990 between the Registrant
                                  and Phil Huston.

                         (l)      First  Amendment dated March 1, 1991 to
                                  Independent Sales Representative Agreement
                                  dated March 28, 1990 between Registrant and
                                  Phil Huston.

                         (m)      Amendment to Independent Sales Representative
                                  Agreement dated March 28, 1990 between
                                  Registrant and Phil Huston.


                                       20
<PAGE>
               (These  documents  are  included as exhibits to the  Registrant's
               Annual Report on Form 10-K as filed March 24, 1993).

                         (n)      Third Amendment to Registrant's Stock Option
                                  Plan of 1989 (amends Exhibit 10(b)).

                         (o)      Third Amendment to Registrant's Non-Employee
                                  Directors Stock Option Plan
                                  (amends Exhibit 10(c)).

                         (p)      Fourth Amendment to Employee Stock Option Plan
                                  of 1989 (amends Exhibit 10(b)).

                         (q)      Fourth Amendment to Non-Employee Directors
                                  Stock Option Plan (amends Exhibit 10(c)).
               (These  documents  are  included as exhibits to the  Registrant's
               Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting of Stockholders to be held
               April 27, 1994).

                         (r)      Restated Loan Agreement dated November 8, 1993
                                  among the  Registrant,  First National Bank of
                                  Omaha,  FirsTier Bank Lincoln,  First National
                                  Bank  of  Wahoo,  National  Bank  of  Detroit,
                                  Norwest Bank  Nebraska,  NA and The  Boatmen's
                                  Bank of St. Louis.

                         (s)      Restated Security  Agreement dated November 8,
                                  1993 among the Registrant, First National Bank
                                  of  Omaha,   FirsTier  Bank   Lincoln,   First
                                  National  Bank  of  Wahoo,  National  Bank  of
                                  Detroit,  Norwest  Bank  Nebraska,  NA and The
                                  Boatmen's Bank of St. Louis.

               (These  documents  are  included as exhibits to the  Registrant's
               Annual Report on Form 10-K as filed March 14, 1994).

                         (t)      Restated  and amended  Non-Employee  Directors
                                  Stock Option Plan.

               (This  document  is  included  as an exhibit to the  Registrant's
               Proxy Statement for the annual meeting of stockholders to be held
               April 26, 1995).

                         (u)      First Amendment to the Restated Loan Agreement
                                  dated  November 8, 1993 among the  Registrant,
                                  First  National  Bank of Omaha,  Firstier Bank
                                  Lincoln,   First   National   Bank  of  Wahoo,
                                  National   Bank  of  Detroit,   Norwest   Bank
                                  Nebraska, NA and The Boatmen's Bank of St.
                                  Louis.
                                       21
<PAGE>
                         (v)      Second   Amendment   to  the   Restated   Loan
                                  Agreement  dated  November  8, 1993  among the
                                  Registrant,  First  National  Bank  of  Omaha,
                                  Firstier Bank Lincoln,  First National Bank of
                                  Wahoo, National Bank of Detroit,  Norwest Bank
                                  Nebraska, NA and The Boatmen's Bank of St.
                                  Louis.

                         (w)      Third Amendment to the Restated Loan Agreement
                                  dated  November 8, 1993 among the  Registrant,
                                  First  National  Bank of Omaha,  Firstier Bank
                                  Lincoln,   First   National   Bank  of  Wahoo,
                                  National   Bank  of  Detroit,   Norwest   Bank
                                  Nebraska, NA and The Boatmen's Bank of St.
                                  Louis.

                         (x)      Fourth   Amendment   to  the   Restated   Loan
                                  Agreement  dated  November  8, 1993  among the
                                  Registrant,  First  National  Bank  of  Omaha,
                                  Firstier Bank Lincoln,  First National Bank of
                                  Wahoo, National Bank of Detroit,  Norwest Bank
                                  Nebraska, NA and The Boatmen's Bank of St.
                                  Louis.

                         (y)      Lease  agreement dated August 30, 1994 between
                                  Registrant   and  The   Prudential   Insurance
                                  Company of America.

                         (z)      First   Amendment  to  lease  agreement  dated
                                  August 30, 1994 among the  Registrant  and The
                                  Prudential Insurance Company of America.

                         (aa)     Senior  Subordinated  Note dated June 30, 1994
                                  between the Registrant  and Equitable  Capital
                                  Private Income and Equity Partnership II, L.P.

               (These  documents  are  included as exhibits to the  Registrant's
               Annual Report on Form 10-K as filed March 28, 1995).

                         (ab)     Fifth Amendment to the Restated Loan Agreement
                                  dated  November  8, 1993 among the  Registrant
                                  and six regional banks.

                         (ac)     Sixth Amendment to the Restated Loan Agreement
                                  dated  November  8, 1993 among the  Registrant
                                  and six regional banks.

                         (ad)     Lease  agreement dated May 2, 1995 between the
                                  Registrant   and  The   Prudential   Insurance
                                  Company of America.

                         (ae)     First  Amendment to lease  agreement dated May
                                  2,  1995  between  the   Registrant   and  The
                                  Prudential Insurance Company of America.

                                       23
<PAGE>
                         (af)     Restated  Loan  Agreement  dated June 29, 1995
                                  among the Registrant and seven regional banks.

                         (ag)     Purchase and service  agreement dated July 13,
                                  1995 between the Registrant and  Knight-Ridder
                                  Financial.

                         (ah)     Adjustment to Independent Sales Representative
                                  Agreement   dated  March  28,   1990   between
                                  Registrant and Phil Houston.

                         (ai)     Senior Subordinated Notes and Warrant Purchase
                                  Agreement   dated   June  30,   1994   between
                                  Registrant  and  Equitable   Capital   Private
                                  Income and Equity Partnership II, L.P.

                         (aj)     First Amendment to Senior  Subordinated  Notes
                                  and Warrant Purchase  Agreement dated June 30,
                                  1994 between  Registrant and Equitable Capital
                                  Private Income and Equity Partnership II, L.P.

               (11)      Statement re computation of income per share.
               (12)      Not applicable.
               (13)      Registrant's 1995 Annual Report to Stockholders.
                         (This document is hereby incorporated by reference.)
               (16)      None.
               (18)      None.
               (19)      None.
               (22)      None.
               (23)      Consent of Deloitte & Touche LLP.
               (24)      None.
               (25)      None.
               (99)      Proxy  Statement for the Annual Meeting of Stockholders
                         of the  Registrant  to be held  April 24,  1996.  (This
                         document is hereby incorporated by reference.)

(b)     No reports on Form 8-K were  filed by the  Registrant  during the fourth
        quarter of the year ended December 31, 1995.

                                   SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the  requirements  of Section 13 or 15(d) of the  Securities
Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on
its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

Data Transmission Network Corporation,
a Delaware Corporation


By:     /s/ Roger R. Brodersen
        -----------------------
        Roger R. Brodersen
        Chief Executive Officer



                                       24
<PAGE>
Dated March 22, 1996.

        Pursuant to the  requirements  of the  Securities  Exchange Act of 1934,
this  report has been  signed  below by the  following  persons on behalf of the
Registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.


By:     /s/ Roger R. Broderson                                  March 22, 1996
        ------------------------------
        Roger R. Brodersen, Chairman of the
        Board, Chief Executive Officer
        and Director


By:     /s/ Greg T. Sloma                                       March 22, 1996
        ------------------------------
        Greg T. Sloma, President and
        Chief Operating Officer
        and Director


By:     /s/ Roger W. Wallace                                    March 22, 1996
        ------------------------------
        Roger W. Wallace, Senior Vice
        President, Co-President-Ag
        Services and Director


By:     /s/ Robert S. Herman                                    March 22, 1996
        ------------------------------
        Robert S. Herman, Senior Vice
        President and Director


By:     /s/ Brian L. Larson                                     March 22, 1996
        ------------------------------
        Brian L. Larson, Vice President,
        Chief Financial Officer,
        Secretary and Treasurer


By:     /s/ David K. Karnes                                     March 22, 1996
        ------------------------------
        David K. Karnes, Director


By:     /s/ J. Michael Parks                                    March 22, 1996
        ------------------------------
        J. Michael Parks, Director


By:     /s/ Jay E. Ricks                                        March 22, 1996
        ------------------------------
        Jay E. Ricks, Director



                                       25
<PAGE>




INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT

Board of Directors and Stockholders
Data Transmission Network Corporation
Omaha, Nebraska

We  have  audited  the  financial   statements  of  Data  Transmission   Network
Corporation as of December 31, 1995 and 1994, and for each of the three years in
the period  ended  December  31, 1995 and have issued our report  thereon  dated
January 30, 1996; such financial statements and report are included in your 1995
Annual Report to  Stockholders  and are  incorporated  herein by reference.  our
audits also  included the  financial  statement  schedules of Data  Transmission
Network Corporation,  listed in Item 14(a)2. These financial statement schedules
are the  responsibility of the company's  management.  Our  responsibility is to
express an opinion based on our audits. In our opinion, such financial statement
schedules,  when considered in relation to the basic financial  statements taken
as a whole,  present fairly in all material  respects the  information set forth
therein.


/s/  Deloitte & Touche  LLP
- ---------------------------

     DELOITTE & TOUCHE  LLP

     Omaha, Nebraska
         January 30, 1996






                                       26
<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                    Schedule II


                      DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION

                        VALUATION AND QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS

                  YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995, 1994, and 1993



                                  Balance at                     Charged to                   Balance at
                                  Beginning       Charged to       Other                          End
Description                       of Period        Expenses       Accounts    Deductions       of Period
                                 -----------      ----------     ----------   ----------      -----------  

Allowance for doubtful
accounts:

<S>                                <C>            <C>                          <C>             <C>     
Year ended December 31, 1995:      $220,000       $358,000            -        $278,000        $300,000


Year ended December 31, 1994:      $180,000       $283,000            -        $243,000        $220,000


Year ended December 31, 1993:      $120,000       $270,000            -        $210,000        $180,000

</TABLE>



                                       27
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                   EXHIBIT INDEX
Exhibit                                                                                                    Page
Number                                  Item                                                              Number
- -------                                 ----                                                              ------    
<S>            <C>                                                                                         <C>    
 3.(a)         Certificate of Incorporation of Registrant                                                   *
 3.(b)         By-Laws of Registrant                                                                        *
 4.(a)         Specimen certificate representing shares of common stock,                                    *
               $.001 par value, of Registrant
 4.(b)         Certificate of Incorporation of Registrant                                                   *
10.(a)         Lease Agreement between the Registrant and Embassy Plaza                                     *
               Limited Partnership
10.(b)         Registrant's Stock Option Plan of 1989                                                       *
10.(c)         Registrant's Non-Employee Directors Stock Option Plan                                        *
10.(d)         Form of indemnification agreement between the Registrant                                     *
               and the Officers and Directors of the Registrant
10.(e)         First Amendment to Registrant's Stock Option Plan of 1989                                    *
10.(f)         First Amendment to Registrant's Non-Employee Directors                                       *
               Stock Option Plan
10.(g)         Second Amendment to Registrant's Stock Option Plan of 1989                                   *
10.(h)         Second Amendment to Registrant's Non-Employee Directors                                      *
               Stock Option Plan
10.(i)         Loan  Agreement  dated  October 9, 1992                                                      *
10.(j)         First  Amendment  to Loan Agreement  dated  October  9,  1992                                *
10.(k)         Independent  Sales  Representative Agreement with Phil                                       *
               Huston dated March 28, 1990
10.(l)         First Amendment dated March 1, 1991 to Independent Sales                                     *
               Representative Agreement with Phil Huston
10.(m)         Amendment to Independent Sales Representative Agreement                                      *
               with Phil Huston
10.(n)         Third Amendment to Registrant's Stock Option Plan of 1989                                    *
10.(o)         Third Amendment to Registrant's Non-Employee Directors                                       *
               Stock Option Plan
10.(p)         Fourth Amendment to Registrant's Stock Option Plan of 1989                                   *
10.(q)         Fourth Amendment to Registrant's Non-Employee Directors                                      *
               Stock Option Plan
10.(r)         Restated Loan Agreement dated November 8, 1993                                               *
10.(s)         Restated  Security Agreement dated November 8, 1993                                          *
10.(t)         Restated and amended  Non-Employee  Directors Stock Option Plan                              *
10.(u)         First Amendment to Restated Loan Agreement dated November 8, 1993                            *
10.(v)         Second Amendment to Restated Loan Agreement dated November 8, 1993                           *
10.(w)         Third Amendment to Restated Loan Agreement dated November 8, 1993                            *
10.(x)         Fourth Amendment to Restated Loan Agreement dated November 8, 1993                           *
10.(y)         Lease agreement with The Prudential Insurance Company of America                             *
               dated August 30, 1994
10.(z)         First amendment to Lease Agreement dated August 30, 1994                                     *
10.(aa)        Senior Subordinated Note between Registrant and The Prudentiaal Insurance                    *
               Company of America dated June 30, 1994                                                       
10.(ab)        Fifth Amendment to the Restated Loan Agreement dated November 8, 1993                        31
10.(ac)        Sixth Amendment to the Restated Loan Agreement dated November 8, 1993                        33
10.(ad)        Lease agreement with The Prudential Insuance Company of America                              35
               dated May 2, 1995
</TABLE>
                                       29
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<S>            <C>                                                                                         <C>    
10.(ae)        First Amendment to Lease Agreeement dated May 2, 1995                                        68
10.(af)        Restated Loan Agreement dated June 29, 1995                                                  73
10.(ag)        Purchase Agreement with Knight-Ridder Financial dated July 13, 1995                         120
10.(ah)        Adjustment to Indenpendent Sales Representative Agreement dated March 28, 1995              151
               with Phil Huston
10.(ai)        Senior Subordinated Notes and Warrant Purchase Agreement dated June 30, 1994                152
10.(aj)        First Amendment to Senior Subordinated Notes and Warrant Purchase Agreement dated           267 
               June 30, 1994
11.            Statement re computation of income per share                                                270
13.            Registrant's 1995 Annual Report to Stockholders                                             272
23.            Consent of Deloitte & Touche  LLP                                                           325
27.            Financial Data Schedule for year ended 12/31/95                                             326  
99.            Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting of Stockholders                                      327
               of the Registrant to be held April 24, 1996
<FN>

*   - These  documents have been  incorporated by reference as indicated in Item
    14(a) (3).
</FN>
</TABLE>









                                       30
<PAGE>

                 FIFTH AMENDMENT TO 1993 RESTATED LOAN AGREEMENT


        THIS FIFTH  AMENDMENT  TO 1993  RESTATED  LOAN  AGREEMENT is intended to
amend the terms of the 1993 Restated Loan Agreement (the  "Agreement")  dated as
of  November  8, 1993,  as  amended  by the First  Amendment  to  Restated  Loan
Agreement (the "First  Amendment") dated as of April 11, 1994, as amended by the
Second  Amendment to and Extension of 1993 Restated Loan  Agreement (the "Second
Amendment") dated as of June 29, 1994, as amended by the Third Amendment to 1993
Restated Loan Agreement (the "Third  Amendment") dated as of August 30, 1994 and
as amended by the Fourth  Amendment to 1993 Restated Loan Agreement (the "Fourth
Amendment")  dated as of  November  29,  1994  among DATA  TRANSMISSION  NETWORK
CORPORATION,  FIRST NATIONAL BANK OF OMAHA, FIRSTIER BANK, NATIONAL ASSOCIATION,
LINCOLN, NEBRASKA, FIRST NATIONAL BANK, WAHOO, NEBRASKA, NBD BANK, N.A., NORWEST
BANK NEBRASKA,  N.A. and THE BOATMEN'S NATIONAL BANK OF ST. LOUIS. All terms and
conditions  of the  Agreement  shall  remain in full force and effect  except as
expressly  amended herein.  All capitalized terms herein shall have the meanings
prescribed in the Agreement. The Agreement shall be amended as follows:

        The parties hereby  acknowledge  that,  effective as of the date hereof,
$2,250,000 of the outstanding  balance of the Borrower's loan shall be converted
to a term loan in  accordance  with  Sections 2.3 and 2.4 of the  Agreement.  In
Section 2.1 of the  Agreement,  change the  reference  to the maximum  amount of
revolving  credit  advanced  from  $23,400,000  to  $21,150,000  and  reduce the
references to each Bank's maximum advance limit accordingly on a pro rata basis.
In connection  with this amendment the Borrower is  contemporaneously  executing
and delivering to the Banks six Secured  Business  Promissory  Notes dated as of
the date  hereof in the  respective  principal  amounts of  $699,750,  $418,500,
$22,500,  $418,500,  $396,000 and $294,750.  This amendment shall not affect and
there remain outstanding from the Borrower to the Banks, the Existing Term Notes
and the Related Bank Debt and those certain Secured  Business  Promissory  Notes
dated as of June 29, 1994, August 30, 1994 and November 29, 1994.

        This  Amendment  may  be  executed  in  several  counterparts  and  such
counterparts together shall constitute one and the same instrument.

        IN WITNESS  WHEREOF,  the undersigned have executed this FIFTH AMENDMENT
TO 1993 RESTATED LOAN AGREEMENT dated as of February 27, 1995.

                                              DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK
                                              CORPORATION


                                              By:     /s/  Greg T. Sloma
                                                      ------------------------
                                              Title:  Executive Vice President
                                                      and Chief Operating
                                                      Officer
                                                      -------------------------

                                       31
<PAGE>

                                            FIRST NATIONAL BANK OF OMAHA

                                          By:     /S/ James P. Bonham 
                                               --------------------------
                                          Title:  Vice President
                                               --------------------------


                                            FIRSTIER BANK, NATIONAL
                                            ASSOCIATION, LINCOLN, NEBRASKA


                                          By:     /s/ John Arrigo
                                               ----------------------------
                                          Title:  Officer
                                               ----------------------------
 

                                            FIRST NATIONAL BANK, WAHOO,
                                            NEBRASKA

                                          By:     /s/  Elizabeth E. Rezac
                                               ----------------------------
                                          Title:  Loan Officer
                                               ----------------------------

                                            NBD BANK, N.A.

                                          By:   /s/ Thomas A. Levasseur
                                               ----------------------------
                                          Title:  Vice President
                                               ----------------------------


                                            NORWEST BANK NEBRASKA, N.A.

                                         By:    /s/  Leslie J. Volk
                                               ----------------------------
                                          Title:  Vice President
                                               ----------------------------


                                            THE BOATMEN'S NATIONAL BANK
                                            OF ST. LOUIS


                                         By:    /s/ Joseph L. Scooter, Jr.
                                               ----------------------------
                                          Title:   Vice President
                                               ----------------------------

4429E/70-76



                                       32
<PAGE>


                 SIXTH AMENDMENT TO 1993 RESTATED LOAN AGREEMENT


        THIS SIXTH  AMENDMENT  TO 1993  RESTATED  LOAN  AGREEMENT is intended to
amend the terms of the 1993 Restated Loan Agreement (the  "Agreement")  dated as
of  November  8, 1993,  as  amended  by the First  Amendment  to  Restated  Loan
Agreement (the "First  Amendment") dated as of April 11, 1994, as amended by the
Second  Amendment to and Extension of 1993 Restated Loan  Agreement (the "Second
Amendment") dated as of June 29, 1994, as amended by the Third Amendment to 1993
Restated Loan Agreement (the "Third  Amendment") dated as of August 30, 1994, as
amended by the Fourth  Amendment to 1993  Restated Loan  Agreement  (the "Fourth
Amendment") dated as of November 29, 1994, and as amended by the Fifth Amendment
to 1993 Restated Loan Agreement (the "Fifth Amendment") dated as of February 27,
1995, among DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION, FIRST NATIONAL BANK OF OMAHA,
FIRSTIER BANK, NATIONAL  ASSOCIATION,  LINCOLN,  NEBRASKA,  FIRST NATIONAL BANK,
WAHOO, NEBRASKA,  NBD BANK, N.A., NORWEST BANK NEBRASKA,  N.A. and THE BOATMEN'S
NATIONAL BANK OF ST.  LOUIS.  All terms and  conditions  of the Agreement  shall
remain in full  force  and  effect  except  as  expressly  amended  herein.  All
capitalized  terms herein shall have the meanings  prescribed in the  Agreement.
The Agreement shall be amended as follows:

        (a)     The definition of "Consolidated Tangible Net Worth" in
        Article I of the Agreement shall be deleted.

        (b) The last sentence of Section 4.3 of the  Agreement  shall be deleted
        and all references in the Agreement to Section 4.3 shall, after the date
        hereof, exclude any reference to the omitted sentence.

        This  Amendment  may  be  executed  in  several  counterparts  and  such
counterparts together shall constitute one and the same instrument.

        IN WITNESS  WHEREOF,  the undersigned have executed this SIXTH AMENDMENT
TO 1993 RESTATED LOAN AGREEMENT dated as of April 28, 1995.

                                             DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK
                                             CORPORATION


                                             By:    /s/  Greg T. Sloma
                                                    ----------------------------
                                             Title:  Executive Vice President
                                                     and Chief Operating Officer
                                                     ---------------------------

                                       33
<PAGE>
                                            FIRST NATIONAL BANK OF OMAHA

                                          By:     /S/ James P. Bonham 
                                               --------------------------
                                          Title:  Vice President
                                               --------------------------


                                            FIRSTIER BANK, NATIONAL
                                            ASSOCIATION, LINCOLN, NEBRASKA


                                          By:     /s/ John Arrigo
                                               ----------------------------
                                          Title:  Officer
                                               ----------------------------
 

                                            FIRST NATIONAL BANK, WAHOO,
                                            NEBRASKA

                                          By:     /s/  Elizabeth E. Rezac
                                               ----------------------------
                                          Title:  Loan Officer
                                               ----------------------------

                                            NBD BANK, N.A.

                                          By:   /s/ Thomas A. Levasseur
                                               ----------------------------
                                          Title:  Vice President
                                               ----------------------------


                                            NORWEST BANK NEBRASKA, N.A.

                                         By:    /s/  Leslie J. Volk
                                               ----------------------------
                                          Title:  Vice President
                                               ----------------------------


                                            THE BOATMEN'S NATIONAL BANK
                                            OF ST. LOUIS


                                         By:    /s/ Joseph L. Scooter, Jr.
                                               ----------------------------
                                          Title:   Vice President
                                               ----------------------------


4429E/70-76
                                       34
<PAGE>


                                  EMBASSY PLAZA

                              STANDARD OFFICE LEASE


THIS LEASE is made this 2nd day of May, 1995,  between The Prudential  Insurance
Company  of  America,  having an office at One  Prudential  Plaza,  Suite  1200,
Chicago, Illinois 60601 ("Landlord"), and Data Transmission Network Corporation,
having an office at 9110 West Dodge  Road,  Suite 200,  Omaha,  Nebraska,  68114
("Tenant"),  for space in the building  located at 9110 West Dodge Road,  Omaha,
Nebraska  (such  building,  the  related  parking  areas,  driveways  and  other
improvement,  together  with the land  described in Exhibit "C" attached  hereto
upon which such building and improvements are situated, being herein referred to
as the "Building").

The following schedule sets forth certain basic terms of this Lease:


BASIC TERMS:

A.   Premises:  Approximately  75,931 rentable square feet (RSF) of space in the
     Building  described  above,  and more  specifically  known as Suites  #175A
     (10,144 RSF),  #110 (4,141 RSF),  #200 (27,719 RSF), #300 (2,268 RSF), #301
     (1,843 RSF),  #310 (5,970 RSF),  #320 (1,406 RSF),  #325 (2,177 RSF),  #340
     (12,477  RSF),  #360  (6,472),  and #362 (1,314 RSF), as shown on the floor
     plans  attached  hereto,  marked as Exhibits  "A", "B", and "C" and by this
     reference made a part hereof.

B.   Base Rent: Nine Million,  Nine Hundred  Sixty-Six  Thousand,  Eight Hundred
     Fifty-Six  Dollars and  Thirty-Seven  Cents  ($9,966,856.37)  for the Term,
     payable monthly as follows:

              May 1, 1995 - May 31, 1995  $64,496.94 June 1, 1995 - December 31,
              1997  $71,166.40  Per  Month  January  1,  1998  -  May  31,  2000
              $83,635.07  Per Month June 1, 2000 - May 31, 2005  $87,846.40  Per
              Month

C.   Term:  That period of time  commencing May 1, 1995; for Suites #110,  #200,
     #300,  #310, #340, #360, and #362; June 1, 1995, for Suites #301, #320. and
     #325;  and  January 1, 1998 for Suite 175A (the  "Commencement  Dates") and
     ending May 31, 2005, (the  "Expiration  Date") unless sooner  terminated as
     set forth herein.

D.   Tenant's  Proportionate  Share:  Tenant's  Proporationate  Share  shall  be
     equivilent  to the  percentage  Tenant's  total  leased  Premises is to the
     Building's  total  rentable  square feet (130,436  RSF). The following is a
     schedule  of Tenant's  Proporationate  Share  relative to the  Commencement
     Dates specified in Paragraph C of the Basic Terms:

     May 1, 1995 - May 31, 1995              46.37% (60,361 RSF / 130,173 RSF)
     June 1, 1995 - December 31, 1997        50.44% (65,787 RSF / 130,436 RSF)
     January 1, 1998 - May 31, 2005          58.21% (75,931 RSF / 130,436 RSF)

                                       35
<PAGE>
E.   Base Expense Year and Base Tax Year:  1994

F.   Security Deposit:  No Deposit Required

G.   Broker(s):  Pacific Realty Group, Inc. ("Broker")

H.   Guarantor(s):  None

I.   Exhibits:    A.  First Floor Plan of Premises
                  B.  Second Floor Plan of Premises
                  C.  Third Floor Plan of Premises
                  D.  Legal Description of Building
                  E.  Tenant Improvement Work Schedule
                  F.  Rules and Regulations
                  G.  Antenna License Agreement

1. DEMISE AND TERM.  Landlord  leases to Tenant and Tenant  leases from Landlord
the premises (the "Premises") described in Item "A" of the Basic Terms and shown
on the floor  plans,  attached  hereto as Exhibits  "A" and "B",  subject to the
covenants  and  conditions  set forth in this  Lease,  for a term  (the  "Term")
commencing  on  the  Commencement  Date  and  expiring  on the  Expiration  Date
described in Item C of the Basic Terms,  unless terminated  earlier as otherwise
provided  in this  Lease.  If Tenant  shall  occupy  the  Premises  prior to the
beginning of the Term of this Lease with Landlord's consent,  all the provisions
of this Lease shall be in full force and effect as soon as Tenant  occupies  the
Premises.

2.  RENT.

A.   Definitions. For purposes of this Lease, the following terms shall have the
     following meanings:

     (i)  "Base  Expenses" or "Base  Expense  Year" shall mean the amount or the
          year set forth in Item E of the Basic Terms

     (ii) "Expenses" shall mean all expenses, costs and disbursements (including
          Taxes) paid or incurred by Landlord in connection  with the ownership,
          management,  maintenance,  operation,  replacement  and  repair of the
          Building. Expenses shall not include: (a) costs of tenant alterations;
          (b) costs of capital  improvements  (except  for costs of any  capital
          improvements made or installed for the purpose of reducing Expenses or
          made or installed  pursuant to  governmental  requirement or insurance
          requirement,  which costs shall be amortized by Landlord in accordance
          with sound  accounting  and management  principles);  (c) interest and
          principal  payments on mortgages  (except  interest on the cost of any
          capital  improvements  for which  amortization  may be included in the
          definition  of Expenses) or any rental  payments on any ground  leases
          (except for rental payments which constitute  reimbursement  for Taxes
          and Expenses);  (d) advertising expenses and leasing commissions;  (e)
          any cost or expenditure  for which Landlord is reimbursed,  whether by
          insurance  proceeds  or  otherwise,  except  through  Adjustment  Rent
          (hereinafter  defined);  (f) the cost of any kind of service furnished
          to any other tenant in the Building  which Landlord does not generally
          make  available to all tenants in the Building;  (g) legal expenses of
          negotiating  leases;  (h)  salaries  and fringe  benefits of employees


                                       36
<PAGE>

          above the grade of building manager. Expenses shall be determined on a
          cash or accrual basis, as Landlord may elect.

     (iii)"Rent"  shall  mean Base Rent,  Adjustment  Rent and any other sums or
          charges due by Tenant hereunder.

     (iv) "Taxes"  shall mean all taxes,  assessments  and fees  levied upon the
          Building,  the  property  of  Landlord  located  therein  or the rents
          collected  therefrom,  by  any  governmental  entity  based  upon  the
          ownership,  leasing,  renting or operation of the Building,  including
          all costs and expenses of protesting  any such taxes,  assessments  or
          fees.  Taxes  shall  not  include  any  net  income,   capital  stock,
          succession,  transfer,  franchise,  gift, estate or inheritance taxes;
          provided,  however, if at any time during the Term, a tax or excise on
          income is levied or assessed by any governmental entity, in lieu of or
          as a substitute  for, in whole or in part,  real estate taxes or other
          ad valorem taxes,  such tax shall constitute and be included in Taxes.
          For the purpose of determining Taxes for any given year, the amount to
          be  included  for such year (a) from  special  assessments  payable in
          installments  shall  be  the  amount  of  the  installments  (and  any
          interest)  due and payable  during  such year,  and (b) from all other
          Taxes  shall at  Landlord's  election  either be the  amount  accrued,
          assessed  or  otherwise  imposed  for such year or the  amount due and
          payable in such year.

     (v)  "Tenant's  Proportionate Share" shall mean the percentage set forth in
          Item D of the Basic Terms which has been  determined  by dividing  the
          rentable  square feet in the Premises by the  rentable  square feet in
          the Building.

B.   Components of Rent.  Tenant agrees to pay the following amounts to Landlord
     at  the  office  of  the  Building  or at  such  other  place  as  Landlord
     designates:

     (i)  Base rent  ("Base  Rent") to be paid in  monthly  installments  in the
          amount set forth in Item B of the Basic  Terms in advance on or before
          the first day of each month of the Term,  except that Tenant shall pay
          the first month's Base Rent upon execution of this Lease.

     (ii) Adjustment  rent  ("Adjustment  Rent") in an amount  equal to Tenant's
          Proportionate  Share of (a) the  increase in Expenses for any calendar
          year  over the Base  Expenses  and (b) the  increase  in Taxes for any
          calendar  year over the Base  Taxes.  (If the Basic  Terms set forth a
          Base  Expense  Year and a Base Tax Year rather than Base  Expenses and
          Base  Taxes,  the Base  Expenses  and the Base Taxes  shall  equal the
          amount of Expenses and Taxes, respectively,  for the Base Expense Year
          and the Base Tax Year.) Prior to each calendar  year,  Landlord  shall
          estimate the amount of Adjustment  Rent due for such year,  and Tenant
          shall pay Landlord  one-twelfth  of such  estimate on the first day of
          each month during such year.  Such estimate may be revised by Landlord
          whenever it obtains information  relevant to making such estimate more
          accurate.  After the end of each calendar year, Landlord shall deliver
          to Tenant a report  setting  forth the actual  Expenses  and Taxes for
          such calendar  year and a statement of the amount of  Adjustment  Rent


                                       37
<PAGE>

          that Tenant has paid and is payable for such year.  Within thirty days
          after receipt of such report,  Tenant shall pay to Landlord the amount
          of Adjustment  Rent due for such calendar year,  minus any payments of
          Adjustment  Rent made by Tenant for such year.  If Tenant's  estimated
          payments of  Adjustment  Rent exceed the amount due  Landlord for such
          calendar  year,  Landlord  shall apply such excess as a credit against
          Tenant's other  obligations  under this Lease or promptly  refund such
          excess to Tenant if the Term has already  expired,  provided Tenant is
          not then in default  hereunder,  in either  case  without  interest to
          Tenant.

C. Payment of Rent. The following  provisions  shall govern the payment of Rent:
(i) if this  Lease  commences  or ends on a day other than the first day or last
day of a calendar month, the Rent for the month in which this Lease so begins or
ends shall be prorated and adjusted accordingly;  (ii) all Rent shall be paid to
Landlord  without  offset or  deduction,  and the  covenant to pay Rent shall be
independent  of every other  covenant in this Lease;  (iii) if during all or any
portion of any year the Building is not fully rented and occupied,  Landlord may
elect to make an appropriate  adjustment of Expenses  and/or Taxes for such year
to determine  the Expenses that would have been paid or incurred by Landlord had
the  Building  been fully rented and occupied for the entire year and the amount
so  determined  shall be deemed to have been the Expenses  and/or Taxes for such
year;  (iv) any sum due from Tenant to Landlord which is not paid when due shall
bear  interest  from the date due  until  the date  paid at the  annual  rate of
eighteen  percent (18%) or the maximum rate permitted by law,  whichever is less
(the "Default Rate"); and, in addition,  Tenant shall pay Landlord a late charge
for any Rent payment  which is paid more than five days after its due date equal
to five  percent of such  payment;  (v) if changes are made to this Lease or the
Building  changing the number of square feet contained in the Premises or in the
Building,   Landlord   shall  make  an   appropriate   adjustment   to  Tenant's
Proportionate  Share;  (vi)  Tenant  shall have the right to inspect  Landlord's
accounting  records  relative to Expenses and Taxes during normal business hours
at any time within thirty days  following the furnishing to Tenant of the annual
statement of Rent Adjustment; and, unless Tenant shall take written exception to
any item in any such  statement  within such thirty day period,  such  statement
shall be considered  as final and accepted by Tenant;  (vii) in the event of the
termination of this Lease prior to the  determination  of any  Adjustment  Rent,
Tenant's agreement to pay any such sums and Landlord's  obligation to refund any
such sums  (provided  Tenant is not in  default  hereunder)  shall  survive  the
termination  of this Lease;  (viii) no  adjustment  to the Rent by virtue of the
operation of the rent  adjustment  provisions  in this Lease shall result in the
payment  by Tenant in any year of less than the Base Rent set forth in Item B of
the Basic  Terms;  (ix)  Landlord  may at any time change the fiscal year of the
Building;  (x) each amount owed to Landlord  under this Lease for which the date
of  payment  is not  expressly  fixed  shall be due on the same date as the Rent
listed on the statement  showing such amount is due; and (xi) if Landlord  fails
to give Tenant an  estimate of  Adjustment  Rent prior to the  beginning  of any
calendar year, Tenant shall continue to pay Adjustment Rent, as the case may be,
at the  rate  for the  previous  calendar  year  until  Landlord  delivers  such
estimate.

D.  Allocation of Rent.  (INTENTIONALLY DELETED)

                                       38
<PAGE>

3. USE. Tenant agrees that it shall occupy and use the Premises only as business
offices and for no other purposes.  Tenant shall comply with all federal,  state
and municipal laws, ordinances and regulations and all covenants, conditions and
restrictions of record  applicable to Tenant's use or occupancy of the Premises.
Without  limiting  the  foregoing,  Tenant  shall not  cause,  nor  permit,  any
hazardous  or toxic  substances  to be brought  upon,  produced,  stored,  used,
discharged or disposed of in, on or about the Premises without the prior written
consent  of  Landlord  and  then  only  in   compliance   with  all   applicable
environmental  laws.  If as a result of  Tenant's  use of the  Premises  (a) the
amount of insurance  premiums  payable by Landlord for  insurance  maintained by
Landlord for or in respect to the Building is increased,  (b) any such insurance
coverage  is  decreased,  or (c)  cancellation  or  refusal  to  renew  any such
insurance  policy is  threatened,  Landlord  shall so notify  Tenant,  whereupon
Tenant shall  immediately pay any such increased  premium or cease any such use,
failing which (or in the event of a threatened  cancellation or refusal to renew
any such insurance policy which may not be cured by the payment of an additional
premium)  Landlord  shall have the right and option,  in addition to  Landlord's
other rights and remedies hereunder, to terminate this Lease upon written notice
to Tenant effective on the date set forth in such notice.

4. CONDITION OF PREMISES.  Tenant's  taking  possession of the Premises shall be
conclusive  evidence  that the  Premises  were in good  order  and  satisfactory
condition  when  Tenant  took  possession.  No  agreement  of Landlord to alter,
remodel,  decorate, clean or improve the Premises or the Building (or to provide
Tenant  with any  credit  or  allowance  for the  same),  and no  representation
regarding the condition of the Premises or the Building, have been made by or on
behalf of Landlord or relied upon by Tenant,  except as stated  herein or in the
Tenant  Improvement  Work Schedule  executed by Landlord and Tenant and attached
hereto as Exhibit "E".

5.  BUILDING SERVICES.

A. Basic Services.  Landlord shall furnish the following  services:  (i) heating
and air conditioning to provide a temperature  condition required, in Landlord's
judgment,  for  comfortable  occupancy  of the Premises  under  normal  business
operations,  daily from 7:30 A.M. to 6:00 P.M.  (Saturday from 8:00 A.M. to 1:00
P.M.), Sundays and holidays excepted;  (ii) water for drinking,  and, subject to
Landlord's  approval,  water at Tenant's  expense for any private  restrooms and
office  kitchen  requested  by Tenant;  (iii)  men's and  women's  restrooms  at
locations designated by Landlord,  in common with other tenants of the Building;
(iv) daily  janitor  service in the Premises  and common areas of the  Building,
weekends and holidays excepted and (v) passenger elevator service in common with
Landlord and other tenants of the Building,  24 hours a day, 7 days a week;  and
freight elevator service daily, weekends and holidays excepted,  upon request of
Tenant and subject to scheduling  and charges by Landlord.  Notwithstanding  the
above,  Tenant  will not be  required to meter and pay for water used within the
Premises  (except  through the  provisions  of paragraph  2B(ii) as an Expense),
unless Tenant installs special  equipment that  specifically  utilizes water for
processing or cooling, such as but not limited to air conditioning or computers,
excluding drinking fountains.

B.  Electricity.  Electricity shall be distributed to the Premises either by the
electric  utility  company  serving the Building or, at  Landlord's  option,  by
Landlord,  and Landlord shall permit Landlord's wire and conduits, to the extent


                                       39
<PAGE>
available, suitable and safely capable, to be used for such distribution. If and
so long as Landlord is  distributing  electricity to the Premises,  Tenant shall
obtain all of its  electricity  from  Landlord  and shall pay all of  Landlord's
charges,  which charges shall be based,  at Landlord's  option,  either on meter
readings  or on a survey of  Tenant's  electrical  usage made by  Landlord or on
Tenant's prorata share of all space,  including the Premises,  which is commonly
metered with the  Premises.  If the  electric  utility  company is  distributing
electricity  to the  Premises,  Tenant  at its cost  shall  make  all  necessary
arrangements  with the  electric  utility  company for  metering  and paying for
electric current furnished to the Premises.

C. Telephones.  Tenant shall arrange for telephone  service directly with one or
more of the public  telephone  companies  servicing  the  Building  and shall be
solely responsible for paying for such telephone  service.  If Landlord acquires
ownership of the telephone  cables in the Building at any time,  Landlord  shall
permit Tenant to connect to such cables on such terms and conditions as Landlord
may  prescribe.  In no event does Landlord make any  representation  or warranty
with respect to telephone  service in the Building,  and Landlord  shall have no
liability with respect thereto.

D. Additional Services.  Landlord shall not be obligated to furnish any services
other than those stated above. If Landlord elects to furnish services  requested
by Tenant in addition to those stated above  (including  services at times other
than those stated above),  Tenant shall pay Landlord's then  prevailing  charges
for such services as Additional Rent within ten (10) days of Landlord's  invoice
therefor.  If Tenant shall fail to make any such payment,  Landlord may, without
notice to Tenant and in addition to all other  remedies  available  to Landlord,
discontinue any additional services. No discontinuance of any such service shall
result in any liability of Landlord to Tenant or be considered as an eviction or
a  disturbance  of  Tenant's  use of the  Premises.  In  addition,  if  Tenant's
concentration  of personnel or equipment  adversely  affects the  temperature or
humidity in the Premises or the Building, Landlord may install supplementary air
conditioning  units  in the  Premises;  and  Tenant  shall  pay for the  cost of
installation, utility charges, and maintenance thereof.

E. Failure or Delay in Furnishing  Services.  Tenant agrees that Landlord  shall
not be liable for damages for failure or delay in furnishing  any service stated
above if such  failure  or delay is caused,  in whole or in part,  by any one or
more of the events stated in Section 25(j) below,  nor shall any such failure or
delay be  considered  to be an eviction or  disturbance  of Tenant's  use of the
Premises, or relieve Tenant from its obligation to pay any Rent when due or from
any other obligations of Tenant under this Lease.

6. RULES AND REGULATIONS.  Tenant shall observe and comply,  and shall cause its
subtenants,  assignees,  invitees, employees,  contractors and agents to observe
and comply, with the rules and regulations listed on Exhibit "E" attached hereto
and with such  reasonable  modifications  and additions  thereto as Landlord may
make from time to time.  Landlord  shall not be liable for failure of any person
to obey such rules and  regulations.  Landlord shall not be obligated to enforce
such rules and  regulations  against any person,  and the failure of Landlord to
enforce any such rules and regulations  shall not constitute a waiver thereof or
relieve Tenant from compliance therewith.



                                       40
<PAGE>
7. CERTAIN RIGHTS RESERVED TO LANDLORD.  Landlord reserves the following rights,
each of which  Landlord  may  exercise  without  notice  to Tenant  and  without
liability to Tenant,  and the exercise of any such rights shall not be deemed to
constitute  an eviction or  disturbance  of Tenant's  use or  possession  of the
Premises  and shall not give rise to any claim for set-off or  abatement of rent
or any other claim:  (a) to change the name or street address of the Building or
the suite number of the Premises; (b) to install, affix and maintain any and all
signs  on the  exterior  or  interior  of the  Building;  (c) to  make  repairs,
decorations,  alterations,  additions,  or improvements,  whether  structural or
otherwise,  in and about the  Building,  and for such purposes to enter upon the
Premises, temporarily close doors, corridors and other areas in the Building and
interrupt or  temporarily  suspend  services or use of common areas,  and Tenant
agrees to pay Landlord for overtime and similar  expenses  incurred if such work
is done other than during ordinary  business hours at Tenant's  request;  (d) to
retain at all  times,  and to use in  appropriate  instances,  keys to all doors
within and into the  Premises;  (e) to grant to any  person or to  reserve  unto
itself the exclusive  right to conduct any business or render any service in the
Building;  (f) to show or inspect  the  Premises  at  reasonable  times and,  if
vacated or abandoned,  to prepare the Premises for reoccupancy;  (g) to install,
use and maintain in and through the Premises  pipes,  conduits,  wires and ducts
serving the Building, provided that such installation,  use and maintenance does
not  unreasonably  interfere with Tenant's use of the Premises;  and (h) to take
any  other  action  which  Landlord  deems  reasonable  in  connection  with the
operation,  maintenance or  preservation  of the Building.  Notwithstanding  the
above,  Landlord shall not change the name of the Building  without the Tenant's
prior  approval,  which shall not be  unreasonably  withheld.  In addition,  the
Tenant's suite numbers will not be changed without prior approval of the Tenant,
which shall not unreasonably be withheld.

8. MAINTENANCE AND REPAIRS.  Tenant, at its expense, shall maintain and keep the
Premises  in good order and repair at all times  during the Term.  In  addition,
Tenant  shall  reimburse  Landlord  for the cost of any repairs to the  Building
necessitated  by the acts or omissions  of Tenant,  its  subtenants,  assignees,
invitees,  employees,  contractors  and  agents,  to the extent  Landlord is not
reimbursed for such costs under its insurance policies. Subject to the preceding
sentence,  Landlord  shall  perform any  maintenance  or make any repairs to the
Building as Landlord shall desire or deem necessary for the safety, operation or
preservation of the Building,  or as Landlord may be required or requested to do
by the City of Omaha,  Nebraska or by the order or decree of any court or by any
other proper authority.

9.  ALTERATIONS.

A. Requirements. Tenant shall not make any replacement,  alteration, improvement
or addition  to or removal  from the  Premises  (collectively  an  "alteration")
without the prior written  consent of Landlord.  In the event Tenant proposes to
make any alteration,  Tenant shall, prior to commencing such alteration,  submit
to Landlord for prior written approval:  (i) detailed plans and  specifications;
(ii) sworn  statements,  including the names,  addresses and copies of contracts
for all contractors;  (iii) all necessary permits evidencing compliance with all
applicable governmental rules,  regulations and requirements;  (iv) certificates
of insurance in form and amounts  required by Landlord,  naming Landlord and any
other parties designated by Landlord as additional  insureds;  and (v) all other
documents and information as Landlord may reasonably  request in connection with


                                       41
<PAGE>
such alteration.  Tenant agrees to pay Landlord's standard charges for review of
all such items and supervision of the alteration.  Neither approval of the plans
and   specifications  nor  supervision  of  the  alteration  by  Landlord  shall
constitute  a  representation  or  warranty  by  Landlord  as to  the  accuracy,
adequacy,  sufficiency  or  propriety  of such plans and  specifications  or the
quality of workmanship or the compliance of such alteration with applicable law.
Tenant  shall  pay the  entire  cost of the  alteration  and,  if  requested  by
Landlord,  shall  deposit  with  Landlord,  prior  to  the  commencement  of the
alteration,  security for the payment and  completion of the  alteration in form
and amount required by Landlord.  Each  alteration  shall be performed in a good
and workmanlike manner, in accordance with the plans and specifications approved
by Landlord, and shall meet or exceed the standards for construction and quality
of  materials  established  by Landlord  for the  Building.  In  addition,  each
alteration shall be performed in compliance with all applicable governmental and
insurance  company  laws,  regulations  and  requirements,   including,  without
limitation,  all  requirements  of The  Americans  with  Disabilities  Act. Each
alteration shall be performed in harmony with Landlord's employees,  contractors
and other tenants. Each alteration, whether temporary or permanent in character,
made by  Landlord or Tenant in or upon the  Premises  (excepting  only  Tenant's
furniture,  equipment and trade fixtures) shall become  Landlord's  property and
shall remain upon the Premises at the  expiration or  termination  of this Lease
without compensation to Tenant; provided,  however, that Landlord shall have the
right to require  Tenant to remove such  alteration  at  Tenant's  sole cost and
expense  in  accordance  with  the  provisions  of  Section  15 of  this  Lease.
Notwithstanding  the above,  Landlord  recognizes  Tenant  will  arrange for and
supervise  its own  construction.  Landlord's  charges  for  review of plans and
construction  will be limited to the actual cost of any third party  consultants
reasonably  required  by  Landlord  (such as,  but not  limited  to,  Structural
Engineers,   Mechanical/Electrical   Engineers,  or  Architects).  In  addition,
Landlord recognizes that Tenant may relocate its existing self contained package
air conditioning units (with no network of above ceiling ductwork) to supplement
the  Building's  system  in the  Premises.  If  such is the  case  or if  Tenant
purchases with its own funds and installs similar type units, upon expiration or
termination  of this Lease,  Tenant will be allowed to or Landlord,  at its sole
discretion,  may require  Tenant to remove such units at Tenant's  sole cost and
expense  in  accordance  with  the  provisions  of  Section  15 of  this  Lease.
Notwithstanding the above, Landlord as a part of its review of Tenant's proposed
alterations  under  this  Paragraph  9, shall  stipulate  at the time the Tenant
requests  approval of the proposed  alterations,  any proposed  alterations that
will be required to be removed by Tenant upon  surrender  of the Premises by the
Tenant.

B. Liens.  Upon  completion of any  alteration,  Tenant shall  promptly  furnish
Landlord  with sworn  owner's  and  contractors'  statements  and full and final
waivers of lien  covering all labor and materials  included in such  alteration.
Tenant shall not permit any mechanic's lien to be filed against the Building, or
any part thereof,  arising out of any alteration  performed,  or alleged to have
been  performed,  by or on behalf of Tenant.  If any such lien is filed,  Tenant
shall within ten days thereafter have such lien released of record or deliver to
Landlord  a bond in  form,  amount,  and  issued  by a  surety  satisfactory  to
Landlord, indemnifying Landlord against all costs and liabilities resulting from
such lien and the foreclosure or attempted  foreclosure thereof. If Tenant fails
to have such lien so released  or to deliver  such bond to  Landlord,  Landlord,
without  investigating the validity of such lien, may pay or discharge the same;
and  Tenant  shall  reimburse  Landlord  upon  demand  for the amount so paid by
Landlord, including Landlord's expenses and attorneys' fees.

                                       42
<PAGE>
10. INSURANCE.  Tenant,  at its expense,  shall maintain at all times during the
Term the following  insurance policies:  (a) fire insurance,  including extended
coverage,  vandalism,  malicious  mischief,  sprinkler  leakage and water damage
coverage and demolition and debris removal,  insuring the full  replacement cost
of all  improvements,  alterations or additions to the Premises made at Tenant's
expense,  and all other  property  owned or used by Tenant  and  located  in the
Premises;  (b) commercial  general liability  insurance,  contractual  liability
insurance  and property  damage  insurance  with respect to the Building and the
Premises,  with limits to be set by Landlord  from time to time but in any event
not less than $3,000,000 combined single limit for personal injury,  sickness or
death or for damage to or  destruction of property for any one  occurrence;  and
(c) insurance against such other risks and in such other amounts as Landlord may
from  time to time  require.  The  form of all  such  policies  and  deductibles
thereunder  shall be subject to  Landlord's  prior  approval.  All such policies
shall be issued by insurers  acceptable  to Landlord and licensed to do business
in the State of Nebraska and shall contain a waiver of any rights of subrogation
thereunder.  In addition, the policies shall name Landlord and any other parties
designated  by Landlord as  additional  insureds,  shall require at least thirty
days' prior written notice to Landlord of termination or modification  and shall
be primary and not  contributory.  Tenant shall,  at least ten days prior to the
Commencement  Date,  and within ten days  prior to the  expiration  of each such
policy,  deliver to Landlord certificates  evidencing the foregoing insurance or
renewal thereof, as the case may be.

11.  WAIVER AND INDEMNITY.

A.  Waiver.  Tenant  releases  Landlord,   Landlord's  beneficiaries  and  their
respective  agents and  employees  from,  and waives all claims  for,  damage or
injury  to person or  property  and loss of  business  sustained  by Tenant  and
resulting from the Building or the Premises or any part thereof or any equipment
therein  becoming in disrepair,  or resulting  from any accident in or about the
Building.  This paragraph  shall apply  particularly,  but not  exclusively,  to
flooding, damage caused by Building equipment and apparatus, water, snow, frost,
steam, excessive heat or cold, broken glass, sewage, gas, odors, excessive noise
or vibration or the bursting or leaking of pipes, plumbing fixtures or sprinkler
devices.  Without  limiting the generality of the  foregoing,  Tenant waives all
claims and rights of recovery against  Landlord,  Landlord's  beneficiaries  and
their respective  agents and employees for any loss or damage to any property of
Tenant,  which  loss or damage is insured  against,  or  required  to be insured
against,  by Tenant  pursuant  to Section 10 above,  whether or not such loss or
damage is due to the fault or  negligence  of  Landlord  or such  beneficiaries,
agents  or  employees,  and  regardless  of the  amount  of  insurance  proceeds
collected or collectible under any insurance policies in effect.

B.  Indemnity.  Tenant agrees to indemnify,  defend and hold harmless  Landlord,
Landlord's  beneficiaries  and their respective  agents and employees,  from and
against any and all claims, demands,  actions,  liabilities,  damages, costs and
expenses (including  attorneys' fees), for injuries to any persons and damage to
or theft or  misappropriation  or loss of  property  occurring  in or about  the
Building  and arising  from the use and  occupancy  of the  Premises or from any
activity,  work, or thing done,  permitted or suffered by Tenant in or about the
Premises (including,  without limitation,  any alteration by Tenant) or from any
breach or default on the part of Tenant in the  performance  of any  covenant or
agreement on the part of Tenant to be  performed  under this Lease or due to any
other act or omission of Tenant, its subtenants, assignees, invitees, employees,

                                       43
<PAGE>
contractors and agents. Without limiting the foregoing,  Tenant shall indemnify,
defend and hold Landlord harmless from any claims,  liabilities,  damages, costs
and expenses  arising out of the use or storage of hazardous or toxic  materials
in the Building by Tenant.  If any such proceeding is filed against  Landlord or
any such  indemnified  party,  Tenant agrees to defend Landlord or such party in
such proceeding at Tenant's sole cost by legal counsel  reasonably  satisfactory
to Landlord, if requested by Landlord.

12.  FIRE AND  CASUALTY.  If all or a  substantial  part of the  Premises or the
Building is rendered untenantable by reason of fire or other casualty,  Landlord
may, at its option,  either restore the Premises and the Building,  or terminate
this Lease  effective  as of the date of such fire or other  casualty.  Landlord
agrees to give Tenant  written  notice within sixty days after the occurrence of
any such  fire or other  casualty  designating  whether  Landlord  elects  to so
restore or terminate  this Lease.  If Landlord  elects to terminate  this Lease,
Rent shall be paid through and  apportioned as of the date of such fire or other
casualty.  If Landlord elects to restore,  Landlord's  obligation to restore the
Premises  shall be limited  to  restoring  those  improvements  in the  Premises
existing  as of the  date of such  fire or other  casualty  which  were  made at
Landlord's  expense  and  shall  exclude  any  furniture,  equipment,  fixtures,
additions,  alterations or improvements in or to the Premises which were made at
Tenant's expense. If Landlord elects to restore,  Rent shall abate for that part
of the Premises which is  untenantable on a per diem basis from the date of such
fire or other casualty until Landlord has substantially completed its repair and
restoration work, provided that Tenant does not occupy such part of the Premises
during said  period.  If the  restoration  takes longer than two hundred and ten
(210) days or if such damage  occurs during the last eighteen (18) months of the
Lease Term,  the Tenant shall have the option to terminate  this Lease as of the
date of casualty by submitting written notice to the Landlord.

13.  CONDEMNATION.  If the Premises or the Building is rendered  untenantable by
reason of a condemnation (or by a deed given in lieu thereof), then either party
may terminate  this Lease by giving  written  notice of termination to the other
party  within  thirty  days after such  condemnation,  in which event this Lease
shall terminate effective as of the date of such condemnation.  If this Lease so
terminates,  Rent shall be paid through and  apportioned  as of the date of such
condemnation.  If such condemnation does not render the Premises or the Building
untenantable,  this Lease shall  continue in effect and Landlord  shall promptly
restore the  portion  not  condemned  to the extent  reasonably  possible to the
condition existing prior to the condemnation.  In such event, however,  Landlord
shall not be required to expend an amount in excess of the proceeds  received by
Landlord  from  the  condemning  authority.  Landlord  reserves  all  rights  to
compensation for any  condemnation.  Tenant hereby assigns to Landlord any right
Tenant may have to such  compensation,  and Tenant  shall make no claim  against
Landlord  or the  condemning  authority  for  compensation  for  termination  of
Tenant's  leasehold  interest  under this Lease or  interference  with  Tenant's
business,  unless Tenant is entitled by applicable  law to separate  award which
does not diminish or reduce award otherwise made to Landlord.

14.  ASSIGNMENT AND SUBLETTING.  The Tenant  covenants and agrees not to assign,
sublet,  license or grant a  concession  or part with  possession  of the leased
premises or any part thereof  without first obtaining the written consent of the
Landlord,  except  in the case of  assignment  or  sublet  to  Tenant  affiliate
company,  provided  assignee or sublessee  affiliate  company has, at a minimum,
equal credit worthiness as Tenant such consent not to be unreasonable withheld.

                                       44
<PAGE>
Provided that in any such assignment, subletting, license, concession or parting
with  possession,  the Landlord  shall  reserve its right to approve any further
assignment, license or concession or parting with possession and may require the
Assignee,  Sublessee,  Licensee,  Concessionaire  or person taking possession to
covenant  directly  with the  Landlord to  observe,  perform and comply with the
event  of such  assignment,  subletting  license,  concession  or  parting  with
possession,   all  monies   payable  by  the  Assignee,   Sublessee,   Licensee,
Concessionaire  or  person  taking  possession  shall  be paid  directly  to the
Landlord,  who shall credit the same as payments required and reserve hereunder.
The  Landlord  shall be  entitled  to receive any excess of such monies over and
above monies  payable and reserved  hereunder,  for its own use  absolutely  and
forever.  Tenant shall remain responsible for all of the terms and conditions of
this Lease,  except in the case when an assignment has been approved by Landlord
to an assignee to have, at a minimum, equal credit worthiness as Tenant.

If at any time herein: (i) any person other than the Tenant has or exercises the
right to manage or control the leased  premises,  or any part  thereof or any of
the  business  carried  on  therein  other  than  subject to the direct and full
supervisions and control of the Landlord; or (ii) effective control of the Lease
is acquired or exercised by any person or persons not having  effective  control
of the same shall constitute a default entitling the Landlord, at its option, to
terminate  this Lease,  unless prior  thereto the Tenant shall have received the
written consent of the Landlord.

As an alternative to such consent (and without being so obliged or affecting its
other  rights) the Landlord at its option,  shall have the right  within  thirty
(30)  days of its being  asked for such  consent  to, by  written  notice to the
Tenant,  cancel this Lease as of and from the date at which the Tenant wishes to
assign,  sublet,  license or grant a concession  or part with  possession of the
leased premises or any part thereof;  provided the Tenant shall have thirty (30)
days from the date of its  receipt of such  written  notice to deliver a written
revocation  of such  request  for  consent to the  Landlord;  in which event the
Landlord's  right to cancel pursuant to this Paragraph 14 shall be deemed lapsed
until the next such request.

Any  attempt  to assign,  sublet,  license  or grant a  concession  or part with
possession of the leased premises or any part thereof without complying with the
terms and provisions of this Paragraph shall be null and void.

15.  SURRENDER.  Upon termination of the Term or Tenant's right to possession of
the  Premises,  Tenant  shall  return the Premises to Landlord in good order and
condition,  ordinary  wear and  damage by fire or other  casualty  excepted.  If
Landlord  requires Tenant to remove any alterations  pursuant to Section 9, then
such  removal  shall be done in a good and  workmanlike  manner;  and upon  such
removal  Tenant  shall  restore  the  Premises  to its  condition  prior  to the
installation  of such  alterations.  If Tenant does not remove such  alterations
after request to do so by Landlord, Landlord may remove the same and restore the
Premises;  and Tenant  shall pay the cost of such  removal  and  restoration  to
Landlord,  plus a fee equal to  twenty  percent  (20%) of  Landlord's  cost,  as
Additional Rent upon demand. Tenant shall also remove its furniture,  equipment,
trade fixtures and all other items of personal  property from the Premises prior
to termination  of the Term or Tenant's right to possession of the Premises.  If
Tenant does not remove such items, Tenant shall be conclusively presumed to have
conveyed the same to Landlord  without  further payment or credit by Landlord to
Tenant;  or at Landlord's sole option such items shall be deemed  abandoned,  in
which  event  Landlord  may cause such items to be removed  and  disposed  of at

                                       45
<PAGE>
Tenant's  expense without notice to Tenant and without  obligation to compensate
Tenant.

16.  DEFAULTS AND REMEDIES.

A. Default. The occurrence of any of the following shall constitute a default (a
"Default") by Tenant under this Lease: (i) Tenant fails to pay any Rent when due
and such failure is not cured within five days after notice from Landlord (which
notice may be in the form of a landlord statutory five-day notice);  (ii) Tenant
fails to perform any other provision of this Lease and such failure is not cured
within  thirty  days  (or  immediately  if  the  failure  involves  a  hazardous
condition) after notice from Landlord; (iii) the leasehold interest of Tenant is
levied upon or attached  under  process of law;  (iv) Tenant or any guarantor of
this Lease dies or  dissolves;  (v) Tenant  vacates  the  Premises;  or (vi) any
voluntary  or  involuntary  proceedings  are filed by or  against  Tenant or any
guarantor of this Lease under any bankruptcy, insolvency or similar laws and, in
the case of any involuntary  proceedings,  are not dismissed  within thirty days
after filing.

B. Right of Re-Entry.  Upon the  occurrence of a Default,  Landlord may elect to
terminate  this Lease or, without  terminating  this Lease,  terminate  Tenant's
right to  possession of the Premises.  Upon any such  termination,  Tenant shall
immediately  surrender and vacate the Premises and deliver possession thereof to
Landlord.  Tenant  grants  to  Landlord  the right to enter  and  repossess  the
Premises and to expel  Tenant and any others who may be  occupying  the Premises
and to remove any and all property therefrom, without being deemed in any manner
guilty of trespass and without  relinquishing  Landlord's  rights to Rent or any
other right given to Landlord hereunder or by operation of law.

C.  Reletting.  If  Landlord  terminates  Tenant's  right to  possession  of the
Premises without terminating this Lease,  Landlord may relet the Premises or any
part thereof.  In such case,  Landlord shall use reasonable efforts to relet the
Premises on such terms as Landlord shall reasonably deem appropriate;  provided,
however, Landlord may first lease Landlord's other available space and shall not
be  required  to  accept  any  tenant  offered  by  Tenant  or  to  observe  any
instructions  given  by  Tenant  about  such  reletting.  If  the  consideration
collected by Landlord upon any such reletting,  after payment of the expenses of
reletting the Premises which have not been reimbursed by Tenant, is greater than
the amount necessary to pay the full amount of the Rent, the full amount of such
excess shall be retained by Landlord and shall in no event be payable to Tenant.

D. Termination of Lease. If Landlord terminates this Lease, Landlord may recover
from Tenant and Tenant shall pay to Landlord,  on demand,  as and for liquidated
and final damages,  an accelerated  lump sum amount equal to the amount by which
Landlord's  estimate of the aggregate amount of Rent owing from the date of such
termination  through  the  Expiration  Date  plus  Landlord's  estimate  of  the
aggregate expenses of reletting the Premises, exceeds Landlord's estimate of the
fair rental value of the Premises for the same period (after deducting from such
fair  rental  value  the time  needed to relet the  Premises  and the  amount of
concessions  which would  normally be given to a new tenant) both  discounted to
present value at the rate of five percent per annum.



                                       46
<PAGE>
E. Other  Remedies.  Landlord  may but shall not be  obligated  to  perform  any
obligation of Tenant under this Lease; and, if Landlord so elects, all costs and
expenses paid by Landlord in performing such obligation,  together with interest
at the Default Rate,  shall be  reimbursed by Tenant to Landlord on demand.  Any
and all  remedies  set forth in this Lease:  (i) shall be in addition to any and
all  other  remedies  Landlord  may  have at law or in  equity,  (ii)  shall  be
cumulative,  and (iii) may be pursued  successively  or concurrently as Landlord
may  elect.  The  exercise  of any  remedy  by  Landlord  shall not be deemed an
election of remedies or preclude  Landlord from exercising any other remedies in
the future.

F. Bankruptcy. If Tenant becomes bankrupt, the bankruptcy trustee shall not have
the right to assume or assign this Lease  unless the trustee  complies  with all
requirements  of the United  States  Bankruptcy  Code;  and  Landlord  expressly
reserves all of its rights, claims, and remedies thereunder.

G. Waiver of Trial by Jury. Landlord and Tenant waive trial by jury in the event
of any action,  proceeding or counterclaim  brought by either Landlord or Tenant
against the other in connection with this Lease.

H. Venue.  If either  Landlord or Tenant  desires to bring an action against the
other in connection with this Lease, such action shall be brought in the federal
or state courts located in Omaha,  Nebraska.  Landlord and Tenant consent to the
jurisdiction of such courts and waive any right to have such action  transferred
from such courts on the grounds of improper venue or inconvenient forum.

17.  HOLDING  OVER.  If Tenant  retains  possession  of the  Premises  after the
expiration  or  termination  of the Term or Tenant's  right to possession of the
Premises,  Tenant  shall pay Rent  during such  holding  over at one hundred and
forty percent  (140%) of the rate in effect  immediately  preceding such holding
over  computed  on a monthly  basis for each month or partial  month that Tenant
remains in possession. Tenant shall also pay, indemnify and defend Landlord from
and against all claims and damages,  consequential as well as direct,  sustained
by reason of Tenant's  holding over. The provisions of this Section do not waive
Landlord's right of re-entry or right to regain  possession by actions at law or
in equity or any other rights hereunder,  and any receipt of payment by Landlord
shall not be deemed a consent by Landlord to Tenant's remaining in possession or
be  construed  as  creating or  renewing  any lease or right of tenancy  between
Landlord and Tenant.

18.  SECURITY  DEPOSIT.  Upon execution of this Lease,  Tenant shall deposit the
security  deposit  set  forth  in Item "F" of the  Basic  Terms  (the  "Security
Deposit") with Landlord as security for the performance of Tenant's  obligations
under this Lease. Upon the occurrence of a Default,  Landlord may use all or any
part of the  Security  Deposit for the payment of any Rent or for the payment of
any amount which  Landlord may pay or become  obligated to pay by reason of such
Default,  or to  compensate  Landlord for any loss or damage which  Landlord may
suffer by reason of such  Default.  If any  portion of the  Security  Deposit is
used,  Tenant shall within five days after written demand therefor  deposit cash
with  Landlord in an amount  sufficient  to restore the Security  Deposit to its
original  amount.  Landlord  shall not be required to keep the Security  Deposit
separate from its general funds, and Tenant shall not be entitled to interest on
the Security  Deposit.  In no event shall the Security  Deposit be considered an
advanced  payment of Rent,  and in no event shall  Tenant be entitled to use the
Security  Deposit  for the  payment  of Rent.  If no  default  by Tenant  exists
hereunder,  the  Security  Deposit or any balance  thereof  shall be returned to

                                       47
<PAGE>
Tenant within  thirty days after the  expiration of the Term and vacation of the
Premises  by Tenant.  Landlord  shall have the right to  transfer  the  Security
Deposit to any purchaser of the Building. Upon such transfer,  Tenant shall look
solely to such purchaser for return of the Security Deposit;  and Landlord shall
be relieved of any liability with respect to the Security Deposit.

19.   SUBSTITUTION  OF  OTHER  PREMISES.   Except  for  Tenant's   computer  and
transmission areas, at any time hereafter,  Landlord may upon thirty days' prior
notice to Tenant substitute for the Premises other premises in the Building (the
"New Premises"),  provided that the New Premises shall be reasonably  usable for
Tenant's  business  hereunder;  and,  if Tenant is already in  occupancy  of the
Premises, then in addition Landlord shall pay the expenses of moving Tenant from
the Premises to the New Premises and for improving the New Premises so that they
are substantially similar to the Premises.

20.  ESTOPPEL  CERTIFICATE.  Tenant agrees that, from time to time upon not less
than ten days' prior  request by Landlord,  Tenant shall  execute and deliver to
Landlord a written certificate certifying: (i) that this Lease is unmodified and
in full force and effect (or if there have been modifications,  a description of
such modifications and that this Lease as modified is in full force and effect);
(ii) the dates to which Rent has been paid;  (iii) that Tenant is in  possession
of the Premises, if that is the case; (iv) that Landlord is not in default under
this Lease, or, if Tenant believes Landlord is in default, the nature thereof in
detail;  (v) that Tenant has no off-sets or defenses to the  performance  of its
obligations  under this Lease (or if Tenant  believes  there are any off-sets or
defenses,  a full and complete  explanation  thereof);  and (vi) such additional
matters as may be requested by Landlord,  it being agreed that such  certificate
may be relied upon by any  prospective  purchaser,  mortgagee,  or other  person
having or acquiring an interest in the Building.  If Tenant fails to execute and
deliver any such  certificate  within ten days after  request,  Tenant  shall be
deemed to have irrevocably  appointed  Landlord and Landlord's  beneficiaries as
Tenant's  attorneys-in-fact  to execute and deliver such certificate in Tenant's
name.

21. SUBORDINATION.  This Lease is and shall be expressly subject and subordinate
at all  times to (i) any  ground or  underlying  lease of the  Building,  now or
hereafter existing,  and all amendments,  renewals and modifications to any such
lease;  and (ii)  the  lien of any  mortgage  or  trust  deed  now or  hereafter
encumbering fee title to the Building and/or the leasehold estate under any such
lease. If any such mortgage or trust deed is foreclosed, or if any such lease is
terminated, upon request of the mortgagee, holder or lessor, as the case may be,
Tenant will attorn to the  purchaser  at the  foreclosure  sale or to the lessor
under such lease,  as the case may be. The foregoing  provisions are declared to
be  self-operative  and no further  instruments shall be required to effect such
subordination  and/or  attornment;  provided,  however,  that Tenant agrees upon
request by any such mortgagee,  holder,  lessor or purchaser at foreclosure,  to
execute and deliver such subordination  and/or attornment  instruments as may be
required by such person to confirm  such  subordination  and/or  attornment.  If
Tenant  fails to execute and deliver any such  instrument  within ten days after
request,  Tenant  shall be deemed to have  irrevocably  appointed  Landlord  and
Landlord's  beneficiaries as Tenant's  attorneys-in-fact  to execute and deliver
such instrument in Tenant's name.

                                       48
<PAGE>
22. QUIET ENJOYMENT.  As long as no Default exists,  Tenant shall peacefully and
quietly  have and enjoy the  Premises for the Term,  free from  interference  by
Landlord,  subject,  however,  to the  provisions  of this  Lease.  The  loss or
reduction of Tenant's  light,  air or view will not be deemed a  disturbance  of
Tenant's occupancy of the Premises nor will it affect Tenant's obligations under
this Lease or create any liability of Landlord to Tenant.

23.  BROKER.  Tenant  represents to Landlord that Tenant has dealt only with the
broker(s) set forth in Item "G" of the Basic Terms (the  "Broker") in connection
with this Lease and that,  insofar as Tenant knows,  no other broker  negotiated
this Lease or is entitled  to any  commission  in  connection  herewith.  Tenant
agrees to indemnify,  defend and hold Landlord and Landlord's  beneficiaries and
agents  harmless from and against any claims for a fee or commission made by any
broker, other than the Broker,  claiming to have acted by or on behalf of Tenant
in connection with this Lease. Landlord agrees to pay the Broker a commission in
accordance with a separate agreement between Landlord and the Broker.

24. NOTICES. All notices and demands to be given by one party to the other party
under this Lease shall be given in writing,  mailed or delivered,  if to Tenant,
at Suite 200 in the Building,  and if to Landlord at the address set forth below
or at such other address as either party may hereafter designate.

If to Landlord:        The Prudential Insurance Company of America
                       One Prudential Plaza; Suite 1200
                       130 East Randolph Street
                       Chicago, Illinois   60601
                       Attn.:  Vice President - Equity Investments

                       and

                       The Prudential Insurance Company of America
                       One Prudential Plaza; Suite 1300
                       130 East Randolph Street
                       Chicago, Illinois   60601
                       Attn.:  Regional Counsel


with a copy to:        Pacific Realty Group, Inc.
                       1905 Harney Street, Suite 403
                       Omaha, Nebraska   68102
                       Attn.:Senior Vice President-
                             Management Operations

Notices  shall be  delivered by United  States  certified  or  registered  mail,
postage  prepaid,  return  receipt  requested,  or  by a  nationally  recognized
overnight  courier service.  Notices shall be considered to have been given upon
the earlier to occur of actual receipt or two business days after posting in the
United States mail.

25. MISCELLANEOUS.

A. Successors and Assigns.  Subject to Section 14 of this Lease,  each provision
of this Lease shall  extend to,  bind and inure to the  benefit of Landlord  and
Tenant and their respective legal  representatives,  successors and assigns; and
all references herein to Landlord and Tenant shall be deemed to include all such
parties.

                                       49
<PAGE>
B. Entire Agreement.  This Lease, and the riders and exhibits,  if any, attached
hereto  which are  hereby  made a part of this  Lease,  represent  the  complete
agreement between Landlord and Tenant;  and Landlord has made no representations
or warranties  except as expressly set forth in this Lease.  No  modification or
amendment of or waiver under this Lease shall be binding upon Landlord or Tenant
unless in writing signed by Landlord and Tenant.

C. Time of Essence. Time is of the essence of this Lease and each and all of its
provisions.

D.  Execution and Delivery.  Submission of this  instrument  for  examination or
signature by Tenant does not  constitute a reservation of space or an option for
lease, and it is not effective until execution and delivery by both Landlord and
Tenant.  Execution  and  delivery  of this  Lease by  Tenant to  Landlord  shall
constitute an irrevocable offer by Tenant to lease the Premises on the terms and
conditions  set forth  herein,  which offer may not be revoked for fifteen  days
after such delivery.

E.  Severability.  The invalidity or  unenforceability  of any provision of this
Lease shall not affect or impair any other provisions.

F.  Governing  Law.  This Lease shall be governed by and construed in accordance
with the laws of the State of Nebraska.

G.  Delay in  Possession.  In no event  shall  Landlord  be  liable to Tenant if
Landlord  is unable  to  deliver  possession  of the  Premises  to Tenant on the
Commencement Date for causes outside Landlord's  reasonable control. If Landlord
is unable to deliver  possession  of the Premises to Tenant by the  Commencement
Date,  the  Commencement  Date shall be  deferred  until  Landlord  can  deliver
possession  to Tenant,  and the  Expiration  Date shall be deferred for an equal
number of days.

H. Joint and Several  Liability.  If Tenant is comprised of more than one party,
each such party shall be jointly and severally  liable for Tenant's  obligations
under this Lease.

I. Force Majeure.  Landlord  shall not be in default  hereunder and Tenant shall
not be excused from performing any of its  obligations  hereunder if Landlord is
prevented from performing any of its obligations  hereunder due to any accident,
breakage,  strike,  shortage of  materials,  acts of God or other causes  beyond
Landlord's reasonable control.

J.  Demolition or  Renovation.  Landlord  shall have the right to terminate this
Lease  without  compensation  to Tenant upon one hundred and eighty  (180) days'
prior  notice to Tenant if Landlord  is  required  to  renovate or demolish  the
Building  or  a  substantial  part  thereof.  However,  if  such  renovation  or
demolition is  discretionary  on behalf of the  Landlord,  Landlord will pay the
Tenant the fair  market  value of  Tenant's  remaining  leasehold  interest  and
reasonable physical moving costs, based on the actual costs incurred.

K. Captions.  The headings and titles in this Lease are for convenience only and
shall have no effect upon the construction or interpretation of this Lease.

                                       50
<PAGE>
L. No Waiver.  No receipt of money by Landlord from Tenant after  termination of
this Lease or after the  service of any  notice or after the  commencing  of any
suit or after  final  judgment  for  possession  of the  Premises  shall  renew,
reinstate,  continue  or extend the Term or affect any such  notice or suit.  No
waiver of any default of Tenant  shall be implied  from any omission by Landlord
to take any action on account of such  default if such  default  persists  or be
repeated,  and no express waiver shall affect any default other than the default
specified  in the  express  waiver  and then only for the time and to the extent
therein stated.

M. Limitation of Liability.  Any liability of Landlord under this Lease shall be
limited  solely  to its  interest  in the  Building,  and in no event  shall any
personal  liability be asserted  against  Landlord in connection with this Lease
nor shall any recourse be had to any other property or assets of Landlord.

N.  Hazardous  Materials.  In the  event  any  Hazardous  Material  (hereinafter
defined)  is brought  into or onto the  Premises  by Tenant,  its  employees  or
agents,  Tenant shall handle any such material in compliance with all applicable
federal,  state  and/or  local  regulations.   For  purposes  of  this  Section,
"Hazardous  Materials"  means and  includes  any  hazardous,  toxic or dangerous
waste,  substance  or  material  defined  as such in (or  for  purposes  of) the
Comprehensive  Environmental  Response,  Compensation  and  Liability  Act,  any
so-called  "Superfund"  or  "Superlien"  law,  or any  federal,  state  or local
statute,  law, ordinance,  code, rule,  regulation,  order or decree regulating,
relating  to, or imposing  liability or  standards  of conduct  concerning,  any
hazardous,  toxic or dangerous  waste,  substance or material,  as now or at any
time  hereafter  in effect.  Tenant  shall submit to Landlord on an annual basis
copies of any approved hazardous  materials  communication plan, OSHA monitoring
plan and permits required by the Resource Recovery and Conversation Act of 1976,
which Tenant is required to prepare,  file or obtain.  Tenant will indemnify and
hold harmless Landlord from any losses, liabilities,  damages, costs or expenses
(including  reasonable  attorneys' fees) which Landlord may suffer or incur as a
result of  Tenant's  introduction  into or unto the  Premises  of any  Hazardous
Material.  This Section shall survive the  expiration or sooner  termination  of
this Lease.

O.  Modification  for  Mortgage.  Should  any  mortgage,  leasehold  or  similar
arrangement  require  a  modification  or  modifications  of this  Lease,  which
modification or modifications will not bring about any increased cost or expense
to Tenant or in any other way substantially change the rights and obligations of
Tenant hereunder,  then and in such event,  Tenant agrees that this Lease may be
so  modified.  Tenant  further  agrees to  execute  and  deliver  any  documents
requested to evidence  such  modification  within ten (10) days  following  such
request.

P. Rider.  A Rider  consisting of one (2) pages,  and  containing  paragraphs 26
through 32 is attached hereto and made a part of this Lease.

IN WITNESS  WHEREOF,  Landlord and Tenant have executed this Lease as of the day
and year first above written.

                                       51
<PAGE>


TENANT:                                    LANDLORD:

Data Transmission Network Corporation,     The Prudential Insurance Company 
a Delaware corporation                     of America, a New Jersey corporation

                                           By:      Pacific Realty Group, Inc.,
By:  /s/  Greg T. Sloma                             its Managing Agent
     ----------------------------
Its:  Executive Vice President
      and Chief Operating Officer
     ----------------------------

                                       52
<PAGE>

EXHIBIT  "D" - to be made a part of a Lease  between  THE  PRUDENTIAL  INSURANCE
COMPANY  OF  AMERICA  (Landlord)  and  DATA  TRANSMISSION   NETWORK  CORPORATION
(Tenant), dated May 2, 1995.


                          LEGAL DESCRIPTION OF BUILDING




That part of the  Southeast  Quarter of the  Southwest  Quarter  of Section  15,
Township  15  North,  Range 12 East of the 6th P.M.,  in the City of  Omaha,  in
Douglas County, Nebraska, more particularly described as follows:

Beginning at a point on the Westerly  right-of-way  line of 90th Street which is
50.00  feet West of the East line and 92.59 feet North of the South line of said
Southeast Quarter of the Southwest Quarter;  thence North  00(degree)00'00" East
(assumed  bearing)  along  said  Westerly  right-of-way  line of 90th  Street  a
distance of 718.41 feet to a point on the Southerly right-of-way line of Embassy
Row; thence North  90(degree)00'00" West along said Southerly  right-of-way line
of  Embassy  Row  a  distance  of  190.00  feet  to a  point  of  curve;  thence
Southwesterly on a curve to the left, along said Southerly  right-of-way line of
Embassy  Row,  said curve having a radius of 595.24 feet, a long chord of 420.72
feet  bearing  South  69(degree)18'22"  West and an arc  length of 430.09  feet;
thence  South  44(degree)41'22"  East a distance of 182.60  feet;  thence  South
00(degree)18'38"  West a  distance  of 460.04  feet to a point on the  Northerly
right-of-way line of West Dodge Road; thence South  89(degree)41'22"  East along
said Northerly  right-of-way  line of West Dodge Road a distance of 173.30 feet;
thence North  00(degree)18'32"  East along said Northerly  right-of-way  line of
West Dodge Road a distance of 11.00 feet;  thence  South  89(degree)41'22"  East
along said Northerly  right-of-way line of West Dodge Road, a distance of 270.00
feet; thence North  51(degree)10'21" East along said Northerly right-of-way line
of West Dodge Road a distance of 18.36 feet to the Point of  Beginning.

                                       53
<PAGE>
EXHIBIT"E" to be made a part of a Lease between THE PRUDENTIAL INSURANCE COMPANY
OF AMERICA (Landlord), and DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION (Tenant), dated
May 2, 1995. (Page 1 of 2)


                        TENANT IMPROVEMENTS WORK SCHEDULE



                                    ARTICLE I
                       Landlord's Construction Obligations

     Landlord  shall have no  construction  obligations  under  this  Amendment.
Tenant accepts the Additional Premises in an "as is" condition,  with all faults
and  with  the  understanding  that  it  shall  be  responsible  for any and all
improvements required for its occupancy and use in accordance with Article II of
this Exhibit "B".

                                   ARTICLE II
                       Construction of Tenant Improvements

     Tenant  shall  have the right to place  partitions  and  fixtures  and make
improvements or other alterations in the Additional  Premises in accordance with
the  provisions of Paragraph 9 of the Lease.  Landlord  shall  provide  Tenant a
tenant finish allowance of up to One Hundred Eighty-Six Thousand,  Eight Hundred
Forty Dollars and No Cents  ($186,840.00)  to be applied  toward the cost of any
such tenant-provided improvements as follows:

     1. The tenant finish allowance shall be paid in periodic installments,  not
more frequently than once per month,  equal to the total of the  contractor's or
consultant's  invoice amounts for improvements made to the Additional  Premises,
excluding   any   furnishings   or  business   equipment   (such  as  computers,
satellite/microwave  dish, office  equipment,  etc.), as submitted by Tenant and
verified to Landlord's  reasonable  satisfaction;  provided,  however, that such
payments  will be made only if Tenant is not then in Default  under the terms of
this Lease and invoices are  accompanied  by lien waivers in the amount equal to
that of the  invoices.  The  tenant  finish  allowance  shall be  allocated  and
distributed subject to the provisions of this Exhibit "B" as follows:

              June 1, 1995 - February 29, 1996 Up To $65,112.00
              January 1, 1998 - September 30, 1998 Up To $121,728.00

     2. Upon the earlier of the end dates identified in the allocation  schedule
specified  in  Paragraph  1  above,  or  the  satisfaction  of  all  obligations
associated  with the  tenant  improvements  covered  under  this  Article II and
receipt of the  associated  lien waivers for the work,  the Tenant shall forfeit
any unused  portion of the allowance.  Any requests for payment  received by the
Landlord after the above specified end dates, will be returned to the Tenant and
will be the obligation and sole responsibility of the Tenant.

     3. In addition  to the  provisions  set forth in  Paragraph 9 of the Lease,
Tenant's contractor shall (and its contract shall so provide):

         (a)  conduct  its  work  in  such a  manner  so as not to  unreasonably
              interfere with other tenants in the Building, Building operations,
              or any other  construction  occurring on or in the Building or the
              Premises;
                                       54
<PAGE>
         (b)  execute  a set  of and  comply  with  all  rules  and  regulations
              relating to the  construction  activities in or on the Building as
              may be reasonably promulgated from time to time by Landlord or its
              agents;

         (c)  maintain such insurance  (such as general  liability and workman's
              compensation)  and bonds (such as performance  and  completion) in
              force and effect as may be reasonably  requested by Landlord or as
              required by  applicable  law (but in any event said bonds shall be
              in amounts  equal to the full value or cost of the work being done
              by the Tenant contractor);

         (d)  be  responsible  for reaching an agreement  with  Landlord and its
              agents as to the terms and  conditions  for all  contractor  items
              relating to the conducting of its work,  including but not limited
              to, those matters relating to hoisting,  systems interfacing,  use
              of  temporary  utilities,  storage  of  materials,   placement  of
              dumpsters,  access  to the  Premises  and  the  Building,  and the
              purchase and return of Building standard materials.

         (e)  Upon completion of any tenant improvements,  Tenant shall promptly
              furnish  Landlord with sworn owner's and  contractors'  statements
              and  full  and  final  waivers  of lien  covering  all  labor  and
              materials included in such  improvements.  Tenant shall not permit
              any mechanic's lien to be filed against the Building,  or any part
              thereof,  arising out of any improvement performed,  or alleged to
              have been performed,  by or on behalf of Tenant.  If any such lien
              is filed,  Tenant shall within ten (10) days  thereafter have such
              lien  released  of record or deliver  to  Landlord a bond in form,
              amount,   and  issued  by  a  surety   satisfactory  to  Landlord,
              indemnifying  Landlord against all costs and liabilities resulting
              from  such  lien  and the  foreclosure  or  attempted  foreclosure
              thereof.  If  Tenant  fails to have such  lien so  released  or to
              deliver such bond to Landlord, Landlord, without investigating the
              validity of such lien,  may pay or discharge the same;  and Tenant
              shall  reimburse  Landlord  upon  demand for the amount so paid by
              Landlord, including Landlord's expenses and attorney's fees.

     4. Landlord shall have the right to approve all  subcontractors  to be used
by the Tenant's contractor, which approval shall not be unreasonably withheld as
long as such subcontractors satisfy the requirements of this Article II.

     5.  Tenant  shall  indemnify  and  hold  harmless  Landlord,   its  agents,
contractors (including Building Contractor), and any mortgagee of Landlord, from
and against  any and all losses,  damages,  costs  (including  costs of suit and
attorneys' fees), liabilities, or causes of action for injury to or death of any
person,  for damage to any property,  and for mechanic's  materialmen's or other
liens or  claims  arising  out of or in  connection  with  the work  done by the
Tenant's    contractor   (and   Tenant's    contractor's    subcontractors   and
sub-subcontractors) under its contract with Tenant.

                                       55
<PAGE>
     6. The failure by Tenant,  after receiving  written  notice,  to materially
comply with any of the provisions of Article II of this Exhibit shall constitute
a Default  by Tenant  under the terms of the Lease and  Landlord  shall have the
benefit of all remedies  provided for in the Lease,  except  Tenant shall have a
thirty (30) day right to cure Default upon receipt of written notice .

     7. Upon  completion  of the Tenant  Improvements,  Tenant shall  deliver to
Landlord  two (2)  copies of the "as  built"  plans and  specifications  for the
Tenant  Improvements  completed  under Article II of this Exhibit  within thirty
(30) days of completing the same.



                                       56
<PAGE>
EXHIBIT  "F" to be made a part  of a  Lease  between  THE  PRUDENTIAL  INSURANCE
COMPANY  OF  AMERICA  (Landlord),  and  DATA  TRANSMISSION  NETWORK  CORPORATION
(Tenant), dated May 2, 1995. (Page 1 of 2)

                               RULES & REGULATIONS

     1. Sidewalks,  doorways, vestibules, halls, stairways, elevator lobbies and
other  similar  areas in the common areas of the Building  shall not be used for
the  storage of  materials  or disposal of trash,  be  obstructed  by tenants or
Landlord,  or be used by tenants or Landlord for any purpose other than entrance
to and from the  tenant's  leased  areas and the Building and for going from one
part of the Building to another part of the Building.

     2. Plumbing fixtures shall be used only for the purposes for which they are
designed, and no sweepings, rubbish, rags or other unsuitable materials shall be
disposed into them.  Damage resulting to any such fixtures proven to result from
misuse by a tenant, and not by Landlord's cleaning  contractors  responsible for
cleaning the tenant's  leased area and the  Building,  shall be the liability of
said tenant.

     3. Signs,  advertisements,  graphics  or notices  visible in or from public
corridors,  any common area or public  areas of the Building or from outside the
Building shall be subject to Landlord's (or Landlord's property manager's) prior
written approval,  which approval shall not be unreasonably withheld. No part of
the Complex may be defaced by Tenants .

     4.  Significant  movement in or out of the  Building of  furniture,  office
equipment,  or any other bulky or heavy  materials  shall be  restricted to such
hours as Landlord (or Landlord's  property manager) shall reasonably  designate.
Landlord (or Landlord's  property manager) will determine the method and routing
of the  movement  of said items so as to ensure the  safety of all  persons  and
property  concerned and Tenant shall be  responsible  for all costs and expenses
associated  therewith.  Advance written notice of intent to move such items must
be made to the Landlord (or Landlord's  property  manager) at least  twenty-four
(24) hours before the time of such move. For non significant  movement in or out
of the  Building of portable  items which do not require use of dollies or other
moving equipment,  notice to Landlord (or Landlord's property manager) shall not
be required.

     5. All  deliveries  to a  tenant's  leased  premises,  requiring  dedicated
elevator  service for multiple trips that  potentially  will disrupt service for
visitors and other tenants of the Building during normal business  operations as
defined in paragraph 5.A., shall be made through special  arrangements  with the
Landlord.  In general,  passenger elevators are to be used only for the movement
of persons and small deliveries during these normal business hours.  Tenants may
obtain the prior written  consent of Landlord (or Landlord's  property  manager)
for any exception to the provisions of this Paragraph 5.

     6. Landlord (or  Landlord's  property  manager) shall have the authority to
approve the proposed  weight and location of any safes and heavy  furniture  and
equipment,  which shall in all cases  stand on  supporting  devices  approved by
Landlord in order to distribute the weight.

     7.  Corridor  doors which lead to common areas of the Building  (other than
doors  opening into the elevator  lobby on floors  leased  entirely to a tenant)
shall be kept closed at all times.
                                       57
<PAGE>
     8. Each tenant shall  cooperate  with  Landlord  (and  Landlord's  property
manager) in keeping its leased area neat and clean.  No tenant  shall employ any
person for the purpose of such cleaning other than the  Building's  cleaning and
maintenance personnel without prior approval of Landlord (or Landlord's property
manager).

     9. All  elevator  lobbies  are to be kept neat and clean.  The  disposal of
trash or storage of materials in these areas is prohibited.

     10. No birds, fish or other animals shall be brought into or kept in, on or
about the Building (except for Seeing Eye dogs).

     11. Tenants shall not tamper with or attempt to adjust temperature  control
thermostats in their leased  premises.  Landlord shall promptly  respond to each
tenant's  notices as to, and Landlord (or  Landlord's  property  manager)  shall
adjust thermostats as required to maintain,  the Building standard  temperature.
Each  tenant  shall use  reasonable  efforts to keep all window  blinds down and
tilted at a 45 degree angle toward the street to help maintain  comfortable room
temperatures and conserve energy.

     12. Each tenant will comply with all  security  procedures  necessary  both
during  business  hours and after hours and on weekends.  Landlord  will provide
each  tenant  with prior  notice of such  security  procedures  and any  changes
thereto promptly.

     13. Tenants are requested to lock all office doors leading to corridors and
to turn out all lights at the close of their  working  day;  provided,  however,
that  no  tenant  shall  be  responsible  to  ensure  that  Landlord's  cleaning
contractor  locks doors and turns out lights after cleaning the tenant's  leased
premises.

     14. All requests for overtime air conditioning or heating must be submitted
in writing  to  Landlord  (or  Landlord's  property  manager)  by an  authorized
representative  of the  tenant.  A list of persons  authorized  to request  such
overtime  services (and any amendments  thereto) will be furnished by the tenant
to Landlord and  Landlord  shall be entitled to rely  thereon.  Any such request
must be made by 2:00 p.m. on the day desired for weekday requests,  by 2:00 p.m.
Friday for weekend  requests and by 2:00 p.m. on the preceding  business day for
holiday  requests.  Requests  made after  that time may result in an  additional
charge  (not to  exceed  Landlord's  cost)  to such  Tenant,  if  acted  upon by
Landlord. Landlord will make reasonable efforts to accommodate untimely requests
by Tenant for  overtime  air  conditioning  or  heating.  Charges  for  overtime
operation of air  conditioning  or heating  shall be at the then current cost of
operating  the required  system  components.  Charges will be billed on Tenant's
monthly statement and are due within thirty (30) days of receipt of by Tenant of
the statement.

     15. No  flammable or  explosive  fluids or materials  shall be kept or used
within the Building except in areas approved by Landlord,  and each tenant shall
comply with all applicable building and fire codes relating thereto.

     16.  Tenants  may not make any  modifications,  alterations,  additions  or
repairs to their leased  premises and may not install any furniture,  fixture or
equipment in their  leased  premises  which is in  violation  of any  applicable
building  and/or fire code governing  their lease  premises or the Project.  The
tenant must  obtain  prior  approval  from  Landlord  (or)  Landlord's  property
manager) of any such alterations,  modifications and additions and shall deliver

                                       58
<PAGE>
"as built" plans therefor to Landlord (or  Landlord's  property  manager),  upon
completion,   except  as  otherwise   permitted  in  the  tenant's  lease.  Such
alterations  include,  but are not limited to, any  communication  equipment and
associated  wiring  which must meet fire code.  The  contractor  conducting  the
modifications  and additions  must be a licensed  contractor,  is subject to all
rules and  regulations  of Landlord  (and  Landlord's  property  manager)  while
performing  work in the  Building  and must  obtain all  necessary  permits  and
approvals prior to commencing the modifications and additions.

     17. No  vending  machines  of any type  shall be  allowed  in tenant  space
without the prior written consent of Landlord (or Landlord's  property manager),
which will not be unreasonably  withheld.  Landlord acknowledges that Tenant has
advised that it will have vending machines in their Premises.

     18. All locks for doors in each  tenant's  leased  areas  shall be Building
Standard except as otherwise permitted by Landlord and no tenant shall place any
additional  lock or locks on any door in its leased area without  Landlord's (or
Landlord's  property manager's) written consent except as otherwise permitted in
such tenant's  lease.  All requests for duplicate keys shall be made to Landlord
(or Landlord's property manager).

     19. No tenant (or their  visitors)  shall  interfere  in any way with other
tenants' (or their visitors') quiet enjoyment of their leased premises.

     20. Except in cases of gross negligence on behalf of the Landlord, Landlord
will not be liable or  responsible  for lost or stolen  money,  jewelry or other
personal  property from any tenant's leased area or public areas of the Building
or Project.

     21. No machinery of any kind other than normal  office  equipment  shall be
operated by any tenant in its leased area without the prior  written  consent of
Landlord (or Landlord's property manager).

     22. Canvassing,  peddling, soliciting and distribution of hand bills in the
Building (except for activities  within a tenant's leased premises which involve
only such tenant's employees) is prohibited.  Each tenant is requested to notify
Landlord (or Landlord's property manager) if such activities occur.

     23. All tenants will refer all  contractors,  contractors'  representatives
and  installation  technicians  tendering  any service to them to  Landlord  for
Landlord's  supervision,  approval  and control  before the  performance  of any
contractual  services.  This provision  shall apply to all work performed in the
Building  (other than work under  contract for  installation  or  maintenance of
security  equipment  or  banking  equipment),  including,  but not  limited  to,
installations  of  telephones,   telegraph  equipment,  electrical  devices  and
attachments,  and any and all  installations of every nature  affecting  floors,
walls,  woodwork,  trim,  windows,  ceilings,  equipment and any other  physical
portion of the Building.

     24.  Smoking is not  permitted  in the  restrooms,  stairwells,  elevators,
public lobbies or public corridors.

                                       59
<PAGE>
     25. Each tenant and their  contractors are responsible for removal of trash
resulting from large deliveries or move-ins. Such trash must be removed from the
Building and Building  facilities may not be used for dumping.  If such trash is
not promptly removed,  Landlord (or Landlord's  property manager) may cause such
trash to be removed at the  tenant's  sole cost and  expense  plus a  reasonable
additional   charge  to  be   determined   by  Landlord   to  cover   Landlord's
administrative costs in connection with such removal.

     26. Tenants may not install, leave or store equipment,  supplies, furniture
or trash in the  common  areas  of the  Building  (i.e.,  outside  their  leased
premises).

     27. Each tenant shall provide  Landlord's  property  manager with names and
telephone numbers of individuals who should be contacted in an emergency.

     28. Tenants shall comply with the Building life safety program  established
by Landlord (or by Landlord's  property  manager),  including without limitation
fire drills,  training programs and fire warden staffing  procedures,  and shall
exercise  all  reasonable  efforts to cause all tenant  employees,  invitees and
guests to comply with such program.

     29. To insure orderly  operation of the Building,  no ice, mineral or other
water, towels, newspapers, etc., shall be delivered to any leased area except by
persons appointed or approved by Landlord in writing.

     30. Should a tenant require telegraphic,  telephonic,  annunciator or other
communication service, Landlord will direct the electricians where and how wires
are to be introduced and placed and none shall be introduced or placed except as
Landlord  shall approve.  Electric  current shall not be used for space heaters,
cooking  or  heating  devices or similar  appliances  without  Landlord's  prior
written permission.

     31.  Nothing shall be swept or thrown into the corridors,  halls,  elevator
shafts or stairways.

     32. No portion  of any  tenant's  leased  area shall at any time be used or
occupied as sleeping or lodging  quarters,  nor shall personnel  occupancy loads
exceed limits reasonably established by Landlord for the Building.




                                       60
<PAGE>
EXHIBIT  "G" - to be made a part of a Lease  between  THE  PRUDENTIAL  INSURANCE
COMPANY OF AMERICA (Landlord) and DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION (Tenant)
dated May 2, 1995. (Page 1 of 2)

Property #:  21139
                            ANTENNA LICENSE AGREEMENT

                                     BETWEEN

                   THE PRUDENTIAL INSURANCE COMPANY OF AMERICA
                                       AND
                      DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION


This  Agreement  made as of the day of , 1995,  by and  between  The  Prudential
Insurance  Company Of America,  a New Jersey  corporation,  (hereinafter  called
"Licenser") and Data Transmission Network Corporation,  a Delaware  corporation,
(hereinafter called "Licensee").

                                   WITNESSETH:

I. Licenser,  for and in consideration of the payments hereinafter set forth and
of the covenants and agreements made by Licensee herein  contained,  does hereby
grant unto the Licensee a non-exclusive license to utilize space in the building
located  at 9110 West  Dodge  Road,  Omaha,  Nebraska,  (hereinafter  called the
"Building")  for the purpose of installing  and using various  satellite  dishes
(herein  referred to as  "Antenna")  to be attached to the roof of the  Building
during the Term of the Lease unless  extended or sooner  terminated  as provided
herein.

II. Licensee shall make payments to Licenser,  at the office of the Building, or
elsewhere as designated  from time to time by notice in writing to Licensee,  in
monthly installments as follows:

         "Except for the Rent required under the Lease and as otherwise provided
         herein,  Licensee  shall not be required to pay any monthly  rental for
         this Antenna License Agreement."

III.  The size,  location  and  placement  as well as the  manner  and method of
installation  and removal of the Antenna and related  equipment shall be subject
to  the  prior  written  approval  of  Licenser.  If  Licenser  elects  to  hire
structural,  mechanical, roofing and/or other engineers or consultants to review
such  plans  and  specifications,  Licensee  shall  reimburse  Licenser  for the
reasonable  costs  thereof,  whether  or  not  Licenser  grants  such  approval.
Notwithstanding  the  above,  all  Antenna  installed  as of the  date  of  this
agreement do not need written approval.

IV. In addition  to the monthly  rental,  Licensee  shall pay for all  utilities
consumed to install,  maintain, operate and remove its Antenna and equipment, as
well as the  reasonable  costs  of any  engineers  or  consultants  employed  by
Licenser to review or monitor same.
                                       61
<PAGE>
V. Prior to the  installation  of said  Antenna and  equipment,  Licensee  shall
secure and shall at all time  thereafter  maintain  all required  approvals  and
permits of the  Federal  Communications  Commission  and all other  governmental
bodies  having  jurisdiction  over its business,  including its  communications,
operations and facilities.  Licensee shall at all times comply with all laws and
ordinances  and all rules  and  regulations  of  municipal,  state  and  federal
governmental  authorities  relating to the  installation,  maintenance,  height,
location,  use,  operation,  and removal of said Antenna and equipment and shall
fully  indemnify  Licenser  against  any loss,  cost,  or  expense  which may be
sustained  or  incurred  by it as a  result  of the  installation,  maintenance,
operation,  or  removal  of  said  Antenna  and  equipment.  Licenser  makes  no
representation  that  applicable  laws,  ordinances  or  regulations  permit the
installation or operation of antennas on the subject real estate.

VI.  Licenser  hereby grants unto Licensee the right,  to be exercised as herein
set  forth,  to enter  upon the roof of the  Building  for the sole  purpose  of
gaining access to the Licensee's  installation.  In addition  thereto,  Licenser
grants unto Licensee the right,  to be exercised as herein set forth, to install
such  equipment,   conduits,  cables  and  materials  (hereinafter  called  "the
connecting equipment") in shafts, ducts,  conduits,  chases, utility closets and
other  facilities  of the Building as  designated  by Licenser as is  reasonably
necessary  to connect  Licensee's  Antenna to  Licensee's  other  machinery  and
equipment in other parts of the  Building,  subject to the  requirements  of any
permits and the codes, regulations and rules of any governmental body, agency or
authority.  Licenser further grants to Licensee the right of access to the areas
where such  connecting  equipment  is located for the  purposes of  maintaining,
repairing,  testing and replacing the connecting equipment;  provided, that such
access and  installations do not cause damage to or interfere with the operation
or maintenance of any part of the Building or with any other tenant's operation.

VII. Licensee shall promptly  reimburse Licenser for the costs of repairs of any
damage to the Building directly or indirectly caused by Licensee's installations
or the operation, maintenance or removal thereof.

VIII.  Licensee,  at its  expense,  shall be  solely  responsible  for and shall
maintain its Antenna and related equipment in a safe,  structural,  sound, clean
and sightly condition and shall indemnify and save harmless Licenser against all
liens and claims of mechanics and material men furnishing labor and materials in
the construction and maintenance of same.

IX.  Licensee  agrees to defend,  indemnify  and save  harmless  Licenser and to
assume all  liability  for death or injury to any persons and all  liability for
loss, damage or injury to any property incurred or sustained by Licensee arising
from, growing out of or resulting from Licensee's installation or its use of the
roof of the Building or any other areas in the Building where Licensee's related
equipment  is  located,  including  costs,  attorney's  fees and other  expenses
incurred by Licenser in  defending  any such claim  unless such loss,  damage or
injury is due to the negligence of Licenser, its employees, agents, or invitees.

X. The  license  hereby  granted  to  Licensee  shall  not be  deemed to give to
Licensee the exclusive  right to use the roof or tower of the Building and shall
not preclude Licenser from granting a license or licenses to others.  The rights
of other licensees shall be exercised without causing unreasonable  interference
with the  activities  being  carried  on by  Licensee  in  accordance  with this

                                       62
<PAGE>
license.  Similarly, the rights of Licensee hereunder shall be exercised without
causing  interference with the activities being carried on by other licensees in
accordance  with  their  respective  licenses.  Licensee  shall  not  change  or
materially  alter the Antenna or related  equipment agreed to herein without the
prior written consent of Licenser.

XI.  Licensee  hereby  waives  and  releases  all  claims  arising  out of  this
agreement,  or in any way  whatsoever  connected with the subject matter of this
agreement,  against  licenser its  officers,  directors,  agents,  employees and
servants,  and  agrees  that they  shall not be liable  for  injury to person or
damage to property  sustained by Licensee or by any occupancy of the Building or
any other  person  occurring  in or about the  Building  resulting  directly  or
indirectly from any existing or future condition, defect, matter of thing in the
Building or any part of it or from  equipment  or  appurtenance  becoming out of
repair,  or from any occurrence,  act, or from the negligence or omission of any
tenant or  occupant  of the  Building  or of any other  person;  except  for the
negligence or omission by Licenser, its officers,  directors,  agents, employees
and servants.

XII.  No notice or demand  related to or  required  by this  Agreement  shall be
effective unless same is in writing and is delivered as provided in paragraph 24
of the Lease.

XIII.  Licenser  shall have the right to  terminate  this  License  upon written
notice to  Licensee,  in the event  that:  (a)  Licensee  shall  default  in the
performance of any of the  obligations  imposed upon it hereunder and shall not,
after being  notified by Licenser of the existence of such default,  immediately
take all reasonable  steps to cure the same; or (b) it shall be determined  that
such  installation or use materially  interferes with the operation of machinery
and  apparatus of the  Building,  such as the  elevators;  or (c) it is found by
public authority having  jurisdiction  over the Building that such  installation
and use constitute a nuisance or hazard to the public or to the occupants of the
Building; or (d) the use of such antenna interferes with the use of any tenant's
equipment or data processing  machines in the Building;  or (e) Licensee's lease
or right to possession of space in the Building shall expire or be terminated.

XIV.  At the  termination  of this  license by lapse of time or  otherwise,  the
Antenna  and the related  equipment  installed  under the terms of this  license
shall be  removed  by  Licensee  and the area of the  Building  where  they were
installed  shall  be  restored  by  Licensee  to as good  condition  as  existed
immediately prior to installation of such Antenna and related equipment.

XV.  This  Agreement  shall be binding  upon the  successors  and assigns of the
parties hereto, provided that Licensee shall not assign or transfer this License
to anyone else without Licenser's prior written consent which may be withheld at
its sole discretion.



                                       63
<PAGE>

LICENSEE:                                   LICENSER:

Data Transmission Network Corporation,      The Prudential Insurance Company Of
Delaware corporation                         America,  New Jersey corporation

                                             By:      Pacific Realty Group, Inc.
                                                       its Managing Agent


                                       64
<PAGE>
                                      RIDER

This Rider forms a part of that certain Standard Office Lease dated May 2, 1995,
between The  Prudential  Insurance  Company of America,  as  Landlord,  and Data
Transmission Network Corporation, as Tenant.
OTHER PROVISIONS:

26. TENANT'S USE OF THE PREMISES.  It is understood  that the Tenant's  intended
use of the Premises will be for general administration and office space, as well
as, for the installation and operation of the various  technical  equipment used
in Tenant's primary business, such as but not limited to, transmission and other
network equipment. In the event that the Tenant's use of the space or population
of either  people or  equipment  within the Premises  results in above  standard
requirements  of the  base  building's  structural,  mechanical  and  electrical
systems, it will be the obligation and sole responsibility of the Tenant to make
any modifications to or supplement the base building structural,  mechanical and
electrical  systems  that may be required in the  reasonable  discretion  of the
Landlord.

27. ELECTRICITY  METERS.  Notwithstanding  the provisions of paragraph 5B of the
Lease,  Tenant will be responsible for the cost of any above standard electrical
requirements as a result of its use and occupancy, including but not limited to,
the cost of providing the separate metering,  additional service facilities, and
the on-going  associated  utility costs.  Landlord will periodically  undertake,
through a certified  engineering  consultant,  a study of the estimated  utility
usage and associated  systems  impact of all tenants of the Building.  The study
will be used to establish the average usage per rentable  square foot of tenants
with "like type office uses" in the building.  This average will then be used as
a standard for the calculation of any above standard usage and any corresponding
utility  charges to be paid by Tenant in accordance  with the provisions of this
paragraph and paragraph 5B.

28. MONUMENT SIGNAGE.  The Tenant will be allowed, at its sole cost and expense,
subject to the  provisions of Exhibit "D" of the Lease,  to cause to be designed
and installed a monument sign  identifying its occupancy in the building,  It is
anticipated  that this monument sign will be low-profile and located on the West
Dodge  Road side of the  property.  It is  understood  that the  Tenant  will be
limited to Tenant's  Proportionate  Share of the total  signage  allowed for the
project,  based upon all current codes and  ordinances  that  regulate  monument
signage in Omaha,  Nebraska.  The Landlord reserves the right, in its reasonable
discretion,  to approve  the  design  and  materials  of the  Tenant's  proposed
monument sign. The final location of the proposed monument sign will be mutually
agreed upon between the Tenant and the Landlord.

29. FUTURE EXPANSION. Provided Tenant is not then in Default, and subject to the
further provisions of this Paragraph 27, Landlord grants to Tenant the following
opportunities to expand the Premises:

A. Option Space. Provided Tenant is not then in Default, Tenant shall have a one
time option add to the  Premises,  as a part of this Lease,  Suite 175B  (10,144
R.S.F.) (the "Option Space") on the first floor of the Building as further shown
on Exhibit "A", subject to the further provisions herein.

                                       65
<PAGE>
(i)  Requirements.  In order to  exercise  this  option,  Tenant must notify the
Landlord of its intent to exercise  this option prior to June 1, 1997. If Tenant
exercises  this option,  then such Option Space will become part of the Premises
leased to  Tenant,  subject  to all of the terms and  conditions  of the  Lease.
Tenant agrees to enter into an amendment to the Lease setting forth the terms on
which the Option Space is to be added to the Premises  within  fifteen (15) days
after  receipt  of such  amendment  from  Landlord.  If Tenant  does not  timely
exercise  its  option,  or if Tenant  fails to execute  and  deliver  such lease
amendment  with  respect  thereto  within such  fifteen  (15) day  period,  then
Landlord  will have the right to lease such  Option  Space to a third  party and
Tenant's  option as to such  space  hereunder  will  lapse and be of no  further
effect.

(ii) Terms and  Conditions.  Should  Tenant  exercise  this  option as  provided
herein,  the  Commencement  Date for said Option Space shall be January 1, 1998,
and end coterminous  with this Lease. The annual Base Rental rate for the Option
Space will be $14.75 per R.S.F., plus the then current Adjustment Rent, based on
increases in Expenses  over the Base  Expenses  and  increases in Taxes over the
Base Taxes above the Base Expense  Year and Base Tax Year of 1994.  As a part of
this option, and subject to the provisions of Exhibit "E" to the Lease, Landlord
shall  provide  Tenant a tenant  finish  allowance  of up to  $121,728.00  to be
applied toward the cost of any tenant-provided improvements to the Option Space.

B. Right Of First  Refusal.  Provided  Tenant is not then in  Default,  Landlord
grants to Tenant a right of first  refusal  on all or any space in the  Building
that becomes "available" for lease during the term of the Lease. For the purpose
of this lease  provision,  "available"  shall mean the rights  contained  in the
lease of an existing  tenant have  expired and the tenant has no other rights to
occupy the space. In addition,  such right shall be subject to the rights of the
other current tenants of the Building.

(i)  Requirements.  If any space in the  Building  becomes  available,  prior to
leasing the  available  space to a third party,  Landlord  will notify Tenant of
Landlord's  intent to lease such space and the date such space will be available
for  occupancy  ("Landlord's  Notice").  Tenant will have five (5) business days
after receipt of Landlord's Notice,  time being of the essence,  within which to
exercise Tenant's right of first refusal by giving notice thereof to Landlord in
the manner  specified in the Lease for giving notices.  If Tenant exercises such
right of first  refusal,  then such  additional  space will  become  part of the
Premises leased to Tenant pursuant to the Lease, as amended, on the commencement
date specified in Landlord's  Notice to Tenant,  subject to all of the terms and
conditions of the Lease, as amended. Tenant agrees to enter into an amendment to
the Lease setting forth the terms on which the  additional  space is to be added
to the Premises  within  fifteen (15) days after receipt of such  amendment from
Landlord.  If Tenant does not timely exercise its right of first refusal,  or if
Tenant fails to execute and deliver such lease  amendment  with respect  thereto
within  such  15-day  period,  then  Landlord  will have the right to lease such
additional space to a third party and Tenant's right of first refusal as to such
space  hereunder  will  lapse and be of no further  effect.  This right of first
refusal is personal to Data Transmission  Network  Corporation,  and in no event
will any assignee of the Lease or  sublessee  of the Premises  have the right of
first refusal set forth in this Paragraph.

                                       66
<PAGE>
(ii) Terms and Conditions.  During the period from June 1, 1995, through January
1, 1998,  the annual  Base  Rental rate for the space will be $14.75 per R.S.F.,
plus the then current  Adjustment  Rent, based on increases in Expenses over the
Base  Expenses and increases in Taxes over the Base Taxes above the Base Expense
Year and Base Tax Year of 1994. Associated with this Base Rental rate, will be a
Tenant Improvement Allowance of up to $12.00 per R.S.F.,  pro-rated based on the
remaining  lease term at the time the space  becomes a part of the master lease.
Space that  becomes  available  after  January 1, 1998,  shall be offered to the
Tenant at the then  current  market  rate for  similar  space in the West  Omaha
Suburban market.

30. SATELLITE  SCREEN. At any time during the Term of this Lease,  Landlord,  at
its sole  discretion,  may require Tenant to spend up to $10,000.00  towards the
design and construction of architectural screening to be located around Tenant's
antennas  and/or  satellites  located  on the  roof  of the  building.  Landlord
reserves the right, in its sole discretion,  to approve the design and materials
of any proposed  screening.  Provided however,  in no event shall such screening
render the antennas and/or satellites inoperable.

31.  TERMINATION  OF PREVIOUS  LEASES.  Upon  commencement  of this  Lease,  the
previous  lease between Data  Transmission  Network  (Lessee) and The Prudential
Insurance Company Of America  (Lessor),  successor in interest to Pacific Realty
Group, Inc. and Embassy Plaza Limited Partnership,  commencing June 1, 1990, and
as further  amended by the parties in Addendum  No. 1, dated  October 12,  1990,
Lease Addendum No. 2, dated  February 18, 1992,  Lease Addendum No. 3, dated May
13, 1992,  Lease Addendum No. 4, dated  November 5, 1992,  Lease Addendum No. 5,
dated  February  23,  1993,  Lease  Addendum  No. 6, dated  June 8, 1993,  and a
Modification  of Lease  Addendum,  dated January 31, 1994,  shall be terminated.
This  termination  shall not in any way relieve Tenant of any  obligations  owed
under such previous lease prior to its termination.

In addition,  upon  commencement of this Lease,  the previous lease between Data
Transmission  Network (Tenant) and The Prudential  Insurance  Company Of America
(Landlord),  dated August 31, 1994, and as further  amended by a First Amendment
to Lease,  dated October 11, 1994, shall be terminated.  This termination  shall
not in any way relieve  Tenant or Landlord  of any  obligations  owed under such
previous lease prior to its termination.

32. SATTELLITE/ANTENNA AGREEMENTS. The satellite/antenna agreements contained in
this  Lease and  Exhibit G of this  Lease  shall  supersede  and  replace in its
entirety any prior agreements  related to satellites and/or antennas between the
parties,  including agreements contained in that certain lease,  commencing June
1,  1990,   between  Embassy  Plaza  Limited   Partnership   (Lessor)  and  Data
Transmission  Network,  a Delaware  corporation,  and as further  amended by the
parties in Addendum No. 1, dated October 12, 1990,  Lease  Addendum No. 2, dated
February 18, 1992,  Lease Addendum No. 3, dated May 13, 1992, Lease Addendum No.
4, dated November 5, 1992,  Lease Addendum No. 5, dated February 23, 1993, Lease
Addendum No. 6, dated June 8, 1993, and a Modification of Lease Addendum,  dated
January 31, 1994, and any other agreements either written or verbal.

TENANT:                                    LANDLORD:

Data Transmission Network Corporation,     The Prudential Insurance Company 
a Delaware corporation                     of America, a New Jersey Corporation

                                           By:      Pacific Realty Group, Inc.,
                                                    its Managing Agent

                                       67
<PAGE>

                            FIRST AMENDMENT TO LEASE


         THIS FIRST  AMENDMENT  TO LEASE (the  "Amendment")  is made and entered
into this 29th day of September,  1995, by and between THE PRUDENTIAL  INSURANCE
COMPANY OF AMERICA  ("Landlord"),  having an  address at One  Prudential  Plaza,
Suite 1200, Chicago,  Illinois, 60601, and DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION
("Tenant"), having an office at 9110 West Dodge Road, Suite 200, Omaha, Nebraska
68114.

                                    RECITALS

A.       The  Prudential  Insurance  Company  of America  and Data  Transmission
         Network  Corporation entered into that certain Lease dated as of May 2,
         1995 (the "Lease"),  for Suites #175A,  #110,  #200,  #300, #301, #310,
         #320, #325, #340, #360, and #362 containing 75,931 rentable square feet
         in the  Building  known as  Embassy  Plaza,  located at 9110 West Dodge
         Road, Omaha, Nebraska ("the Premises").

B.       All  capitalized  terms not  defined  herein  shall  have the  meanings
         ascribed to them in the Lease.

         NOW,  THEREFORE,  in consideration of the foregoing  promises and other
good and  valuable  considerations,  the  receipt and  sufficiency  of which are
hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto covenant and agree as follows:

1.       Premises.  The  Premises  shall be  expanded  to  include:  Space  "A",
         effective  October  1,  1995,  measuring  3,688  RSF;  and  Space  "B",
         effective  July  1,  1996,   measuring   2,902  RSF  (the   "Additional
         Premises"). Both Space "A" and Space "B" are located on the third floor
         of the Building as shown on the floor plan attached  hereto,  marked as
         Exhibit "A", and by this reference made a part hereof. As of October 1,
         1995,  the Premises shall consist of 79,619 RSF and as of July 1, 1996,
         the Premises shall consist of 82,521 RSF (the Revised Premises)

2.       Term.  The term of the Lease  with  respect  to Space "A" and Space "B"
         shall be that period of time commencing October 1, 1995, for Space "A",
         and July 1,  1996,  for Space  "B" and  ending  on May 31,  2005,  (the
         "Expiration Date").

3.       Base Rent.  Tenant shall pay as Base Rent for the  Additional  Premises
         during  the Term  the sum of Nine  Hundred  and  Seven  Thousand,  Five
         Hundred Twenty-One Dollars and No Cents  ($907,521.00)  payable monthly
         as follows:

          October 1, 1995 - June 30, 1996                $4,533.17 / Month
          July 1, 1996 - May 31, 2005                    $8,100.21 / Month

                                       68
<PAGE>
4.       Tenant  Improvements.  Landlord  shall  provide  a  tenant  improvement
         allowance of up to $30,412.00  for Space "A", and up to $30,790.22  for
         Space "B", to be applied toward the cost of Tenant's  required building
         improvements.  All  improvements  shall be performed in accordance with
         the Tenant Improvement Work Schedule attached hereto, marked as Exhibit
         "B", and by this reference made a part hereof.

5.       Tenant's  Proportionate  Share. The schedule of Tenant's  Proportionate
         Share  contained  in Item D of the Basic  Terms of the  Lease  shall be
         replaced with the following schedule:

          May 1, 1995 - May 31, 1995           46.37% (60,361 RSF / 130,173 RSF)
          June 1, 1995 - September 30, 1995    50.44% (65,787 RSF / 130,436 RSF)
          October 1, 1995 - June 30, 1996      53.05% (69,475 RSF / 130,950 RSF)
          July 1, 1996 - December 31, 1997     55.21% (72,377 RSF / 131,094 RSF)
          January 1, 1998 - May 31, 2005       62.95% (82,521 RSF / 131,094 RSF)

6.       Adjustment Rent. Effective with commencement of the Term for Spaces "A"
         and "B",  Tenant shall pay Adjustment Rent in accordance with the terms
         and conditions contained in Paragraph 2 of the Lease.

7.       Effect of Agreement.  Except as herein specifically provided, the terms
         and conditions of the Lease shall continue in full force and effect.

6.       This  Amendment  shall be binding  upon and inure to the benefit of the
         parties hereto, their successors and assigns.

7.       The  parties   hereto  hereby   reaffirm  and  ratify  all   covenants,
         representations  and  warranties  in  the  Lease  as  amended  by  this
         Amendment.

         IN WITNESS WHEREOF, Landlord and Tenant have executed this Amendment as
of the day and year first above written.


Tenant:                                    Landlord:

Data Transmission Network Corporation,     The Prudential Insurance Company 
a Delaware corporation                     of America, a New Jersey corporation

By:  /s/ Greg T. Sloma                     By:  Pacific Realty Group, Inc.,
     -----------------------------               its Managing Agent
Its:  Executive Vice President and
      Chief Operating Officer
     -----------------------------

                                       69
<PAGE>
EXHIBIT  "B" to be  made a part  of a  First  Amendment  To  Lease  between  THE
PRUDENTIAL  INSURANCE  COMPANY  OF  AMERICA  (Landlord),  and DATA  TRANSMISSION
NETWORK CORPORATION (Tenant), dated September  29, 1995. (Page 1 of 2)

                        TENANT IMPROVEMENTS WORK SCHEDULE

                                    ARTICLE I
                       Landlord's Construction Obligations

     Landlord  shall have no  construction  obligations  under  this  Amendment.
Tenant accepts the Additional Premises in an "as is" condition,  with all faults
and  with  the  understanding  that  it  shall  be  responsible  for any and all
improvements required for its occupancy and use in accordance with Article II of
this Exhibit "B".

                                   ARTICLE II
                       Construction of Tenant Improvements

     Tenant  shall  have the right to place  partitions  and  fixtures  and make
improvements or other alterations in the Additional  Premises in accordance with
the  provisions of Paragraph 9 of the Lease.  Landlord  shall  provide  Tenant a
tenant finish allowance of up to Sixty-One  Thousand,  Eight Hundred  Thirty-Two
Dollars and Twenty Cents  ($61,832.20) to be applied toward the cost of any such
tenant-provided improvements as follows:

     1. The tenant finish allowance shall be paid in periodic installments,  not
more frequently than once per month,  equal to the total of the  contractor's or
consultant's  invoice amounts for improvements made to the Additional  Premises,
excluding   any   furnishings   or  business   equipment   (such  as  computers,
satellite/microwave  dish, office  equipment,  etc.), as submitted by Tenant and
verified to Landlord's  reasonable  satisfaction;  provided,  however, that such
payments  will be made only if Tenant is not then in Default  under the terms of
this Lease and invoices are  accompanied  by lien waivers in the amount equal to
that of the  invoices.  The  tenant  finish  allowance  shall be  allocated  and
distributed subject to the provisions of this Exhibit "B" as follows:

              October 1, 1995 - February 29, 1996 Up To $30,412.00  July 1, 1996
              - November 30, 1996 Up To $30,790.22

     2. Upon the earlier of the end dates identified in the allocation  schedule
specified  in  Paragraph  1  above,  or  the  satisfaction  of  all  obligations
associated  with the  tenant  improvements  covered  under  this  Article II and
receipt of the  associated  lien waivers for the work,  the Tenant shall forfeit
any unused  portion of the allowance.  Any requests for payment  received by the
Landlord after the above specified end dates, will be returned to the Tenant and
will be the obligation and sole responsibility of the Tenant.

     3. In addition  to the  provisions  set forth in  Paragraph 9 of the Lease,
Tenant's contractor shall (and its contract shall so provide):

         (a)  conduct  its  work  in  such a  manner  so as not to  unreasonably
              interfere with other tenants in the Building, Building operations,
              or any other  construction  occurring on or in the Building or the
              Premises;

                                       70
<PAGE>
         (b)  execute  a set  of and  comply  with  all  rules  and  regulations
              relating to the  construction  activities in or on the Building as
              may be reasonably promulgated from time to time by Landlord or its
              agents;

         (c)  maintain such insurance  (such as general  liability and workman's
              compensation)  and bonds (such as performance  and  completion) in
              force and effect as may be reasonably  requested by Landlord or as
              required by  applicable  law (but in any event said bonds shall be
              in amounts  equal to the full value or cost of the work being done
              by the Tenant contractor);

         (d)  be  responsible  for reaching an agreement  with  Landlord and its
              agents as to the terms and  conditions  for all  contractor  items
              relating to the conducting of its work,  including but not limited
              to, those matters relating to hoisting,  systems interfacing,  use
              of  temporary  utilities,  storage  of  materials,   placement  of
              dumpsters,  access  to the  Premises  and  the  Building,  and the
              purchase and return of Building standard materials.

         (e)  Upon completion of any tenant improvements,  Tenant shall promptly
              furnish  Landlord with sworn owner's and  contractors'  statements
              and  full  and  final  waivers  of lien  covering  all  labor  and
              materials included in such  improvements.  Tenant shall not permit
              any mechanic's lien to be filed against the Building,  or any part
              thereof,  arising out of any improvement performed,  or alleged to
              have been performed,  by or on behalf of Tenant.  If any such lien
              is filed,  Tenant shall within ten (10) days  thereafter have such
              lien  released  of record or deliver  to  Landlord a bond in form,
              amount,   and  issued  by  a  surety   satisfactory  to  Landlord,
              indemnifying  Landlord against all costs and liabilities resulting
              from  such  lien  and the  foreclosure  or  attempted  foreclosure
              thereof.  If  Tenant  fails to have such  lien so  released  or to
              deliver such bond to Landlord, Landlord, without investigating the
              validity of such lien,  may pay or discharge the same;  and Tenant
              shall  reimburse  Landlord  upon  demand for the amount so paid by
              Landlord, including Landlord's expenses and attorney's fees.

     4. Landlord shall have the right to approve all  subcontractors  to be used
by the Tenant's contractor, which approval shall not be unreasonably withheld as
long as such subcontractors satisfy the requirements of this Article II.

     5.  Tenant  shall  indemnify  and  hold  harmless  Landlord,   its  agents,
contractors (including Building Contractor), and any mortgagee of Landlord, from
and against  any and all losses,  damages,  costs  (including  costs of suit and
attorneys' fees), liabilities, or causes of action for injury to or death of any
person,  for damage to any property,  and for mechanic's  materialmen's or other
liens or  claims  arising  out of or in  connection  with  the work  done by the
Tenant's    contractor   (and   Tenant's    contractor's    subcontractors   and
sub-subcontractors) under its contract with Tenant.

                                       71
<PAGE>

     6. The failure by Tenant,  after receiving  written  notice,  to materially
comply with any of the provisions of Article II of this Exhibit shall constitute
a Default  by Tenant  under the terms of the Lease and  Landlord  shall have the
benefit of all remedies  provided for in the Lease,  except  Tenant shall have a
thirty (30) day right to cure Default upon receipt of written notice .

     7. Upon  completion  of the Tenant  Improvements,  Tenant shall  deliver to
Landlord  two (2)  copies of the "as  built"  plans and  specifications  for the
Tenant  Improvements  completed  under Article II of this Exhibit  within thirty
(30) days of completing the same.


                                       72
<PAGE>



                          1995 RESTATED LOAN AGREEMENT

        This 1995 Restated Loan Agreement (the  "Agreement")  is entered into as
of the 29th day of June, 1995 among DATA  TRANSMISSION  NETWORK  CORPORATION,  a
Delaware  corporation  having its principal place of business at Suite 200, 9110
West Dodge Road, Omaha, Nebraska 68114 (the "Borrower"),  FIRST NATIONAL BANK OF
OMAHA, a national banking  association having its principal place of business at
One First  National  Center,  Omaha,  Nebraska 68102  ("FNB-O"),  FIRSTIER BANK,
NATIONAL  ASSOCIATION,  LINCOLN,  NEBRASKA a national banking association having
its principal place of business at 13th and M Streets,  Lincoln,  Nebraska 68508
("FirsTier"),   FIRST  NATIONAL  BANK,  WAHOO,   NEBRASKA,  a  national  banking
association  having its  principal  place of business at Wahoo,  Nebraska  68066
("FNB-W"),  NBD BANK, a bank  organized  under the laws of the State of Michigan
and having its  principal  place of business at 611  Woodward  Avenue,  Detroit,
Michigan  48226  ("NBD"),  NORWEST  BANK  NEBRASKA,  N.A.,  a  national  banking
association  having its principal  place of business at 20th and Farnam Streets,
Omaha,  Nebraska 68102 ("Norwest"),  THE BOATMEN'S NATIONAL BANK OF ST. LOUIS, a
national  banking  association  having its  principal  place of  business at One
Boatmen's Plaza, 800 Market Street, P.O. Box 236, St. Louis, Missouri 63166-0236
("Boatmen's"),  and  AgAmerica,  FCB, a farm credit  bank doing  business at 206
South 19th Street, Omaha, Nebraska 68102-1745 ("AgAmerica").


                                   WITNESSETH:

        WHEREAS,  the  Borrower,   FNB-O,  FirsTier,  FNB-W,  NBD,  Norwest  and
Boatmen's  are  parties  to  a  1993  Restated  Loan   Agreement   dated  as  of
November\8,\1993,  as amended by a First  Amendment to Restated  Loan  Agreement
dated as of April\11,\1994, a Second Amendment to and Extension of Restated Loan
Agreement  dated as of  June\29,\1994,  a Third  Amendment to 1993 Restated Loan
Agreement dated as of August\30,\1994,  a Fourth Amendment to 1993 Restated Loan
Agreement dated as of November\29,\1994, a Fifth Amendment to 1993 Restated Loan
Agreement dated as of February\27,\1995,  and a Sixth Amendment to 1993 Restated
Loan Agreement dated as of April\28,\1995;




                                       73
<PAGE>
        WHEREAS,  the  Borrower,   FNB-O,  FirsTier,  FNB-W,  NBD,  Norwest  and
Boatmen's  wish to further  amend such prior 1993 Restated  Loan  Agreement,  as
amended;

        WHEREAS,  the  Borrower,   FNB-O,  FirsTier,  FNB-W,  NBD,  Norwest  and
Boatmen's wish to restate such prior 1993 Restated Loan  Agreement,  as amended,
and to have this 1995 Restated Loan Agreement be the controlling  agreement with
respect to the matters set forth  herein,  which shall  supersede the prior 1993
Restated Loan Agreement, as amended;

        WHEREAS,  the  Borrower,   FNB-O,  FirsTier,  FNB-W,  NBD,  Norwest  and
Boatmen's do not intend for this 1995  Restated  Loan  Agreement to be deemed to
extinguish any existing indebtedness of the Borrower or to release, terminate or
affect the priority of any security therefor; and

        WHEREAS,  AgAmerica  wishes to become a party to this 1995 Restated Loan
Agreement, and the other parties are agreeable thereto;

        NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises, and for other good and
valuable  consideration,   the  receipt  and  sufficiency  of  which  is  hereby
acknowledged, it is agreed as follows:


                                                 I.  DEFINITIONS

        For purposes of this Agreement, the following definitions shall apply:

ADVANCE:          Any  advance of funds to the  Borrower  by the Banks or any of
                  them pursuant to this Agreement.

AGAMERICA:        AgAmerica, FCB, a farm credit bank doing business at 206 South
                  19th Street,  Omaha,  Nebraska 68102-1745,  and its successors
                  and assigns.

AGREEMENT:        This 1995 Restated Loan  Agreement  dated as of  June\29,\1995
                  between the Borrower and the Banks.

BANKS:            FNB-O, FirsTier, FNB-W, NBD, Norwest, Boatmen's and AgAmerica.

BASE RATE:        The floating  interest rate announced from time to time
                  by FNB-O as its  "National  Base  Rate."  This  rate is set by
                  FNB-O,  solely in its  discretion,  to reflect  generally  the
                  rates  charged  by  national   money  center  banks  as  their
                  reference rates. (Previously, the rate was announced by


                                       74
<PAGE>

                  FNB-O as its "New York Base Rate.") Rates charged by FNB-O may
                  be at, above or below the National Base Rate, as determined by
                  FNB-O as to each respective customer.

BOATMEN'S:        The Boatmen's  National Bank of St. Louis, a national  banking
                  association  having its  principal  place of  business  at One
                  Boatmen's  Plaza,  800  Market  Street,  St.  Louis,  Missouri
                  63166-0236, and its successors and assigns.

BORROWER:         Data Transmission Network Corporation,  a Delaware corporation
                  having its principal place of business at Suite 200, 9110 West
                  Dodge Road, Omaha, Nebraska 68114.

BUSINESS
DAY:              Any day other than a  Saturday,  Sunday or a legal  holiday on
                  which  banks  in the  State  of  Nebraska  are  not  open  for
                  business.

CHANGE OF
CONTROL:          (a) At any  time  when  any of the  equity  securities  of the
                  Borrower   shall  be  registered   under  Section  12  of  the
                  Securities  Exchange  Act of 1934 as amended from time to time
                  (the  "Exchange  Act"),  (i) any  person,  entity  or  "group"
                  (within the meaning of Section  13(d)(3) of the Exchange  Act)
                  (other than any person which is a management employee,  or any
                  such "group" which consists entirely of management  employees,
                  of the  Borrower)  being or  becoming  the  beneficial  owner,
                  directly or  indirectly,  of more than 50% of the voting stock
                  of the  Borrower,  or (ii) a  majority  of the  members of the
                  Borrower's  board of directors  (the  "Board")  consisting  of
                  persons  other  than  Continuing   Directors  (as  hereinafter
                  defined);  and (b) at any  other  time,  less  than 50% of the
                  voting  stock  of  the  Borrower  being  owned   beneficially,
                  directly or  indirectly,  by  employees of the Borrower or its
                  subsidiaries.  As used herein, the term "Continuing  Director"
                  means any member of the Board on the date hereof and any other
                  member of the Board who shall be  recommended  or  elected  to
                  succeed a  Continuing  Director  by a majority  of  Continuing
                  Directors who are the members of the Board.




                                       75
<PAGE>
COLLATERAL:       All  personal  property  of  the  Borrower  described  in  the
                  Security  Agreement,  whether now owned or hereafter acquired,
                  including, without limitation:

                  (a)  all  of the  Borrower's  accounts,  accounts  receivable,
                  chattel  paper,  documents,   instruments,  goods,  inventory,
                  equipment, general intangibles; and

                  (b) all proceeds and products of the foregoing.

CONVERSION:       This term shall have the meaning set forth in Section 2.3.

EXISTING
TERM              NOTES:  Those  certain  promissory  notes from the Borrower to
                  FNB-O, FirsTier, FNB-W, NBD, Norwest and Boatmen's dated as of
                  January\15,  1992,  February\4,  1992,  March\3,  1992, May\6,
                  1992, July\7, 1992, October\1, 1992, October\12, 1992, October
                  13, 1992,  October\19,  1992,  November\3,  1992,  December 7,
                  1992, December\31,  1992, January\4,  1993, February\9,  1993,
                  April\16,  1993, July\8, 1993, August\30,  1994,  November\29,
                  1994,  and  February\27,  1995, all as described on Schedule A
                  hereto.

FIRSTIER:         FirsTier Bank,  National  Association,  Lincoln,  Nebraska,  a
                  national  banking  association  having its principal  place of
                  business at 13th and M Streets,  Lincoln,  Nebraska 68508, and
                  its successors and assigns.

FNB-O:            First National Bank of Omaha, a national  banking  association
                  having its principal  place of business at One First  National
                  Center, Omaha, Nebraska 68102, and its successors and assigns.

FNB-W:            First  National  Bank,  Wahoo,  Nebraska,  a national  banking
                  association  having its principal  place of business at Wahoo,
                  Nebraska 68066, and its successors and assigns.

FIXED RATE
NOTICE:           This term shall have the meaning set forth in Section 2.4.

NBD:              NBD  Bank,  a bank  organized  under  the laws of the State of
                  Michigan  and having its  principal  place of  business at 611
                  Woodward Avenue, Detroit, Michigan 48226.

                                       76
<PAGE>
NET WORTH:        The  Borrower's  net worth as determined in accordance with
                  generally  accepted  accounting  principles plus  subordinated
                  debt.  For purposes of this  definition,  "subordinated  debt"
                  means indebtedness of the Borrower which is subordinate,  in a
                  manner  satisfactory to the Banks, to the  indebtedness due to
                  the Banks,  and the repayment of which is forbidden during the
                  existence of any Event of Default hereunder; provided however,
                  that any such  indebtedness  shall not be deemed  subordinated
                  debt to the extent of the amount of  principal  payments  that
                  are  due   thereon   within   one   year   from  the  date  of
                  determination.

NORWEST:          Norwest Bank Nebraska,  N.A., a national  banking  association
                  having  its  principal  place of  business  at 20th and Farnam
                  Streets,   Omaha,  Nebraska  68102,  and  its  successors  and
                  assigns.

     Note A:  Promissory  note  dated  as of the  date  hereof  and  made by the
     Borrower to FNB-O in the principal amount of $9,315,000,  or any promissory
     note given in extension or substitution thereof.

     Note B:  Promissory  note  dated  as of the  date  hereof  and  made by the
     Borrower  to  FirsTier  in  the  principal  amount  of  $3,795,000,  or any
     promissory note given in extension or substitution thereof.

     Note C:  Promissory  note  dated  as of the  date  hereof  and  made by the
     Borrower to FNB-W in the principal  amount of $345,000,  or any  promissory
     note given in extension or substitution thereof.

     Note D:  Promissory  note  dated  as of the  date  hereof  and  made by the
     Borrower to NBD in the principal  amount of  $7,245,000,  or any promissory
     note given in extension or substitution thereof.

     Note E:  Promissory  note  dated  as of the  date  hereof  and  made by the
     Borrower  to  Norwest  in  the  principal  amount  of  $6,555,000,  or  any
     promissory note given in extension or substitution thereof.

     Note F:  Promissory  note  dated  as of the  date  hereof  and  made by the
     Borrower  to  AgAmerica  in  the  principal  amount  of  $7,245,000  or any
     promissory note given in extension or substitution thereof.


                                       77
<PAGE>

NOTES:            Note A,  Note B,  Note C,  Note D,  Note E and  Note F and any
                  separate  promissory  notes given to  evidence  the term loans
                  created by Conversion.

OPERATING
CASH              FLOW: The Borrower's  average monthly  earnings or loss before
                  interest, depreciation and taxes, less current tax expense and
                  plus or minus any non-ordinary  non-cash charges or credits to
                  earnings,  which  average  shall be  based  on the  Borrower's
                  actual  financial  results  in the two  full  calendar  months
                  preceding   the  date  of   determination.   For  purposes  of
                  calculating  Operating  Cash  Flow  for  this  Agreement,  the
                  Borrower shall not permit deferred  commission  expenses to be
                  capitalized for any period in excess of twelve months.

OPERATIVE
DOCUMENTS:        This 1995 Restated Loan Agreement, the Related Loan Agreement,
                  the Notes,  the Existing Term Notes,  the Security  Agreement,
                  the  financing  statements  regarding the  Collateral  and the
                  documents and certificates delivered pursuant to Article V.

PRINCIPAL
LOAN AMOUNT:      As to the Revolving  Credit  facility,  the aggregate
                  principal  amount of all unpaid  Advances  outstanding  at any
                  time not including the unpaid  balance under the Existing Term
                  Notes or any amounts  converted to a term loan hereunder,  and
                  as to term loan hereunder,  the unpaid principal amount of any
                  Conversion under Section 2.3.

QUARTERLY
COMPLIANCE
CERTIFICATE:      The  certificate  delivered  to  the  Banks  by  the  Borrower
                  pursuant to Section 4.1(d).

RELATED
BANK DEBT:        The aggregate unpaid balance of all indebtedness, now or
                  hereafter  existing  (including  future  advances)  under  the
                  Related Loan  Agreement,  including,  without  limitation  the
                  amounts  outstanding under those certain promissory notes from
                  the Borrower to FNB-O,  FirsTier and FNB-W dated as of October
                  13, 1992 and December 7, 1992.

                                       78
<PAGE>
RELATED
LOAN
AGREEMENT:        The Loan  Agreement  dated as of October 9, 1992  between  the
                  Borrower and FNB-O, FirsTier and FNB-W.

REVOLVING
CREDIT            RATE: The Base Rate plus the  applicable  margin as determined
                  pursuant to Section 2.2.

REVOLVING
LENDERS:          FNB-O, FirsTier, FNB-W, NBD, Norwest and AgAmerica.

SECURITY
AGREEMENT:        The Restated  Security  Agreement dated as of November 8, 1993
                  between the  Borrower  and FNB-O,  as agent for the Banks,  as
                  amended from time to time.

SUBSCRIBERS:      Those  customers of the Borrower which have subscribed for the
                  Borrower's  "Basic  DTN  Subscription  Service"  and/or  other
                  services and who are not in default of their  payment or other
                  obligations with respect thereto.

TOTAL
INDEBTEDNESS:     All loans and other  obligations  of the Borrower for borrowed
                  money (including,  without limitation, the indebtedness due to
                  the Banks)  regardless  of the maturity  thereof but such term
                  shall not include  subordinated  debt, as such term is defined
                  in the  definition  of Net  Worth  up to  $15,000,000  if such
                  subordinated debt is existing on the date of this Agreement.

All  accounting  terms not  otherwise  defined  herein  shall  have the  meaning
ordinarily applied under generally accepted accounting principles.


                                 II. LOAN TERMS

        2.1 Revolving Credit. Until the earlier of June\30,  1996 or the date on
which the loan hereunder is converted to a term loan in accordance  with Section
2.3, the Revolving  Lenders agree to advance funds not to exceed  $34,500,000 to
the Borrower on a revolving credit basis (amounts outstanding under the Existing
Term Notes and Related Bank Debt shall not be counted  against such  $34,500,000
limit).  Such  advances  shall  be made on a pro  rata  basis  by the  Revolving
Lenders,  based on the  following  maximum  advance  limits  for each  Revolving
Lender: (1) as to FNB-O, $9,315,000; (ii) as to FirsTier, $3,795,000;


                                       79
<PAGE>

(iii) as to FNB-W,  $345,000;  (iv) as to NBD,  $7,245,000;  (v) as to  Norwest,
$6,555,000;  and (vi) as to  AgAmerica,  $7,245,000.  The Borrower  shall not be
entitled to any Advance  hereunder  if,  after the making of such  Advance,  the
Total Indebtedness  would exceed thirty-six times the Borrower's  Operating Cash
Flow,  determined at the time of the Advance. Nor shall the Borrower be entitled
to any further  Advances  hereunder  after the occurrence of a material  adverse
change in its management  personnel,  as described in Section 4.14(b).  Advances
shall  be  made,  on the  terms  and  conditions  of this  Agreement,  upon  the
Borrower's request. Requests shall be made by 12 noon Omaha time on the Business
Day  prior  to the  requested  date of the  Advance.  Requests  shall be made by
presentation  to FNB-O of a drawing  certificate  in the form of  Exhibit A. The
Borrower  shall pay to the Revolving  Lenders a commitment fee of one quarter of
one percent (.25%) per annum of the unadvanced portion of the $34,500,000 credit
line  described  above.  Such fee  shall be paid to  FNB-O  quarterly  (calendar
quarters) in arrears and based on the average  unused  portion of the  revolving
credit commitment during the preceding  quarter.  FNB-O shall distribute to each
Revolving  Lender  its pro rata share of such fee based on the  maximum  advance
limits set forth  above.  If the  Borrower's  most recent  Quarterly  Compliance
Certificate  shows that,  as of the end of the prior  quarter  (the  "Applicable
Quarter"),  Total  Indebtedness  was equal to or in excess of 250% of Net Worth,
then each Revolving Lender may deduct from the amount of any subsequent  advance
requested  during the quarter  following  the  Applicable  Quarter a closing fee
equal to  one-half  of one  percent  (.50%) of the amount of the  advance (if an
advance is requested and made during the first twenty days of a quarter, and the
Borrower  has  not yet  made  the  foregoing  calculation  as to the  Applicable
Quarter, the Revolving Lenders reserve the right to invoice the Borrower for, or
deduct from any subsequent advance,  any such fee which would have been deducted
but for the fact that the Quarterly  Compliance  Certificate  for the Applicable
Quarter had not been completed). In addition to the foregoing fees, the Borrower
will pay at  closing a  commitment  fee to each Bank  shown  below in the amount
indicated opposite such Bank's name:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                     Commitment
         Bank          Increase in Facility                              Fee
        --------      ----------------------                         ----------
<S>                          <C>                                     <C>       
         FNB-O               $2,758,500                              $ 3,448.13
         FNB-W                  133,500                                  166.88
         NBD                  3,226,500                                4,033.13
         Norwest              2,959,500                                3,699.38
                                                                     ----------
                                                                     $11,347.47

</TABLE>
Furthermore  the Borrower  will pay to FNB-O at closing an agenting fee equal to
$2,826.72.

                                       80
<PAGE>
        2.2 Interest on Revolving Credit.  Until the earlier of June 30, 1996 or
the date on which the loan hereunder is converted to a term loan, interest shall
accrue on the Principal Loan Amount  outstanding from time to time at a variable
rate,  which shall  fluctuate on a monthly basis,  equal to the Base Rate plus a
margin as determined below,  except that after an Event of Default has occurred,
interest  shall  accrue on the  entire  outstanding  balance  of  principal  and
interest at a  fluctuating  rate equal to the  Revolving  Credit Rate as defined
below plus four percent  (4.00%).  The margin shall be adjusted  quarterly after
receipt of the Borrower's Quarterly Compliance Certificate. Adjustments shall be
retroactive to the beginning of the current quarter.

                (i) If the Quarterly  Compliance  Certificate  shows that, as of
        the end of the prior quarter,  Total  Indebtedness was less than 200% of
        Net Worth,  the margin for the current  quarter  (meaning the quarter in
        which the certificate is required to be delivered) shall be zero.

                (ii) If the Quarterly  Compliance  Certificate shows that, as of
        the end of the prior quarter, Total Indebtedness was equal to or greater
        than 200% of Net Worth but less than 250% of Net  Worth,  the margin for
        the current quarter shall be one quarter of one percent (.25%).

                (iii) If the Quarterly Compliance  Certificate shows that, as of
        the end of the prior quarter, Total Indebtedness was equal to or greater
        than 250% of Net Worth but less than 300% of Net  Worth,  the margin for
        the current quarter shall be three quarters of one percent (.75%).

                (iv) If the Quarterly  Compliance  Certificate shows that, as of
        the end of the prior quarter, Total Indebtedness was equal to or greater
        than 300% of Net Worth,  the margin for the current quarter shall be one
        and one quarter percent (1.25%).

The Base Rate plus the  applicable  margin as  determined  above is  hereinafter
referred to as the "Revolving  Credit Rate." Interest shall be calculated on the
basis of the actual number of days  outstanding  and a 360-day year.  Changes in
the Base Rate shall be  effective  on the first day of each month,  based on the
Base Rate in effect on such day.  Interest  shall be due upon the  rendering  of
each monthly invoice therefor by FNB-O.

        2.3 Term Loan.  Upon the  earlier  of: (i)  June\30,  1996;  or (ii) the
Borrower's  giving notice of its election to convert the loan hereunder,  or any
portion  thereof,  to a term loan, the revolving credit loan described above (or
applicable   portion   thereof)  shall  be  deemed  converted  to  a  term  loan
(hereinafter referred to as "Conversion"). At the option of the parties,

                                       81
<PAGE>
any such term loans may be evidenced by notes  separate from Notes A, B, C, D, E
and F. Upon  Conversion,  no  further  Advances  shall be made by the  Revolving
Lenders on the converted amount and the then  outstanding  Principal Loan Amount
of the respective  term loan shall become due and payable in  forty-eight  equal
installments of principal,  with the first such  installment due on the 30th day
of the month following Conversion, or, if such day is not a Business Day, on the
next succeeding Business Day, and subsequent installments due on the same day of
each consecutive month thereafter.  In any event, the total amount of all unpaid
principal and accrued interest  hereunder shall be due and payable no later than
June\30, 2000.

        2.4 Interest on Term Loan.  After  Conversion,  interest shall accrue on
the Principal Loan Amount  outstanding on the respective  term loan from time to
time at a variable  rate,  which shall  fluctuate on a monthly  basis,  which is
equal to the Revolving  Credit Rate plus one quarter of one percent (.25%).  For
purposes of  computing  such  variable  rate,  changes in the Base Rate shall be
effective  on the  first day of each  month  based on the Base Rate in effect on
such day.  Notwithstanding  anything in the  foregoing  to the  contrary,  after
Conversion, the Borrower may elect one of the following alternatives in order to
have a fixed  interest  rate  apply to the  outstanding  Principal  Loan  Amount
converted  and  outstanding  after the date of giving  notice of such fixed rate
election (the "Fixed Rate Notice"):

                (a) if the Fixed Rate Notice is given  within  twelve  months of
        Conversion, the Borrower may elect a fixed rate equal to the greater of

                         (i) the Revolving  Credit Rate in effect on the date of
                the notice, plus three quarters of one percent (.75%), or

                         (ii) two and one-half percent (2.50%) above the average
                of  the  yields  on  constant   maturity   Treasury  Bonds  with
                maturities  of three  years  and five  years,  as  quoted in the
                immediately   preceding  monthly  Federal  Reserve   Statistical
                Release (the "Release") for the month preceding such Release;

                (b) if the Fixed Rate  Notice is given after  twelve  months but
        within twenty-four months of Conversion,  the Borrower may elect a fixed
        rate equal to the greater of

                         (i) the Revolving  Credit Rate in effect on the date of
                the notice, plus three quarters of one percent (.75%), or

                         (ii) two and one-half  percent  (2.50%) above the yield
                on constant maturity Treasury Bonds with a

                                       82
<PAGE>
                maturity of three years as quoted in the  immediately  preceding
                monthly Release for the month preceding such Release;

                (c) if the Fixed Rate Notice is given after  twenty-four  months
        of Conversion but within thirty-six  months of Conversion,  the Borrower
        may elect a fixed rate equal to the greater of

                         (i) the Revolving  Credit Rate in effect on the date of
                the notice, plus one-half of one percent (.50%), or

                         (ii) two and one-half  percent  (2.50%) above the yield
                on  constant  maturity  Treasury  Bonds with a  maturity  of two
                years,  as quoted in the immediately  preceding  monthly Release
                for the month preceding such Release; and

                (d) if the Fixed Rate Notice is given after thirty-six months of
        Conversion  but prior to the maturity of the term loan, the Borrower may
        elect a fixed rate equal to the  Revolving  Credit Rate in effect on the
        date of the notice, plus one-half of one percent (.50%).

Any  election of a fixed rate by the  Borrower  shall be final and  irrevocable.
Notwithstanding  the foregoing,  after an Event of Default has occurred interest
shall accrue on the entire  outstanding  balance of principal  and interest at a
fluctuating  rate equal to the Revolving  Credit Rate plus four percent (4.00%).
Interest  shall  be  calculated  on the  basis  of the  actual  number  of  days
outstanding  and a 360-day year.  Interest shall be due each month  concurrently
with the Borrower's principal payment.  Interest shall continue to accrue on the
full unpaid  balance  hereunder  notwithstanding  any  permitted or  unpermitted
failure of the Borrower to make a scheduled payment or the fact that a scheduled
payment  day falls on a day other than a Business  Day. If the  Borrower's  most
recent Quarterly  Compliance  Certificate shows that, as of the end of the prior
quarter,  Total  Indebtedness  was in excess of 250% of Net Worth,  the  current
quarter shall be deemed a "Restricted Quarter." If, any time during a Restricted
Quarter (including,  without limitation, during any period in such quarter prior
to delivery of the Quarterly Compliance Certificate), the interest rate accruing
on any Existing Term Note or term loan hereinafter  created under this Agreement
is less than seven and  one-half  percent  (7.50%),  a "Trigger  Event" shall be
deemed to have occurred.  Upon the  occurrence of a Trigger Event,  the Borrower
shall be obligated to pay the following fees: (i)  three-eighths  of one percent
(.375%) of the outstanding principal balance of such Note or term loan as of the
date  preceding the Trigger Event,  which amount shall be payable  promptly upon
invoicing by the Banks;  (ii) the same amount as computed in clause (i), payable
on the six-month anniversary of the Trigger Event; and

                                       83
<PAGE>
(iii) the same amount as computed  in clause  (i),  payable on the  twelve-month
anniversary of the Trigger Event.

        2.5 Payment. The Borrower's obligation to make payments of principal and
interest  hereunder shall be further  evidenced by the Notes. All obligations of
the Borrower under the Notes and the other Operative  Documents shall be payable
in immediately  available  funds in lawful money of the United States of America
at the principal office of FNB-O in Omaha,  Nebraska or at such other address as
may be designated by FNB-O in writing.

        2.6  Prepayment.  The Borrower may at any time prepay the Principal Loan
Amount  outstanding  under the Revolving  Credit  facility or any term loan. Any
such  prepayment  may be made  without  penalty  except  after  Conversion  when
interest  is  accruing on a fixed rate basis  under  Section  2.4(a),  2.4(b) or
2.4(c), in which event a prepayment fee shall be due as follows: (i) if interest
is  accruing at the rate set forth in Section  2.4(a),  the fee shall be one and
one-half percent (1.50%) of the amount of such  prepayment;  (ii) if interest is
accruing at the rate set forth in Section 2.4(b), the fee shall be three-fourths
of one  percent  (.75%) of the amount of such  prepayment;  (iii) if interest is
accruing at the rate set forth in Section 2.4(c),  the fee shall be three-tenths
of one percent (.30%) of the amount of such prepayment.

        2.7 Security.  All  obligations of the Borrower  hereunder and under the
Operative Documents,  including,  without limitation, the Borrower's obligations
to make payments of principal and interest  shall be secured by a first security
interest in the  Collateral,  as more  specifically  described  in the  Security
Agreement.

        2.8 Existing Term Notes. The Borrower's  obligations  under the Existing
Term Notes shall continue in full force and effect in accordance  with the terms
thereof.  Such notes shall be deemed  amended to include this 1995 Restated Loan
Agreement  within  the  definition  of  Obligations  in  such  notes,  it  being
understood that this 1995 Restated Loan Agreement, rather than the 1993 Restated
Loan  Agreement  of  November  8, 1993,  shall be  controlling  with  respect to
defaults,  covenants and all other relevant  matters  arising under the Existing
Term Notes and the Notes  executed and  delivered in  connection  with this 1995
Restated Loan Agreement. The Existing Term Notes shall continue to be secured by
the security interest provided in the Security Agreement.

        2.9 Related Loan  Agreement.  Nothing herein shall be deemed to alter or
amend the  Borrower's  obligations  under the  Related  Loan  Agreement  and the
Related Bank Debt shall continue in full force and effect in accordance with the
terms thereof.

                                       84
<PAGE>
                       III. REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

        The Borrower  represents  and warrants that as of the date hereof and as
of the date of each and every  request for an Advance  hereunder,  the following
are and shall be true and correct:

        3.1 Corporate  Existence.  It is a corporation  duly organized,  validly
existing and in good  standing  under the laws of the State of Delaware and duly
qualified  and in good  standing  in all  jurisdictions  in  which  it is  doing
business and in which failure to qualify would have a material  adverse  effect,
including without limitation the States of Nebraska,  Iowa,  Illinois,  Indiana,
Kansas, Michigan,  Minnesota,  Missouri, Ohio, South Dakota and Wisconsin and it
has full power and authority to own and operate its  properties  and to carry on
its business.

        3.2 Corporate  Authority.  It has full  corporate  power,  authority and
legal right to execute,  deliver and perform the Operative Documents to which it
is a party,  and all other  instruments and agreements  contemplated  hereby and
thereby,  and to perform its  obligations  hereunder  and  thereunder;  and such
actions have been duly authorized by all necessary corporate action, and are not
in conflict with any  applicable law or  regulation,  or any order,  judgment or
decree  of any Court or other  governmental  agency  or  instrumentality  or its
articles of  incorporation  or bylaws,  or with any provisions of any indenture,
contract  or  agreement  to  which  it is a party  or by  which it or any of its
property may be bound.

        3.3  Validity of  Agreements.  Its  Operative  Documents  have been duly
authorized,  executed and delivered and constitute its legal,  valid and binding
agreements, enforceable against the Borrower in accordance with their respective
terms  (except  to the extent  that  enforcement  thereof  may be limited by any
applicable  bankruptcy,  reorganization,  moratorium  or  similar  laws  now  or
hereafter in effect, or by principles of equity).

        3.4  Litigation.  It is not a party to any pending lawsuit or proceeding
before or by any court or governmental body or agency, which is likely to have a
materially  adverse effect on the Borrower's  ability to perform its obligations
under its  Operative  Documents;  nor is the  Borrower  aware of any  threatened
lawsuit or proceeding, to which it may become a party or of any investigation of
any Court or governmental  body or agency into its affairs,  which if instituted
would have a material adverse effect upon the Borrower's  ability to perform its
obligations under its Operative Documents.

        3.5  Governmental Approvals.  The execution, delivery and
performance by the Borrower of the Operative Documents do not

                                       85
<PAGE>
require the consent or  approval  of, the giving of notice to, the  registration
with,  or the taking of any other  action in respect of, any  federal,  state or
other  governmental  authority or agency other than as  contemplated  herein and
therein.

        3.6 Defaults Under Other Documents. The Borrower is not in default or in
violation  (nor has any event  occurred  which,  with notice or lapse of time or
both,  would  constitute  a default  or  violation)  under any  document  or any
agreement or  instrument  to which it may be a party or under which it or any of
its  properties  may be bound and the  result  of which  would  have a  material
adverse effect upon the Borrower's  ability to perform its obligations under its
Operative Documents.

        3.7 Judgments.  There are no outstanding or unpaid  judgments (which are
not  adequately  bonded) of the  Borrower  which  would have a material  adverse
effect  upon the  Borrower's  ability  to  perform  its  obligations  under  its
Operative Documents.

        3.8  Compliance  with  Laws.  It  is  not  in  violation  of  any  laws,
regulations or judicial or governmental  decrees in any respect which could have
any material  adverse effect upon the validity or  enforceability  of any of the
terms of its Operative  Documents or which could have a material  adverse effect
upon its ability to perform its obligations under its Operative Documents.

        3.9 Taxes.  All its tax returns for material  taxes required to be filed
have been filed or extensions permitted by law have been obtained;  all taxes of
a material  nature and which are due and payable as  reflected  on such  returns
have been paid, other than taxes which are due but for which only a nominal late
payment  penalty  is  payable  and for which  the  taxing  authority  is not yet
entitled to enforce its remedies for payment  thereof and other than taxes being
contested in good faith and with respect to which  adequate  reserves  have been
established;  and no material amounts of taxes not reflected on such returns are
payable.

        3.10  Collateral.  The  Borrower  has good and  marketable  title to the
Collateral and the Collateral is free from all liens,  encumbrances  or security
interests,  except as disclosed on Schedule B attached  hereto.  The  Borrower's
principal  place of business,  chief  executive  office,  and the place where it
keeps its records  concerning the Collateral is Suite 200, 9110 West Dodge Road,
Omaha, Nebraska 68114.

        3.11  Pension  Benefits.  The  Borrower  does not  maintain  a "Plan" as
defined in Section 3 of the  Employees  Retirement  Income  Security Act of 1974
("ERISA") or is in compliance with the minimum funding requirements with respect
to any such
                                       86
<PAGE>
"Plan" maintained by the Borrower and the Borrower has not incurred any material
liability  to the Pension  Benefit  Guaranty  Corporation  ("PBGC") or otherwise
under ERISA in connection with any such Plan.

        3.12 Margin Regulations. No part of the proceeds of any Advance shall be
used to purchase or carry any "margin stock" (within the meaning of Regulation U
of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System of the United States) or
any  "margin  security"  (within the  meaning of  Regulation  G of said Board of
Governors),  or to extend  credit to others  for the  purpose of  purchasing  or
carrying  any such margin stock or margin  security.  No part of the proceeds of
any  Advance  shall  be  used  for  any  purpose  that  violates,  or  which  is
inconsistent  with,  the  provisions of Regulation G, T, U or X of said Board of
Governors.

        3.13  Financial  Condition.  The financial  condition of the Borrower is
truly and accurately set forth in the most recent financial  statement which has
been  provided to the Banks and no material  adverse  change has occurred  which
would make such financial statement inaccurate or misleading.


                                  IV. COVENANTS

        The Borrower hereby covenants that:

        4.1  Financial Reports.

                (a) Within forty-five (45) days after the end of each month, the
        Borrower,  at its sole expense,  shall furnish the Banks a balance sheet
        and statement of earnings of the Borrower,  prepared in accordance  with
        generally  accepted  accounting  principles   consistently  applied  and
        certified as completed and correct,  subject to normal changes resulting
        from year-end audit  adjustments,  by the chief financial officer of the
        Borrower.

                (b) Within  ninety  (90) days after the close of the  Borrower's
        fiscal year, the Borrower, at its sole expense, shall furnish the Banks:
        (i) a balance sheet and statement of earnings of the Borrower, certified
        by Deloitte & Touche, or other independent  certified public accountants
        acceptable to the Banks,  that such financial reports fairly present the
        financial condition of the Borrower and have been prepared in accordance
        with generally accepted accounting principles  consistently applied; and
        (ii) a certificate from such  accountants  certifying that in making the
        requisite   audit  for   certification   of  the  Borrower's   financial
        statements,  the auditors either (1) have obtained no knowledge, and are
        not otherwise aware of, any condition

                                       87
<PAGE>
        or event which constitutes an event of default or which with the passage
        of time or the  giving of notice  would  constitute  an event of default
        under  Sections  4.3,  4.4,  4.7,  4.9(b),  4.9(d) or 4.11;  or (2) have
        discovered such condition or event,  as  specifically  set forth in such
        certificate,  which  constitutes  an event of  default or which with the
        passage of time or the  giving of notice  would  constitute  an event of
        default  under such  Sections.  The auditors  shall not be liable to the
        Banks by reason of the  auditors'  failure to obtain  knowledge  of such
        event or  condition  in the  ordinary  course of their audit unless such
        failure  is the  result  of  negligence  or  willful  misconduct  in the
        performance of the audit.

                (c)  Within  30 days  after  submission  to the  Securities  and
        Exchange  Commission,  the Borrower shall provide to the Banks copies of
        its Forms 10K and 10Q,  as  submitted  to the  Securities  and  Exchange
        Commission during the term of this Agreement.

                (d) Within twenty (20) days after the end of each  quarter,  the
        Borrower,  at its expense,  shall furnish the Banks a certificate of the
        chief  financial  officer  of the  Borrower  in the form of  Exhibit  B,
        setting  forth  such  information   (including  detailed   calculations)
        sufficient to verify the  conclusions  of such officer after due inquiry
        and review, that:

                         (i) The Borrower,  either (y) is in compliance with the
                requirements  set  forth  in  this  Agreement  or  (z) is NOT in
                compliance with the foregoing for reasons specifically set forth
                therein; and

                         (ii) The chief  financial  officer of the  Borrower has
                reviewed  or  caused  to be  reviewed  all of the  terms  of the
                Operative  Documents of the Borrower and that such review either
                (1) has NOT  disclosed  the  existence of any condition or event
                which  constitutes an event of default or any condition or event
                which with the  passage  of time or the  giving of notice  would
                constitute an event of default under the Operative  Documents or
                (2) has  disclosed  the  existence of a condition or event which
                constitutes  an event of default,  or a condition or event which
                with  the  passage  of  time  or  the  giving  of  notice  would
                constitute an event of default,  under the aforesaid  instrument
                or   instruments   and  the  specific   condition  or  event  is
                specifically set forth.

                (e) The  Borrower  shall  provide  the  Banks  with  such  other
        financial reports and statements as the Banks may reasonably request.

                                       88
<PAGE>
        4.2  Corporate  Structure  and Assets.  The Borrower  shall not merge or
consolidate  with any other  corporation  or entity unless the Borrower shall be
the surviving  entity,  nor sell any assets except items that are obsolete or no
longer  necessary  for  operation  of the  business,  other than in the ordinary
course of business  without the prior  written  consent of the Banks.  The Banks
shall be entitled to receive as a  prepayment  on the Notes the  proceeds of any
sale of assets of the Borrower which are  prohibited by the preceding  sentence.
Notwithstanding the foregoing prepayment requirements,  any such prohibited sale
shall remain a violation of this Agreement.  In addition, the Borrower shall not
engage in any business  materially  different from that in which it is presently
engaged without the prior written consent of the Banks,  which consent shall not
be   unreasonably   withheld.   The  foregoing   restrictions   on  mergers  and
consolidations  shall not apply if: (i) in the case of a merger, the Borrower is
the surviving entity and expressly reaffirms its obligations hereunder;  (ii) in
the case of a consolidation,  the resulting  corporation  expressly  assumes the
obligations  of  the  Borrower  hereunder;  (iii)  the  surviving  or  resulting
corporation  is organized  under the laws of the United States or a jurisdiction
thereof; (iv) after giving effect to such merger or consolidation, the surviving
or  resulting  corporation  will be engaged in  substantially  the same lines of
business as are now engaged in by the Borrower; and (v) immediately after giving
effect  to such  merger  or  consolidation,  no  event  of  default  will  exist
hereunder.

        4.3 Net Worth.  The Borrower  shall  maintain a minimum Net Worth during
the term of this Agreement of at least $11,000,000;  provided,  however,  solely
for purposes of determining  compliance with the provisions of this Section 4.3,
"Net Worth" shall not include any subordinated debt.

        4.4  Indebtedness.

                (a) The  Borrower  shall not at any time  permit  the sum of the
        Total  Indebtedness to the Banks to exceed  forty-eight  times Operating
        Cash Flow.

                (b) The Borrower shall not at any time permit Total Indebtedness
        to exceed 350% of Net Worth.

                (c) On the day the Borrower  becomes  liable with respect to any
        debt and  immediately  after giving effect thereto and to the concurrent
        retirement of any other debt,  the sum of Total  Indebtedness,  plus the
        amount  of  any  outstanding  subordinated  debt,  plus  the  Borrower's
        contingent  obligations  under  any  guaranty  of the debt of any  other
        person or entity (other than unsecured debt of a subsidiary  incurred in
        the  ordinary  course of business  for other than  borrowed  money or to
        finance the purchase price

                                       89
<PAGE>
        of any property or  business)  shall not exceed an amount equal to sixty
        times Operating Cash Flow at such date.

        4.5 Use of  Proceeds.  The  Borrower  shall not use the  proceeds of the
Advances  hereunder to purchase or carry any "margin  stock" (within the meaning
of Regulation U of the Board of Governors of the Federal  Reserve  System of the
United States) or any "margin  security"  (within the meaning of Regulation G of
said  Board of  Governors),  or to extend  credit to others  for the  purpose of
purchasing or carrying any such margin stock or margin security. No part of such
proceeds shall be used for any purpose that violates,  or which is  inconsistent
with, the provisions of Regulation G, T, U or X of said Board of Governors. This
section shall not preclude the Borrower from  repurchasing any of its own issued
and outstanding  common stock;  provided however,  that such repurchase does not
result in the occurrence of any other Event of Default hereunder.

        4.6  Notice of Default.  The Borrower shall give to the
Banks prompt written notification of the existence or
occurrence of:

                (a) any fact or event which results, or which with notice or the
        passage of time, or both, would result in an Event of Default hereunder;

                (b) any proceedings instituted by or against the Borrower in any
        federal, state or local court or before any governmental body or agency,
        or before any  arbitration  board,  or any such  proceedings  threatened
        against the Borrower by any governmental agency, which is likely to have
        a material  adverse  effect upon the  Borrower's  ability to perform its
        obligations under its Operative Documents;

                (c) any  default or event of default  involving  the  payment of
        money  under  any  agreement  or  instrument  which is  material  to the
        Borrower  to which the  Borrower is a party or by which it or any of its
        property may be bound,  and which default or event of default would have
        a material  adverse  effect upon the  Borrower's  ability to perform its
        obligations under its Operative Documents; and

                (d) the Borrower shall give immediate notice of the commencement
        of any proceeding  under the Federal  Bankruptcy  Code by or against the
        Borrower.

        4.7  Distributions.

                (a) The  Borrower  shall not declare any  dividends  or make any
        cash  distribution  in  respect of any  shares of its  capital  stock or
        warrants of its capital stock, without the

                                       90
<PAGE>
        prior written consent of the Banks; provided, however, that the Borrower
        may declare stock dividends;  provided,  further, that the Borrower need
        not obtain the Banks'  consent with respect to dividends in any one year
        which are, in aggregate,  less than 25% of the  Borrower's net operating
        profit after taxes in the  previous  four  quarters,  as reported to the
        Banks pursuant to Section 4.1.

                (b) The Borrower shall not purchase, redeem, or otherwise retire
        any shares of its capital  stock or  warrants  of its capital  stock if,
        immediately  after  the  making  of such  purchase  or  redemption,  the
        Borrower  will be in default of any other  covenant or provision of this
        Agreement (including,  without limitation,  the covenants and provisions
        pertaining to minimum net worth and limitations on indebtedness).

        4.8 Compliance  with Law and  Regulations.  The Borrower shall comply in
all  material   respects  with  all  applicable   federal  and  state  laws  and
regulations.

        4.9  Maintenance of Property; Accounting; Corporate Form;
Taxes; Insurance.

                (a) The Borrower  shall  maintain its property in good condition
        in all material respects,  ordinary wear and tear excepted, and make all
        renewals, replacements,  additions, betterments and improvements thereto
        necessary for the efficient operation of its business.

                (b) The Borrower shall keep true books of record and accounts in
        which  full  and  correct  entries  shall  be made  of all its  business
        transactions,  all in  accordance  with  generally  accepted  accounting
        principles consistently applied.

                (c)  The  Borrower  shall  do or  cause  to be done  all  things
        necessary  to preserve  and keep in full force and effect its  corporate
        form of existence as is necessary for the  continuation  of its business
        in substantially the same form.

                (d)  The  Borrower   shall  pay  all  taxes,   assessments   and
        governmental  charges  or  levies  imposed  upon  it  or  its  property;
        provided, however, that the Borrower shall not be required to pay any of
        the foregoing taxes which are being  diligently  contested in good faith
        by  appropriate  legal  proceedings  and with respect to which  adequate
        reserves have been established.

                (e)  The Borrower shall maintain liability insurance
        and casualty insurance upon the Collateral (excluding

                                       91
<PAGE>
        equipment or inventory provided to Subscribers in the ordinary course of
        business) tangible assets. The Borrower shall name the Banks as the loss
        payee on all such casualty  insurance,  and as an additional  insured on
        all such  liability  insurance and shall provide the Banks with evidence
        of such insurance upon request.

        4.10  Inspection of Properties and Books.  The Borrower shall  recognize
and honor the right of the Banks, upon request to an officer of the Borrower, to
visit and inspect any of the properties of, to examine the books,  accounts, and
other  records of, and to take  extracts  therefrom  and to discuss the affairs,
finances,  loans  and  accounts  of,  and to be  advised  as to the  same by the
officers  of, the  Borrower at all such times,  in such detail and through  such
agents and representatives as the Banks may reasonably desire.

        4.11  Guaranties.  The Borrower shall not guaranty or
become responsible for the indebtedness of any other person or
entity.

        4.12  Collateral.  The  Borrower  shall not incur or permit to exist any
mortgage,   pledge,   lien,  security  interest  or  other  encumbrance  on  the
Collateral,  except as permitted in the Security  Agreement.  Subject to Section
4.4(b),  the  foregoing  shall not be construed  to prohibit  the Borrower  from
acquiring leased equipment in the ordinary course of business.

        4.13 Name;  Location.  The  Borrower  shall give the Banks  fifteen days
notice prior to changing its name, identity or corporate  structure,  moving its
principal place of business,  chief executive office or place where it keeps its
records concerning the Collateral.

        4.14 Notice of Change in  Ownership  or  Management.  During the term of
this  Agreement,  the Borrower  shall give the Banks notice of the occurrence of
any of the following  described  events,  which notice shall be given as soon as
the Borrower obtains notice or knowledge thereof:

                (a)  any change, directly or indirectly, in the
        existing controlling interest in the Borrower; or

                (b) any material adverse change in its management  personnel.  A
        material adverse change in the Borrower's  management personnel shall be
        deemed to have  occurred if any one of the  following  has occurred with
        respect to three  individuals  who are both  officers and members of the
        Board of Directors of the Borrower: (i) the resignation,  retirement, or
        voluntary or involuntary termination of employment and/or status of such
        person  as  an  officer  and   director  of  the   Borrower;   (ii)  any
        announcement, notice of

                                       92
<PAGE>
        intent, resolution or similar advance notice with respect to the matters
        referenced in the foregoing  clause;  or (iii) the death,  disability or
        legal incompetence of such person.

        4.15.  Interest  Coverage.  The ratio of Operating Cash Flow to interest
expense  (as  determined  in  accordance  with  generally  accepted   accounting
principles but excluding  amortization  of deferred  offering costs and any fees
related to the  Trigger  Event in Section 2.4 of this  Agreement)  at the end of
each  quarter  during  the term of this  Agreement,  as  shown on the  Quarterly
Compliance Report, shall not be less than 2.25 to 1.0.

        4.16  Subordinated  Debt. The Borrower shall not incur any  subordinated
debt or issue any preferred  stock or warrants for  preferred  stock except upon
the  prior  written  consent  of the  Banks.  The  Borrower  shall  not make any
voluntary  or optional  prepayment  on any  subordinated  debt without the prior
written  consent  of the  Banks.  Similarly,  the  Borrower  shall not amend its
articles of incorporation  or any other documents or agreements  relating to the
issuance of subordinated  debt,  preferred stock or warrants for preferred stock
without the prior written consent of the Banks.

                             V. CONDITIONS PRECEDENT

        Any  and  all   obligations  of  the  Banks  hereunder  are  subject  to
satisfaction of the following conditions precedent:

                (a) the  Revolving  Lenders  shall have  received  an opinion of
        counsel to the Borrower covering such matters referred to in Article III
        as the Revolving Lenders may request, satisfactory in form and substance
        to counsel to the Revolving Lenders;

                (b) the Revolving  Lenders shall have received such certificates
        and documents as the Revolving  Lenders may reasonably  request from the
        Borrower,  including articles of incorporation and bylaws,  certificates
        regarding  good  standing,   incumbency,   copies  of  other   corporate
        documents, and appropriate authorizing resolutions; and

                (c) the Operative  Documents shall have been duly authorized and
        executed and shall be in full force and effect,  and such UCC  financing
        statements  shall have been executed and filed in such offices as may be
        appropriate to perfect the security  interest of FNB-O, as agent for the
        Banks, in the Collateral.

                                       93
<PAGE>
                            VI. DEFAULTS AND REMEDIES

        6.1 Events of Default.  Any of the following shall be deemed an event of
default under this Agreement (an "Event of Default"):

                (a) Any payment of  principal  required by any of the  Operative
        Documents shall not be paid when due.

                (b) Any payment of interest or other fees due hereunder or under
        any of the Operative Documents shall not be paid within 15 calendar days
        after the date on which such payment was invoiced or due.

                (c) Any  representation or warranty of the Borrower under any of
        the  Operative  Documents,  or any  financial  reports or  statements or
        certificates  submitted pursuant to this Agreement,  shall prove to have
        been false in any material respect when made.

                (d) A failure of the Borrower to comply with any  requirement or
        restriction  contained in Sections 4.1, 4.2, 4.3, 4.4, 4.7, 4.11,  4.12,
        4.13, 4.14, 4.15 or 4.16 of this Agreement.

                (e) A failure of the Borrower to comply with any  requirement or
        restriction  contained in any provision of the  Operative  Documents not
        otherwise specified in this Article VI, which failure remains unremedied
        for ten days following receipt of notice from the Banks.

                (f)  The  occurrence  of a  default  or a  breach  of any of the
        Borrower's obligations under any note, loan agreement,  preferred stock,
        subordinated  debt  instrument  or  agreement,  or any  other  agreement
        evidencing an obligation to repay borrowed money.

                (g) The entry of a final  judgment  against the Borrower for the
        payment of money, which is not covered by insurance,  and the expiration
        of 30 days from the date of such entry  during which the judgment is not
        discharged in full or stayed.

                (h)  The occurrence of any one or more of the
        following:

                         (1) The  Borrower  shall file a  voluntary  petition in
                bankruptcy  or  an  order  for  relief  shall  be  entered  in a
                bankruptcy  case as to such entity or shall file any petition or
                answer   seeking   or   acquiescing   in   any   reorganization,
                arrangement, composition, readjustment, liquidation, dissolution
                or similar

                                       94
<PAGE>
                relief for itself under any present or future federal,  state or
                other  statute,   law  or  regulation  relating  to  bankruptcy,
                insolvency or other relief for debtors; or shall seek or consent
                to or acquiesce in the  appointment of any trustee,  receiver or
                liquidator  of  the  Borrower  or of  all  or  any  part  of its
                property,  or of any or all of the royalties,  revenues,  rents,
                issues or profits thereof,  or shall make any general assignment
                for the  benefit of  creditors,  or shall  admit in writing  its
                inability to pay its debts or shall  generally not pay its debts
                as they become due; or

                         (2) A court of  competent  jurisdiction  shall enter an
                order, judgment or decree approving a petition filed against the
                Borrower  seeking  any  reorganization,  dissolution  or similar
                relief  under  any  present  or future  federal,  state or other
                statute, law or regulation relating to bankruptcy, insolvency or
                other  relief for  debtors,  and such order,  judgment or decree
                shall remain  unvacated  and unstayed for an aggregate of thirty
                (30) days  (whether or not  consecutive)  from the first date of
                entry  thereof;  or any trustee,  receiver or  liquidator of the
                Borrower or of all or any part of its property, or of any or all
                of the royalties,  revenues,  rents,  issues or profits thereof,
                shall be appointed  without the consent or  acquiescence  of the
                Borrower  and  such  appointments  shall  remain  unvacated  and
                unstayed for an  aggregate  of thirty (30) days  (whether or not
                consecutive); or

                         (3) A writ of  execution or  attachment  or any similar
                process shall be issued or levied  against all or any part of or
                interest in the Collateral,  or any judgment  involving monetary
                damages shall be entered against the Borrower which shall become
                a lien on the  Collateral  or any  portion  thereof or  interest
                therein and such  execution,  attachment  or similar  process or
                judgment is not released,  bonded, satisfied,  vacated or stayed
                within thirty (30) days after its entry or levy.

                (i)  Any event of default shall occur under any
        Operative Document.

                (j) A change  shall  occur after  November 8, 1993,  directly or
        indirectly,  in the  ownership  or  control of the  Borrower;  provided,
        however,  that changes in the  ownership or control of, or new issuances
        of,  voting common stock which do not exceed,  cumulatively,  50% of the
        total issued and outstanding  shares of the Borrower as of September 30,
        1993 shall not be deemed an Event of Default under this

                                       95
<PAGE>
        Section 6.1(j); provided further, that acquisitions of additional shares
        by members of the existing  executive  management  group of the Borrower
        shall not be  counted  as  changes  in the  ownership  or control of the
        Borrower under this Section 6.1(j).  For purposes of computing the total
        issued and  outstanding  shares as of September  30, 1993,  warrants and
        options for such shares shall be included.

                (k) An Event of  Default  shall  occur  under the  Related  Loan
        Agreement and the expiration of any applicable cure period thereunder.

                (l) The Borrower shall be obligated to prepay all or any portion
        of its subordinated debt as a result of a Change of Control.

        6.2 Remedies. If an Event of Default occurs and is continuing,  upon the
election  of  the  Banks  holding  two-thirds  of  the  then  outstanding  Total
Indebtedness  of the Borrower to the Banks the entire  unpaid  principal  amount
under the Notes and the Existing Term Notes and all Related Bank Debt,  together
with interest accrued thereon,  shall become immediately due and payable without
presentment,  demand,  protest  or notice of any kind,  all of which are  hereby
expressly  waived,  and the  Banks may  exercise  their  rights  under the other
Operative  Documents  and  the  Related  Loan  Agreement,   including,   without
limitation, under the Security Agreement. In addition, the Banks shall have such
other  remedies  as are  available  at law and in  equity.  Remedies  under this
Agreement and the other Operative  Documents are cumulative.  Any waiver must be
in writing by the Banks and no waiver shall  constitute a waiver as to any other
occurrence  which  constitutes  an  Event  of  Default  or as to any  party  not
specifically included in such written waiver.

                       ARTICLE VII. INTER-BANK AGREEMENTS

        7.1 FNB-O as Servicer. FNB-O will act as sole servicer of the loans made
to the Borrower hereunder (including,  without limitation,  the loans made under
the Existing Term Notes). FNB-O will enforce, administer and otherwise deal with
the loans made by FirsTier,  FNB-W,  NBD,  Norwest,  Boatmen's  and AgAmerica in
accordance with safe and prudent banking standards employed by FNB-O in the case
of the loan made by FNB-O.  Without  limiting the  generality of the  foregoing,
FNB-O will, on its own behalf and on behalf of the Banks: (i) maintain originals
of the Operative Documents; (ii) receive requests for Advances from the Borrower
and make such Advances on behalf of the Revolving  Lenders  (provided that FNB-O
is assured of  reimbursement  therefor by the other Revolving  Lenders for their
pro rata shares);  (iii) receive  payments and prepayments from the Borrower and
apply such payments as provided in Section

                                       96
<PAGE>
7.2; (iv) receive notices from the Borrower and send copies thereof to FirsTier,
FNB-W,  NBD,  Norwest,  Boatmen's and AgAmerica if FNB-O has reasonable cause to
believe that such banks have not received such notice from another  source;  and
(v) advise  FirsTier,  FNB-W,  NBD,  Norwest,  Boatmen's  and  AgAmerica  of the
occurrence of any material Event of Default which FNB-O obtains actual knowledge
of. FirsTier, FNB-W, NBD, Norwest,  Boatmen's and AgAmerica agree not to attempt
to take any action against the Borrower  without  FNB-O's consent unless holders
of two-thirds of the then outstanding Total  Indebtedness of the Borrower to the
Banks shall have  requested  FNB-O to take specific  action against the Borrower
and FNB-O shall have failed to do so within a reasonable period after receipt of
such request. All actions, consents, waivers and approvals by the Banks shall be
deemed taken or given and  amendments  hereto deemed agreed to if the holders of
more than  two-thirds of the outstanding  Total  Indebtedness of the Borrower to
the Banks  shall have  indicated  their  consent  thereto.  Notwithstanding  the
foregoing,  any  reduction or  compromise  of the  Principal  Loan Amount or the
Existing  Term  Notes or the  amount or rate of  interest  accrued  or  accruing
thereon or  extension of the date of any  scheduled  payment  shall  require the
unanimous approval of the Banks.

        7.2  Application of Payments.  Until the earlier of the occurrence of an
Event of  Default or any  Bank's  giving of notice to the  others  that it deems
itself insecure,  payments or prepayments made by the Borrower may be applied to
the indebtedness designated by the Borrower or otherwise applied as follows:

                (a)      first, to pay interest to date on the Revolving
        Credit;

                (b)      second, to make payments due but unpaid under any
        of the Term Notes, Existing Term Notes and Related Bank
        Debt; and

                (c)      third, pro rata to the Banks, such pro rata share
        to be determined as set forth below in subsection (bb) of
        this Section 7.2.

After the  occurrence of an Event of Default or any Bank's giving of notice that
it deems itself  insecure,  payments or prepayments  on the Notes,  the Existing
Term Notes or the  Related  Bank Debt  received by FNB-O or any of the Banks and
funds realized upon the disposition of any of the Collateral shall be applied as
follows:

                (aa) first,  to  reimburse  FNB-O for any costs,  expenses,  and
        disbursements  (including attorneys' fees) which may be incurred or made
        by FNB-0: (i) in connection

                                       97
<PAGE>
        with its servicing  obligations;  (ii) in the process of collecting such
        payments  or funds;  or (iii) as  advances  made by FNB-O to protect the
        Collateral  (provided,  however,  that FNB-O shall have no obligation to
        make such protective advances); and

                (bb)  second,  pari passu among  FNB-O,  FirsTier,  FNB-W,  NBD,
        Norwest,  Boatmen's and  AgAmerica  based on their  respective  pro rata
        shares of the funds to be  applied.  Each Bank's pro rata share shall be
        equal to a fraction,  (x) the numerator of which shall be the portion of
        the  Principal  Loan Amount  then  outstanding  which has been  actually
        advanced by each such Bank along with the amount owing to each such Bank
        under its Existing  Term Note and under the Related  Bank Debt,  and (y)
        the  denominator of which shall be the total  Principal Loan Amount then
        outstanding  along with the total  amount  owing to the Banks  under the
        Existing Term Notes and the Related Bank Debt.

Except as  specifically  provided  in this  Section  7.2,  FNB-O  shall  have no
obligation  to repay or prepay any amount due from the Borrower to either of the
other Banks nor shall  FNB-O have any  obligation  to purchase  all or a part of
Note B, Note C, Note D, Note E, Note F, the  Existing  Term Notes or any Advance
made by such Banks,  nor shall such Banks have any recourse  whatsoever  against
FNB-O with  respect to any  failure of the  Borrower  to repay the  indebtedness
described herein.

        7.3  Liability of FNB-O.  FNB-O shall not be liable to the Banks for any
error  of  judgment  or for any  action  taken  or  omitted  to be  taken  by it
hereunder,  except for gross negligence or willful misconduct.  Without limiting
the  generality of the foregoing,  FNB-O,  except as expressly set forth herein,
(a) may consult with legal counsel,  independent  public  accountants  and other
experts  selected by it and shall not be liable for any action  taken or omitted
to be taken in good faith by it in  accordance  with the advice of such counsel,
accountants or experts; (b) makes no representation or warranty with respect to,
and  shall  not be  responsible  for,  the  accuracy,  completeness,  execution,
legality,  validity,  legal effect or  enforceability of this 1995 Restated Loan
Agreement,  the Notes, the Existing Term Notes or the other Operative  Documents
or the value or  sufficiency  of any  collateral  given by the  Borrower  or the
priority of the Banks' security  interest therein or the financial  condition of
the Borrower; and (c) shall not be responsible for the performance or observance
of any of the terms,  covenants or conditions of the Operative  Documents on the
part of the  Borrower  and  shall  not  have any duty to  inspect  the  property
(including, without limitation, the books and records) of the Borrower.

                                       98
<PAGE>
        7.4 Transfers.  FirsTier,  FNB-W, NBD, Norwest,  Boatmen's and AgAmerica
shall not  subdivide,  transfer  or grant a  participation  in their  respective
Notes,  the  Existing  Term Notes or in any Advance,  without the prior  written
consent of FNB-O which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld.

        7.5  Reliance.  The Banks  acknowledge  that they have been advised that
none of the Notes,  the Existing Term Notes nor any interest  therein or related
thereto has been (i)  registered  under the  Securities Act of 1933, as amended,
nor (ii)  insured  by the  Federal  Deposit  Insurance  Corporation.  The  Banks
acknowledge that they have received from the Borrower all financial  information
and other data  relevant to their  decision to extend credit to the Borrower and
that they have independently approved the credit quality of the Borrower.

        7.6  Relationship  of Banks.  The  Banks  intend  for the  relationships
created by this  Agreement to be construed as concurrent  direct loans from each
Bank  respectively to the Borrower.  Nothing herein shall be construed as a loan
from  FirsTier,  FNB-W,  NBD,  Norwest,  Boatmen's  or  AgAmerica to FNB-O or as
creating a partnership or joint venture relationship among them.


                           ARTICLE VIII. MISCELLANEOUS

        8.1 Entire  Agreement.  This Agreement  constitutes the entire agreement
between the parties hereto with respect to the subject matter hereof and may not
be effectively amended, changed, modified or altered, except in writing executed
by all parties.

        8.2  Governing  Law. The  Operative  Documents  shall be governed by and
construed pursuant to the laws of the State of Nebraska.

        8.3 Notices.  Until  changed by written  notice from one party hereto to
the other, all communications  under the Operative Documents shall be in writing
and shall be hand  delivered  or mailed by  registered  mail to the  parties  as
follows:

                If to the Borrower:

                         DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION
                         Suite 200
                         9110 West Dodge Road
                         Omaha, Nebraska 68114
                         Attention:  Chief Financial Officer

                                       99
<PAGE>
                If to the Banks:

                         FIRST NATIONAL BANK OF OMAHA
                         One First National Center
                         Omaha, Nebraska  68102
                         Attention:  Mr. James P. Bonham

Notices  shall be  deemed  given  when  mailed,  except  that any  notice by the
Borrower  under  Section 2.3 or 2.4 shall not be deemed given until  received by
FNB-O.

        8.4 Headings.  The captions and headings herein are for convenience only
and in no way define, limit or describe the scope or intent of any provisions or
sections of this Agreement.

        8.5 Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in several counterparts
and such counterparts together shall constitute one and the same instrument.

        8.6  Survival;  Successors  and  Assigns.  The  covenants,   agreements,
representations  and warranties made herein,  and in the certificates  delivered
pursuant  hereto,  shall survive the execution and delivery to the Banks of this
Agreement and shall continue in full force and effect so long as the Note or any
obligation to the Banks under any of the Operative  Documents is outstanding and
unpaid.  Whenever in this  Agreement  any of the parties  hereto is referred to,
such  reference  shall be deemed to include the  successors  and assigns of such
party,  and all  covenants,  promises  and  agreements  by or on  behalf  of the
Borrower  which are contained in this  Agreement  shall bind the  successors and
assigns of the  Borrower  and shall inure to the benefit of the  successors  and
assigns of the Banks.

        8.7 Severability. Should any one or more provisions of this Agreement be
determined  to  be  illegal  or   unenforceable,   all  other  provisions  shall
nonetheless remain effective.

        8.8  Assignment.  The Borrower may not assign its rights or  obligations
hereunder and any assignment in contravention of the terms hereof shall be void.

        8.9  Amendments.  Any  amendment,  modification  or  supplement  to this
Agreement must be in writing and must be signed by the parties hereto.

                                      100
<PAGE>
        IN WITNESS  WHEREOF,  the  Borrower  and the Banks have caused this 1995
Restated  Loan  Agreement  to be  executed  by their duly  authorized  corporate
officers as of the day and year first above written.


                                       DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK
                                       CORPORATION


                                       By:     /s/  Brian Larson
                                             ---------------------------------
                                       Title:  Chief Financial Officer
                                             ---------------------------------

                                       FIRST NATIONAL BANK OF OMAHA

                                       By:      /s/ J.P. Bonham
                                              --------------------------------
                                       Title:  Vice President
                                              --------------------------------


                                      101
<PAGE>



                                         FIRSTIER BANK, NATIONAL
                                         ASSOCIATION, LINCOLN, NEBRASKA


                                         By:   /s/ John Arrigo
                                             ----------------------------------
                                         Title:   Officer
                                             ----------------------------------






NOTICE: A credit  agreement must be in writing to be enforceable  under Nebraska
law. To protect you and us from any  misunderstandings  or disappointments,  any
contract,  promise,  undertaking,  or offer to forebear repayment of money or to
make any other financial  accommodation in connection with this loan of money or
grant or extension of credit,  or any amendment of,  cancellation of, waiver of,
or  substitution  for any or all of the terms or provisions of any instrument or
document executed in connection with this loan of money or grant or extension of
credit, must be in writing to be effective.

                                                       INITIALED:
                                                        /s/ BL
                                                       ----------
                                                       Borrower

4266J


                                      102
<PAGE>



                                         FIRST NATIONAL BANK, WAHOO,
                                         NEBRASKA


                                         By:     /s/  Elizabeth E. Rezac
                                               -------------------------------
                                         Title:  Loan Officer
                                               -------------------------------







NOTICE: A credit  agreement must be in writing to be enforceable  under Nebraska
law. To protect you and us from any  misunderstandings  or disappointments,  any
contract,  promise,  undertaking,  or offer to forebear repayment of money or to
make any other financial  accommodation in connection with this loan of money or
grant or extension of credit,  or any amendment of,  cancellation of, waiver of,
or  substitution  for any or all of the terms or provisions of any instrument or
document executed in connection with this loan of money or grant or extension of
credit, must be in writing to be effective.

                                                            INITIALED:
                                                             /s/  BL
                                                            ---------
                                                            Borrower

4266J


                                      103
<PAGE>


                                               NBD BANK


                                               By:   /s/  Thomas A. Levasseur
                                                    ---------------------------

                                               Title:  Vice President
                                                    ---------------------------




NOTICE: A credit  agreement must be in writing to be enforceable  under Nebraska
law. To protect you and us from any  misunderstandings  or disappointments,  any
contract,  promise,  undertaking,  or offer to forebear repayment of money or to
make any other financial  accommodation in connection with this loan of money or
grant or extension of credit,  or any amendment of,  cancellation of, waiver of,
or  substitution  for any or all of the terms or provisions of any instrument or
document executed in connection with this loan of money or grant or extension of
credit, must be in writing to be effective.

                                                            INITIALED:
                                                           
                                                            /s/ BL
                                                            ----------
                                                            Borrower

4266J

                                      104
<PAGE>

                                              NORWEST BANK NEBRASKA, N.A.


                                              By:   /s/  Leslie A. Volk
                                                   ---------------------------
                                              Title:  Vice President
                                                   --------------------------



NOTICE: A credit  agreement must be in writing to be enforceable  under Nebraska
law. To protect you and us from any  misunderstandings  or disappointments,  any
contract,  promise,  undertaking,  or offer to forebear repayment of money or to
make any other financial  accommodation in connection with this loan of money or
grant or extension of credit,  or any amendment of,  cancellation of, waiver of,
or  substitution  for any or all of the terms or provisions of any instrument or
document executed in connection with this loan of money or grant or extension of
credit, must be in writing to be effective.

                                                            INITIALED:

                                                            /s/  BL
                                                            ----------
                                                            Borrower

4266J


                                      105
<PAGE>

                                              THE BOATMEN'S NATIONAL BANK OF
                                              ST. LOUIS


                                               By:  /s/  Joseph L. Scooter, Jr.
                                                    ---------------------------
                                               Title:  Vice President
                                                    ---------------------------




NOTICE: A credit  agreement must be in writing to be enforceable  under Nebraska
law. To protect you and us from any  misunderstandings  or disappointments,  any
contract,  promise,  undertaking,  or offer to forebear repayment of money or to
make any other financial  accommodation in connection with this loan of money or
grant or extension of credit,  or any amendment of,  cancellation of, waiver of,
or  substitution  for any or all of the terms or provisions of any instrument or
document executed in connection with this loan of money or grant or extension of
credit, must be in writing to be effective.

                                                            INITIALED:
                                                            
                                                            /s/   BL
                                                            -----------
                                                            Borrower

4266J


                                      106
<PAGE>


                                               AGAMERICA, FCB


                                               By:    /s/   Kevin D. Munro
                                                    --------------------------- 
                                               Title:  Vice President
                                                    ---------------------------




NOTICE: A credit  agreement must be in writing to be enforceable  under Nebraska
law. To protect you and us from any  misunderstandings  or disappointments,  any
contract,  promise,  undertaking,  or offer to forebear repayment of money or to
make any other financial  accommodation in connection with this loan of money or
grant or extension of credit,  or any amendment of,  cancellation of, waiver of,
or  substitution  for any or all of the terms or provisions of any instrument or
document executed in connection with this loan of money or grant or extension of
credit, must be in writing to be effective.

                                                            INITIALED:

                                                            /s/  BL
                                                            -----------
                                                            Borrower

4266J


                                      107
<PAGE>


                                    EXHIBIT A

                         TO 1995 RESTATED LOAN AGREEMENT
                                     BETWEEN
                          FIRST NATIONAL BANK OF OMAHA,
             FIRSTIER BANK, NATIONAL ASSOCIATION, LINCOLN, NEBRASKA,
                      FIRST NATIONAL BANK, WAHOO, NEBRASKA,
                                    NBD BANK,
                          NORWEST BANK NEBRASKA, N.A.,
                    THE BOATMEN'S NATIONAL BANK OF ST. LOUIS,
                                 AGAMERICA, FCB
                                       AND
                      DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION




                               DRAWING CERTIFICATE




                                      108
<PAGE>
                               DRAWING CERTIFICATE
                      DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION


To induce the First National Bank of Omaha, FirsTier Bank, National Association,
Lincoln,  Nebraska, First National Bank, Wahoo, Nebraska, NBD Bank, Norwest Bank
Nebraska,  N.A. and AgAmerica,  FCB (the "Revolving Lenders") to make an advance
under the 1995 Restated Loan  Agreement  dated as of June 30, 1995,  between the
undersigned  (the  "Borrower"),   The  Boatmen's  National  Bank  of  St.  Louis
("Boatmen's")  (as to Boatmen's and the Revolving  Lenders together the "Banks")
and the Revolving  Lenders,  the Borrower hereby certifies to the Banks that its
Operating Cash Flow (as defined in the Loan  Agreement) as represented  below is
true and  correct  and that there is no default  under the  aforementioned  Loan
Agreement, or on any other liability of the Borrower to the Banks.

All information as of:  Date
                               ---------------------------
a)  Principal on Term Notes Outstanding     $
                                              ---------------------------------
b)  Principal on Revolving Credit           $
                                              ---------------------------------
c)  ADVANCE REQUEST                         $
                                              ---------------------------------
d)    Total Proposed Bank Debt
      (line a + line b + line c)            $
                                              ---------------------------------
e)  Most recent month's operating cash flow $
                                              ---------------------------------
f)  Prior month's operating cash flow       $
                                              ---------------------------------
g)  Operating Cash Flow
    (average of line e and line f)          $
                                              ---------------------------------
h)    36 x Operating Cash Flow              $
                                              ---------------------------------
i)    Excess (line h - line d)              $
                                              ---------------------------------

Name of Borrower:  Data Transmission Network Corporation

Signature:
            ---------------------------------------
Title:
            ---------------------------------------

4266J

                                      109
<PAGE>

                                    EXHIBIT B

                         TO 1995 RESTATED LOAN AGREEMENT
                                     BETWEEN
                          FIRST NATIONAL BANK OF OMAHA,
             FIRSTIER BANK, NATIONAL ASSOCIATION, LINCOLN, NEBRASKA,
                      FIRST NATIONAL BANK, WAHOO, NEBRASKA,
                                    NBD BANK,
                          NORWEST BANK NEBRASKA, N.A.,
                    THE BOATMEN'S NATIONAL BANK OF ST. LOUIS,
                                 AGAMERICA, FCB
                                       AND
                      DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION






                              OFFICER'S CERTIFICATE




                                      110
<PAGE>

                             COMPLIANCE CERTIFICATE
                      DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION


First National Bank of Omaha                 Date:
Attn:  James Bonham                                --------------------------
16th & Dodge Streets
Omaha, Nebraska 68102

I certify that Data Transmission  Network  Corporation is in compliance with the
requirements  set forth in the 1995 Restated Loan Agreement dated as of June 30,
1995, between First National Bank of Omaha, FirsTier Bank, National Association,
Lincoln,  Nebraska, First National Bank, Wahoo, Nebraska, NBD Bank, Norwest Bank
Nebraska,  N.A., The Boatmen's  National Bank of St. Louis,  AgAmerica,  FCB and
Data Transmission Network Corporation.

The following  calculations  are as of  (statement  date) as required by section
4.1(d) of said Loan Agreement:

Evaluations:

Total Indebtedness/Net Worth =         /        =       %
                               -------  -------   -----
(for the purposes of this document this calculation will be
abbreviated by TI/NW)

Operating Cash Flow:      most recent month    previous month
                          ending               ending
                                 ----------           -----------         
   Net Income (loss)
                          -----------------    ------------------
   Interest Expense
                          -----------------    ------------------
   Depreciation
                          -----------------    ------------------
   Deferred Income Taxes
                          -----------------    ------------------
   Non-Ordinary Non-Cash
      Charges (Credits)
                          -----------------    ------------------

   Total               a)                    b)
                          -----------------    ------------------

        Operating Cash Flow = OCF = (a+b)/2 =
                                               ------------------

Section 2.1

        Advance          Fee:  If  TI/NW  equals  or  exceeds  250%  then a 1/2%
                         advance fee on new advances is due.

        Position:        The advance fee does/does not apply.


                                      111
<PAGE>
Section 2.2

        Pricing:         If TI/NW is less than 200% then the margin is zero.
                         If TI/NW is equal or greater than 200% but
                         less than 250% then the margin is 1/4%.
                         If TI/NW is equal or greater than 250% but
                         less than 300% then the margin is 3/4%.
                         If TI/NW is equal or greater than 300% then
                         the margin is 1 1/4%.

        Position:        The Revolving Credit Rate is the Base Rate
                         plus zero or 1/4% or 3/4% or 1 1/4%.


Section 2.4

        Trigger Fee:     If TI/NW exceeds 250%, then a one time fee,
                         paid in three installments of 3/8% of the
                         then outstanding principal balances, on any
                         of the Existing Term Notes which have an
                         interest rate less than 7.5% is due.

        Position:        A Trigger Event  has/has not  occurred.


Section 4.3

        Net Worth:       A minimum Net Worth (exclusive of
                         subordinated debt) of $11,000,000 is required.

        Position:        Net Worth (exclusive of subordinated debt)=
                           $                         .
                             -----------------------


Section 4.4

        Indebtedness:    At no time will Total Indebtedness exceed 48 x OCF.

        Position:        (48 x OCF)  -  Total Indebtedness  =
                                        -                   =
                         --------------     ---------------   ----------------
 
        Indebtedness:    At no time will TI/NW exceed 350%.

        Position:        TI/NW =           %
                                 ---------

                                      112
<PAGE>
        Total            At no time will Adjusted Total Indebtedness
        Indebtedness     exceed 60 x OCF
        plus
        subordinated
        debt plus
        guaranty
        contingencies
        (Adjusted
        Total
        Indebtedness or
        ATI):

        Position:        Adjusted Total Indebtedness = $
                                                         ---------------------
                         (60 x OCF) - (ATI) = $
                                                 -----------------------------
Section 4.15

        Interest         The ratio of OCF to Interest Expense ("IE")
        Coverage:        at the end of each quarter will not be less
                         than 2.25 to 1.0 (200%).

        Position:        OCF = $
                                  ------------------------
                         IE = $
                                  ------------------------
                         OCF/IE =                          %
                                  ------------------------

Additional Representations:

        There  have/have  not been any  sale(s) of assets  which  would  require
        prepayment of the Notes under Section 4.2.

        There has/has not been:

              (i)        a Change of Control as defined in Section 4 of
                         the Agreement; or

             (ii)        a default under Section 6.1(j) regarding a change
                         in ownership or control of the Company.


Name of Borrower: Data Transmission Network Corporation

Signature:
                  -------------------------------------

Title:            -------------------------------------

4266J/39-41

                                      113
<PAGE>
                                   SCHEDULE A

                         TO 1995 RESTATED LOAN AGREEMENT
                                     BETWEEN
                          FIRST NATIONAL BANK OF OMAHA,
             FIRSTIER BANK, NATIONAL ASSOCIATION, LINCOLN, NEBRASKA,
                      FIRST NATIONAL BANK, WAHOO, NEBRASKA,
                                    NBD BANK,
                          NORWEST BANK NEBRASKA, N.A.,
                    THE BOATMEN'S NATIONAL BANK OF ST. LOUIS,
                                 AGAMERICA, FCB
                                       AND
                      DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION


                               EXISTING TERM NOTES
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                     Balance as of                              Maturity
 Bank                  Date                          June 30, 1995             Rate               Date
 ----                  ----                         ----------------           ----              ------
<S>                   <C>                           <C>                         <C>              <C>  
FNB-O                 01/15/92                      $   41,562.50               7.25%            12/30/95
                      02/04/92                         190,000.00               7.25             01/30/96
                      03/03/92                         106,875.00               7.25             02/29/96
                      05/06/92                          65,312.50               7.25             04/30/96
                      07/07/92                         154,375.00               6.75             06/30/96
                      10/01/92                         190,000.00               6.75             09/30/96
                      10/12/92                          95,000.00               6.75             09/30/96
                      10/13/92                         356,250.00               7.50             10/12/97
                      10/19/92                          95,000.00               6.75             09/30/96
                      11/03/92                         100,937.50               6.75             10/30/96
                      12/07/92                         356,250.00               8.14             12/06/97
                      01/04/93                         102,916.57               6.75             12/30/96
                      02/09/93                         108,333.24               6.75             01/30/97
                      04/16/93                         227,500.09               6.75             03/30/97
                      07/08/93                         281,666.74               6.75             06/30/97
                      08/30/94                       4,431,750.00               8.00             07/30/98
                      11/29/94                       1,328,229.12               8.50             10/30/98
                      02/27/95                         641,437.48               9.25             01/30/99

NBD                   01/04/93                      $   41,562.50               6.75             12/30/96
                      02/09/93                          43,750.00               6.75             01/30/97
                      04/16/93                          96,250.00               6.75             03/30/97
                      07/08/93                         109,375.00               6.75             06/30/97
                      08/30/94                       2,650,500.00               8.00             07/30/98
                      11/29/94                         794,375.00               8.50             10/30/98
                      02/27/95                         383,625.00               9.25             01/30/99

Norwest               08/30/94                      $2,508,000.00               8.00             07/30/98
                      11/29/94                         751,666.62               8.50             10/30/98
                      02/27/95                         363,000.00               9.25             01/30/99

</TABLE>
                                      114
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                     Balance as of                              Maturity
 Bank                  Date                          June 30, 1995             Rate               Date
 ----                  ----                         ----------------           ----              ------
<S>                   <C>                           <C>                         <C>              <C>  
Boatmen's             08/30/94                      $1,866,750.00                8.00            07/30/98
                      11/29/94                         559,479.12                8.50            10/30/98
                      02/27/95                         270,187.48                9.25            01/30/99

FirsTier
  Lincoln             01/15/92                       $  29,166.53                7.25            12/30/95
                      02/04/92                         133,333.20                7.25            01/30/96
                      03/03/92                          74,999.85                7.25            02/29/96
                      05/06/92                          45,833.21                7.25            04/30/96
                      07/07/92                         108,333.17                6.75            06/30/96
                      10/01/92                         133,333.21                6.75            09/30/96
                      10/12/92                          66,666.56                6.75            09/30/96
                      10/13/92                         250,000.00                7.50            10/12/97
                      10/19/92                          66,666.56                6.75            09/30/96
                      11/03/92                          70,833.23                6.75            10/30/96
                      12/07/92                         250,000.00                8.14            12/06/97
                      01/04/93                          49,479.07                6.75            12/30/96
                      02/09/93                          52,083.24                6.75            01/30/97
                      04/16/93                         114,583.42                6.75            03/30/97
                      07/08/93                         130,208.41                6.75            06/30/97
                      08/30/94                       2,650,500.00                8.00            07/30/98
                      11/29/94                         794,375.00                8.50            10/30/98
                      02/27/95                         383,625.00                9.25            01/30/99

FNB-W                 01/15/92                        $  2,187.50                7.25            12/30/95
                      02/04/92                          10,000.00                7.25            01/30/96
                      03/03/92                           5,625.00                7.25            02/29/96
                      05/06/92                           3,437.50                7.25            04/30/96
                      07/07/92                           8,125.00                6.75            06/30/96
                      10/01/92                          10,000.00                6.75            09/30/96
                      10/12/92                           5,000.00                6.75            09/30/96
                      10/13/92                          18,750.00                7.50            10/12/97
                      10/19/92                           5,000.00                6.75            09/30/96
                      11/03/92                           5,312.50                6.75            10/30/96
                      12/07/92                          18,750.00                8.14            12/06/97
                      01/04/93                           3,958.43                6.75            12/30/96
                      02/09/93                           4,166.76                6.75            01/30/97
                      04/16/93                           9,166.58                6.75            03/30/97
                      07/08/93                          10,416.59                6.75            06/30/97
                      08/30/94                         142,500.00                8.00            07/30/98
                      11/29/94                          42,708.31                8.50            10/30/98
                      02/27/95                          20,625.00                9.25            01/30/99
</TABLE>
        Notwithstanding  any definition of "Existing Term Notes" to the contrary
in the 1995 Restated Loan  Agreement,  the Notes issued  thereunder or the First
Amendment to Restated Security  Agreement,  no "Existing Term Notes" were issued
on December 31, 1992.

4266J/42-43

                                      115
<PAGE>
                                   SCHEDULE B

                         TO 1995 RESTATED LOAN AGREEMENT
                                     BETWEEN
                          FIRST NATIONAL BANK OF OMAHA,
             FIRSTIER BANK, NATIONAL ASSOCIATION, LINCOLN, NEBRASKA,
                      FIRST NATIONAL BANK, WAHOO, NEBRASKA,
                                    NBD BANK,
                          NORWEST BANK NEBRASKA, N.A.,
                    THE BOATMEN'S NATIONAL BANK OF ST. LOUIS,
                                 AGAMERICA, FCB
                                       AND
                      DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION



                             PERMITTED ENCUMBRANCES

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
Secured Party                                                 Financing Statements
<S>                                                     <C>                 <C>                  <C>    
NEBRASKA SECRETARY OF STATE

First National Bank of Omaha                             12/28/87           #401690
                                                         10/13/92           #564918              Amendment
                                                         11/13/92           #568176              Continued

FirsTier, Lincoln                                         6/24/87           #384782
First National Bank of Omaha                              2/03/88           #405477              Amendment
First National Bank, Wahoo                                5/28/92           #553205              Continued
NBD, Detroit                                             10/13/92           #564919              Amendment
                                                          2/05/93           #576038              Amendment
                                                         11/10/93           #603168              Amendment

FirsTier, Lincoln                                         2/10/88           #406144
First National Bank of Omaha                             10/13/92           #564917              Amendment
First National Bank, Wahoo                                1/07/93           #572981              Continued
NBD, Detroit                                              2/05/93           #576039              Amendment
                                                         11/10/93           #603169              Amendment

First Bank of Minneapolis                                11/25/91           #534665
 (Norstan)                                                8/24/92           #561090              Assignment



DOUGLAS COUNTY CLERK, NEBRASKA

FirsTier, Lincoln                                         2/11/88           #000534
First National Bank of Omaha                             10/15/92           #000534              Amendment
First National Bank, Wahoo                                1/08/93           #0000054             Continued
NBD, Detroit                                              2/05/93           #000253              Amendment
                                                         11/17/93           #54                  Amendment

</TABLE>
                                      116
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>




Secured Party                                                 Financing Statements
<S>                                                     <C>                 <C>                  <C>    

IOWA SECRETARY OF STATE

FirsTier, Lincoln                                         2/10/88           H842023
First National Bank of Omaha                             10/15/92           K395184              Amendment
First National Bank, Wahoo                                1/08/93           K424887              Continued
NBD, Detroit                                              2/08/93           K434908              Amendment
                                                         11/15/93           K503145              Amendment


KANSAS SECRETARY OF STATE

FirsTier, Lincoln                                         2/10/88           #1286572
First National Bank of Omaha                             10/15/92           #1842986             Amendment
First National Bank, Wahoo                                1/08/93           #1868482             Continued
NBD, Detroit                                              2/11/93           #1879069             Amendment
                                                         11/12/93           #1964342             Amendment


ILLINOIS SECRETARY OF STATE

FirsTier, Lincoln                                         3/18/88           #2402370
First National Bank of Omaha                             10/21/92           #3043202             Amendment
First National Bank, Wahoo                                2/11/93           #3084199             Amendment
NBD, Detroit                                              2/25/93           #3089132             Continued
                                                         12/09/93           #3197498             Amendment


MICHIGAN SECRETARY OF STATE

FirsTier, Lincoln                                         2/12/88           #C034473
First National Bank of Omaha                             10/16/92           #C646856             Amendment
First National Bank, Wahoo                                1/08/93           #C672590             Continued
NBD, Detroit                                              3/01/93           #C689434             Amendment
                                                         11/15/93           #C778208             Amendment


WISCONSIN SECRETARY OF STATE

FirsTier, Lincoln                                         2/18/88           #968701
First National Bank of Omaha                             10/21/92           #1309942             Amendment
First National Bank, Wahoo                               01/15/93           #1326550             Continued
NBD, Detroit                                              2/08/93           #1331412             Amendment
                                                         11/23/93           #1393268             Amendment


INDIANA SECRETARY OF STATE

FirsTier, Lincoln                                         2/11/88           #1454192
First National Bank of Omaha                             10/21/92           #1808780             Amendment
First National Bank, Wahoo                                1/11/93           #1822115             Continued
NBD, Detroit                                              2/08/93           #187451              Amendment
                                                         11/12/93           #1878806             Amendment
</TABLE>
                                      117
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
Secured Party                                                 Financing Statements
<S>                                                     <C>                 <C>                  <C>    
MINNESOTA SECRETARY OF STATE

FirsTier, Lincoln                                         2/17/88           1#121648#00
First National Bank of Omaha                             10/16/92           #1537269             Amendment
First National Bank, Wahoo                               01/19/93           #1557397             Continued
NBD, Detroit                                              2/08/93           #1562125             Amendment
                                                         11/23/93           #1632156             Amendment


SOUTH DAKOTA SECRETARY OF STATE

FirsTier, Lincoln                                         2/10/88           880410802864
First National Bank of Omaha                             10/16/92           #22901003596         Amend.
First National Bank, Wahoo                                1/08/93           #30081001734         Cont.
NBD, Detroit                                              2/09/93           #30391203308         Amend.
                                                         11/22/93           #33261003899         Amend.


MISSOURI SECRETARY OF STATE

FirsTier, Lincoln                                         2/11/88           #1555991
First National Bank of Omaha                             10/16/92           #2184193             Amendment
First National Bank, Wahoo                                1/08/93           #2212473             Continued
NBD, Detroit                                              2/08/93           #2224113             Amendment
                                                         11/15/93           #2331876             Amendment


OHIO SECRETARY OF STATE

FirsTier, Lincoln                                         2/12/88           #Y00095612
First National Bank of Omaha                             10/19/92           #01097336            Amendment
First National Bank, Wahoo                                1/11/93           #01119343901         Cont.
NBD, Detroit                                              2/09/93           #02099338901         Amend.
                                                         11/12/93           #1129331801          Amendment


KENTUCKY SECRETARY OF STATE

First National Bank of Omaha                             11/12/93           134318


PENNSYLVANIA DEPARTMENT OF STATE

First National Bank of Omaha                             11/12/93           22571277


OKLAHOMA SECRETARY OF STATE

First National Bank of Omaha                             11/12/93           059782

</TABLE>

                                      118
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<S>                                                     <C>                 <C>                  <C>    
MISSISSIPPI SECRETARY OF STATE

First National Bank of Omaha                             11/12/93           0756092--


COLORADO SECRETARY OF STATE

First National Bank of Omaha                             11/12/93           932082461


CALIFORNIA SECRETARY OF STATE

First National Bank of Omaha                             11/12/93           93229491


WASHINGTON SECRETARY OF STATE

First National Bank of Omaha                             11/15/93           933190075


MONTANA SECRETARY OF STATE

First National Bank of Omaha                             11/15/93           419540


ARIZONA SECRETARY OF STATE

First National Bank of Omaha                             11/15/93           765359


NORTH CAROLINA SECRETARY OF STATE

First National Bank of Omaha                             11/15/93           050742


NORTH DAKOTA SECRETARY OF STATE

First National Bank of Omaha                             11/16/93           93-380331


FLORIDA SECRETARY OF STATE

First National Bank of Omaha                             11/17/93           930000236992


TEXAS SECRETARY OF STATE

First National Bank of Omaha                             11/29/93           227591--



4266J/44-47

</TABLE>


                                      119
<PAGE>



                INFORMATION LICENSE AND ASSET PURCHASE AGREEMENT

This Information License and Asset Purchase Agreement  ("Agreement") is executed
and entered into as of July 13, 1995, by and between Data  Transmission  Network
Corporation, a Delaware corporation ("DTN") and Knight-Ridder Financial, Inc., a
Delaware corporation ("KRF").

                                    RECITALS:

DTN owns and  operates an  information  transmission  system that  provides  its
subscribers  with  access  via  electronic  transmission  to  various  types  of
information services. DTN has approximately 2,400 customers who subscribe to its
DTNstant(R)  information  service  which  provides  instant  futures and options
quotations from the major commodity  exchanges,  commercial  grain news,  export
basis  information,   weather   information  and  general   agricultural  market
information.  DTN also offers other information services serving the agriculture
industry as well as other industries.

KRF  owns  and  operates  a  satellite  information  transmission  system  and a
phone-line based  transmission  system that provides its subscribers with access
via electronic  transmission to various types of information  services.  KRF has
approximately 2,900 customers who subscribe to its CommodityCenter platform.


KRF and DTN desire to enter into an agreement  providing for (i) the purchase by
DTN of certain assets of KRF relating to KRF Subscribers,  (ii) the continuation
of  the  provision  of  information  services  to  the  KRF  Subscribers  during
transition,  (iii) the conversion of the KRF Subscribers to information services
provided  over the DTN System,  (iv) the delivery and non  exclusive  license of
certain  information by KRF to DTN for  dissemination by DTN over the DTN System
and (v) other related matters.


NOW,  THEREFORE,  in  consideration  of the premises and mutual  agreements  and
covenants contained herein, the parties hereto agree as follows:

1.       Definitions.  Capitalized  terms used  herein  shall have the  meanings
         ascribed to them elsewhere in this Agreement and as follows:

         "Affiliate"  means a Person who directly or indirectly,  through one or
         more  intermediaries  or otherwise,  controls,  is controlled by, or is
         under common control with another  Person.  Control means owning 20% or
         more of the voting interest.

         "Base  Services"  means  collectively  the  DTNstant  Service  and  KRF
         Services.

         "Base Service Fees" means the Fees Earned during the Service Period for
         Base Services;  provided, however, such fees shall not include any Fees


                                      120
<PAGE>

         Earned  by DTN  from  subscribers  to Base  Services  (i) for  one-time
         installation  fees to the extent  such fees do not exceed a  reasonable
         third party equivalent cost, (ii) for sales,  use,  privilege,  excise,
         property or other taxes  assessments or  governmental  charges or (iii)
         for the  first  $7,500  per month of  Optional  Service  fees.  For the
         avoidance  of doubt  any  Optional  Service  fees in  relation  to Base
         Services  in excess of $7,500 per month in  relation  to Base  Services
         plus Limited Services will be included as part of Base Service Fees.

         "Closing"  means the time at which the parties  hereto  consummate  the
         sale of the  Purchased  Assets (as defined in Section 2) which  Closing
         shall take place on the date KRF and DTN deliver to the other party the
         assets  listed in  Sections 4, 5(a) and 5(b) but shall be no later than
         July 31, 1995 or such later date as the parties hereto shall agree.

         "CommodityCenter"  means the  standalone,  custom  designed,  low cost,
         computer system capable of receiving KRF Information.

         "CommodityCenter  Digital  Data Feed" means that part of the KRF System
         and  KRF  Land-Line  System  needed  to  service  the   CommodityCenter
         platform.

         "Conversion  Period" means the period  commencing on the Effective Date
         and ending on December 31, 1996.

         "Converted  Subscribers"  means those KRF  Subscribers who have allowed
         DTN to replace some or all of the KRF  Equipment  with DTN's  equipment
         and provide  any DTN  Service  over the DTN System at any time during a
         period of 24 months from the Effective  Date,  irrespective  of whether
         they are still a DTN subscriber at the end of that period.

         "Customer Contracts" means the contracts or agreements  associated with
         the KRF Subscribers listed in Exhibit "A".

         "DTN Subscription Agreements" mean those written contracts entered into
         by DTN with  subscribers  to any  DTNstant  Service or any DTN  service
         containing KRF Information.

         "DTNstant  Service"  means  collectively  the  DTNstant(R)  information
         service and those  information  services of DTN which provide Real-Time
         commodity information from the agricultural,  energy,  lumber,  metals,
         softs or transport  industries.  The DTNstant  Service does not include
         existing  or  future  DTN  information  services  which do not  provide
         Real-Time commodity information from the agricultural,  energy, lumber,
         metals,  softs or transport  industries or any information  supplied by
         KRF, such as, by way of  illustration  only, the DTN Wall Street(R) and
         DTNergy(R) information services.  DTNergy shall only be excluded if the
         product contains no KRF Information and no Real-Time  information other
         than New York Mercantile Exchange ("NYMEX").

         "DTN  System"  means the  information  transmission  system  related to
         various types of DTN information services.

         "Effective Date" means 12:01 a.m. on the day immediately after Closing.

                                      122
<PAGE>
         "FAP  Information   Package"  means  KRF's  complete  or  substantially
         complete  existing  information  package known as the Full Agricultural
         Package  which  includes  news  and  statistical   information  on  the
         following  categories:   Agriculture,   Economics,   General,   Grains,
         Livestock and Soya and Textiles;  provided,  however,  KRF reserves the
         right  to  modify  the  content  of  the  FAP  Information  Package  as
         commercially  reasonable  so  long as the  benefit  to DTN  under  this
         Agreement is not materially impaired thereby.


         "Fees Earned"  means earned  revenue of DTN as determined in accordance
         with accounting  policies and procedures  regularly  followed by DTN in
         the preparation of its financial statements but in accordance with this
         Agreement.

         "KRF Equipment" means all of the equipment in the possession of the KRF
         Subscribers  used to obtain and operate the KRF Services except for the
         equipment owned by KRF Subscribers.


         "KRF Information"  means collectively all information and data included
         in the FAP  Information  Package to be  transmitted  as part of the KRF
         Services and any other information  packages  currently provided to KRF
         Subscribers as detailed in Exhibit G or any other information  supplied
         by KRF at a later  time  but  excluding  all  weather  information  and
         information unrelated to the agriculture, energy, lumber, metals, softs
         or transport industries.

                                      121
<PAGE>
         "KRF Land-Line System" means the Land-Line  (dedicated  telephone line)
         transmission system related to the CommodityCenter platform.

         "KRF Optional Services" means those information services where all or a
         portion of the KRF  Information  is offered as an optional  package and
         DTN has an  obligation  to charge a separate fee for such  services and
         share such fees with KRF.

         "KRF Services" means all  CommodityCenter  platform services related to
         KRF  Subscribers  pursuant to  Customer  Contracts,  including  but not
         limited to information services and electronic mail services.

         "KRF Services Business" means the business of providing KRF Services as
         conducted by KRF prior to the date of this Agreement.


         "KRF Subscribers" means customers who subscribe to the  CommodityCenter
         platform as listed in Exhibit A.


         "KRF System" means the KRF satellite transmission system related to the
         CommodityCenter platform.

                                      123
<PAGE>
         "Limited  Services"  means those  information  services  offered by DTN
         which  do  not  provide  Real-Time   commodity   information  from  the
         agriculture,  energy,  lumber, metals, softs or transport industries or
         any information  supplied by KRF but do provide any Real-Time commodity
         quotations  from the  agriculture,  energy,  lumber,  metals,  softs or
         transport industries.

         "Limited  Service Fees" means the Fees Earned during the Service Period
         for Limited Services;  provided,  however,  such fees shall not include
         any Fees Earned by DTN from subscribers to Limited Services (i) for one
         time  installation  fees  provided such fees do not exceed a reasonable
         third party equivalent cost , (ii) for sales, use,  privilege,  excise,
         property or other taxes,  assessments or governmental  charges or (iii)
         for the  first  $7,500  per month of  Optional  Service  fees.  For the
         avoidance  of doubt any  Optional  Service  fees in relation to Limited
         Services in excess of $7,500 per month in relation to Limited  Services
         plus Base Services will be included as part of Limited Service Fees.


         "Optional Services" means those information  services provided by Third
         Parties and offered as an  optional  package and DTN has a  contractual
         obligation  to charge a separate  fee for such  services and share such
         fees with the Third Parties.

         "Purchased  Equipment" means those items of KRF Equipment consisting of
         satellite dish, antennae and mounts, cables, color monitors, keyboards,
         accessories   and  printers   (specifically   excluding  LNB  and  data
         receivers) which are in the possession of Converted Subscribers and are
         compatible with and may be used in the DTN System without alteration or
         modification other than normal field adjustments.

         "Purchased Equipment Value" means KRF's net book value of the Purchased
         Equipment as of January 1, 1995,  determined from the schedule of KRF's
         net book value of all KRF  Equipment  attached  as Exhibit  "D" to this
         Agreement, subject to adjustment as provided in Subsection 4(b).

         "Person" means any individual, business trust, corporation, joint stock
         company, limited liability company,  association,  partnership or other
         un-incorporated organization, trust or governmental authority.


         "Quote  Information" means U.S. commodity exchange  quotations from the
         agriculture, energy, lumber, metals, softs or transport industries .
 
        "Real-Time"  means any KRF  supplied  information  and/or  continuously
         updating  Quote  Information  which does not  constitute  delayed Quote
         Information under the relevant exchange contract terms and conditions.


         "Service Period" means the period  commencing on the Effective Date and
         ending on the last day of the calendar year  designated by either party
         in a written  notice to the other party at least 180 days prior to such
         designated  date;  provided such  designated  date shall not be earlier
         than  December  31, 2000 and may be extended as provided in  Subsection
         23(c).

                                      124
<PAGE>
         "Territory" means collectively the United States of America and Canada.

         "Third Party" means any Person unrelated to either KRF or DTN.

2.       Agreement  to  Purchase.  Upon the terms and subject to the  conditions
         contained  herein,  KRF shall  sell and  transfer  to DTN and DTN shall
         purchase and acquire from KRF, at the  Closing,  certain  assets of KRF
         used in the KRF Services  Business as of the Closing  (which assets are
         hereinafter  collectively called the "Purchased Assets"),  described as
         follows:

         (a)      The Purchased Equipment;

         (b)      All rights of KRF under the Customer Contracts;


         (c)      All  rights of KRF under  contracts  or  agreements  listed on
                  Exhibit "B"  attached  hereto,  relating  to the KRF  Services
                  Business   which  DTN   reasonably   require  to  perform  its
                  obligations  under the Agreement;  provided that KRF shall not
                  transfer  those  rights,  if any,  under  such  contracts  and
                  agreements  relating to KRF activities other than KRF Services
                  Business;

         (d)      All  warranties  held by KRF  with  respect  to the  Purchased
                  Assets to the extent that such  warranties  are  assignable or
                  KRF will provide the warrantee service; and

         (e)      All  of  KRF's  customer  lists,  records,  engineering  data,
                  equipment  lists,  parts  lists,  data and  telephone  numbers
                  relating to the KRF Services Business.  To the extent that any
                  of the  above-listed  items  are  not  easily  separable  from
                  similar  items of KRF that are not related to the KRF Services
                  Business, KRF shall retain possession of the originals of such
                  items and DTN shall be  permitted to copy the portions of such
                  items which DTN deems necessary. Within thirty (30) days after
                  Closing KRF shall execute a license  agreement in favor of DTN
                  in the form of Exhibit "C"  attached  hereto,  granting to DTN
                  the right to review,  copy, use,  disclose and sub-license all
                  such items relating to the KRF Services  Business which remain
                  in the possession of KRF after the Closing.

KRF shall retain the specific right to use any list,  data or other  information
transferred to DTN as part of the Purchased Assets.

3.       Liabilities.

         (a)      DTN shall  assume,  agree to pay, and  discharge  when due the
                  following debts, obligations and liabilities of KRF:


                  (i)      All  obligations of KRF under the Customer  Contracts
                           related to the KRF Service or  Subscribers  set forth
                           in Exhibit  "A" with  respect to the period  from and
                           after the Effective Date;

                                      125
<PAGE>
                  (ii)     All  obligations of KRF associated with the contracts
                           and agreements  listed on Exhibit "B" with respect to
                           the period from and after the Effective Date;

                  (iii)    All obligations associated with any payments required
                           to be  made  to  third  parties  in  relation  to the
                           Customer Contracts which shall include, but shall not
                           be limited to, fees  payable to  exchanges  and third
                           party  providers  of Optional  Services and any taxes
                           and governmental  charges, with respect to the period
                           from and after the Effective Date;

                  (iv)     All  obligations  of KRF,  excluding any  outstanding
                           lease  commitments,  associated  with  the  Purchased
                           Equipment from and after the Effective Date; and.


         (b)      DTN and KRF agree that DTN is not  assuming  and shall have no
                  responsibility   for  any  of  the   debts,   obligations   or
                  liabilities  of KRF  relating  to the  KRF  Services  Business
                  arising prior to the Effective  Date all of which shall remain
                  the  responsibility of KRF. KRF shall retain the right to deal
                  with its obligations as it deems appropriate.

4.       Purchase Price.


         (a)      The purchase  price (the  "Purchase  Price") for the Purchased
                  Assets  identified in Section 2 and the restrictive  covenants
                  contained  in  Section  10 shall  be the sum of Three  Million
                  Dollars  ($3,000,000) plus the Purchased  Equipment Value. DTN
                  and  KRF  will  mutually  agree  upon  the  allocation  of the
                  Purchase Price among the Purchased Assets and such restrictive
                  covenants at the  Closing.  DTN and KRF shall each prepare IRS
                  Form 8594 in accordance  with such  allocation and timely file
                  such form with the Internal Revenue Service in accordance with
                  applicable IRS procedures and U.S. Treasury regulations.

         (b)      At Closing,  KRF shall  compute an  estimate of the  Purchased
                  Equipment Value using KRF's  equipment  records and based upon
                  the  assumptions  that  all  KRF  Subscribers  on the  date of
                  Closing will be Converted  Subscribers and that those items of
                  KRF  Equipment  in their  possession  which are eligible to be
                  Purchased Equipment qualify as Purchased Equipment. The actual
                  Purchased Equipment Value will be determined at the end of the
                  Conversion   Period  by  reference  to  the  total  number  of
                  Converted Subscribers.

         (c)      At  Closing,  DTN  shall  pay  to  KRF  by  wire  transfer  of
                  immediately  available  funds  the  sum  of One  Million  Five
                  Hundred  Thousand  Dollars  ($1,500,000)  plus one-half of the
                  estimated  Purchased  Equipment Value. DTN shall pay to KRF by
                  wire transfer of immediately  available  funds on the one year
                  anniversary of the Closing the sum of One Million Five Hundred
                  Thousand Dollars  ($1,500,000).  The remainder of the Purchase
                  Price which shall equal the actual  Purchased  Equipment Value

                                      126
<PAGE>
                  minus one-half the estimated  Purchase  Equipment  Value which
                  shall have been paid  previously,  shall be paid by DTN to KRF
                  by wire transfer of  immediately  available  funds on the last
                  day of the Conversion Period.


5.       Closing.

         (a)      At Closing,  in addition to any other  documents  specifically
                  required  to be  delivered  pursuant  to this  Agreement,  KRF
                  shall,  in form and substance  reasonably  satisfactory to DTN
                  and its counsel and to the extent reasonably practicable:

                  (i)      Deliver to DTN on magnetic media,  if available,  the
                           billing and account  receivable  database  associated
                           with the KRF Services Business; and

                  (ii)     Deliver or provide  access to DTN on magnetic  media,
                           if  available,  at the date of  Closing,  all drafts,
                           microfiche,  microfilm,  records,  data, input forms,
                           computer  transaction  sheets  and all other  similar
                           information or materials relating to the

                           servicing  of Customer  Contracts,  provided  that in
                           lieu of delivering  any of the foregoing  items which
                           are not easily  separable  from other  assets of KRF,
                           KRF may deliver to DTN a license  agreement  in favor
                           of DTN in the form of Exhibit "C" granting to DTN the
                           right to review,  copy, use, disclose and sub-license
                           such items.

         (b)      At  the   Closing,   in  addition   to  any  other   documents
                  specifically   required  to  be  delivered  pursuant  to  this
                  Agreement,  DTN  shall  deliver  to KRF  such  assumptions  or
                  undertakings as may be reasonably  necessary to evidence DTN's
                  agreement  and  obligation  to pay,  discharge and satisfy the
                  liabilities  and  obligations  of  KRF  to be  assumed  by DTN
                  pursuant  to  Subsection  3(a)  hereofin  form  and  substance
                  satisfactory to KRF and its counsel.

         (c)      As soon as reasonably  practical but no later than thirty (30)
                  days after Closing or such later date mutually  agreed between
                  the  parties  on a case  by  case  in  addition  to any  other
                  documents  specifically  required to be delivered  pursuant to
                  this Agreement,  KRF shall, inform and substance  satisfactory
                  to DTN and its counsel:

                  (i)      Deliver   to  DTN   such   deeds,   bills   of  sale,
                           endorsements,  assignments, other good and sufficient
                           instruments  of  sale,  assignment,   conveyance  and
                           transfer as shall be required and where  available to
                           effectively vest in DTN all of KRF's right, title and
                           interest in and to all of the Purchased Assets,  free
                           and clear of all liens, charges, claims, encumbrances
                           and equities  except as  otherwise  disclosed in this
                           Agreement;

                                      127
<PAGE>
                  (ii)     Deliver to DTN all KRF consents to the  assignment to
                           DTN of each contract, agreement, commitment, Customer
                           Contract or other  undertaking  comprising  a part of
                           the Purchased Assets that requires such consent;

                  (iii)    Deliver  to  DTN  executed  originals  of  all of the
                           Customer  Contracts,  all amendments  thereto and all
                           extensions and renewals thereof;

                  (iv)     Deliver or provide access to DTN all data, documents,
                           information   or  materials,   if  any,   theretofore
                           delivered  by  customers to KRF which are required by
                           Customer  Contracts to be returned upon expiration or
                           termination of such contracts;


                  (v)      Deliver or provide  access to DTN on magnetic  media,
                           if  available,  at the date of  Closing,  all drafts,
                           microfiche,  microfilm,  records,  data, input forms,
                           computer  transaction  sheets  and all other  similar
                           information  or materials  relating to the  Purchased
                           Equipment and the maintenance thereof; and

                  (vi)     Deliver to DTN executed  originals  of all  contracts
                           and agreements set forth on Exhibit "B" together with
                           all data,  documents,  information  or  materials  in
                           KRF's  possession  relating  to  such  contracts  and
                           agreements.

         (d)      As soon as reasonably  practical but no later than thirty (30)
                  days after Closing or such later date mutually  agreed between
                  the  parties  on a case  by  case  in  addition  to any  other
                  documents  specifically  required to be delivered  pursuant to
                  this  Agreement,  DTN shall  provide  to KRF access to all DTN
                  services  to  provide  KRF  with the  ability  to view the KRF
                  Information  provided in DTN services in a form and  substance
                  satisfactory to KRF and its counsel.

6.       Other Documentation.

         (a)      From  time  to  time  after  the  Closing,   without   further
                  consideration,  KRF shall  execute  and deliver all such other
                  instruments of sale,  assignments,  conveyances  and transfers
                  and shall take all such other  actions  as are  reasonable  to
                  more effectively transfer to and vest in DTN and to put DTN in
                  possession of, any of the Purchased Assets.

         (b)      From  time  to  time  after  the  Closing,   without   further
                  consideration,  DTN shall  execute  and deliver all such other
                  instruments  of  assumption  and  shall  take all  such  other
                  actions  as are  reasonable  to more  effectively  assume  the
                  obligations to pay,  discharge and satisfy the liabilities and
                  obligations assumed by DTN pursuant to Subsection 3(a) hereof.


                                      128
<PAGE>
         (c)      From  time  to  time  after  the  Closing,   without   further
                  consideration,  KRF shall  deliver  or  provide  access to DTN
                  customer  service  files  of  KRF  relating  to  the  Customer
                  Contracts,  all notices, claims,  correspondence,  performance
                  standard  reports and other documents,  data,  information and
                  materials  relating to the  Customer  Contracts,  which are in
                  KRF's  possession,  provided that in lieu of delivering any of
                  the foregoing items which are not easily  separable from other
                  assets of KRF,  KRF may deliver to DTN a license  agreement in
                  favor of DTN in the form of Exhibit  "C"  granting  to DTN the
                  right to review,  copy,  use,  disclose and  sub-license  such
                  items;

7.       Representations  and  Warranties of KRF.  Subject to and except for the
         information  which is set forth in a list of exceptions,  identified by
         the section to which they pertain and contained in a schedule  attached
         hereto as Exhibit  "E" and signed for  identification  on behalf of DTN
         and KRF, KRF represents and warrants to DTN that:


         (a)      KRF is a corporation  duly organized,  validly existing and in
                  good standing under the laws of the State of Delaware;

         (b)      KRF has all  requisite  corporate  power and authority to own,
                  lease and operate its assets and to carry on the KRF  Services
                  Business as now being conducted;

         (c)      This  Agreement   constitutes  a  valid  and  legally  binding
                  agreement,  enforceable  against  KRF in  accordance  with its
                  terms and the execution and delivery of this  Agreement by KRF
                  and the consummation of the transactions  contemplated  hereby
                  have been duly authorized by a duly appointed representative;

         (d)      The execution,  delivery and performance of this Agreement and
                  the consummation of the transactions  contemplated hereby will
                  not (i) violate or breach or  conflict  with or  constitute  a
                  default  under,  any  of the  terms  or  provisions  of KRF 's
                  Certificate  of   Incorporation  or  By-Laws  or,  to  KRF  's
                  knowledge,  any  contract or agreement to which KRF is a party
                  or by which it is bound (and will not be an event which, after
                  notice  or  lapse  of time or both,  will  result  in any such
                  violation, breach, conflict, or default) or any law, judgment,
                  decree,   order,   rule  or  regulation  of  any  governmental
                  authority or court, whether federal, state or local, at law or
                  in equity, or any arbitration decision, applicable

                  to DTN or to any of its  properties or assets,  (ii) knowingly
                  result in the creation of any security interest,  claim, lien,
                  charge or  encumbrance  upon any of the property of KRF, (iii)
                  knowingly  terminate  or  result  in  the  termination  of any
                  agreement to which KRF is a party or (iv) knowingly in any way
                  affect or violate the terms or  conditions of or result in the
                  cancellation, modification, revocation or suspension of any of
                  the licenses, approvals, permits or authorizations required by
                  KRF for the conduct of the KRF Services Business;


                                      129
<PAGE>
         (e)      KRF has, to the best of KRF's knowledge,  performed all of the
                  obligations  required to be  performed  by it under any lease,
                  contract, commitment,  distributor agreement or arrangement of
                  any kind  relating to the KRF Services  Business;  and neither
                  KRF nor,  to the  knowledge  of KRF,  any other  party,  is in
                  default  under any lease,  contract,  commitment,  distributor
                  agreement  or  arrangement  of any  kind  relating  to the KRF
                  Services  Business.  To the best of knowledge of KRF, no event
                  has occurred which, after the giving of notice or the lapse of
                  time or otherwise, would constitute a default under, or result
                  in a breach of, any lease, contract,  commitment,  distributor
                  agreement or  arrangement  to which KRF is a party or by which
                  KRF is bound and which relates to the KRF Services Business;

         (f)      KRF has good  and  marketable  title  to all of the  Purchased
                  Assets  free and  clear  of any  security  interests,  claims,
                  liens, charges or encumbrances whatsoever;

         (g)      KRF has  maintained  and will  continue to maintain  until the
                  Closing  insurance  on its  assets  and  business  operations,
                  including but not limited to public  liability  insurance,  of
                  the  kinds  and  in  the   amounts   customarily   carried  by
                  responsible companies of the size of KRF engaged in a business
                  similar to that of KRF;


         (h)      With respect to the Customer  Contracts,  KRF  represents  and
                  warrants to DTN that:

                  (i)      KRF  is  the  contracting  party  that  provides  the
                           services  under each of the  contracts,  KRF has full
                           right and power and is not restricted in assigning to
                           DTN all of the  rights of the  service  provider  set
                           forth in the  contracts  and such  contracts  are not
                           subject to termination or  re-negotiation as a result
                           of their assignment to DTN;

                  (ii)     The contracts and  amendments  constitute  all of the
                           current agreements of KRF relating to the performance
                           of services offered by the KRF Services Business;

                  (iii)    KRF has delivered to DTN correct and complete  copies
                           of all of the  contracts and all  amendments  thereto
                           and all extensions and renewals thereof;

                  (iv)     KRF has, to the best of KRF's knowledge,  received no
                           written  notices of any warranty,  indemnity or other
                           claims by customers  under the  contracts  which have
                           not been settled to the  satisfaction of the customer
                           claimant, except of an insignificant nature;

                  (v)      No enhancements to services have been promised by KRF
                           to its customers;

                                      130
<PAGE>
                  (vi)     KRF has, to the best of KRF's knowledge,  received no
                           written notice of default from any customer under any
                           of the contracts,  except of an insignificant nature;
                           and

                  (vii)    KRF has, to the best of KRF's knowledge,  received no
                           notice of the filing by any customer of a petition in
                           bankruptcy,  assignment for the benefit of creditors,
                           a  petition  seeking   reorganization,   composition,
                           liquidation,  dissolution  or similar  arrangement or
                           the appointment of a trustee,  conservator,  receiver
                           or  similar   fiduciary   for  any  customer  or  for
                           substantially all of a customer's  assets,  except as
                           disclosed on Exhibit "A", except of an  insignificant
                           nature.

                  (i) No consent, approval, or authorization of, or filing with,
                  any  governmental  authority on the part of KRF is required in
                  connection  with the execution and delivery of this  Agreement
                  or the consummation of the  transactions  contemplated by this
                  Agreement, except as provided in this Agreement; and


         (j)      KRF,  to the  best of KRF's  knowledge,  is not a party to any
                  contract,  lease or  agreement,  which would  prevent DTN's or
                  KRF's  performance  under this  Agreement  except the Customer
                  Contracts and those contracts and agreements listed on Exhibit
                  "B" attached hereto.

8.       Representations of DTN.  DTN represents and warrants to KRF that:

         (a)      DTN is a corporation  duly organized,  validly existing and in
                  good standing under the laws of the State of Delaware;

         (b)      DTN has all requisite  corporate  power and authority to enter
                  into  this   Agreement,   to   consummate   the   transactions
                  contemplated  by this Agreement and to fulfill its obligations
                  under this Agreement;

         (c)      This Agreement has been duly executed and delivered by DTN and
                  constitutes a valid and legally binding agreement  enforceable
                  against DTN in accordance with its terms;

         (d)      The  execution  and delivery of this  Agreement by DTN and the
                  performance of its obligations  hereunder are not in violation
                  or breach of, and do not conflict with or constitute a default
                  under, any of the terms or provisions of DTN's  Certificate of
                  Incorporation or By-Laws or, to DTN's knowledge,  any contract
                  or  agreement  to which DTN is a party or by which it is bound
                  (and will not be an event which, after notice or lapse of time
                  or both, will result in any such violation,  breach, conflict,
                  or  default)  or any law,  judgment,  decree,  order,  rule or
                  regulation  of any  governmental  authority or court,  whether
                  federal,  state  or  local,  at  law  or  in  equity,  or  any
                  arbitration  decision,  applicable  to  DTN  or to  any of its
                  properties or assets; and


                                      131
<PAGE>
         (e)      No consent,  approval or authorization of, or filing with, any
                  governmental  authority  on the  part  of DTN is  required  in
                  connection  with the execution and delivery of this  Agreement
                  or the consummation of the  transactions  contemplated by this
                  Agreement, except as provided in this Agreement.

         (f)      Any  customer  information  provided  by KRF to DTN as part of
                  this  Agreement  will be held in  confidence by DTN where such
                  information  may be  considered  by the  customer or by law as
                  confidential information.

9.       Absence of Brokers.  Each of the parties hereto represents to the other
         that it has not retained or incurred any liability to any other Person,
         for a  broker's,  finder's  or agent's  fee for  services  rendered  in
         connection with the  transactions  contemplated by this Agreement;  and
         each of the parties hereto agrees to indemnify the other against and to
         hold the other harmless from any claim made by any Person,  claiming to
         have  been  employed  by such  party as a  broker,  finder  or agent in
         connection with the transactions contemplated by this Agreement.

         10.      Restrictive Covenants.


         (a)      KRF  agrees  that  during  the  Service  Period  KRF shall not
                  directly or indirectly in the United States of America  permit
                  the  distribution  or  transmission  of  the  FAP  Information
                  Package  via  any  electronic  platform  delivering  Real-Time
                  commodity quotations;  provided, however, that nothing in this
                  Agreement shall preclude KRF from:

                  (i)      Offering   the  FAP   Information   Package   or  any
                           information  service  where the customer pays a total
                           fee or charge in  excess of a monthly  equivalent  of
                           $800 (excluding exchange fees) per customer;

                  (ii)     Offering   the  FAP   Information   Package   or  any
                           information  service  where the customer pays a total
                           fee or charge in  excess of a monthly  equivalent  of
                           $250 (excluding  exchange fees) per monitor receiving
                           the service;

                  (iii)    Offering   the  FAP   Information   Package   or  any
                           information  service to  customers of KRF who receive
                           the  information  service  using  their own  computer
                           hardware  or  software,  until  such  time  as  DTN's
                           datafeed is compatible with such customer's  computer
                           hardware  and  software  and the  customers  agree to
                           convert to DTN's  datafeed.  The terms and conditions
                           for DTN to serve certain KRF datafeed  customers will
                           be included in a separate addendum to this Agreement;

                  (iv)     Offering   the  FAP   Information   Package   or  any
                           information  service  of a dial-up,  non-  real-time,
                           print or other intermittent nature; or

                  (v)      Providing  KRF  Services  in   accordance   with  the
                           provisions of this Agreement.

                                      132
<PAGE>
         KRF shall be deemed to be engaged in a  restricted  activity  if any of
         its officers,  directors,  employees or Affiliates  shall engage in any
         restricted  activity either  directly or indirectly,  whether for their
         own  account  or  for  that  of  any  other  Person  and  whether  as a
         shareholder,  partner or investor  possessing any ownership interest in
         any such Person, or as principal,  agent, proprietor,  consultant or in
         any other capacity.


         (b)      KRF agrees that during the Service  Period neither KRF nor its
                  Affiliates shall, directly or indirectly, solicit any of DTN's
                  subscribers  to  the  DTNstant  Service  existing  as  of  the
                  Effective Date or any of the KRF  Subscribers  for the purpose
                  of obtaining  their trade in the business of providing  any of
                  the KRF  Services  except where DTN is not able to provide the
                  subscriber  with  the  delivery  platform  or  information  it
                  requires.


         (c)      If any court having  jurisdiction  at any time hereafter shall
                  hold any of such restrictive  covenants to be unenforceable or
                  unreasonable as to its scope, territory or period of time, and
                  if such  court in its  judgment  or decree  shall  declare  or
                  determine  the scope,  territory  or period of time which such
                  court deems to be  reasonable,  then such scope,  territory or
                  period  of  time,   as  the  case  may  be,  shall  be  deemed
                  automatically  to  have  been  reduced  to  that  declared  or
                  determined to be reasonable by such court. Notwithstanding the
                  foregoing, if any clause or provision of this Section 10 shall
                  be  unenforceable,  then  such  clause or  provision  shall be
                  deemed to be deleted  from this  Section  10, but every  other
                  clause and provision  shall continue in full force and effect.
                  These  covenants  are an  integral  part  of the  transactions
                  contemplated  by this Agreement and DTN would not have entered
                  into this Agreement in the absence of such covenants.  DTN and
                  KRF agree  that  although  a  portion  of the  Purchase  Price
                  provided   for  in  this   Agreement   is  allocated  to  such
                  restrictive

                  covenants,  such  allocation  does not in any way  reflect the
                  damages  which would  accrue to DTN in the event of any breach
                  of such restrictive covenants.

         (d)      KRF acknowledges that the agreements contained in this Section
                  10 are  reasonable  and  necessary in order for DTN to receive
                  the  benefits  which  are  intended  to accrue to DTN from the
                  transactions  contemplated  by this  Agreement  and  that  any
                  breach  thereof will result in  irreparable  injury to DTN for
                  which DTN has no adequate remedy at law. KRF therefore  agrees
                  that,  in  the  event  KRF  breaches  any  of  the  agreements
                  contained  in this  Section  10, DTN shall be  authorized  and
                  entitled to seek from any court of competent  jurisdiction (i)
                  a temporary  restraining order, (ii) preliminary and permanent
                  injunctive  relief,  (iii)  an  equitable  accounting  of  all
                  profits  or  benefits  arising  out of such  breach  and  (iv)
                  direct, incidental and consequential damages arising from such

                                      133
<PAGE>
                  breach.  Such rights or remedies  shall be  cumulative  and in
                  addition  to any other  rights or remedies to which DTN may be
                  entitled.

11.      KRF's Employees.  Unless DTN so desires,  which  determination shall be
         made  within  thirty  (30)  days  after  Closing,  DTN  shall  have  no
         obligation  to hire any  employees of KRF and KRF shall be  responsible
         for any and all obligations to any and all of its employees,  including
         but not limited to any  salaries,  bonuses,  vacation  pay,  retirement
         benefits, sick pay, insurance premiums,  severance pay and other fringe
         benefits.

12.      Indemnification by KRF.

         (a)      Except for those debts,  obligations and liabilities expressly
                  assumed by DTN pursuant to Subsection 3(a) hereof,  DTN is not
                  assuming  and  shall  have  no  responsibility  for any of the
                  debts,  obligations  or liabilities of KRF, all of which shall
                  remain  the  responsibility  of KRF and KRF  hereby  agrees to
                  indemnify  and hold DTN  harmless  from any  loss,  liability,
                  damage,   cost  or  expense  (including  but  not  limited  to
                  reasonable  attorneys' fees) ("Damages")  arising by reason of
                  KRF's  nonpayment  or   nonperformance   of  any  such  debts,
                  obligations or liabilities not expressly assumed by DTN.

         (b)      KRF agrees that all claims received by DTN relating to the KRF
                  Services Business which are received by DTN after the Closing,
                  but which  relate  to the time  period  prior to the  Closing,
                  including any fees or penalties  which must be paid,  shall be
                  the  responsibility of KRF and that KRF, but not DTN, can make
                  any adjustments KRF deems appropriate to adjust such claims.

         (c)      KRF shall  indemnify  and hold DTN  harmless  from any Damages
                  arising  by reason of any claim of any  customer  of KRF based
                  upon  any  action  or  omission  to act by  KRF  prior  to the
                  Closing.

         (d)      KRF agrees to  indemnify  DTN against any Damages  incurred or
                  sustained  by DTN  as a  result  of (i)  any  breach  of  this
                  Agreement by KRF,  (ii) any material  inaccuracy in any of the
                  representations or warranties made by KRF in this Agreement or
                  (iii) any  material  inaccuracy  or  misrepresentation  in any
                  certificate or other  document or instrument  delivered by KRF
                  in accordance with the provisions of this Agreement.

         (e)      KRF agrees to  indemnify  DTN against  any Damages  arising by
                  reason of non-compliance by KRF with the Bulk Sales provisions
                  of the Uniform  Commercial  Code or any equivalent  statute of
                  any state or other jurisdiction, as they relate to the sale of
                  the Purchased Assets.

         13.      Indemnification by DTN.

         (a)      DTN hereby  agrees to indemnify and hold KRF harmless from any
                  Damages arising from the  liabilities  assumed by DTN pursuant
                  to section 3(a).

                                      134
<PAGE>
         (b)      DTN  agrees  that  all  claims  relating  to the KRF  Services
                  Business  which are  received by DTN or KRF after the Closing,
                  and  which  relate  to the  time  period  after  the  Closing,
                  including any fees or penalties  which must be paid,  shall be
                  the  responsibility of DTN and that DTN, but not KRF, can make
                  any adjustments DTN deems appropriate to adjust such claims.

         (c)      DTN shall  indemnify  and hold KRF  harmless  from any damages
                  arising by reason of any claim of any  customer  of DTN or any
                  information  provider  or any other  third  party  provider of
                  equipment,  software  or  services  which  relate  to the time
                  period after the Closing, except that such indemnity shall not
                  relate to any loss,  damage,  cost,  claim or expense  arising
                  solely from content or  information  created  solely by KRF or
                  arising  solely from the  negligence or willful  misconduct of
                  KRF or its appointed gents or representatives.


         (d)      DTN agrees to  indemnify  KRF against any damages  incurred or
                  sustained  by KRF  as a  result  of (i)  any  breach  of  this
                  Agreement by DTN,  (ii) any material  inaccuracy in any of the
                  representations or warranties made by DTN in this Agreement or
                  (iii) any  material  inaccuracy  or  misrepresentation  in any
                  certificate or other  document or instrument  delivered by DTN
                  in accordance with the provisions of this Agreement.


14.      Taxes; Prorating.

         (a)      The parties  agree that all sales and other similar taxes (not
                  including state or federal income taxes) payable in connection
                  with the  transfer of the  Purchased  Assets  shall be paid by
                  DTN.

         (b)      The parties agree that all property taxes, annual license fees
                  and any  other  similar  annual  levies  or  assessments  due,
                  whenever  assessed,  as a result of the ownership or operation
                  of any of the Purchased  Assets shall be prorated  between DTN
                  and KRF, with KRF to have the  liability for said taxes,  fees
                  and assessments  before the Effective Date and DTN to have the
                  liability for said taxes,  fees and assessments from and after
                  the Effective Date. Within thirty (30) days after Closing, KRF
                  will  provide to DTN an estimate  of all such taxes,  fees and
                  assessments  payable for the period beginning on the Effective
                  Date and ending as of the end of the current fiscal period for
                  each  collecting  authority  and shall make  available  to DTN
                  copies of all assessments, notices and related documents.


         (c)      KRF agrees to pay to DTN within thirty (30) days after Closing
                  (i) all prepaid  fees of any kind  received by KRF pursuant to
                  the Customer  Contracts which accrue on or after the Effective
                  Date and (ii) all  deposits  of money  held by or on behalf of
                  KRF pursuant to the Customer Contracts.

15.      NON-ASSIGNABLE   RIGHTS.  Despite  anything  contained  herein  to  the
         contrary,  this  Agreement  shall not constitute an agreement to assign

                                      135
<PAGE>
         any contract,  order, commitment,  license or right if an assignment or
         attempted  assignment  thereof  without  the consent of the other party
         thereto would constitute a breach thereof or in any material way affect
         the  rights of KRF  thereunder  or  hereunder  unless  such  consent is
         obtained.  If any  such  consent  is not  obtained  or if an  attempted
         assignment  would be  ineffective  and would  materially  affect  KRF's
         rights  thereunder,  so that DTN  would  not in fact  receive  all such
         rights,  the parties agree to cooperate in any  reasonable  arrangement
         designed  to  assure  that DTN  shall  have all the  benefits,  rights,
         obligations  and duties  under  such  contracts,  orders,  commitments,
         licenses and rights.

16.      CONFIDENTIAL AGREEMENT OF THE PARTIES. The terms and conditions of this
         Agreement are and shall remain and be kept  completely  confidential by
         the parties hereto, their employees,  agents and legal counsel.  Except
         as required by law, regulations or auditing requirements,  the terms of
         this  Agreement  shall not be  disclosed  to any third person by either
         party without the prior written  consent of the other.  There should be
         discussion or disclosure of the existence or details of this  Agreement
         except as  absolutely  required in  preparation  for Closing,  prior to
         Closing. In addition,  no press release shall be issued by either party
         without the prior  written  consent of the other party , which  consent
         shall not be unreasonably withheld.

17.      CONDUCT AND TRANSACTIONS OF KRF PRIOR TO CLOSING. From the date of this
         Agreement until the Closing,  except to the extent expressly  permitted
         by this Agreement or otherwise consented to by an instrument in writing
         signed by DTN:

         (a)      KRF  will  keep the KRF  Services  Business  and  organization
                  intact and will not take or permit to be taken or do or suffer
                  to be done anything  other than in the ordinary  course of its
                  business as the same is presently being conducted and KRF will
                  use its best  efforts to keep  available  the  services of its
                  officers,  employees  and agents and to maintain  the goodwill
                  and reputation associated with the KRF Services Business;

         (b)      KRF will not make any change in its articles of  incorporation
                  or By-Laws,  which would preclude,  hinder,  interfere with or
                  otherwise impair the ability of KRF to perform its obligations
                  pursuant to this  Agreement and  consummate  the  transactions
                  contemplated hereby;

         (c)      KRF will  exercise its best efforts to maintain the  Purchased
                  Assets,  tangible or intangible,  in good operating  condition
                  and repair and take all steps necessary to keep its operations
                  functioning as they presently are;

         (d)      KRF will not sell,  lease or dispose of, or make any  contract
                  for the sale,  lease or  disposition  of, any of the Purchased
                  Assets  other  than in the  ordinary  and usual  course of its
                  business consistent with the representations and warranties of
                  KRF  contained  herein  and  not  in  breach  of  any  of  the
                  provisions of this Section 17;

         (e)      KRF shall not encumber or permit to be  encumbered  any of the
                  Purchased Assets; and

                                      136
<PAGE>
         (f)      KRF shall not do, or cause to be done,  any act or suffer,  or
                  cause to be  suffered,  any  omission  which would cause to be
                  breached,  or  might  result  in  a  breach  of,  any  of  the
                  representations,  warranties  or  covenants  of KRF  contained
                  herein if the same were made anew  immediately  after any such
                  act or omission.


18.      Conditions  Precedent to DTN's  Obligations.  Each of the agreements of
         DTN to be  performed  by it at the Closing  pursuant to this  Agreement
         shall  be  subject  to  the   fulfillment  of  each  of  the  following
         conditions,  any one or more of  which  may be  waived,  in whole or in
         part, in writing, by DTN:

         (a)      Each of the representations and warranties of KRF set forth in
                  Section 7 hereof  shall be true and  correct  both on the date
                  hereof and on the date of the Closing as if made at that time,
                  except insofar as changes  contemplated by this Agreement have
                  occurred after the date hereof;

         (b)      KRF shall have  performed  and complied  with all  agreements,
                  undertakings   and  obligations   which  are  required  to  be
                  performed  or complied  with by it at or prior to the Closing;
                  and

         (c)      At the  Closing,  KRF shall have  delivered  to DTN all of the
                  items required to be delivered  under  Subsection 5(a) of this
                  Agreement.

19.      Conditions  Precedent to KRF's  Obligations.  Each of the agreements of
         KRF to be  performed  by it at the Closing  pursuant to this  Agreement
         shall  be  subject  to  the   fulfillment  of  each  of  the  following
         conditions,  any one or more of  which  may be  waived,  in whole or in
         part, in writing, by KRF:

         (a)      The representations and warranties of DTN set forth in Section
                  8 of this Agreement shall be true and correct both on the date
                  hereof and on the date of the as if made at that time,  except
                  insofar  as  changes   contemplated  by  this  Agreement  have
                  occurred after the date hereof;

         (b)      DTN shall have  performed  and complied  with all  agreements,
                  undertakings  and  obligations as are required to be performed
                  or complied with by it at or prior to the Closing; and

         (c)      At the  Closing,  DTN shall have  delivered  to KRF all of the
                  items required to be delivered  under  Subsection 5(b) of this
                  Agreement.


20.      Risk of Loss.  KRF shall bear all risk of loss prior to the Closing and
         DTN shall bear all risk of loss after the Closing  with  respect to the
         tangible  personal  property  being sold by KRF to DTN pursuant to this
         Agreement.  In the event of significant loss in the Purchased Equipment
         between  Execution  and prior to  Closing,  DTN and KRF may agree to an

                                      137
<PAGE>
         equitable  adjustment in the Purchase  Price or if there is a loss of a
         material  portion of the  Purchased  Equipment  being  purchased by DTN
         between Execution and prior to Closing,  either DTN or KRF may elect to
         terminate this Agreement.

21.      Conversion  of KRF  Subscribers.  No conversion or other contact of KRF
         customers may be made prior to the beginning of the Conversion Period.

         (a)      KRF  Subscribers  presently  receive KRF Services via both the
                  KRF System and the KRF Land-Line System. During the Conversion
                  Period,  KRF shall  continue to transmit  the  applicable  KRF
                  Information to those KRF Subscribers receiving services on the
                  KRF  Land-Line   System  in  compliance  with  their  Customer
                  Contracts  and DTN  will  reimburse  KRF  for the  cost of the
                  land-lines and any other clearly  identifiable  and documented
                  costs  that  KRF  would   otherwise   not  incur  if  the  KRF
                  Subscribers had been converted to the DTN System.

         (b)      Prior to March 31, 1996, DTN will install at DTN's expense, in
                  the KRF Equipment of each KRF Subscriber  using the KRF System
                  replacement parts and other equipment necessary to enable such
                  subscribers to receive the applicable  KRF  Information  using
                  the KRF  Equipment  via a  datafeed  transmitted  over the DTN
                  System (the  "Installation").  Prior to the  Installation  for
                  each such subscriber,  KRF shall continue to transmit over the
                  KRF System the applicable KRF  Information to such  subscriber
                  in compliance with its Customer  Contract.  DTN will reimburse
                  KRF  for  any  clearly   identifiable   and  documented  costs
                  associated   with  this  continued   support  that  KRF  would
                  otherwise not incur if the KRF  Subscriber  had been converted
                  to the DTN  System.  After the  Installation  but  before  the
                  Conversion  (as  defined  in  Subsection  21(c)) for each such
                  subscriber,  such subscriber  shall receive the applicable KRF
                  Information  using  the  KRF  Equipment  and  DTN's  satellite
                  transmission of the KRF Information  furnished to DTN pursuant
                  to Section 22.

                  Notwithstanding  the foregoing  provisions of this  subsection
                  (b), DTN may forego the Installation for any KRF Subscriber if
                  the Conversion of such  subscriber is completed prior to March
                  31, 1996.

         (c)      During the Conversion  Period, DTN will replace some or all of
                  the KRF Equipment with equipment  necessary to enable each KRF
                  Subscriber to obtain the  applicable KRF  Information  via the
                  DTN  System  without  use  of any  KRF  Equipment  other  than
                  Purchased  Equipment (the  "Conversion").  Upon  completion of
                  each  Conversion,  DTN will cause to be  delivered  to KRF, in
                  proper  packaging to be furnished by the Converted  Subscriber
                  or KRF, the KRF Equipment known by DTN to be in the possession
                  of the Converted  Subscriber  other than Purchased  Equipment.
                  DTN will complete the Conversion of all KRF Subscribers by the
                  end of the Conversion Period.

         (d)      Prior to the Effective Date, KRF shall at its expense maintain
                  and replace  the KRF  Equipment  as  required by the  Customer
                  Contracts.  After the Effective Date, DTN shall at its expense

                                      138
<PAGE>
                  maintain  and replace the  Purchased  Equipment as required by
                  the Customer  Contracts.  In addition,  during the  Conversion
                  Period, until returned to KRF as provided in Subsection 21(c),
                  DTN  shall  at  its  expense  maintain  and  replace  the  KRF
                  Equipment that is not Purchased Equipment;  provided, however,
                  without further consideration,  KRF shall from time to time at
                  DTN's expense as requested by DTN during the Conversion Period
                  furnish to DTN the tools,  parts,  supplies  and  replacements
                  necessary  to service and  maintain  such  equipment in proper
                  working  order.  In addition,  KRF shall allow DTN  reasonable
                  access  to  qualified  personnel  of KRF  for the  purpose  of
                  assisting  DTN's  customer  service   representatives,   field
                  technicians and engineers in maintaining uninterrupted service
                  to KRF  Subscribers  as provided in this  Agreement.  KRF also
                  shall make available to DTN prior to the Effective Date, up to
                  two hundred and fifty (250) or such other lower  number  based
                  on KRF current inventory levels as KRF shall determine, Valley
                  Receivers of the type  included in the KRF  Equipment to which
                  DTN will at its expense  install  replacement  parts necessary
                  for  such  receivers  to  receive  the KRF  Information  to be
                  transmitted  over the DTN System.  These  supplemental  Valley
                  Receivers will be used by DTN to facilitate the  Installations
                  referred to in Subsection 21(b). KRF authorizes DTN to install
                  such replacement parts in the Valley Receivers and DTN further
                  agrees to return such Valley  Receivers in the same  condition
                  as delivered to DTN, fair wear and tear accepted. Any such KRF
                  receivers not returned to KRF by 01 April 1996 will be charged
                  to DTN at their net book  value as of 01 January  1996.  As of
                  the Effective Date, without further consideration,  KRF agrees
                  to provide at a time  mutually  convenient  to both parties at
                  DTN's facility in Omaha, Nebraska, up to seventy (70) hours of
                  in-house customer service and field technician training on how
                  to handle  inquiries from KRF  Subscribers,  troubleshoot  and
                  service  and   maintain  the  KRF   Equipment.   Any  training
                  requirements  above and beyond the initial  seventy (70) hours
                  will be charged to DTN at full cost.

         (e)      During the Conversion Period,  without further  consideration,
                  KRF  agrees  to   cooperate   with  DTN  to  convert  all  KRF
                  Subscribers  from the KRF System or KRF Land-Line  System,  as
                  applicable,  to the DTN System;  provided,  however, KRF shall
                  not be required to incur significant  out-of-pocket  expenses,
                  except as specifically  provided in this  Agreement.  Prior to
                  the  Effective  Date,  DTN and KRF will prepare a letter to be
                  sent from KRF to all KRF Subscribers explaining the conversion
                  to the DTN System and informing the KRF Subscribers  that your
                  KRF Information  will now be provided on the DTN System.  Such
                  letter is to be accompanied by promotional materials furnished
                  by DTN and  delivered at times  designated by DTN. The content
                  of such letter shall be mutually agreeable to DTN and KRF. DTN
                  will be responsible  for assembly of such mailing and will pay
                  the postage charges.

         (f)      As an accommodation to DTN, without further consideration, KRF
                  will bill KRF  Subscribers  for all  services  which are to be
                  billed for the first full month  following the Effective  Date
                  pursuant to the  Customer  Contracts  and receive on behalf of

                                      139
<PAGE>
                  DTN all payments  relating to the accounts  receivable  of DTN
                  generated  from such  billings.  DTN will  offset  against the
                  payments  next becoming due to KRF pursuant to Section 23, the
                  amounts of the payments received from time to time by KRF with
                  respect to such accounts receivable of DTN. KRF shall not have
                  any  obligations  with respect to such  receivable,  except to
                  have the amounts  received  credited to DTN as mentioned above
                  and  KRF  does  not to any  extent  whatsoever  guarantee  the
                  collection or collectibility  of such receivable,  which shall
                  remain the exclusive  property of DTN. DTN shall remit to KRF,
                  upon   receipt,   any  payments   received  by  DTN  from  KRF
                  Subscribers  which represent payment for KRF Services rendered
                  prior to the Effective Date; provided,  however, DTN shall not
                  have  any   obligations   with   respect  to  KRF's   accounts
                  receivable,  except to remit the amounts received as mentioned
                  in this  sentence  and DTN does not to any  extent  whatsoever
                  guarantee the collection or collectibility of such receivable,
                  which shall remain the exclusive property of KRF. DTN shall be
                  responsible  for billing and  collecting all fees due from KRF
                  Subscribers  for all periods  after the first month  following
                  the Effective Date.

         (g)      KRF shall permit DTN to keep and maintain,  at DTN's  expense,
                  for a period no longer  than six months  from the  Closing and
                  involving  no more  than  three  employees  at any  one  time,
                  employees (to be designated by DTN) at KRF's  principal  place
                  of business for the purpose of  familiarizing  themselves with
                  the KRF Services Business.

22.      KRF Information; License.


         (a)      KRF agrees to provide all of the KRF Information to DTN during
                  the  Service  Period as provided  in this  Agreement.  The KRF
                  Information  shall  be  furnished  to DTN,  to  enable  DTN to
                  broadcast the KRF  Information  over the DTN System to the KRF
                  Subscribers in compliance with their Customer Contracts and to
                  DTNstant  subscribers  and  DTN  shall  reimburse  KRF for any
                  clearly  identifiable  costs. Such costs to be mutually agreed
                  between the parties.


         (b)      KRF will provide the equipment  described on Exhibit "F" which
                  is necessary  for KRF to provide to DTN by  telecommunications
                  lines and support  equipment,  the DTN Information so that DTN
                  can directly  input the KRF  Information  onto the DTN System.
                  KRF will  provide  the KRF  Information  to DTN in the  format
                  described on Exhibit "F".

         (c)      KRF hereby  grants to DTN a license to sell and  broadcast the
                  KRF  Information  to the KRF  Subscribers  and all present and
                  future   subscribers  to  the  DTNstant   Service  within  the
                  Territory  during  the  Service  Period  upon  the  terms  and
                  conditions  described in this  Agreement KRF further grants to
                  DTN  a  license  to  make  available  to  subscribers  of  DTN
                  services, other than the DTNstant service, the KRF Information
                  as a KRF  Optional  Service  at a fee  to be  mutually  agreed
                  between the parties.

                                      140
<PAGE>
         (d)      KRF  assumes  full  responsibility  for the content of the KRF
                  Information  delivered to DTN or KRF  Subscribers  pursuant to
                  the terms of this  Agreement.  KRF  represents and warrants to
                  DTN  that KRF has and will  continue  to have the full  power,
                  right and authority to obtain, transmit and distribute the KRF
                  Information to DTN for  distribution by DTN as contemplated by
                  this  Agreement.  KRF further  represents  and warrants to DTN
                  that DTN's broadcast of the KRF Information to its subscribers
                  as  contemplated  by this Agreement will not infringe upon the
                  rights of any third party respecting  copyright,  trade secret
                  or any privacy interest in the Territory  subject to receiving
                  all  consent  that  may be  required.  DTN  acknowledges  that
                  information  contained in the KRF Information is obtained from
                  various sources which KRF believes to be reliable.  Subject to
                  the  indemnification  obligations  of KRF  set  forth  in this
                  Agreement  KRF does not  guarantee  and makes no warranties or
                  representations  with  respect  to  the  sequence,   accuracy,
                  completeness  or  timeliness  of  any  information   furnished
                  hereunder;   nor  does  it  represent  that  the   information
                  disseminated may be relied upon for trading purposes.

         (e)      DTN agrees that prior to the broadcast of any KRF  Information
                  to a DTN  subscriber on the DTN System,  DTN will obtain a DTN
                  Subscription Agreement  substantially in the form of Exhibit H
                  subject to the  normal  customer  renewal or new  subscription
                  activity.   Any   substantial   changes  to  these  terms  and
                  conditions,  which  shall  include but shall not be limited to
                  changes to any indemnity,  warranty, limited liability and use
                  provisions will require the prior written consent of KRF which
                  shall not be unreasonably withheld.


         (f)      DTN agrees where not otherwise obvious to DTN users of the KRF
                  Information,  to attribute the KRF Information as "Source KRF"
                  or  similar   attribution  and  to  clearly  indicate  on  any
                  marketing or  advertising  material  that KRF is the source of
                  the KRF Information.


         (g)      DTN agrees to title and market any DTN service which  includes
                  a  significant   amount  of  KRF  Information  as  a  standard
                  component  as  "DTNstant  /  Knight-Ridder  Financial"  unless
                  otherwise agreed between the parties.


         (h)      KRF shall  retain  all  rights  to,  title to,  ownership  of,
                  copyright  to  and  any  other  interest  in  any  information
                  supplied to DTN. DTN  acknowledges  and agrees that all of the
                  information  provided by KRF as part of this  agreement is the
                  sole and exclusive  property of KRF. DTN agrees to not modify,
                  archive (for other than operational and maintenance purposes),
                  create  derivatives or use the information  provided by KRF in
                  any way other than contemplated by this agreement and shall be
                  permitted to only utilize the information  provided by KRF for
                  the sole purpose of permitting subscribers in the territory to
                  receive the information only for their internal use.

                                      136
<PAGE>
         23.      Revenue Sharing.

         (a)      In   consideration   for  the  rights   granted  and  the  KRF
                  Information provided by KRF pursuant to Section 22, DTN agrees
                  to share with KRF the Base Service Fees,  Limited Service Fees
                  and  Optional  Service fees as provided in this  section.  DTN
                  agrees to pay to KRF that  percentage of the Base Service Fees
                  set forth below opposite the period with respect to which such
                  Base Service Fees were earned by DTN:

                       Period                                    Percentage
          -----------------------------------                    ----------
                                                                  
          From the Effective Date to Month 12                         30%
          From Month 13 to Month 24                                   20%
          From  Month 25 to December 31, 1997                         15%
          From January 1, 1998 to December 31, 1998                   14%
          From January 1, 1999 to December 31, 1999                   13%
          From January 1, 2000 to December 31, 2000                   13%
          From January 1, 2001 to December 31, 2001 [1]               12%
          From and after January 1, 2002 [1]                          11%
          From and after January 01, 2003 [1]                         10%


         Notwithstanding  the  foregoing  percentages,  if over  the  period  of
         twenty-four  (24)  months from the  Effective  Date there are less than
         1,000 Converted  Subscribers plus KRF Subscribers,  then, after written
         claim has been  received  from DTN and  verification  of that claim has
         been independently  audited and  substantiated,  the percentage of Base
         Service  Fees to be paid to KRF during  the  remainder  of the  Service
         Period shall be ten percent (10%).

         DTN agrees to pay to KRF a  percentage  share,  to be  mutually  agreed
         between the Parties,  of any KRF Optional Service revenue where the KRF
         Information  is  offered as a KRF  Optional  Service  as  described  in
         Section 22(c).

         DTN agrees to pay to KRF five percent  (5%) of Limited  Service Fees to
         the extent that such Limited  Service Fees exceed  $35,000 per month or
         the  amount  of  Limited  Service  Fees  at the  Effective  Date of the
         agreement whichever is lower.


         DTN shall pay the applicable  percentages  of the KRF Optional  Service
         fees,  the Base  Service  Fees and Limited  Service  Fees to KRF within
         fifteen (15) days after the end of each calendar quarter based upon the
         Base Service Fees and Limited  Service Fees for such calendar  quarter.
         DTN  shall  have the  right to  offset  against  the  payments  due KRF
         pursuant to this subsection, any moneys due to DTN from KRF pursuant to
         this Agreement.  Each payment by DTN to KRF pursuant to this subsection
         shall be accompanied by a statement detailing the customers subscribing
         to  any  Base  Services,  Limited  Services  or any  Optional  Services
         together with a written summary of how such amount was computed.

         (a)      KRF shall have the right,  at its  expense,  upon at least ten
                  (10)  days  prior  written  notice  to DTN and  during  normal
                  business  hours,  to have access to DTN's books and records in

                                      141
<PAGE>
                  order to perform an audit to determine  DTN's  compliance with
                  the revenue  sharing  provisions of this Section 23. DTN shall
                  be obligated to pay any  underpayment of fees revealed by such
                  audits plus  interest  at the then prime rate.  In addition if
                  such  underpayment  represents  more than 5% of the total fees
                  due for  the  relevant  period,  DTN  shall  be  obligated  to
                  reimburse  KRF for the cost of the audit plus a penalty of 10%
                  of the underpayment amount.

         (b)      Except   in  the   case   of   default   under   section   25,
                  notwithstanding any other contrary provision contained in this
                  Agreement, if KRF elects to terminate the Service Period prior
                  to December 31, 2000, then DTN has the option,  exercisable in
                  its sole discretion, to unilaterally extend the Service Period
                  for an  additional  two (2) years  after the date at which the
                  Service Period  otherwise would end. Only sections 1 - 9, 12 -
                  16, 20, 22 - 30 of this  Agreement  shall still  apply  during
                  such  additional  two year period,  except that in lieu of the
                  revenue sharing arrangements  provided in this Section 23, DTN
                  shall  pay to KRF on the  last  day of each  calendar  quarter
                  during such  additional two year period an amount equal to the
                  aggregate  payment due to KRF pursuant to Subsection 23(a) for
                  the last calendar  quarter  preceding such additional two year
                  period.

24.      PROVISION OF EXCHANGE QUOTE  INFORMATION.  For the  convenience of DTN,
         KRF  agrees  to  include  in the  datafeed  provided  as  part  of this
         Agreement,  the normal quote  information from the Winnipeg Futures and
         London Metals Exchanges.  DTN agrees that it must first arrange to gain
         full and  proper  rights to  distribute  this  information  from  those
         corresponding  exchanges prior to distributing  this  information.  DTN
         will hold KRF harmless for any exchange  fees or other costs related to
         DTN's use of this exchange information.

25.      SURVIVAL OF REPRESENTATIONS  AND WARRANTIES.  The  representations  and
         warranties  of  DTN  and  KRF,  respectively,  as  set  forth  in  this
         Agreement,  shall survive the Closing and the expiration or termination
         of this Agreement.

26.      DEFAULT.  This  Agreement may be terminated by either party upon thirty
         (30) days prior  written  notice that the other party has  breached the
         provisions of this  Agreement and has not cured such breach within such
         notice  period.  Upon  the  occurrence  of any  event of  default,  the
         non-defaulting  party may  exercise  any  right or remedy  which may be
         available to it under applicable law including, but not limited to, the
         right to pursue the specific  performance  of any  agreement  contained
         herein.  In  addition,  the  defaulting  party shall be liable for, and
         reimburse the non-  defaulting  party for, all reasonable and necessary
         legal fees and other costs and expenses incurred by the  non-defaulting
         party  as  a  result  of  such   defaults   or  the   exercise  of  the
         non-defaulting party's remedies. No right, power or remedy conferred by
         this Agreement  shall be exclusive of any other right,  power or remedy
         referred to herein or now or hereafter  available at law, in equity, by
         statute or otherwise.

27.      NO  ASSIGNMENT.  Neither  party may assign or  subcontract  its rights,
         duties or obligations  under this Agreement to any Person,  except with
         the prior  written  consent of the other  party,  which  consent may be

                                      142
<PAGE>
         withheld  for any reason  whatsoever,  provided  however,  that nothing
         herein shall  prevent any change in ownership of KRF or the  assignment
         of such rights and obligations to any entity in the Knight-Ridder group
         of companies..

28.      EXPENSES  OF  TRANSACTION.  Except  as  specifically  provided  in this
         Agreement,  the  parties  hereto  each shall  bear all of the  expenses
         respectively incurred by them in connection with this Agreement and the
         consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby.

29.      ENTIRE  AGREEMENT.  This  document,   including  the  Exhibits  hereto,
         contains the entire  agreement  between the parties hereto with respect
         to the  subject  matter  of this  Agreement;  and  there  are no  other
         agreements, representations, warranties, or covenants, written or oral,
         with respect to the  transactions  contemplated by this Agreement which
         are not expressly set forth in this document.

30.      AMENDMENTS.  This  Agreement may be amended by letter or other document
         which by its terms specifically  states that it is an amendment to this
         Agreement; provided, that such letter or other document shall be signed
         by all of the parties hereto.

31.      NOTICES.  Any notice  which may be  permitted  or  required to be given
         pursuant to this  Agreement  shall be delivered  personally or shall be
         sent by a nationally  recognized  overnight courier or by United States
         registered or certified mail,  postage prepaid,  addressed as set forth
         below:

If to KRF:                          Knight-Ridder Financial, Inc.
                                    75 Wall St.
                                    23rd Floor
                                    New York, NY  10006
                                    Attn.:  Managing Director / Americas

With a copy to:                     Knight-Ridder Financial, Inc.
                                    2020 West 89th St.
                                    Leawood, KS  66206
                                    Attn.: Vice President / Finance



If to DTN:                          Data Transmission Network Corporation
                                    9110 West Dodge Road
                                    Suite 200
                                    Omaha, Nebraska  68114
                                    Attn.:  President

With a copy to:                     R. Craig Fry, Esq.
                                    Abrahams, Kaslow & Cassman
                                    8712 West Dodge Road
                                    Suite 300
                                    Omaha, Nebraska  68114


or to any other address as any party may by written notice to the other party in
accordance with this Section designate.

                                      143
<PAGE>


1        BINDING  EFFECT.  The terms and provisions of this  Agreement  shall be
         binding  upon and inure to the benefit of the parties  hereto and their
         respective heirs, successors and permitted assigns.

1        SECTION  HEADINGS.  The headings of the sections in this  Agreement are
         for the  purpose  of  reference  only and shall not limit or  otherwise
         affect the meaning of any of the provisions of this Agreement.

2        INCORPORATION OF EXHIBITS.  Each of the Exhibits referred to herein and
         attached  hereto  are  incorporated  herein and shall be deemed to be a
         part of this Agreement.

3        ATTORNEYS'  FEES. In the event of any action or  proceeding  brought in
         connection with this Agreement,  the prevailing  party therein shall be
         entitled to recover its costs and reasonable attorneys' fees.

4        PAYMENT LOCATION. All payments due under this Agreement from DTN to KRF
         will be  made  by wire  transfer  to:  Knight-Ridder  Financial,  Chase
         Manhattan Bank,  New York, NY ,  Account No:

5        APPLICABLE LAW. This Agreement shall be governed in all respects by the
         laws of the State of Nebraska.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF,  the corporate  parties hereto have caused this Agreement to
be  duly  executed  on  their  respective  behalves  by  their  respective  duly
authorized officers, all as of the day and year first above written.


FOR:     KNIGHT-RIDDER FINANCIAL, INC., a

Delaware corporation

By:              /s/ Patrice M. O'Grady
               ----------------------------------------------------------------
Name:            Patrice O'Grady
               ----------------------------------------------------------------
Title:           Managing Director
               ----------------------------------------------------------------
Date:            13 July 1995
               ----------------------------------------------------------------



FOR:     DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK

CORPORATION, a Delaware corporation

By:               /s/ Greg T. Sloma
               ----------------------------------------------------------------
Name:             Greg T. Sloma
               ----------------------------------------------------------------
Title:            Executive Vice President and Chief Operating Officer
               ----------------------------------------------------------------
Date:             7/13/95
               ----------------------------------------------------------------

                                      144
<PAGE>

                                   EXHIBIT "A"


                           Schedule of KRF Subscribers

                         (To be delivered after Closing)


                                   EXHIBIT "B"

             Contracts and Agreements other than Customer Contracts

                         (To be delivered after Closing)


                                   EXHIBIT "C"

                                License Agreement

                         (To be delivered after Closing)






                                      145
<PAGE>





                                   EXHIBIT "D"

                     Values Assigned to Purchased Equipment

                (estimate pr Section 4(b) delivered after Closing
                     details to be delivered after Closing)




                                   EXHIBIT "E"

                             Schedule of Exceptions





(1)    In some situations,  by special  agreement,  certain  subscribers have in
       their Service  Agreement a requirement to obtain written consent from the
       Subscriber prior to assignment of their Service Agreement.

       DTN/KRF  will work  together to obtain the consent of the  Subscriber  to
       assignment.

(2)    Certain information  relating to optional services and private customer E
       Mail may or may not be deliverable to DTN without  specific  agreement of
       the source.


                                  


                                      146
<PAGE>


                                   EXHIBIT "F"

                   Description of Input Equipment and Format /
                   Specifications for KRF Information Datafeed









                                      147
<PAGE>










                                   EXHIBIT "G"

                         Description of KRF Information

 






                                      148
<PAGE>











                                   EXHIBIT "H"

                           DTN Subscription Agreement

                         (To be delivered after Closing)









                                      149
<PAGE>


                                   EXHIBIT "I"

                          ALLOCATION OF PURCHASE PRICE



Purchased Equipment*                                           $1,000,000

Subscription Lists/Contracts**                                  4,970,000
                                                               -----------
         Total Purchase Price                                   $5,970,000
                                                               ===========




* This number  represents  the  estimated  value of those items of KRF Equipment
which are in the possession of Converted Subscribers and are compatible with and
may be used in the DTN System  without  alteration  or  modification  other than
normal field  adjustments.  This estimation may be adjusted when full conversion
is complete.

** This number  includes an estimation  of the revenue  sharing  agreement  that
exceeds 15% in years one and two. The 15%  represents  the amount that DTN would
pay for news  services  that KRF  provides  to the  subscribers.  Above  the 15%
constitutes  additional  monies  that  will  be  paid  by  DTN to  KRF  for  the
subscription lists/contracts. This estimation may be adjusted at the end of year
one and/or year two.







                                      150
<PAGE>



TO:               PHIL HUSTON                                  DECEMBER 30, 1994
FROM:             ROBERT S. HERMAN

REF:              INDEPENDENT SALES REPRESENTATIVE AGREEMENT dated 28 MARCH
                  1990 FIRST AMENDMENT to the above document dated MARCH 1,
                  1991 specifically: AMENDMENT "A", II. B.

RE:               ADJUSTMENT OF THE SPECIFIED MINIMUM MONTHLY PETROLEUM FEE
                  and the implementation of shared revenue from ALTERNET
                  delivery of message traffic.



1) Effective March 1, 1995, the MINIMUM MONTHLY  PETROLEUM FEE will be increased
from the  current  figure  of $44.00  per unit per month to $50.00  per unit per
month.  This amount will remain in place until the next adjustment date of March
1, 1997.

2)  Effective  April  1,  1995  DTN  is  projected  to  have  recovered  initial
developmental,   implementation,   overhead,   and  operational  costs  for  the
telephone-based  system  known  as  ALTERNET.  With the  understanding  that DTN
retains full rights to recover further  expansion,  development,  overhead,  and
operational  costs  as they may  occur in the  future,  DTN will  undertake  the
inclusion of Revenues, less the above-referenced  expenses and less direct phone
line or VAN  expenses,  into the  general  pool of funds  subject to our revenue
sharing  agreement.  Under this agreement,  Mr. Huston will receive 40% of these
revenues.

The  determination  of all amounts and all  appropriateness  of allocations  for
recoverable expenses relating to Alternet operations is solely at the discretion
of DTN,  and my be changed at any time by DTN,  and my be changed at any time by
DTN according to the then-existing situation. Changes to the expense withholding
amount from  Alternet  gross  revenues are not tied to the two-year  cycle as is
item #1 above.

By way of reference, DTN's budgeting projections would indicate that the ongoing
expense  level on a  month-to-month  basis  will be in the range of  $5,000  per
month.  This  includes  operations,  implementation  of  upgrades,  and overhead
allocations.  It does not include further  hardware for additional  expansion of
the system beyond that which will be paid for by April 1, 1995.

3) All other terms, including various letters of understanding, remain unchanged
other than as amended herein.

ACKNOWLEDGED ON THIS DATE

/s/ Robert S. Herman                             /s/ Phil Huston
- -------------------------------                --------------------------------
Robert S. Herman                               Phil Huston
Senior Vice President                          Independent Sales Representative
Data Transmission Network Corp.                DTNergy


Date                                           Date 
      -------------------------                     ---------------------------

                                      151
<PAGE>


                                                                  EXECUTION COPY


- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------




                      DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION

                    11.25% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2004
                        Warrants to Purchase Common Stock






                                NOTE AND WARRANT
                               PURCHASE AGREEMENT








                            Dated as of June 30, 1994







- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

                                      152
<PAGE>

                               TABLE OF CONTENTS



1.  Authorization of Notes and Warrants........................................1

2.  Sale and Purchase of Notes and Warrants....................................2

3.  Closing; Fees..............................................................2
        3.1.  Closing..........................................................2
        3.2.  Legal Fees.......................................................3

4.  Conditions to Closing......................................................3
        4.1.  Representations and Warranties...................................3
        4.2.  Performance; No Default..........................................3
        4.3.  Compliance Certificate...........................................3
        4.4.  Opinions of Counsel..............................................4
        4.5.  Bank Loan Agreement..............................................4
        4.6.  Purchase Permitted By Applicable Law, etc........................4
        4.7.  Proceedings and Documents........................................5
        4.8.  Fees.............................................................5

5.  Representations and Warranties, etc........................................5
        5.1.  Organization, Standing, etc......................................5
        5.2.  Subsidiaries.....................................................5
        5.3.  Qualification....................................................5
        5.4.  Business; Financial Statements...................................5
        5.5.  Changes, etc.....................................................6
        5.6.  Tax Returns and Payments.........................................7
        5.7.  Debt.............................................................7
        5.8.  Title to Properties; Liens.......................................8
        5.9.  Litigation, etc..................................................8
        5.10. Compliance with Other Instruments, etc...........................9
        5.11. Governmental Consent.............................................9
        5.12. Patents, Trademarks, Authorizations, etc.........................9
        5.13. Offer of Notes..................................................10
        5.14  Use of Proceeds.................................................10
        5.15. Federal Reserve Regulations.....................................10
        5.16. Environmental Matters...........................................11
        5.17. Status Under Certain Federal Statutes...........................11
        5.18. Foreign Assets Control Regulations, etc.........................11
        5.19. Compliance with ERISA...........................................12
        5.20. Disclosure......................................................14

6.  Purchase Intent; Source of Funds..........................................14
        6.1.  Purchase Intent.................................................14
        6.2.  Source of Funds.................................................15

7.  Furnishing of Information.................................................15

                                        i

                                      153
<PAGE>
        7.1.  Accounting; Financial Statements and Other
              Information.....................................................15
        7.2.  Rule 144A.......................................................20

8.  Inspection; Confidentiality...............................................20
        8.1.  Inspection......................................................20
        8.2.  Confidentiality.................................................21

9.  Prepayment of Notes.......................................................21
        9.1.  Required Prepayments............................................21
        9.2.  Optional Prepayments with Premium...............................22
        9.3.  Contingent Prepayments Upon Change of Control
              ................................................................22
        9.4.  Contingent Prepayment Upon Sale of Certain Assets
              ................................................................23
        9.5.  Master Premium Table............................................24
        9.6.  Notice of Optional Prepayments; Officers'
              Certificate.....................................................24
        9.7.  Allocation of Partial Prepayments...............................25
        9.8.  Maturity; Surrender, etc........................................25
        9.9.  Acquisition of Notes............................................25

10. Business and Financial Covenants..........................................26
       10.1.  Debt............................................................26
       10.2.  Liens, etc......................................................27
       10.3.  Investments, Guaranties, etc....................................28
       10.4.  Restricted Payments and Restricted Investments
              ................................................................31
       10.5.  Minimum Net Worth...............................................32
       10.6.  Transactions with Affiliates....................................32
       10.7.  Consolidation, Merger, Sale of Assets, etc......................33
       10.8.  Corporate Existence, etc.; Business.............................36
       10.9.  Payment of Taxes and Claims.....................................36
       10.10. Compliance with ERISA...........................................37
       10.11. Maintenance of Properties; Insurance............................39
       10.12. Senior Loan Agreements..........................................39

11.  Events of Default; Acceleration..........................................39

12.  Remedies on Default, etc.................................................43
13.  Subordination of Subordinated Notes......................................44
       13.1.  General.........................................................44
       13.2.  Superior Debt...................................................44
       13.3.  Default in Respect of Superior Debt.............................45
       13.4.  Insolvency, etc.................................................46
       13.5.  Payments and Distributions Received.............................47
       13.6   No Prejudice or Impairment......................................48
       13.7.  Payment of Superior Debt, Subrogation, etc......................48
  
                                       ii

                                      154
<PAGE>
14.  Definitions..............................................................49

15.  Registration, Transfer and Substitution of Notes;
     Action by Noteholders....................................................61
       15.1.  Note Register; Ownership of Notes...............................61
       15.2.  Transfer and Exchange of Notes..................................61
       15.3.  Replacement of Notes............................................61
       15.4.  Notes held by Company, etc., Deemed Not
              Outstanding.....................................................62

16.  Payments on Notes........................................................62
       16.1.  Place of Payment................................................62
       16.2.  Home Office Payment.............................................62

17.  Expenses, etc............................................................63

18.  Survival of Representations and Warranties...............................64

19.  Amendments and Waivers...................................................64

20.  Notices, etc.............................................................65

21.  Miscellaneous............................................................66


SCHEDULE A                          Schedule of Purchasers

EXHIBIT A                           Form of Senior Subordinated Note

EXHIBIT B                           Form of Warrant

EXHIBIT C-1                         Form of Opinion of Counsel to Company

EXHIBIT C-2                         Form of Opinion of Counsel to Purchaser

EXHIBIT D                           Debt and Liens of Company


                                       iii


                                      155
<PAGE>

                      Data Transmission Network Corporation
                              9110 West Dodge Road
                                    Suite 200
                              Omaha, Nebraska 68114


               11.25% Senior Subordinated Notes due June 30, 2004
                        Warrants to Purchase Common Stock

                            Dated as of June 30, 1994


TO EACH OF THE PURCHASERS LISTED IN
         THE ATTACHED SCHEDULE A

Ladies and Gentlemen:

                  Data Transmission Network Corporation,  a Delaware corporation
(the "Company"), agrees with you as follows:

                  1.  AUTHORIZATION  OF NOTES AND  WARRANTS.  The  Company  will
authorize the issue and sale of (a) $15,000,000  aggregate  principal  amount of
its 11.25% Senior  Subordinated Notes due June 30, 2004 (the "Notes",  such term
to include any such notes issued in  substitution  therefor  pursuant to section
15), to be substantially in the form of the Note set out in Exhibit A, with such
changes  therefrom,  if any, as may be approved by you and the Company,  and (b)
warrants  (the  "Warrants",   such  term  to  include  any  warrants  issued  in
substitution  therefor  pursuant to section 15) to purchase 25,000 shares of the
Common Stock, par value $.001 per share (the "Common Stock"),  of the Company at
an initial  exercise price per share equal to the average daily Market Price (as
defined in the form of Warrant set out in Exhibit A) of the Common  Stock during
the period of the most  recent  five  consecutive  Business  Days  ending on the
second day preceding the Closing  Date, to be  substantially  in the form of the
Warrant  set out in Exhibit B, with such  changes  therefrom,  if any, as may be
approved  by you  and  the  Company.  Certain  capitalized  terms  used  in this
Agreement are defined in section 14;  references to a "Schedule" or an "Exhibit"
are, unless  otherwise  specified,  to a Schedule or an Exhibit attached to this
Agreement.

                  2. SALE AND PURCHASE OF NOTES AND  WARRANTS.  In reliance upon
the  representations  and warranties  made by you in section 6, the Company will
issue and sell to you and, in reliance upon the  representations  and warranties
made by the  Company in section 5, and  subject to the terms and  conditions  of
this Agreement,  you will purchase from the Company, at the Closing provided for
in section 3, (a) Notes

                                       1

                                      156
<PAGE>
in the  principal  amount  specified  opposite  your name in  Schedule A and (b)
Warrants for the number of shares of Common Stock  specified  opposite your name
in Schedule A; at the  purchase  price of 100% of the  principal  amount of such
Notes.

                  3. CLOSING; FEES. 3.1. CLOSING. The sales of the Notes and the
Warrants  to be  purchased  by you shall take  place at the  offices of Bruce A.
Rich,  Esq., at 10:00 a.m., New York City time, at a closing (the  "Closing") on
June 30, 1994 or on such other  Business Day  thereafter on or prior to July 28,




                                      157
<PAGE>
1994 as may be agreed  upon by the  Company  and you. At the Closing the Company
will deliver to you (a) the Notes to be purchased by you in the form of a single
Note (or such greater number of Notes in  denominations  of at least $100,000 as
shall be set forth in  Schedule A or as you may  request)  dated the date of the
Closing and  registered in your name (or in the name of your  nominee),  and (b)
the Warrants to be purchased by you in the form of a single warrant  certificate
(or such  greater  number  of  warrant  certificates  as  shall be set  forth in
Schedule A or as you may request)  dated the date of the Closing and  registered
in your name (or in the name of your  nominee);  against  delivery by you to the
Company  or its  order  of  immediately  available  funds in the  amount  of the
purchase price therefor. If at the Closing the Company shall fail to tender such
Notes or such Warrants to you as provided above in this section 3, or any of the
conditions  specified  in  section  4 shall  not  have  been  fulfilled  to your
satisfaction,   you  shall,  at  your  election,  be  relieved  of  all  further
obligations  under this Agreement,  without thereby waiving any other rights you
may have by reason of such failure or such nonfulfillment.

                  3.2. LEGAL FEES. On the date of the Closing,  the Company will
pay the reasonable fees and  disbursements  of your special counsel  incurred in
connection with the transactions contemplated by this Agreement and set forth in
a statement delivered to the Company on or prior to the date of the Closing, and
thereafter  the  Company  will pay,  promptly  upon  receipt  of a  supplemental
statement therefor, additional reasonable fees and disbursements of your special
counsel, if any, incurred in connection with such transactions.

                  4. CONDITIONS TO CLOSING.  Your obligation to purchase and pay
for the Notes and  Warrants  to be sold to you at the  Closing is subject to the
fulfillment to your satisfaction,  prior to or at the Closing,  of the following
conditions:
                                        2

                                      158
<PAGE>
                  4.1.  REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES.  The representations and
warranties of the Company  contained in this Agreement and those  otherwise made
in writing by or on behalf of the Company in  connection  with the  transactions
contemplated by this Agreement shall be correct when made and at the time of the
Closing, except as affected by the consummation of such transactions.

                  4.2. PERFORMANCE; NO DEFAULT. The Company shall have performed
and complied with all  agreements  and  conditions  contained in this  Agreement
required to be performed  or complied  with by it prior to or at the Closing and
at the time of the  Closing no Event of Default  or  Potential  Event of Default
shall have occurred and be continuing.

                  4.3. COMPLIANCE CERTIFICATE.  The Company shall have delivered
to you an Officers' Certificate,  dated the date of the Closing, certifying that
the  conditions  specified  in  sections  4.1 and 4.2 have  been  fulfilled  and
demonstrating  that, after giving effect to the issuance of all of the Notes and
Warrants,  the Company will be in compliance  in all material  respects with the
most stringent limitations on the incurrence or maintenance of Debt contained in
any  instrument  or  agreement  applicable  to or  binding  on  the  Company  or
certifying that a complete and correct copy of a waiver or waivers of compliance
with such limitations is attached to such Officers' Certificate.

                  4.4.  OPINIONS OF COUNSEL.  You shall have  received  (a) from
Abrahams, Kaslow & Cassman, counsel for the Company, and (b) from Bruce A. Rich,
Esq., your special counsel in connection with the  transactions  contemplated by
this  Agreement,  favorable  opinions  substantially  in the  forms set forth in
Exhibits C-1 and C-2, respectively,  and covering such other matters incident to
such  transactions as you may reasonably  request,  each addressed to you, dated
the date of the Closing and otherwise satisfactory in substance and form to you.

                  4.5. BANK LOAN  AGREEMENT.  The Bank Loan Agreement shall have
been  amended,  and as amended  shall have been  executed  and  delivered by the
Company and the Banks,  and shall be  satisfactory in form and substance to you.
You  shall  have  received  a copy of the Bank  Loan  Agreement  as so  amended,
certified as a true and complete copy thereof by an officer of the Company.


                                        3

                                      159
<PAGE>
                  4.6. PURCHASE PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, ETC. On the date of
the Closing  your  purchase of Notes and  Warrants (a) shall be permitted by the
laws and regulations of each jurisdiction to which you are subject and (b) shall
not  subject  you to any tax,  penalty or, in your  reasonable  judgment,  other
onerous  condition by reason of any change  after the date of this  Agreement in
any applicable law or  governmental  regulation.  If requested by you, you shall
have  received,  at least five Business Days prior to the Closing,  an Officers'
Certificate  certifying as to such matters of fact as you may reasonably specify
to enable you to determine whether such purchase is so permitted.

                  4.7.  PROCEEDINGS  AND  DOCUMENTS.  All  corporate  and  other
proceedings in connection with the  transactions  contemplated by this Agreement
and all  documents  and  instruments  incident  to such  transactions  shall  be
satisfactory to you and your special  counsel,  and you and your special counsel
shall have received all such counterpart  originals or certified or other copies
of such documents as you or they may reasonably request.

                  4.8.  FEES.  The fees required to be paid by section 3.2 shall
have been paid as therein provided.

                  5. REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES, ETC. The Company represents
and warrants that:

                  5.1. ORGANIZATION, STANDING, ETC. The Company is a corporation
duly  organized,  validly  existing and in good  standing  under the laws of the
State of Delaware and has all requisite corporate power and authority to own and
operate  its  properties,  to  carry on its  business  as now  conducted  and as
proposed to be conducted,  to enter into this  Agreement,  to issue and sell the
Notes and the Warrants and to carry out the terms of this  Agreement,  the Notes
and the Warrants.

                  5.2.  SUBSIDIARIES.  As of the  date  of this  Agreement,  the
Company has no Subsidiaries.

                  5.3. QUALIFICATION.  The Company is duly qualified and in good
standing as a foreign corporation authorized to do business in each jurisdiction
(other than the  jurisdiction of its  incorporation)  in which the nature of its
activities  or the  character  of the  properties  it owns or leases  makes such
qualification  necessary  and in which the  failure so to  qualify  would have a
materially adverse effect on the Company.

                                        4

                                      160
<PAGE>
                  5.4. BUSINESS; FINANCIAL STATEMENTS. The Company has delivered
to you complete and correct copies of (a) its annual reports to stockholders for
the fiscal years ended  December  31, 1991 through 1993 (the "Annual  Reports"),
(b) its  annual  reports  on Form 10-K for such  fiscal  years as filed with the
Securities and Exchange Commission (the "Forms 10-K") and (c) a memorandum dated
May, 1994 prepared by Furman Selz  Incorporated  for use in connection  with the
Company's  private placement of the Notes and Warrants (the  "Memorandum").  The
Annual Reports,  the Forms 10-K and the Memorandum  correctly  describe,  in all
material respects, as of their respective dates, the business then conducted and
proposed to be  conducted  by the Company,  PROVIDED,  however,  with respect to
projections  contained in the Memorandum,  that such  projections are based upon
the good faith  estimates and  assumptions  of management of the Company and are
subject to the uncertainty and approximation inherent in any projections.  There
are included in the Forms 10-K  financial  statements of the Company for each of
the fiscal years ended December 31, 1991 through 1993,  accompanied in each case
by the opinion thereon of Deloitte and Touche (or one of its predecessor firms),
independent public  accountants.  The Company has also delivered to you complete
and  correct  copies  of its  quarterly  reports  to  stockholders  sent or made
available to stockholders, and its quarterly reports on Form 10-Q filed with the
Securities and Exchange  Commission,  in each case for fiscal periods subsequent
to  December  31,  1993,  and  current  reports on Form 8-K,  proxy  statements,
registration statements and prospectuses,  if any, filed by the Company with the
Securities and Exchange  Commission  since such date.  All financial  statements
included  in the  foregoing  materials  delivered  to you  (except as  otherwise
specified  therein)  have been prepared in accordance  with  generally  accepted
accounting  principles  applied on a  consistent  basis  throughout  the periods
specified  and present  fairly the  financial  position of the Company as of the
respective  dates specified and the results of its operations and its cash flows
for the respective periods specified.

                  5.5. Changes, etc. Since December 31, 1993, (a) there has been
no change in the assets,  liabilities  or  financial  condition  of the Company,
other  than  changes in the  ordinary  course of  business  which have not been,
either in any case or in the aggregate,  materially adverse to the Company,  (b)
neither the business,  operations or affairs nor any of the properties or assets
of the Company have been affected by any occurrence or  development  (whether or
not insured against) which has been, either in any case or in

                                        5

                                      161
<PAGE>
the aggregate,  materially adverse to the Company and (c) the Company has not as
of the date of this Agreement directly or indirectly  declared,  ordered,  paid,
made or set apart any sum or property for any Restricted Payment or agreed to do
so.

                  5.6. TAX RETURNS AND  PAYMENTS.  The Company has filed all tax
returns  required  by law to be filed by it and has paid all taxes,  assessments
and  other  governmental  charges  levied  upon  the  Company  and  any  of  its
properties,  assets, income or franchises which are due and payable,  other than
those  presently  payable  without penalty or interest and those presently being
contested in good faith by  appropriate  proceedings  diligently  conducted  for
which such reserves or other appropriate provision, if any, as shall be required
by generally accepted accounting principles shall have been made, and other than
those,  the  failure  to file or pay  which  would  not,  in any  case or in the
aggregate, have a material adverse effect on the Company. The Federal income tax
liabilities of the Company have been finally  determined by the Internal Revenue
Service and satisfied, or the time for audit has expired, for all fiscal periods
through  December 31, 1990.  The charges,  accruals and reserves on the books of
the Company in respect of Federal, state and foreign income taxes for all fiscal
periods are adequate in the opinion of the Company,  and the Company knows of no
unpaid assessment for additional Federal,  state or foreign income taxes for any
period or any basis for any such assessment.

                  5.7.  DEBT.  Exhibit D  correctly  describes  all  secured and
unsecured  Debt  of the  Company  outstanding,  or for  which  the  Company  has
commitments,  on the  date of this  Agreement,  and  identifies  the  collateral
securing  any secured  Debt.  The Company is not in default  with respect to any
Debt or any  instrument  or agreement  relating  thereto,  and no  instrument or
agreement  applicable  to or binding on the  Company  (other  than the Bank Loan
Agreement)  contains  any  restrictions  on the  incurrence  by the  Company  of
additional Debt.

                  5.8.  TITLE TO  PROPERTIES;  LIENS.  The  Company has good and
sufficient  title to its  properties  and assets,  including the  properties and
assets reflected in the financial statements as of December 31, 1993 referred to
in section 5.4 (except  properties and assets disposed of since such date in the
ordinary  course of business and properties and assets held under Capital Leases
referred to in Exhibit D), and none of such  properties  or assets is subject to
any

                                        6


                                      162
<PAGE>
Liens except such as are of the character permitted by section 10.2. The Company
enjoys peaceful and  undisturbed  possession  under all leases  necessary in any
material  respect for the operation of its properties  and assets,  and all such
leases  are valid and  subsisting  and are in full force and  effect.  Except to
perfect and protect  security  interests of the  character  permitted by section
10.2,  and except for  precautionary  financing  statements  filed in respect of
operating leases, no presently  effective  financing statement under the Uniform
Commercial Code which names the Company as debtor is on file in any jurisdiction
and the Company has not signed any presently  effective  financing  statement or
any  presently  effective  security  agreement  authorizing  any  secured  party
thereunder to file any such financing statement.

                  5.9.  LITIGATION,  ETC.  There  is no  action,  proceeding  or
investigation pending or threatened (or any basis therefor known to the Company)
which questions the validity of this Agreement, the Notes or the Warrants or any
action  taken  or to be  taken  pursuant  to this  Agreement,  the  Notes or the
Warrants, or which might result, either in any case or in the aggregate,  in any
adverse change in the business,  operations,  affairs,  condition  (financial or
otherwise),  properties or assets of the Company or in any liability on the part
of the Company, which would be material to the Company.

                  5.10.  COMPLIANCE WITH OTHER INSTRUMENTS,  ETC. The Company is
not in violation of any term of its certificate of incorporation or by-laws, and
is not in violation of any term of any  agreement or instrument to which it is a
party or by which it is bound or any term of any applicable law, ordinance, rule
or regulation of any governmental authority or any term of any applicable order,
judgment  or decree of any court,  arbitrator  or  governmental  authority,  the
consequences of which  violation  might have a materially  adverse effect on the
business, operations, affairs, condition (financial or otherwise), properties or
assets  of  the  Company;  the  execution,  delivery  and  performance  of  this
Agreement,  the Notes and the Warrants will not result in any violation of or be
in conflict  with or  constitute a default  under any such term or result in the
creation  of (or impose any  obligation  on the Company to create) any Lien upon
any of the  properties or assets of the Company  pursuant to any such term;  and
there is no such term which  materially  adversely  affects or in the future may
(so  far as the  Company  can  now  foresee)  materially  adversely  affect  the
business, operations, affairs, condition (financial or otherwise), properties or
assets of the Company.

                                        7

                                      163
<PAGE>
                  5.11.   GOVERNMENTAL   CONSENT.   No   consent,   approval  or
authorization  of, or declaration or filing with, any governmental  authority on
the part of the Company is required for the valid execution and delivery of this
Agreement  or the valid  offer,  issue,  sale and  delivery  of the Notes or the
Warrants pursuant to this Agreement.

                  5.12. PATENTS,  TRADEMARKS,  AUTHORIZATIONS,  ETC. The Company
owns  or  possesses  all  patents,  trademarks,   service  marks,  trade  names,
copyrights,  licenses  and  authorizations,  and all rights with  respect to the
foregoing, necessary for the conduct of its businesses as now conducted, without
any known material conflict with the rights of others.

                  5.13.  OFFER OF NOTES.  Neither  the  Company  nor Furman Selz
Incorporated (the only Person authorized or employed by the Company as financial
adviser or  otherwise  as agent in  connection  with the offering or sale of the
Notes or Warrants or any similar  securities  of the  Company)  has  directly or
indirectly  offered the Notes or the Warrants or any part thereof or any similar
securities  for sale to, or solicited  any offer to buy any of the same from, or
otherwise  approached or negotiated in respect  thereof with,  anyone other than
you and not more than 42 other institutional investors.  Neither the Company nor
anyone  acting  on its  behalf  has taken or will take any  action  which  would
subject the issuance  and sale of the Notes or the Warrants to the  registration
and prospectus delivery provisions of the Securities Act.

                  5.14. USE OF PROCEEDS.  The Company will apply the proceeds of
the sale of the Notes and  Warrants,  simultaneously  with the  Closing,  to the
repayment of  approximately  $14,000,000  principal  amount of Debt  outstanding
under the Bank Loan  Agreement  and the balance of such proceeds will be used to
augment working capital.

                  5.15.  FEDERAL  RESERVE  REGULATIONS.  The  Company  will not,
directly  or  indirectly,  use any of the  proceeds of the sale of the Notes and
Warrants for the purpose, whether immediate, incidental or ultimate, of buying a
"margin  stock"  or  of  maintaining,  reducing  or  retiring  any  indebtedness
originally  incurred to purchase a stock that is currently a "margin stock",  or
for any other  purpose  which  might  constitute  this  transaction  a  "purpose
credit", in each case within the meaning of Regulation G of the Board of

                                        8

                                      164
<PAGE>
Governors  of the  Federal  Reserve  System  (12  C.F.R.  207,  as  amended)  or
Regulation  U of such Board (12 C.F.R.  221, as amended),  or otherwise  take or
permit to be taken any action which would involve a violation of such Regulation
G or Regulation U or of Regulation T (12 C.F.R. 220, as amended) or Regulation X
(12 C.F.R. 224, as amended) or any other regulation of such Board. No Debt being
reduced or retired out of the proceeds of the sale of the Notes and Warrants was
incurred for the purpose of purchasing or carrying any such "margin stock",  and
the Company  neither own nor has any present  intention  of  acquiring  any such
"margin stock".

                  5.16.  ENVIRONMENTAL MATTERS. The Company (a) has obtained all
permits,  licenses  and other  authorizations  which are required to be obtained
under Environmental Laws, (b) is in full compliance with all Environmental Laws,
except where the failure to comply would not have a material  adverse  effect on
the  business,  operations,   condition  (financial  or  otherwise),  assets  or
properties  of the Company,  (c) has not received any notice of any violation of
an  Environmental  Law and no actions,  suits or proceedings have been commenced
or, to the  knowledge  of the Company,  threatened  by any party with respect to
Environmental  Laws, and (d) the Company is not aware of any prior use of any of
its owned or leased properties, by any tenant, subtenant,  prior tenant or prior
subtenant of any of such properties,  that  constitutes a material  violation of
any provision of any Environmental Laws.

                  5.17.  STATUS UNDER CERTAIN FEDERAL  STATUTES.  The Company is
not (a) an "investment  company",  or a company - "controlled" by an "investment
company",  within the meaning of the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended;
(b) a "holding company" or a "subsidiary company" of a "holding company",  or an
"affiliate"  of a "holding  company" or of a "subsidiary  company" of a "holding
company", as such terms are defined in the Public Utility Holding Company Act of
1935, as amended;  (c) a "public utility" as such term is defined in the Federal
Power Act,  as  amended;  or (d) a "rail  carrier or a person  controlled  by or
affiliated  with a rail carrier",  within the meaning of Title 49, U.S.C.,  or a
"carrier" to which 49 U.S.C.ss. 11301(b)(1) is applicable.

                  5.18.  Foreign Assets Control  Regulations,  etc.  Neither the
issue and sale of the  Notes  and  Warrants  by the  Company  nor its use of the
proceeds  thereof as  contemplated  by this  Agreement  will violate the Foreign
Assets Control  Regulations,  the  Transaction  Control  Regulations,  the Cuban

                                        9

                                      165
<PAGE>
Assets Control Regulations,  the Foreign Funds Control Regulations,  the Iranian
Assets Control  Regulations,  the Iranian  Transactions  Regulations,  the Iraqi
Sanctions  Regulations,   the  Haitian  Transactions  Regulations,   the  Libyan
Sanctions Regulations,  or the Soviet Gold Coin Regulations of the United States
Treasury  Department  (31  C.F.R.,  Subtitle  B,  Chapter V as  amended)  or the
restrictions set forth in Executive Orders No. 8389, 9193, 12543 (Libya),  12544
(Libya),  12801  (Libya),  12722 (Iraq),  12724  (Iraq),  12775 (Haiti) or 12779
(Haiti),  as amended, of the President of the United States of America or of any
rules or regulations issued thereunder.

                  5.19.  COMPLIANCE WITH ERISA. (a) The Company has not breached
the  fiduciary  rules of ERISA  or  engaged  in any  prohibited  transaction  in
connection with which the Company could be subjected to (in the case of any such
breach) a suit for damages or (in the case of any such  prohibited  transaction)
either a civil penalty  assessed  under section 502(i) of ERISA or a tax imposed
by section 4975 of the Code,  which suit,  penalty or tax, in any case, would be
materially adverse to the Company.

                  (b) No Plan  (other  than a  Multiemployer  Plan) or any trust
created under any such Plan has been terminated since September 2, 1974. Neither
the Company nor any Related Person has within the past six years  contributed to
a single  employer plan which has at least two  contributing  sponsors not under
common control or ceased operations at a facility in a manner which could result
in liability  under section  4062(f) of ERISA. No liability to the PBGC has been
or is expected by the  Company to be  incurred  with  respect to any Plan (other
than a  Multiemployer  Plan) by the  Company  which  is or  would be  materially
adverse to the Company.  There has been no reportable  event (within the meaning
of section 4043(b) of ERISA) or any other event or condition with respect to any
Plan (other than a  Multiemployer  Plan) which presents a risk of termination of
any such Plan by the PBGC under  circumstances which in any case could result in
liability which would be materially adverse to the Company.

(c) Full  payment has been made of all amounts  which the Company or any Related
Person is required under the terms of each Plan to have paid as contributions to
such Plan as of the last day of the most  recent  fiscal year of such Plan ended
prior to the date hereof,  and no accumulated  funding deficiency (as defined in
section 302 of ERISA and section 412 of the Code), whether or not waived, exists

                                       10

                                      166
<PAGE>
with respect to any Plan (other than a Multiemployer Plan).

                  (d) The present value of all vested accrued benefits under all
Plans  (other  than  Multiemployer  Plans),  determined  as of  the  end  of the
Company's most recently  ended fiscal year on the basis of reasonable  actuarial
assumptions,  did not  exceed  the  current  value of the  assets of such  Plans
allocable to such vested accrued benefits.  The terms "present value",  "current
value", and "accrued benefit" have the meanings specified in section 3 of ERISA.

                  (e) The  Company  is not  and  has  never  been  obligated  to
contribute  to any  "multiemployer  plan" (as such term is  defined  in  section
4001(a)(3) of ERISA).

                  (f) The execution and delivery of this Agreement and the issue
and sale of the  Notes  hereunder  will not  involve  any  transaction  which is
subject to the  prohibitions of section 406 of ERISA or in connection with which
a tax could be imposed pursuant to section 4975 of the Code. The  representation
by the Company in the preceding sentence is made in reliance upon and subject to
the accuracy of your  representation  in section 6.2 of this Agreement as to the
source of the funds used to pay the  purchase  price of the Notes  purchased  by
you.  The Company has  delivered  to you, if  requested  by you, a complete  and
correct list of all employee  benefit plans with respect to which the Company is
a party in  interest  and with  respect  to which its  securities  are  employer
securities.  As used in this section 5.19(f), the terms "employee benefit plans"
and "party in interest" have the respective  meanings  specified in section 3 of
ERISA and the term "employer  securities"  has the meaning  specified in section
407(d)(1) of ERISA.

                  5.20. DISCLOSURE.  Neither this Agreement, the Memorandum, the
Annual Reports, the Forms 10-K nor any other document, certificate or instrument
delivered  to  you by or on  behalf  of  the  Company  in  connection  with  the
transactions  contemplated  by this Agreement  contains (in each case, as of its
date) any untrue  statement of a material fact or omits to state a material fact
necessary in order to make the  statements  contained in this  Agreement  and in
such other  documents,  certificates or instruments not misleading.  There is no
fact (other than matters of a general  economic or political nature which do not
affect the Company  uniquely)  known to the Company which  materially  adversely
affects or in the future may (so far as the Company can now foresee)  materially
adversely affect the business,

                                       11

                                      167
<PAGE>
operations, affairs, condition (financial or otherwise), properties or assets of
the  Company  which  has not been set  forth in this  Agreement  or in the other
documents,  certificates and instruments delivered to you by or on behalf of the
Company specifically for use in connection with the transactions contemplated by
this Agreement.

                  6. PURCHASE INTENT; SOURCE OF FUNDS. 6.1. PURCHASE INTENT. You
represent that you are purchasing the Notes and Warrants  hereunder for your own
account,  not  with a view  to the  distribution  thereof  or with  any  present
intention  of  distributing  or selling any of such Notes or Warrants  except in
compliance  with the Securities Act and any applicable  state  securities  laws,
PROVIDED that the disposition of your property shall at all times be within your
control.  You represent that you are an "accredited  investor",  as such term is
defined in Rule 501 under the Securities Act. You acknowledge that the Notes and
Warrants have not been  registered  under the  Securities Act and you understand
that the Notes and Warrants may not be  transferred  unless they are  registered
under the Securities Act or an exemption from registration is available.

                  6.2.  SOURCE OF FUNDS.  You represent that all or a portion of
the funds to be used by you to pay the purchase  price of the Notes and Warrants
consists of funds which do not  constitute  assets of any employee  benefit plan
(other  than a  governmental  plan  exempt  from the  coverage of ERISA) and the
remaining  portion,  if any, of such funds consists of funds which may be deemed
to constitute  assets of one or more specific  employee benefit plans,  complete
and accurate  information as to the identity of each of which you have delivered
to the Company.  As used in this section 6.2, the terms "employee  benefit plan"
and "government plan" shall have the respective  meanings assigned to such terms
in section 3 of ERISA.

                  7.  FURNISHING  OF  INFORMATION.  7.1.  ACCOUNTING;  FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS AND OTHER INFORMATION. The Company will maintain, and will cause each
of its Subsidiaries, if any, to maintain, a system of accounting established and
administered in accordance with generally accepted  accounting  principles,  and
will  accrue,  and will  cause  each of its  Subsidiaries  to  accrue,  all such
liabilities as shall be required by generally  accepted  accounting  principles.
The Company will deliver (in duplicate) to you, so long as you shall be entitled
to  purchase  Notes under this  Agreement  or you or your  nominee  shall be the
holder of any Notes, and to each other institutional holder of any Notes:

                                       12

                                      168
<PAGE>
                  (a) not later than the earlier to occur of (i) the forty-fifth
         day after the end of each of the first three  quarterly  fiscal periods
         in each  fiscal  year of the  Company  and (ii) the date of the  filing
         thereof  with the  Securities  and  Exchange  Commission,  consolidated
         balance  sheets of the  Company and its  Subsidiaries  as at the end of
         such  period  and  the  related  consolidated   statements  of  income,
         stockholders' equity and cash flows of the Company and its Subsidiaries
         for such  period  and (in the case of the  second  and third  quarterly
         periods) for the period from the  beginning of the current  fiscal year
         to the end of such  quarterly  period,  setting  forth in each  case in
         comparative form the consolidated figures for the corresponding periods
         of the previous fiscal year, all in reasonable  detail and certified by
         a principal  financial officer of the Company as presenting  fairly, in
         accordance with generally  accepted  accounting  principles (except for
         the absence of notes thereto) applied (except as specifically set forth
         therein) on a basis  consistent  with such prior  fiscal  periods,  the
         information contained therein, subject to changes resulting from normal
         year-end  audit  adjustments;  PROVIDED  that so long as the Company is
         subject to the reporting  provisions  of the Exchange Act,  delivery of
         copies of the Company's  quarterly  report on Form 10-Q for such period
         will satisfy the requirements of this paragraph (a);

                  (b) not later than the  earlier to occur of (i) the  ninetieth
         day after the end of each  fiscal year of the Company and (ii) the date
         of the filing  thereof with the  Securities  and  Exchange  Commission,
         consolidated  balance sheets of the Company and its  Subsidiaries as at
         the end of such year and the related consolidated statements of income,
         stockholders' equity and cash flows of the Company and its Subsidiaries
         for such fiscal year,  setting forth in each case in  comparative  form
         the  consolidated   figures  for  the  previous  fiscal  year,  all  in
         reasonable  detail and  accompanied by a report thereon of Deloitte and
         Touche or other independent public  accountants of recognized  national
         standing  selected by the Company (and reasonably  satisfactory to you,
         so long as you shall be entitled to purchase Notes under this Agreement
         or you or your nominee shall be the holder of any of the Notes,  and to
         the holder or holders of more than 50% in principal amount of the Notes
         then outstanding) (subject to section 15.4), which report shall state

                                       13

                                      169
<PAGE>
         that  such  consolidated   financial   statements  present  fairly  the
         financial  position of the Company and its Subsidiaries as at the dates
         indicated and the results of their  operations and their cash flows for
         the periods indicated in conformity with generally accepted  accounting
         principles  applied on a basis  consistent  with prior years (except as
         otherwise  specified  in  such  report)  and  that  the  audit  by such
         accountants in connection with such consolidated  financial  statements
         has been made in accordance with generally accepted auditing standards;
         provided  that so long  as the  Company  is  subject  to the  reporting
         provisions  of the Exchange  Act,  delivery of copies of the  Company's
         annual   report  on  Form  10-K  for  such  period  will   satisfy  the
         requirements of this paragraph (b);

                  (c) not later than the tenth day  following  each  delivery of
         financial  statements  pursuant  to  subdivisions  (a)  and (b) of this
         section 7 (or, if earlier,  not later than the date a similar Officers'
         Certificate  or  compliance  certificate  is  delivered  to  the  Banks
         pursuant to section 4.1 of the Bank Loan  Agreement as in effect on the
         date hereof or similar  provision  as from time to time in effect),  an
         Officers'  Certificate  (i) stating that the signers have  reviewed the
         terms of this Agreement and of the Notes and have made, or caused to be
         made under  their  supervision,  a review in  reasonable  detail of the
         transactions and condition of the Company and its  Subsidiaries  during
         the accounting period covered by such financial state-

         ments and that such review has not disclosed the existence during or at
         the end of such  accounting  period,  and that the  signers do not have
         knowledge of the existence as at the date of the Officers' Certif-

         icate, of any condition or event which  constitutes an Event of Default
         or  Potential  Event of  Default,  or, if any such  condition  or event
         existed or  exists,  specifying  the  nature  and  period of  existence
         thereof  and what action the Company has taken or is taking or proposes
         to take with respect  thereto,  (ii) specifying the amount available at
         the end of such accounting period for Restricted Payments in compliance
         with section  10.4 and showing in  reasonable  detail all  calculations
         required  in  arriving  at such  amount,  and  (iii)  demonstrating  in
         reasonable  detail  compliance during and at the end of such accounting
         period with the restrictions contained in sections 10.1, 10.3, 10.5 and
         10.7;
                                       14

                                      170
<PAGE>
                  (d)  together  with  each  delivery  of  financial  statements
         pursuant to subdivision  (b) of this section 7, a written  statement by
         the  independent  public  accountants  giving  the report  thereon  (i)
         stating that their audit examination has included a review of the terms
         of this Agreement and of the Notes as they relate to accounting matters
         and that such review is sufficient to enable them to make the statement
         referred  to  in  clause  (iii)  of  this  subdivision  (d)  (it  being
         understood that no special audit procedures,  other than those required
         by generally  accepted  auditing  standards,  shall be required),  (ii)
         stating  whether,  in the  course  of  their  audit  examination,  they
         obtained  knowledge  (and  whether,  as of the  date  of  such  written
         statement,  they have  knowledge)  of the existence of any condition or
         event  which  constitutes  an Event of  Default or  Potential  Event of
         Default,  and,  if so,  specifying  the nature and period of  existence
         thereof,  and  (iii)  stating  that they have  examined  the  Officers'
         Certificate  delivered in connection  therewith pursuant to subdivision
         (c) of this section 7 and that the matters set forth in such  Officers'
         Certificate  pursuant to clauses (ii) and (iii) of such subdivision (c)
         have  been  properly  stated  in  accordance  with  the  terms  of this
         Agreement;

                  (e) promptly upon receipt thereof, copies of all final reports
         submitted  to  the  Company  by  independent   public   accountants  in
         connection  with each annual,  interim or special audit of the books of
         the  Company or any  Subsidiary  made by such  accountants,  including,
         without  limitation,   the  final  comment  letter  submitted  by  such
         accountants to management in connection with their annual audit;

                  (f) promptly  upon, but in no event later than ten days after,
         their becoming available, copies of all financial statements,  reports,
         notices and proxy  statements  sent or made available  generally by the
         Company to its public  security  holders,  of all regular and  periodic
         reports and all registration  statements and prospectuses  filed by the
         Company or any  Subsidiary  with any  securities  exchange  or with the
         Securities  and  Exchange  Commission  or  any  governmental  authority
         succeeding to any of its functions, and of all press releases and other
         statements made available generally by the Company or any Subsidiary to
         the public  concerning  material  developments  in the  business of the
         Company or its Subsidiaries;

                                       15

                                      171
<PAGE>
                  (g) immediately  upon any principal  officer of the Company or
         any  other   officer  of  the  Company   involved   in  its   financial
         administration  obtaining  knowledge  of any  condition  or event which
         constitutes an Event of Default or Potential Event of Default,  or that
         the holder of any Note has given any  notice or taken any other  action
         with  respect  to a claimed  Event of  Default  or  Potential  Event of
         Default under this Agreement or that any Person has given any notice to
         the Company or any Subsidiary or taken any other action with respect to
         a claimed  default or event or  condition  of the type  referred  to in
         section  11(f),  an Officers'  Certificate  describing the same and the
         period of existence  thereof and what action the Company has taken,  is
         taking and proposes to take with respect thereto;

                  (h) immediately  upon any principal  officer of the Company or
         any  other   officer  of  the  Company   involved   in  its   financial
         administration  obtaining  knowledge  of  the  occurrence  of  any  (i)
         "reportable  event",  as such term is defined in section 4043 of ERISA,
         or (ii)  "prohibited  transaction",  as such term is defined in section
         4975 of the Code,  in  connection  with any Plan or any  trust  created
         thereunder, a written notice specifying the nature thereof, what action
         the Company  has taken,  is taking and  proposes  to take with  respect
         thereto,  and,  when  known,  any  action  taken or  threatened  by the
         Internal  Revenue  Service or the PBGC with respect  thereto,  provided
         that,  with respect to the occurrence of any  "reportable  event" as to
         which  the PBGC has  waived  the  30-day  reporting  requirement,  such
         written  notice  need be given only at the time  notice is given to the
         PBGC; and

                  (i) with reasonable  promptness,  such other financial reports
         and  information  and data with  respect  to the  Company or any of its
         Subsidiaries as from time to time may be reasonably requested.

                  7.2. RULE 144A.  The Company agrees that, if at any time it is
not subject  either to Section 13 or to Section  15(d) of the  Exchange  Act, it
will furnish to any holder of Notes or Warrants or to a prospective purchaser of
any Note or Warrant designated by such a holder, upon the request of such holder
or such prospective  purchaser,  on or prior to the date such Note or Warrant is
to  be  sold  to  such  prospective  purchaser,  subject  to  a  confidentiality
undertaking by such  prospective  purchaser,  the following  information  (which
shall be reasonably current in relation

                                       16

                                      172
<PAGE>
to the date of such sale under this  paragraph):  a very brief  statement of the
nature of the  business of the Company and the  products and services it offers;
and the Company's most recent audited consolidated balance sheets and profit and
loss and retained earnings statement,  and similar financial  statements for the
two preceding fiscal years.

                  8. INSPECTION;  CONFIDENTIALITY.  8.1. Inspection. The Company
will permit any  authorized  representatives  designated  by you, so long as you
shall be entitled to purchase  Notes under this Agreement or you or your nominee
shall be the holder of any Notes,  or by any other  institutional  holder of any
Notes,  without  expense  to  the  Company,  to  visit  and  inspect  any of the
properties  of the Company or any of its  Subsidiaries,  including its and their
books of account, and to make copies and take extracts therefrom, and to discuss
its and their  affairs,  finances and accounts  with its and their  officers and
independent public accountants, all at such reasonable times and as often as may
be reasonably requested.

                  8.2.  CONFIDENTIALITY.  You agree  that you will not  disclose
without the prior consent of the Company (other than to your employees, auditors
or counsel or to another  holder of the Notes) any  information  with respect to
the Company or any Subsidiary  which is furnished  pursuant to section 7 or this
section  8 and  which  is  designated  by  the  Company  to you  in  writing  as
confidential,  provided  that you may disclose any such  information  (a) as has
become generally  available to the public, (b) as may be required or appropriate
in any report,  statement or  testimony  submitted  to any  municipal,  state or
Federal  regulatory body having or claiming to have  jurisdiction over you or to
the National Association of Insurance  Commissioners or similar organizations or
their  successors,  (c) as may be  required  or  appropriate  in response to any
summons or subpoena or in connection with any litigation, (d) to the extent that
you believe it appropriate  in order to protect your  investment in the Notes or
in order to comply with any law, order,  regulation or ruling  applicable to you
or (e)  to the  prospective  transferee  in  connection  with  any  contemplated
transfer of any of the Notes by you.

                  9. Prepayment of Notes. 9.1. Required Prepayments. On June 30,
2000 and on each June 30 thereafter to and including  June 30, 2003, the Company
will prepay  $3,000,000  principal  amount (or such lesser  principal  amount as
shall then be outstanding) of the Notes, at the principal amount of the Notes so
prepaid, without premium, provided
                                       17

                                      173
<PAGE>
that,  upon any partial  prepayment of the Notes pursuant to section 9.2, 9.3 or
9.4 or any  prepayment  pursuant to section 9.3 or 9.4 of the Notes held by some
but not all holders,  the principal  amount of each  required  prepayment of the
Notes  becoming  due  under  this  section  9.1 on and  after  the  date of such
prepayment  under  section 9.2, 9.3 or 9.4, as the case may be, shall be reduced
in the same proportion as the aggregate  unpaid principal amount of the Notes is
reduced as a result of such prepayment under section 9.2, 9.3 or 9.4.

                  9.2.  OPTIONAL  PREPAYMENTS WITH PREMIUM.  The Company may, at
its option,  upon notice as  provided in section  9.6,  prepay at any time after
June 30,  1997 all,  or from time to time after such date any part (an  integral
multiple of $1,000)  of, the Notes at the  principal  amount so prepaid,  plus a
premium (a percentage of such principal  amount)  applicable in accordance  with
the premium table set forth in section 9.5,  depending upon the 12-month  period
in which the date fixed for such prepayment occurs.

                  9.3.  CONTINGENT  PREPAYMENTS  UPON CHANGE OF CONTROL.  In the
event of the  occurrence  of a Change of Control,  then the  Company  shall give
prompt written notice  thereof to each holder of the Notes,  by registered  mail
(and shall  confirm  such notice by prompt  telephonic  advice to an  investment
officer of each such holder), which notice shall contain a written,  irrevocable
offer by the Company to prepay,  on a date  specified in such notice (which date
shall be not less than 30 days and not more than 60 days  after the date of such
notice),  the Notes  held by such  holder  in full  (and not in part).  Upon the
acceptance  of such offer by such holder  mailed to the Company at least 10 days
prior  to the  date  of  prepayment  specified  in  the  Company's  offer,  such
prepayment shall be made at the principal amount of the Notes so prepaid, plus a
premium (a percentage of such principal  amount)  applicable in accordance  with
the premium table set forth in section 9.5,  depending upon the 12-month  period
in which the date fixed for such prepayment  occurs. Any offer by the Company to
prepay  the  Notes  pursuant  to this  section  9.3 shall be  accompanied  by an
Officers'  Certificate  certifying  that the conditions of this section 9.3 have
been fulfilled and specifying the particulars of such fulfillment. If the holder
of any Notes shall accept such offer,  the principal  amount of such Notes shall
become due and payable on the date  specified  in such offer.  In the event that
there shall have been a partial  prepayment of the Notes under this section 9.3,
the Company shall promptly give notice to the holders of the Notes,  accompanied
by an
                                       18

                                      174
<PAGE>
Officers'  Certificate  setting forth the principal  amount of each of the Notes
that was prepaid and specifying how each such amount was determined, and if some
but not all of the Notes were prepaid,  setting forth the reduced amount of each
required  prepayment  thereafter  becoming  due with  respect to the Notes under
section 9.1 and  certifying  that such reduction has been computed in accordance
with section 9.1.

                  9.4. CONTINGENT PREPAYMENT UPON SALE OF CERTAIN ASSETS. In the
event that at any time there  shall be Excess  Sale  Proceeds,  then the Company
shall  give  prompt  written  notice  thereof to each  holder of the  Notes,  by
registered mail (and shall confirm such notice by prompt telephonic advice to an
investment  officer of each such holder),  which notice shall contain a written,
irrevocable  offer by the Company to prepay,  on a date specified in such notice
(which  date  shall be not less than 30 days and not more than 60 days after the
date of such notice),  the Notes in an aggregate  principal  amount equal to the
amount of Excess Sale Proceeds. Upon the acceptance of such offer by such holder
mailed to the Company at least 10 days prior to the date of prepayment specified
in the Company's offer, such prepayment shall be made at the principal amount of
the Notes so prepaid,  plus a premium (a  percentage of such  principal  amount)
applicable  in  accordance  with the  premium  table set forth in  section  9.5,
depending upon the 12-month  period in which the date fixed for such  prepayment
occurs.  Any offer by the Company to prepay the Notes  pursuant to this  section
9.4  shall  be  accompanied  by an  Officers'  Certificate  certifying  that the
conditions  of  this  section  9.4  have  been   fulfilled  and  specifying  the
particulars  of such  fulfillment.  If the holder of any Notes shall accept such
offer,  the  principal  amount of such Notes to be prepaid  shall become due and
payable on the date specified in such offer.  In the event that there shall have
been a partial prepayment of the Notes under this section 9.4, the Company shall
promptly  give notice to the holders of the Notes,  accompanied  by an Officers'
Certificate  setting  forth the  principal  amount of each of the Notes that was
prepaid and specifying how each such amount was determined,  and if some but not
all of the Notes were prepaid, setting forth the reduced amount of each required
prepayment  thereafter  becoming due with respect to the Notes under section 9.1
and certifying  that such reduction has been computed in accordance with section
9.1.

                  9.5.  MASTER PREMIUM TABLE.  For the purposes of sections 9.2,
9.3, 9.4 and 13, whenever a premium is required to be paid upon  prepayment,  or
acceleration as
                                       19

                                      175
<PAGE>
provided in Section 13, of any Note, the applicable  premium shall be determined
in accordance with the following  table,  depending upon the period in which the
date fixed for such prepayment or acceleration occurs:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

          12-Month Period
        Commencing June 30,                 Premium
        -------------------                 -------
<S>            <C>                           <C>
               1994                          12.00%
               1995                          10.50%
               1996                           9.00%
               1997                           7.50%
               1998                           6.00%
               1999                           4.50%
               2000                           3.00%
               2001                           1.50%
               2002                           0.00%
               2003                           0.00%

</TABLE>

                  9.6. NOTICE OF OPTIONAL  PREPAYMENTS;  OFFICERS'  CERTIFICATE.
The Company will give each holder of any Notes  written  notice of each optional
prepayment  under  section  9.2 not less  than 30 days and not more than 60 days
prior to the date fixed for such prepayment,  in each case specifying such date,
the aggregate principal amount of the Notes to be prepaid,  the principal amount
of each  Note  held by such  holder  to be  prepaid,  and the  premium,  if any,
applicable to such prepayment.  Such notice shall be accompanied by an Officers'
Certificate  certifying  that the conditions of such section have been fulfilled
and specifying the particulars of such fulfillment.

                  9.7.  ALLOCATION OF PARTIAL  PREPAYMENTs.  In the case of each
partial  prepayment  paid or to be  prepaid  (except a  prepayment  pursuant  to
section 9.3 or 9.4 of the Notes held by some but not all holders), the principal
amount of the Notes to be prepaid shall be allocated  (in integral  multiples of
$1,000) among all of the Notes at the time outstanding in proportion,  as nearly
as  practicable,   to  the  respective  unpaid  principal  amounts  thereof  not
theretofore called for prepayment,  with adjustments, to the extent practicable,
to compensate for any prior prepayments not made exactly in such proportion.

                  9.8. MATURITY; SURRENDER, ETC. In the case of each prepayment,
the principal  amount of each Note to be prepaid shall mature and become due and
payable on the date fixed for such prepayment, together with interest on such

                                       20

                                      176
<PAGE>
principal amount accrued to such date and the applicable  premium,  if any. From
and after such date,  unless the Company shall fail to pay such principal amount
when so due and payable,  together  with the  interest  and premium,  if any, as
aforesaid,  interest on such  principal  amount shall cease to accrue.  Any Note
paid or prepaid in full shall be  surrendered  to the Company and  cancelled and
shall  not be  reissued,  and no Note  shall be  issued  in lieu of any  prepaid
principal amount of any Note.

                  9.9.  ACQUISITION OF NOTES. The Company will not, and will not
permit any Subsidiary or Affiliate to, purchase, redeem or otherwise acquire any
Note except upon the payment or prepayment  thereof in accordance with the terms
of this Agreement and such Note.

                  10. BUSINESS AND FINANCIAL  COVENANTS.  The Company  covenants
that from the date of this Agreement  through the Closing and thereafter so long
as any of the Notes are outstanding:

                  10.1.  DEBT.  The  Company  will not,  and will not permit any
Subsidiary to, directly or indirectly,  create,  incur,  assume,  guarantee,  or
otherwise  become or remain  directly or indirectly  liable with respect to, any
Debt, except that:

                  (a)  the Company may become and remain liable with
         respect to the Debt evidenced by the Notes;

                  (b)  the  Company  may  remain  liable  with  respect  to Debt
         outstanding on the date of this Agreement and referred to in Exhibit D,
         but may not  extend,  renew or refund any thereof  except as  otherwise
         permitted by this section 10.1; and

                  (c) the Company may become and remain  liable with  respect to
         Debt  in  addition  to  that  otherwise   permitted  by  the  foregoing
         provisions of this section 10.1, provided that:

                           (i) on the  date  the  Company  becomes  liable  with
                  respect  to any such  additional  Debt and  immediately  after
                  giving effect thereto and to the concurrent  retirement of any
                  other  Debt,  total  Debt of the  Company  shall not exceed an
                  amount equal to sixty times Monthly Operating Cash Flow; and

                                       21

                                      177
<PAGE>
                           (ii) in the case of any such  additional Debt that is
                  subordinate  and  junior in right of payment to any other Debt
                  of the  Company,  such Debt  shall be  Permitted  Subordinated
                  Debt.

For the  purposes  of this  section  10.1,  any Person  extending,  renewing  or
refunding  any Debt  shall be deemed to have  incurred  such Debt at the time of
such  extension,  renewal or refunding.  The Company shall not permit any Person
having  outstanding Debt to become a Subsidiary of the Company after the date of
this Agreement unless the Company shall concurrently have assumed such Debt (and
caused such Person to be discharged  therefrom) in compliance  with this section
10.1.

                  10.2.  LIENS,  ETC.  The Company will not, and will not permit
any Subsidiary to,  directly or indirectly  create,  incur,  assume or permit to
exist  any Lien on or with  respect  to any  property  or asset  (including  any
document  or  instrument  in respect  of goods or  accounts  receivable)  of the
Company or any Subsidiary,  whether now owned or held or hereafter acquired,  or
any income or profits therefrom, except:

                  (a) Liens for taxes, assessments or other governmental charges
         the payment of which is not at the time required by section 10.9;

                  (b)  statutory  Liens of  landlords  and  Liens  of  carriers,
         warehousemen, mechanics and materialmen incurred in the ordinary course
         of business  for sums not yet due or the payment of which is not at the
         time required by section 10.9;

                  (c) Liens (other than any Lien imposed by ERISA or the Code in
         connection  with a Plan)  incurred  or  deposits  made in the  ordinary
         course  of  business  (i) in  connection  with  workers'  compensation,
         unemployment  insurance and other types of social security,  or (ii) to
         secure (or to obtain letters of credit that secure) the  performance of
         tenders, statutory obligations,  surety and appeal bonds, bids, leases,
         performance bonds, purchase,  construction or sales contracts and other
         similar  obligations,  in each case not incurred or made in  connection
         with the borrowing of money, the obtaining of advances or credit or the
         payment of the deferred purchase price of property;

                                       22

                                      178
<PAGE>
                  (d) any  attachment or judgment  Lien,  unless the judgment it
         secures shall not,  within 60 days after the entry  thereof,  have been
         discharged or execution  thereof  stayed pending  appeal,  or shall not
         have been  discharged  within 60 days after the  expiration of any such
         stay;

                  (e)  leases  or  subleases   granted  to  others,   easements,
         rights-of-way,  restrictions and other similar charges or encumbrances,
         in each case  incidental  to, and not  interfering  with,  the ordinary
         conduct of the business of the Company or any Subsidiary; and

                  (f) Liens incurred to secure the Debt (other than subordinated
         Debt) of the Company  outstanding in compliance with section 10.1(b) or
         (c).

For the purposes of this section 10.2,  any Person  becoming a Subsidiary  after
the date of this  Agreement  shall be  deemed to have  incurred  all of its then
outstanding Liens at the time it becomes a Subsidiary, and any Person extending,
renewing  or  refunding  any Debt  secured  by any Lien  shall be deemed to have
incurred such Lien at the time of such extension, renewal or refunding.

          10.3.  INVESTMENTS, GUARANTIES, ETC.  The Company
will not, and will not permit any Subsidiary to, directly or
indirectly (a) make or own any Investment in any Person, or
(b) create or become or be liable with respect to any
Guaranty, except:

                  (i)  the Company and its Subsidiaries may make and
         own Investments in

                           (t)   marketable   direct   obligations   issued   or
                  unconditionally  guaranteed by the United States of America or
                  issued by any agency thereof maturing within one year from the
                  date of acquisition thereof,

                           (u) marketable direct obligations issued by any state
                  of the United States of America or any  political  subdivision
                  of any  such  state  or  any  public  instrumentality  thereof
                  maturing within one year from the date of acquisition  thereof
                  and having as at any date of determination  the highest rating
                  obtainable  from  either  Standard  &  Poor's  Corporation  or
                  Moody's Investors Service, Inc.,

                                       23

                                      179
<PAGE>
                           (v)  commercial  paper maturing no more than 270 days
                  from the date of creation thereof and having as at any date of
                  determination   the  highest  rating  obtainable  from  either
                  Standard & Poor's  Corporation or Moody's  Investors  Service,
                  Inc.,

                           (w)  certificates of deposit maturing within one year
                  from the date of  acquisition  thereof  issued  by  commercial
                  banks  incorporated  under  the laws of the  United  States of
                  America or any state thereof or the District of Columbia, each
                  having as at any date of  determination  combined  capital and
                  surplus of not less than $100,000,000 ("Permitted Banks") or a
                  foreign branch thereof,

                           (x)  bankers'  acceptances  eligible  for  rediscount
                  under  requirements  of The Board of  Governors of the Federal
                  Reserve System and accepted by Permitted Banks,

                           (y)  obligations of the type described in clauses (t)
                  through  (w)  above   purchased   from  a  securities   dealer
                  designated as a "primary  dealer" by the Federal  Reserve Bank
                  of New York or a Permitted Bank as counterparty  pursuant to a
                  repurchase   agreement   obligating   such   counterparty   to
                  repurchase  such  obligations not later than 14 days after the
                  purchase thereof and which provides that the obligations which
                  are the  subject  thereof  are  held  for the  benefit  of the
                  Company  and  its  Subsidiaries  by  a  custodian  which  is a
                  Permitted  Bank  and  which  is not  the  counterparty  to the
                  repurchase agreement in question, and

                           (z)  the   securities  of  any   investment   company
                  registered under the Investment Company Act of 1940 which is a
                  "money market fund" within the meaning of  regulations  of the
                  Securities and Exchange Commission, or an interest in a pooled
                  fund   maintained  by  a  Permitted  Bank  having   comparable
                  investment restrictions;

                  (ii)  the  Company  and  its  Subsidiaries  may  make  and own
         Investments  in any  Subsidiary  or  any  Person  which  simultaneously
         therewith becomes a Subsidiary,  if such Subsidiary or such Person is a
         corporation  organized under the laws of the United States or any state
         thereof or the District of Columbia or Canada and  substantially all of
         whose assets are located and

                                       24

                                      180
<PAGE>
         substantially all of whose business is conducted within
         the United States and Canada;

                  (iii)  any Wholly-Owned Subsidiary may make and
         permit to be outstanding loans and advances to the
         Company;

                  (iv) the Company may become and remain  liable with respect to
         Guaranties of the obligations of Subsidiaries  incurred in the ordinary
         course of the business of such Subsidiaries; and

                  (v) the Company and its  Subsidiaries  may, in addition to the
         Investments and Guaranties  permitted by the foregoing  subdivisions of
         this section 10.3,  make and continue to own Investments in, and become
         and remain liable with respect to Guaranties of the obligations of, any
         Person (other than a Wholly-Owned  Subsidiary or any Person which would
         simultaneously  therewith  become  a  Wholly-Owned  Subsidiary)  if the
         Company would be permitted to make such Investment or Guaranty pursuant
         to, and within the  limitations  specified  in,  section 10.4 (any such
         Investment  or Guaranty made  pursuant to this  subdivision  (vi) being
         referred to as a "Restricted Investment").

Notwithstanding  the  foregoing,  no Guaranty shall be permitted by this section
10.3 unless either the maximum dollar amount of the obligation  being guaranteed
is readily  ascertainable  by the terms of such  obligation  or the agreement or
instrument evidencing such Guaranty specifically limits the dollar amount of the
maximum exposure of the guarantor thereunder.

                  10.4. RESTRICTED PAYMENTS AND RESTRICTED INVESTMENTS.  (a) The
Company will not directly or indirectly  declare,  order, pay, make or set apart
any sum or property  for any  Restricted  Payment,  and the Company will not and
will  not  permit  any  Subsidiary  to  make or  become  obligated  to make  any
Restricted  Investment,  unless,  immediately  after  giving  effect to any such
proposed action:

                  (i) no  condition  or event shall exist which  constitutes  an
         Event of Default or Potential Event of Default;

                  (ii) the Company could incur at least $1 of additional Debt in
         compliance with section 10.1(c); and

                                       25

                                      181
<PAGE>
                  (iii)  the sum of (x) the  aggregate  amount  of all  sums and
         property  included in all  Restricted  Payments  directly or indirectly
         declared,  ordered,  paid,  made or set apart by the Company during the
         period after the date of the Closing to and  including the date of such
         proposed  action  plus  (y)  the  aggregate  amount  of all  Restricted
         Investments  directly  or  indirectly  made  by  the  Company  and  its
         Subsidiaries,  or which they have become obligated to make, during such
         period in any Person (but disregarding any Investment or Guaranty which
         was a  Restricted  Investment  when  made  but  which  on the  date  of
         determination  could have been made pursuant to one of the subdivisions
         of section 10.3 other than  subdivision  (vi)) shall not exceed the sum
         of:

                           (x) $1,000,000; plus

                           (y) 50% (but, in the case of a deficit, 100%)
                  of Consolidated Net Income for such period; plus

                           (z) the  aggregate  amount  of the net cash  proceeds
                  received  by the  Company  during such period from the sale of
                  its Common Stock or its  nonredeemable  preferred stock during
                  such period;

provided that any dividend  which could be paid in compliance  with this section
10.4 at the date of its declaration may continue to be paid  notwithstanding any
subsequent change.

                  (b) For the purposes of this section 10.4, the amount involved
in any Restricted Payment directly or indirectly declared,  ordered,  paid, made
or set apart in property  shall be the greater of the fair market  value of such
property  (as  determined  in good  faith by the  Board)  and the net book value
thereof on the books of the Company  (determined  in accordance  with  generally
accepted accounting principles) on the date such Restricted Payment is declared,
ordered,  paid,  made or set apart.  The Company  will not declare any  dividend
(other than a dividend  payable solely in shares of its own stock) on any shares
of any class of its stock  which is payable  more than 60 days after the date of
declaration  thereof.  The Company will not permit any  Subsidiary,  directly or
indirectly,  to declare,  order,  pay or make any  Restricted  Payment or to set
apart any sum or property for any such purpose.

                                       26

                                      182
<PAGE>
                  10.5.  MINIMUM NET WORTH.  The Company will not at
any time permit Consolidated Tangible Net Worth to be less
than $9,000,000.

                  10.6. TRANSACTIONS WITH AFFILIATES.  The Company will not, and
will not  permit  any  Subsidiary  to,  directly  or  indirectly,  engage in any
transaction  material  to the  Company  or any of its  Subsidiaries  (including,
without limitation, the purchase, sale or exchange of assets or the rendering of
any service) with any Affiliate of the Company, except in the ordinary course of
and  pursuant  to  the  reasonable   requirements   of  the  Company's  or  such
Subsidiary's  business  and upon  fair  and  reasonable  terms  that are no less
favorable  to the  Company or such  Subsidiary,  as the case may be,  than those
which might be obtained,  in the good faith judgment of the Company, in an arm's
length  transaction  at the time from Persons  which are not such an  Affiliate,
provided  that the  foregoing  restrictions  shall not apply to any  transaction
between the Company and a  Wholly-Owned  Subsidiary or between one Wholly- Owned
Subsidiary and another Wholly-Owned Subsidiary.

                  10.7.  CONSOLIDATION, MERGER, SALE OF ASSETS, ETC.
The Company will not, and will not permit any Subsidiary to,
directly or indirectly,

                  (a) consolidate  with or merge into any other Person or permit
         any other Person to consolidate with or merge into it, except that:

                           (i) any Subsidiary may consolidate with or merge into
                  the  Company or a  Wholly-Owned  Subsidiary  if the Company or
                  such Wholly-Owned Subsidiary, as the case may be, shall be the
                  surviving  corporation and if, immediately after giving effect
                  to such  transaction,  no condition or event shall exist which
                  constitutes an Event of Default or Potential Event of Default;

                           (ii) any  corporation  (other than a Subsidiary)  may
                  consolidate  with or merge  into the  Company  if the  Company
                  shall be the surviving  corporation and if,  immediately after
                  giving effect to such  transaction,  (x) no condition or event
                  shall exist which constitutes an Event of Default or Potential
                  Event of Default,  (y)  substantially all of the assets of the
                  Company shall be located and substantially all of its business
                  shall be conducted within the United

                                       27

                                      183
<PAGE>
                  States and Canada, and (z) the Company could incur at least $1
                  of additional Debt in compliance with section 10.1(c); and

                           (iii) the Company may consolidate  with or merge into
                  any other  corporation  if (w) the surviving  corporation is a
                  corporation  organized  and  existing  under  the  laws of the
                  United  States of America or a state  thereof or Canada,  with
                  substantially  all of its assets located and substantially all
                  of its business conducted within the United States and Canada,
                  (x)  such  corporation  expressly  assumes,  by  an  agreement
                  satisfactory in substance and form to the holders of more than
                  50% of the Notes outstanding  (subject to section 15.4) (which
                  agreement  may require the  delivery in  connection  with such
                  assumption  of such  opinions  of counsel as such  holders may
                  reasonably require), the obligations of the Company under this
                  Agreement and under the Notes,  (y)  immediately  after giving
                  effect  to such  transaction,  such  corporation  shall not be
                  liable  with  respect to any Debt or allow its  property to be
                  subject  to any Lien  which it could not  become  liable  with
                  respect to or allow its  property  to become  subject to under
                  this  Agreement  on the  date  of  such  transaction,  and (z)
                  immediately  after giving effect to such transaction (and such
                  assumption),  such  corporation  could  incur  at  least $1 of
                  additional  Debt in  compliance  with  section  10.1(c) and no
                  condition or event shall exist which  constitutes  an Event of
                  Default or a Potential Event of Default; or

                  (b)  sell,  lease,  abandon  or  otherwise  dispose  of all or
          substantially all its assets, except that:



                                      184
<PAGE>

                           (i) any  Subsidiary  may  sell,  lease  or  otherwise
                  dispose of all or substantially  all its assets to the Company
                  or a Wholly-Owned Subsidiary;

                           (ii) the Company may sell, lease or otherwise dispose
                  of all or substantially all its assets to any corporation into
                  which  the  Company  could  be   consolidated   or  merged  in
                  compliance  with  subdivision  (a)(iii) of this section  10.7,
                  provided  that (x) each of the  conditions  set  forth in such
                  subdivision (a)(iii) shall have been

                  fulfilled,  and  (y) no such  disposition  shall  relieve  the
                  Company  from its  obligations  under  this  Agreement  or the
                  Notes; or

                  (c) sell,  lease,  abandon or otherwise  dispose of any of its
         assets  (except in the ordinary  course of business or in a transaction
         permitted by subdivision (b)(ii) of this section 10.7), except that the
         Company or its Subsidiaries

                           (A) may sell  obsolete  equipment and other assets in
                  an aggregate amount not to exceed $100,000 in any fiscal year,
                  and

                           (B) in addition to the asset sales  permitted  by the
                  foregoing   paragraph   (A)  may  sell   assets   for  a  cash
                  consideration  at least  equal to the fair value  thereof  (as
                  determined  in good  faith by the  Board)  at the time of such
                  sale, if the proceeds  thereof shall, on or prior to the 180th
                  day following such sale, be applied either

                                    (x) to the  acquisition  of like  assets  or
                           other assets useful in the  businesses of the Company
                           or such Subsidiary; or

                                    (y)  to  the   prepayment  of  Debt  of  the


                                      185
<PAGE>

                           Company,  first to  senior  Debt of the  Company  and
                           second to the  Notes in the  manner  contemplated  by
                           section  9.4;

                  it being  agreed that if the  Company  shall not prior to such
                  180th day have performed or given notice to the holders of the
                  Notes of its  election to perform  under one of the  foregoing
                  clauses  (x) or (y),  it shall be  deemed to have  elected  to
                  perform the obligation set forth in the foregoing  clause (y),
                  and the provisions of section 9.4 shall be applicable.

                  10.8. CORPORATE EXISTENCE, ETC.; BUSINESS. The Company will at
all times  preserve and keep in full force and effect its  corporate  existence,
and rights and franchises deemed material to its business,  and those of each of
its Subsidiaries, except as otherwise specifically permitted by section 10.7 and
except that the corporate  existence of any  Subsidiary may be terminated if, in
the good faith judgment of the Board,  such  termination is in the best interest
of the Company and is not disadvantageous to

                                       29

                                      186
<PAGE>
the  holders  of the  Notes.  The  Company  will not,  and will not  permit  any
Subsidiary  to,  engage in any business  other than the  business of  delivering
electronic  information  services and other activities  incidental or related to
such business.

                  10.9.  PAYMENT OF TAXES AND CLAIMS. The Company will, and will
cause each  Subsidiary  to, pay all taxes,  assessments  and other  governmental
charges  imposed upon it or any of its properties or assets or in respect of any
of its  franchises,  business,  income or profits before any penalty or interest
accrues  thereon,  and all claims  (including,  without  limitation,  claims for
labor,  services,  materials  and  supplies)  for sums which have become due and
payable and which by law have or might become a Lien upon any of its  properties
or assets, PROVIDED that no such charge or claim need be paid if being contested
in good faith by  appropriate  proceedings  promptly  initiated  and  diligently
conducted and if such reserves or other appropriate provision,  if any, as shall
be required by generally  accepted  accounting  principles  shall have been made
therefor.

                  10.10.  COMPLIANCE WITH ERISA.  The Company will
not, and will not permit any Subsidiary to,

                  (a) engage in any  transaction  in  connection  with which the
         Company or any  Subsidiary  could be subject to either a civil  penalty
         assessed  pursuant  to  section  502(i)  of ERISA or a tax  imposed  by
         section 4975 of the Code,  terminate  or withdraw  from any Plan (other
         than a Multiemployer  Plan) in a manner,  or take any other action with
         respect to any such Plan (including,  without limitation, a substantial
         cessation  of  operations  within the  meaning  of  section  4062(f) of
         ERISA),  which  could  result in any  liability  of the  Company or any
         Subsidiary  to the PBGC,  to a trust  established  pursuant  to section
         4041(c)(3)(B)(ii)  or  (iii)  or  4042(i)  of  ERISA,  or to a  trustee
         appointed under section 4042(b) or (c) of ERISA, incur any liability to
         the PBGC on account of a  termination  of a Plan under  section 4064 of
         ERISA,  fail to make full payment when due of all amounts which,  under
         the  provisions of any Plan,  the Company or any Subsidiary is required
         to pay as  contributions  thereto,  or permit to exist any  accumulated
         funding  deficiency,  whether or not waived,  with  respect to any Plan
         (other than a Multiemployer  Plan),  if, in any such case, such penalty
         or tax or such liability, or the failure to make such

                                       30

                                      187
<PAGE>
          payment,  or the  existence  of such  deficiency,  as the case may be,
          could  have a  material  adverse  effect on the  Company or any of its
          Subsidiaries;

                  (b) permit the present  value of all vested  accrued  benefits
         under  all  Plans  maintained  at  such  time  by the  Company  and any
         Subsidiary (other than  Multiemployer  Plans) guaranteed under Title IV
         of ERISA to  exceed  the  current  value of the  assets  of such  Plans
         allocable to such vested accrued benefits by more than $1,000,000;

                  (c)  permit  the  aggregate  complete  or  partial  withdrawal
         liability under Title IV of ERISA with respect to  Multiemployer  Plans
         incurred by the Company and its Subsidiaries to exceed $1,000,000; or

                  (d)  permit  the sum of (i) the  amount by which  the  current
         value of all vested accrued benefits  referred to in subdivision (b) of
         this section 10.10 exceeds the current value of the assets  referred to
         in such  subdivision (b) and (ii) the amount of the aggregate  incurred
         withdrawal  liability  referred to in  subdivision  (c) of this section
         10.10 to exceed $1,000,000.

For the purposes of subdivisions  (c) and (d) of this section 10.10,  the amount
of the  withdrawal  liability  of the Company and its  Subsidiaries  at any date
shall be the aggregate present value of the amount claimed to have been incurred
less any portion  thereof as to which the  Company  reasonably  believes,  after
appropriate  consideration of possible  adjustments  arising under sections 4219
and 4221 of ERISA, it and its Subsidiaries will have no liability, provided that
the Company  shall  obtain  prompt  written  advice from  independent  actuarial
consultants  supporting such determination.  The Company agrees (i) once in each
calendar year to request and obtain a current statement of withdrawal  liability
from each  Multiemployer  Plan and (ii) to transmit a copy of such  statement to
you,  so long as you or your  nominee  shall be the holder of any Notes,  and to
each other  institutional  holder of any Notes, within 15 days after the Company
receives the same. As used in this section 10.10, the term "accumulated  funding
deficiency" has the meaning specified in section 302 of ERISA and section 412 of
the Code, and the terms "present value",  "current value" and "accrued  benefit"
have the meanings specified in section 3 of ERISA.

                                       31

                                      188
<PAGE>
                  10.11. MAINTENANCE OF PROPERTIES;  INSURANCE. The Company will
maintain or cause to be maintained  in good repair,  working order and condition
all  properties  used  or  useful  in  the  business  of  the  Company  and  its
Subsidiaries and from time to time will make or cause to be made all appropriate
repairs,  renewals and replacements  thereof. The Company will maintain or cause
to be maintained, with financially sound and reputable insurers,  insurance with
respect to its  properties  and business and the  properties and business of its
Subsidiaries  against loss or damage of the kinds customarily insured against by
corporations of established  reputation  engaged in the same or similar business
and  similarly  situated,  of such types and in such amounts as are  customarily
carried under similar  circumstances by such other corporations.  Such insurance
may be subject to  co-insurance,  deductibility  or similar  clauses  which,  in
effect,  result  in  self-insurance  of  certain  losses,   PROVIDED  that  such
self-insurance  is  in  accord  with  the  approved  practices  of  corporations
similarly  situated and adequate insurance reserves are maintained in connection
with such self-insurance.

                  10.12.  Senior  Loan  Agreements.  The Company  will  promptly
deliver to each  holder of the Notes a copy of each  amendment  to the Bank Loan
Agreement  and each  agreement or  instrument  evidencing  any other Debt of the
Company entered into after the date of the Closing.

                  11.  Events of Default; Acceleration.  If any of
the following conditions or events ("Events of Default")
shall occur and be continuing:

                  (a)  if the  Company  shall  default  in  the  payment  of any
         principal of or premium,  if any, on any Note when the same becomes due
         and payable,  whether at maturity or at a date fixed for  prepayment or
         by declaration or otherwise; or

                  (b)  if the  Company  shall  default  in  the  payment  of any
         interest  on any Note for more than 15 days after the same  becomes due
         and payable; or

                  (c) if the  Company  shall  default in the  performance  of or
         compliance  with section 10.1 through 10.7,  inclusive and such default
         shall not have been  remedied  within 15 days after such failure  shall
         first have become known to any officer of the Company or written notice
         thereof  shall have been received by the Company from any holder of any
         Note; or
                                       32

                                      189
<PAGE>
                  (d) if the  Company  shall  default in the  performance  of or
         compliance  with any term contained in this Agreement  other than those
         referred to above in this  section 11 and such  default  shall not have
         been remedied within 30 days after such failure shall first have become
         known to any officer of the  Company or written  notice  thereof  shall
         have been received by the Company from any holder of any Note; or

                  (e) if any representation or warranty made in writing by or on
         behalf of the Company in this Agreement or in any instrument  furnished
         in  compliance  with or in reference to this  Agreement or otherwise in
         connection with the  transactions  contemplated by this Agreement shall
         prove to have been false or incorrect  in any  material  respect on the
         date as of which made; or

                  (f) if the  Company  or any  Subsidiary  shall  default in the
         payment of any principal of or premium or interest on any Debt which is
         outstanding under the Bank Loan Agreement,  or if any event shall occur
         or  condition  shall exist in respect of the Bank Loan  Agreement,  the
         effect  of  which   default,   event  or  condition  is  to  cause  the
         acceleration  of the payment of such Debt before its stated maturity or
         before its regularly scheduled dates of payment; or

                  (g) if  the  Company  or  any  Subsidiary  shall  default  (as
         principal or guarantor or other surety) in the payment of any principal
         of or  premium  or  interest  on any  Debt  which is  outstanding  in a
         principal  amount of at least  $1,000,000  (other than the Notes or the
         Bank Loan  Agreement),  or if any event shall occur or condition  shall
         exist in respect of any such Debt which is  outstanding  in a principal
         amount of at least $1,000,000 or under any evidence of any such Debt or
         of any mortgage,  indenture or other agreement  relating  thereto,  the
         effect of which default,  event or condition is to cause,  or to permit
         the holders of such Debt to cause,  the  acceleration of the payment of
         such Debt before its stated maturity or before its regularly  scheduled
         dates of payment; or

                  (h) if a final judgment or judgments shall be rendered against
         the  Company or any  Subsidiary  for the  payment of money in excess of
         $1,000,000 in the aggregate and any one of such judgments shall not be

                                       33

                                      190
<PAGE>
         discharged or execution  thereon stayed pending appeal,  within 60 days
         after entry  thereof,  or, in the event of such a stay,  such  judgment
         shall not be discharged within 60 days after such stay expires; or

                  (i) if the Company or any  Subsidiary  shall (i) be  generally
         not  paying its debts as they  become  due,  (ii)  file,  or consent by
         answer or otherwise to the filing  against it of, a petition for relief
         or  reorganization  or arrangement or any other petition in bankruptcy,
         for  liquidation  or to take  advantage of any bankruptcy or insolvency
         law of any  jurisdiction,  (iii) make an assignment  for the benefit of
         its  creditors,  (iv)  consent  to  the  appointment  of  a  custodian,
         receiver,  trustee or other officer with similar powers with respect to
         it or with  respect to any  substantial  part of its  property,  (v) be
         adjudicated  insolvent or (vi) take corporate action for the purpose of
         any of the foregoing; or

                  (j)  if  a  court  or  governmental   authority  of  competent
         jurisdiction  shall enter an order  appointing,  without consent by the
         Company or any  Subsidiary,  a  custodian,  receiver,  trustee or other
         officer with  similar  powers with respect to it or with respect to any
         substantial  part of its  property,  or if an order for relief shall be
         entered in any case or proceeding for liquidation or  reorganization or
         otherwise to take  advantage of any bankruptcy or insolvency law of any
         jurisdiction, or ordering the dissolution, winding-up or liquidation of
         the Company or any  Subsidiary,  or if any petition for any such relief
         shall be filed  against the Company or a Subsidiary  and such  petition
         shall not be dismissed within 30 days;


then, (x) upon the  occurrence of any Event of Default  described in subdivision
(i) or (j) of this  section 11 with  respect to the Company  (other than such an
Event of Default  described  in clause (i) of  subdivision  (i) or  described in
clause (vi) of subdivision (i) by virtue of the reference in such clause (vi) to
such clause (i)),  the unpaid  principal  amount of and accrued  interest on the
Notes shall  automatically  become due and payable or (y) upon the occurrence of
any other  Event of Default,  any holder or holders of 25% or more in  principal
amount of the Notes at the time outstanding (subject to section 15.4) may at any
time (unless all defaults shall  theretofore have been remedied) at its or their
option, by written notice or

                                       34

                                      191
<PAGE>
notices to the Company,  declare all the Notes to be due and payable,  whereupon
the same  shall  forthwith  mature and become  due and  payable,  together  with
interest accrued thereon, and there shall also be due and payable, to the extent
permitted by applicable law, a premium determined in accordance with the premium
table set forth in section  9.5,  all without  presentment,  demand,  protest or
notice, which are hereby waived,  provided that during the existence of an Event
of  Default  described  in  subdivision  (a) or (b) of this  section  11,  then,
irrespective of whether the holder or holders of 25% or more in principal amount
of Notes  then  outstanding  shall  have  declared  all the  Notes to be due and
payable  pursuant to this  section  11, any holder of the Notes  (other than the
Company or any of its Subsidiaries or Affiliates) may, at its option,  by notice
in writing to the Company,  declare the Notes then held by such holder to be due
and payable, whereupon the Notes then held by such holder shall forthwith mature
and become due and payable,  together with interest  accrued thereon and, to the
extent permitted by applicable law, a premium  determined in accordance with the
premium table set forth in section 9.5, without presentment,  demand, protest or
notice, all of which are hereby waived.

                  At any time after the principal  of, and interest  accrued on,
any or all of the Notes are declared  due and  payable,  the holders of not less
than 75% in aggregate principal amount of the Notes then outstanding (subject to
section  15.4),  by written notice to the Company may rescind and annul any such
declaration  and its  consequences  if (x) the  Company  has  paid  all  overdue
interest on the Notes, the principal of and premium,  if any, on any Notes which
have become due otherwise  than by reason of such  declaration,  and interest on
such overdue  principal  and premium and (to the extent  permitted by applicable
law) any  overdue  interest  in  respect  of the Notes at the rate of 13.25% per
annum,  (y) all Events of Default,  other than non-payment of amounts which have
become due solely by reason of such  declaration,  and all conditions and events
which  constitute  Events of Default or  Potential  Events of Default  have been
cured or waived  pursuant  to section 19, and (z) no judgment or decree has been
entered  for the  payment  of any  monies  due  pursuant  to the  Notes  or this
Agreement;  but no such  rescission and annulment  shall extend to or affect any
subsequent  Event of Default or  Potential  Event of Default or impair any right
consequent thereon.

                  12.  Remedies on Default, etc.  In case any one or
more Events of Default or Potential Events of Default shall

                                       35

                                      192
<PAGE>
occur and be  continuing,  the  holder of any Note at the time  outstanding  may
proceed to protect  and  enforce  the rights of such holder by an action at law,
suit in  equity  or  other  appropriate  proceeding,  whether  for the  specific
performance  of any  agreement  contained  herein  or in  such  Note,  or for an
injunction against a violation of any of the terms hereof or thereof,  or in aid
of the exercise of any power  granted  hereby or thereby or by law or otherwise.
In case of a default in the payment of any  principal of or premium,  if any, or
interest on any Note,  the Company  will pay to the holder  thereof such further
amount as shall be  sufficient  to cover the cost and  expenses  of  collection,
including,   without  limitation,   reasonable  attorneys'  fees,  expenses  and
disbursements.  No course of  dealing  and no delay on the part of any holder of
any Note in  exercising  any right,  power or remedy  shall  operate as a waiver
thereof or otherwise  prejudice  such holder's  rights,  powers or remedies.  No
right,  power or  remedy  conferred  by this  Agreement  or by any Note upon any
holder thereof shall be exclusive of any other right,  power or remedy  referred
to herein or therein or now or hereafter available at law, in equity, by statute
or otherwise.

                  13.  SUBORDINATION OF SUBORDINATED NOTES. 13.1.  GENERAL.  The
Notes (the  "Subordinated  Debt")  shall be  subordinate  and junior in right of
payment to all Superior  Debt (as defined in section  13.2) to the extent and in
the manner provided in this section 13.

                  13.2.  SUPERIOR  DEBT.  As used in this  section  13, the term
"Superior  Debt"  shall  mean (a) all  principal  of and  premium,  if any,  and
interest  on Debt of the  Company  outstanding  from time to time under the Bank
Loan Agreement and (b) other Debt of the Company  outstanding in compliance with
section  10.1(c) other than (i) Debt which by its terms is  subordinated  to any
other Debt of the Company and (ii) Debt outstanding  between the Company and any
Affiliate of the Company or between any  Subsidiary  and another  Subsidiary  or
Affiliate of the Company).  The Superior Debt shall continue to be Superior Debt
and entitled to the benefits of these subordination  provisions  irrespective of
any  amendment,  modification  or  waiver  of any term of the  Superior  Debt or
extension or renewal of the Superior Debt.

                  13.3.  DEFAULT IN RESPECT OF SUPERIOR  DEBT.  (a) In the event
the Company shall  default in the payment of any  principal  of, or premium,  if
any, or interest on any  Superior  Debt when the same  becomes due and  payable,
whether at maturity or at a date fixed for payment or prepayment

                                       36

                                      193
<PAGE>
thereof or by  declaration  or  otherwise,  then,  unless and until such default
shall have been remedied or waived in writing or shall have ceased to exist,  no
direct or indirect  payment (in cash,  property or  securities  or by set-off or
otherwise,  except  securities  which  are  subordinate  and  junior in right of
payment to the payment of Superior Debt at least to the extent  provided in this
section 13) shall be made on account of the principal of, or premium, if any, or
interest on any Subordinated  Debt, or as a sinking fund for Subordinated  Debt,
or in respect of any redemption,  retirement,  purchase or other  acquisition of
any Subordinated Debt.

                  (b) Upon the  happening of an event of default with respect to
any Superior Debt, as defined therein or in the instrument  under which the same
is  outstanding,  permitting  the holders  thereof to  accelerate  the  maturity
thereof (other than under  circumstances  when the terms of section  13.3(a) are
applicable),  then,  unless  and until  such  event of  default  shall have been
remedied  or waived  in  writing  or shall  have  ceased to exist,  no direct or
indirect  payment (in cash,  property or  securities or by set-off or otherwise,
except  securities  which are  subordinate and junior in right of payment to the
payment of Superior  Debt at least to the extent  provided  in this  section 13)
shall be made on account of the principal of or premium,  if any, or interest on
any  Subordinated  Debt or as a sinking fund for the  Subordinated  Debt,  or in
respect of any  redemption,  retirement,  purchase or other  acquisition  of any
Subordinated Debt, during any period:

                           (i) of up to 180 days (a  "Suspension  Period") after
                  written  notice of such  default  specifying  an  election  to
                  effect such 180-day  prohibition  shall have been given to the
                  Company (and the Company  shall  forward a copy to each holder
                  of  Subordinated  Debt)  by  the  holders  of  a  majority  in
                  principal  amount  of the  Superior  Debt,  provided  that (x)
                  following  the  commencement  of any  Suspension  Period  as a
                  result of any such  default the  duration  of such  Suspension
                  Period shall not be extended as a result of the  occurrence of
                  any additional or subsequent default,  (y) a Suspension Period
                  shall  terminate  upon  the  earlier  to  occur of (A) cure or
                  waiver of the event of default giving rise to such  Suspension
                  Period and (B) the expiration of such Suspension  Period,  and
                  (z) following the termination of any Suspension Period as

                                       37

                                      194
<PAGE>
                  contemplated  by the foregoing  clause (y), no new  Suspension
                  Period may be commenced  until at least ninety days shall have
                  elapsed during which  payments in respect of the  Subordinated
                  Debt may be made; or

                           (ii)  in  which  any  judicial  proceeding  shall  be
                  pending in respect of such default or an  effective  notice of
                  acceleration  of the maturity of the Superior  Debt shall have
                  been transmitted to the Company in respect of such default.

                  13.4.  Insolvency, etc.  In the event of:

                  (a) any  insolvency,  bankruptcy,  receivership,  liquidation,
         reorganization,  readjustment,  composition or other similar proceeding
         relating to the Company, its creditors as such or its property,

                  (b) any proceeding for the  liquidation,  dissolution or other
         winding-up  of the Company,  voluntary or  involuntary,  whether or not
         involving insolvency or bankruptcy proceedings,

                  (c)  any   assignment  by  the  Company  for  the  benefit  of
         creditors, or

                  (d) any other marshalling of the assets of the Company,

all Superior  Debt shall first be paid in full in cash or cash  equivalents  (or
with other assets acceptable to the holders of the Superior Debt) before payment
or distribution, whether in cash, securities or other property, shall be made to
any holder of any  Subordinated  Debt on account of any  Subordinated  Debt. Any
payment or  distribution,  whether in cash,  securities or other property (other
than securities of the Company or any other  corporation  provided for by a plan
of reorganization or readjustment the payment of which is subordinate,  at least
to the extent provided in this section 13 with respect to the Subordinated Debt,
to  the  payment  of  all  Superior  Debt  at the  time  outstanding  and to any
securities  issued in respect thereof under any such plan of  reorganization  or
readjustment), which would otherwise (but for these subordination provisions) be
payable  or  deliverable  in  respect  of  Subordinated  Debt  shall  be paid or
delivered  directly  to the  holders of  Superior  Debt in  accordance  with the
priorities then existing among such holders until all Superior Debt

                                       38

                                      195
<PAGE>
shall have been paid in full in cash or cash  equivalents  (or with other assets
acceptable to the holders of the Superior Debt).

                  13.5. Payments and Distributions  Received.  If any payment or
distribution  of any character or any security,  whether in cash,  securities or
other property  (other than  securities of the Company or any other  corporation
provided for by a plan of reorganization or readjustment the payment of which is
subordinate,  at least to the extent provided in this section 13 with respect to
Subordinated  Debt, to the payment of all Superior Debt at the time  outstanding
and to any  securities  issued  in  respect  thereof  under  any  such  plan  of
reorganization  or  readjustment),  shall  be  received  by  any  holder  of any
Subordinated Debt in contravention of any of the terms hereof and before all the
Superior Debt shall have been paid in full in cash or cash  equivalents (or with
other assets  acceptable to the holders of the Superior  Debt),  such payment or
distribution  or  security  shall be  received  in trust for the benefit of, and
shall be paid over or delivered and  transferred to, the holders of the Superior
Debt at the time  outstanding in accordance  with the  priorities  then existing
among such holders for application to the payment of all Superior Debt remaining
unpaid,  to the extent  necessary to pay all such  Superior Debt in full in cash
(or with other assets acceptable to the holders of the Superior Debt).

                  13.6. No Prejudice or Impairment.  No present or future holder
of any Superior Debt shall be  prejudiced in the right to enforce  subordination
of the Subordinated Debt by any act or failure to act on the part of the Company
or the holders of the Subordinated  Debt. Nothing contained herein shall impair,
as between the Company and the holder of any  Subordinated  Debt, the obligation
of the Company to pay to the holder  thereof the principal  thereof and interest
thereon as and when the same shall become due and payable in accordance with the
terms thereof and of this Agreement,  or prevent the holder of any  Subordinated
Debt from  exercising  all rights,  powers and remedies  otherwise  permitted by
applicable  law or  hereunder  upon a  Potential  Event of  Default  or Event of
Default hereunder, all subject to the terms of this section 13 and the rights of
the holders of the Superior Debt to receive cash,  securities or other  property
otherwise payable or deliverable to the holders of Subordinated Debt.

                  13.7.  Payment of Superior  Debt,  Subrogation,  etc. Upon the
payment in full of all Superior Debt in cash (or


                                       39

                                      196
<PAGE>
with other assets  acceptable to the holders of the Superior Debt),  the holders
of  Subordinated  Debt  shall be  subrogated  to all  rights of any  holders  of
Superior Debt to receive any further payments or distributions applicable to the
Superior Debt until the Subordinated Debt shall have been paid in full, and, for
the purposes of such  subrogation,  no payment or  distribution  received by the
holders of Superior  Debt of cash,  securities,  or other  property to which the
holders of Subordinated Debt would have been entitled except for this section 13
shall,  as between  the  Company  and its  creditors  other than the  holders of
Superior  Debt, on the one hand,  and the holders of  Subordinated  Debt, on the
other,  be deemed to be a payment or  distribution  by the Company on account of
Superior  Debt.  Nothing in this section 13.7 shall be deemed to confer upon the
holders  of the  Subordinated  Debt any  rights  with  respect  to any  security
agreement  securing  any  Superior  Debt,  or to impose  upon the holders of the
Superior Debt any liability to the holders of the Subordinated Debt with respect
to any further payments or distributions applicable to the Superior Debt.

                  14.  DEFINITIONS.  As used herein the following
terms have the following respective meanings:

                  AFFILIATE:  any Person  directly or indirectly  controlling or
controlled  by or under  common  control  with the  Company  or any  Subsidiary,
including (without  limitation) any Person  beneficially owning or holding 5% or
more of any class of voting  securities of the Company or any  Subsidiary or any
other  corporation  of which the Company or any  Subsidiary  owns or holds 5% or
more of any class of voting  securities,  PROVIDED  that,  for  purposes of this
definition,   "control"  (including,   with  correlative  meanings,   the  terms
"controlled  by" and "under common control  with"),  as used with respect to any
Person,  shall mean the  possession,  directly  or  indirectly,  of the power to
direct or cause the  direction  of the  management  and policies of such Person,
whether through the ownership of voting  securities or by contract or otherwise,
and  PROVIDED  FURTHER  that  neither  you  nor any  other  Person  which  is an
institution  shall be deemed to be an  Affiliate  of the  Company  or any of its
Subsidiaries  solely  by reason of  ownership  of the Notes or other  securities
issued in  exchange  for the Notes or by reason of having  the  benefits  of any
agreements or covenants of the Company contained in this Agreement.

                  BANK LOAN AGREEMENT:  the 1993 Restated Loan Agreement,  dated
as of November 8, 1993, among the Company

                                       40

                                      197
<PAGE>
and  the  Banks   (including  any  successor,   assignee  or  replacement   Bank
thereunder),  as amended by First Amendment to Restated Loan Agreement, dated as
of April 11, 1994, and by Second Amendment to Restated Loan Agreement,  dated as
of June 29, 1994,  and as further  amended  from time to time;  and the "Related
Loan Agreement" referred to in such Agreement.

                  BANKS: First National Bank of Omaha;  Firstier Bank,  National
Association,  Lincoln, Nebraska; First National Bank, Wahoo, Nebraska; NBD Bank,
N.A.; Norwest Bank Nebraska, N.A.; and The Boatmen's National Bank of St.
Louis.

                  BOARD:  the Board of Directors of the Company or a
committee of three or more directors lawfully exercising the
relevant powers of the Board.

                  BUSINESS DAY:  any day except a Saturday, a Sunday
or other day on which commercial banks in New York City are
required or authorized by law to be closed.

                  CAPITAL  LEASE:  as  applied to any  Person,  any lease of any
property (whether real, personal or mixed) by such Person as lessee which would,
in accordance with generally accepted accounting  principles,  be required to be
classified  and  accounted  for as a capital  lease on a  balance  sheet of such
Person,  other than, in the case of the Company or a Subsidiary,  any such lease
under which the Company or a Wholly-Owned Subsidiary is the lessor.

                  CAPITAL LEASE  OBLIGATION:  with respect to any Capital Lease,
the amount of the obligation of the lessee thereunder which would, in accordance
with generally accepted accounting principles, appear on a balance sheet of such
lessee in respect of such Capital Lease.

                  CHANGE  OF  CONTROL:  (a) at any time  when any of the  equity
securities of the Company  shall be registered  under Section 12 of the Exchange
Act,  (i) any Person or "group"  (within the meaning of Section  13(d)(3) of the
Exchange Act) (other than any Person which is a management employee, or any such
"group" which consists entirely of management  employees,  of the Company) being
or becoming the beneficial  owner,  directly or indirectly,  of more than 50% of
the Voting  Stock of the  Company or (ii) a majority of the members of the Board
consisting of persons other than Continuing Directors (as hereinafter  defined);
and (b) at any other  time,  less than 50% of the  Voting  Stock of the  Company
being owned beneficially, directly or indirectly, by

                                       41

                                      198
<PAGE>
employees  of  the  Company  or its  Subsidiaries.  As  used  herein,  the  term
"Continuing  Director"  means any member of the Board on the date hereof and any
other  member of the Board who shall be  recommended  or  elected  to  succeed a
Continuing Director by a majority of Continuing Directors who are the members of
the Board.

                  CODE: the Internal  Revenue Code of 1986, as amended from time
to time.
                  COMMON STOCK:  the meaning specified in section 1.

                  CONSOLIDATED  OPERATING CASH FLOW:  with respect to any fiscal
period,  Consolidated Net Income for such period, adjusted by adding thereto all
interest  expense and all  provisions  for  depreciation  and taxes  (other than
current tax expense) that were deducted in arriving at  Consolidated  Net Income
for such period, and further adjusted by adding or subtracting all non-recurring
non-cash losses and gains that were deducted or added, respectively, in arriving
at  Consolidated  Net  Income  for such  period.  For  purposes  of  calculating
Consolidated  Operating  Cash  Flow,  the  Company  shall  not  permit  deferred
commission  expenses  to be  capitalized  over any  period  in  excess of twelve
months.

                  CONSOLIDATED NET INCOME: with reference to any period, the net
income (or deficit) of the Company and its  Subsidiaries  for such period (taken
as a cumulative whole),  after deducting all operating expenses,  provisions for
all taxes and  reserves  and all other  proper  deductions,  all  determined  in
accordance  with  generally  accepted  accounting  principles on a  consolidated
basis,  after  eliminating  all  intercompany  transactions  and after deducting
portions of income properly  attributable to minority interests,  if any, in the
stock and surplus of Subsidiaries, provided that there shall be excluded (a) the
income  (or  deficit)  of any  Person  accrued  prior to the date it  becomes  a
Subsidiary or is merged into or  consolidated  with the Company or a Subsidiary,
(b) the income (or deficit) of any Person (other than a Subsidiary) in which the
Company or any Subsidiary has an ownership  interest,  except to the extent that
any such income has been actually  received by the Company or such Subsidiary in
the form of dividends or similar  distributions,  (c) the undistributed earnings
of any Subsidiary to the extent that the  declaration or payment of dividends or
similar  distributions  by such  Subsidiary is not at the time  permitted by the
terms of its charter or any  agreement,  instrument,  judgment,  decree,  order,
statute, rule or governmental regulation applicable to such

                                       42

                                      199
<PAGE>
Subsidiary,  (d) any deferred  credit  representing  the excess of equity in any
Subsidiary at the date of  acquisition  over the cost of the  investment in such
Subsidiary,  and (e) in the case of a successor to the Company by  consolidation
or merger or as a  transferee  of its  assets,  any  earnings  of the  successor
corporation  prior to such  consolidation,  merger or  transfer  of  assets.  In
addition,  in  calculating  Consolidated  Net Income for purposes of determining
compliance  with section 10.4,  there shall also be excluded,  with reference to
any period, (i) any restoration to income of any contingency reserve,  except to
the extent that provision for such reserve was made out of income accrued during
such period, (ii) any aggregate net gain (but not any aggregate net loss) during
such period  arising  from the sale,  exchange or other  disposition  of capital
assets (such term to include all fixed assets,  whether  tangible or intangible,
all inventory sold in conjunction with the disposition of fixed assets,  and all
securities),  (iii)  any  write-up  of any  asset,  (iv) any net  gain  from the
collection of the proceeds of life insurance policies, (v) any gain arising from
the  acquisition  of any  securities,  or the  extinguishment,  under  generally
accepted accounting  principles,  of any Debt, of the Company or any Subsidiary,
and (vi) any net income or gain (but not any net loss)  during  such period from
any change in accounting,  from any  discontinued  operations or the disposition
thereof, from any extraordinary events or from any prior period adjustments.

                   CONSOLIDATED  NET WORTH:  the sum of the  capital  stock (but
excluding  treasury stock and capital stock subscribed and unissued) and surplus
(including earned surplus, capital surplus and the balance of the current profit
and loss  account not  transferred  to surplus)  accounts of the Company and its
Subsidiaries  appearing on a  consolidated  balance sheet of the Company and its
Subsidiaries   prepared  in  accordance  with  generally   accepted   accounting
principles as of the date of  determination,  after eliminating all intercompany
transactions and all amounts  properly  attributable to minority  interests,  if
any, in the stock and surplus of Subsidiaries.

                  CONSOLIDATED TANGIBLE NET WORTH: Consolidated Net Worth, after
deducting therefrom (without duplication of deductions):

                  (a) the net book amount of all  assets,  after  deducting  any
         reserves applicable thereto, which would be treated as intangible under
         generally   accepted   accounting   principles,    including,   without
         limitation,
                                       43

                                      200
<PAGE>
         such items as good will, trademarks,  trade names, service marks, brand
         names, copyrights, patents and licenses, and rights with respect to the
         foregoing,   unamortized  debt  discount  and  expense,  organizational
         expenses and the excess of cost of purchased  Subsidiaries  over equity
         in the net assets thereof at the date of acquisition;

                  (b) any  write-up  in the book value of any asset on the books
         of the Company or any Subsidiary  resulting from a revaluation  thereof
         subsequent  to December  31, 1993 (other than the  write-up of the book
         value of an asset made in accordance with generally accepted accounting
         principles in connection with the purchase of such asset);

                  (c) the  amounts,  if any, at which any shares of stock of the
         Company or any Subsidiary appear on the asset side of the balance sheet
         from which  Consolidated  Net Worth is  determined  for the purposes of
         this definition;

                  (d) all deferred charges (other than prepaid expenses); and

                  (e) the amounts at which any  Investment  in any Person (other
         than  Investments  which are  permitted  by clauses  (t) through (z) of
         section 10.3) appear on the asset side of such balance sheet.

                  DEBT:  as applied to any Person (without duplication):

                  (a)  any indebtedness for borrowed money which
         such Person has directly or indirectly created,
         incurred or assumed; and

                  (b)  any  indebtedness  secured  by any  Lien  in  respect  of
         property  owned by such Person,  whether or not such Person has assumed
         or  become  liable  for the  payment  of such  indebtedness  (not  here
         referring  to any Lien  described  in  paragraphs  (a)  through  (e) of
         section 10.2); and

                  (c) any  indebtedness  with  respect to which such  Person has
         become directly or indirectly  liable and which  represents or has been
         incurred to finance the  purchase  price (or a portion  thereof) of any
         property or services or business acquired by such Person,

                                       44

                                      201
<PAGE>
         whether by purchase, consolidation, merger or otherwise; and

                  (d) any  indebtedness  of any other  Person  of the  character
         referred to in  subdivision  (a),  (b) or (c) of this  definition  with
         respect to which the Person whose Debt is being  determined  has become
         liable by way of a Guaranty.

                  ENVIRONMENTAL  LAWS:  Federal,  state,  provincial,  local and
foreign laws, rules and regulations relating to emissions,  discharges, releases
or threatened  releases of  pollutants,  contaminants,  chemicals or industrial,
toxic or hazardous substances or wastes into the environment (including, without
limitation,  air, surface water, ground water or land), or otherwise relating to
the manufacture,  processing,  distribution,  use, treatment, storage, disposal,
transport or handling of  pollutants,  contaminants,  chemicals  or  industrial,
toxic or hazardous substances or wastes.

                  ERISA:  the Employee Retirement Income Security
Act of 1974, as amended from time to time.

                  EXCHANGE ACT:  the Securities Exchange Act of
1934, as amended from time to time.

                  EXCESS SALE  PROCEEDS:  as of any date of  determination,  the
excess  of (a)  the  proceeds  of  sales  of  assets  of  the  Company  and  its
Subsidiaries  which are required to be applied to the  prepayment of Debt of the
Company  pursuant to section  10.7(c)(y),  over (b) the amount of senior Debt of
the Company outstanding as of such date and required to be prepaid pursuant to a
provision of the agreement or instrument  evidencing such senior Debt similar in
effect to section 10.7 hereof.

                  EVENT OF DEFAULT:  the meaning specified in section 11.

                  GUARANTY:  as applied to any  Person,  any direct or  indirect
liability,  contingent  or  otherwise,  of  such  Person  with  respect  to  any
indebtedness, lease, dividend or other obligation of another, including, without
limitation,  any such  obligation  directly or indirectly  guaranteed,  endorsed
(otherwise than for collection or deposit in the ordinary course of business) or
discounted  or sold with  recourse by such  Person,  or in respect of which such
Person  is  otherwise   directly  or  indirectly  liable,   including,   without
limitation, any such obligation in effect guaranteed by such

                                       45

                                      202
<PAGE>
Person through any agreement  (contingent or otherwise) to purchase,  repurchase
or otherwise  acquire such  obligation or any security  therefor,  or to provide
funds for the payment or  discharge of such  obligation  (whether in the form of
loans,  advances,  stock purchases,  capital contributions or otherwise),  or to
maintain the solvency or any balance sheet or other  financial  condition of the
obligor of such  obligation,  or to make payment for any products,  materials or
supplies or for any transportation or services regardless of the non-delivery or
nonfurnishing  thereof,  in any  such  case if the  purpose  or  intent  of such
agreement  is to  provide  assurance  that  such  obligation  will  be  paid  or
discharged,  or that any agreements  relating  thereto will be complied with, or
that the holders of such  obligation  will be protected  against loss in respect
thereof. The amount of any Guaranty shall be equal to the outstanding  principal
amount of the  obligation  guaranteed.  For the  purposes of section  10.4,  the
amount involved in any Guaranty which  constitutes a Restricted  Investment made
during any period shall be the aggregate  amount of the  obligation  guaranteed,
less any amount by which the  guarantor  may have been  discharged  with respect
thereto  (including  any  discharge  by way of a reduction  in the amount of the
obligation guaranteed),  PROVIDED that the guarantor shall not be deemed to have
been  discharged  with respect to any Guaranty to the extent the guarantor shall
have been required to perform such Guaranty  (except to the extent that any loss
on such Guaranty has been recognized in reducing Consolidated Net Income).

                  INVESTMENT:  as applied to any Person,  any direct or indirect
purchase or other acquisition by such Person of stock or other securities of any
other Person,  or any direct or indirect  loan,  advance (other than advances to
employees  for  moving  and  travel  expenses,   drawing  accounts  and  similar
expenditures in the ordinary course of business) or capital contribution by such
Person to any other Person, including all Debt and accounts receivable from such
other  Person  which are not current  assets or did not arise from sales to such
other  Person in the  ordinary  course of  business.  In  computing  the  amount
involved in any Investment at the time outstanding,  (a) undistributed  earnings
of, and interest  accrued in respect of Debt owing by, such other Person accrued
after the date of such Investment shall not be included,  (b) there shall not be
deducted from the amounts  invested in such other Person any amounts received as
earnings (in the form of dividends, interest or otherwise) on such Investment or
as loans from such other Person,  and (c)  unrealized  increases or decreases in
value, or
                                       46

                                      203
<PAGE>
write-ups,  write-downs or write-offs, of Investments in such other Person shall
be  disregarded.  For the  purposes  of section  10.4,  the amount  involved  in
Investments which constitute Restricted Investments made during any period shall
be  the  aggregate  cost  to the  Company  and  its  Subsidiaries  of  all  such
Investments  made, or which they became  obligated to make,  during such period,
determined in accordance  with generally  accepted  accounting  principles,  but
without  regard to  unrealized  increases or decreases in value,  or  write-ups,
write-downs  or  write-offs,  of such  Investments  (except to the  extent  that
Consolidated Net Income has been increased or reduced as the result thereof) and
without  regard  to the  existence  of any  undistributed  earnings  or  accrued
interest with respect thereto  accrued after the respective  dates on which such
Investments  were  made,  less any net return of capital  realized  during  such
period  upon the  sale,  repayment  or  other  liquidation  of such  Investments
(determined in accordance with generally  accepted  accounting  principles,  but
without  regard to any amounts  received  during such period as earnings (in the
form of dividends,  interest or otherwise) on such  Investments or as loans from
any Persons in whom such Investments have been made).

                  LIEN: as to any Person, any mortgage,  lien,  pledge,  adverse
claim, charge,  security interest or other encumbrance in or on, or any interest
or title of any  vendor,  lessor,  lender or other  secured  party to or of such
Person under any conditional sale or other title retention  agreement or Capital
Lease with respect to, any  property or asset owned or held by such  Person,  or
the  signing or filing of a  financing  statement  which  names  such  Person as
debtor, or the signing of any security agreement  authorizing any other party as
the secured party thereunder to file any financing statement.

                  MONTHLY OPERATING CASH FLOW:  as of any date of
determination, the monthly average of Consolidated Operating
Cash Flow for the two calendar months ending immediately
prior to such date of determination.

                   MULTIEMPLOYER PLAN: any Plan which is a "multiemployer  plan"
(as such term is defined in section 4001(a)(3) of ERISA).

                   OFFICERS'  CERTIFICATE:  a certificate  executed on behalf of
the  Company by the  Chairman of the Board of  Directors  (if an officer) or its
President or one of its
                                       47

                                      204
<PAGE>
Vice Presidents and its Treasurer or one of its Assistant Treasurers.

                  PBGC:  the Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation or
any governmental authority succeeding to any of its
functions.

                  PERMITTED  SUBORDINATED  DEBT:  unsecured  Debt of the Company
which (a) has a final  maturity  on or  subsequent  to June 30, 2004 (or, if the
Company  shall have made any  prepayment  of Notes  pursuant to section 9.2, the
last date on which a payment or  prepayment of principal of the Notes is, on the
date  the  Company  becomes  liable  with  respect  to such  subordinated  Debt,
scheduled to be made under this  Agreement and the Notes);  (b) does not provide
for any required prepayments,  fixed sinking fund payments, serial maturities or
similar payments in respect of the principal of such  subordinated Debt prior to
June 30, 1997 or which  would,  in any case,  amortize in any  calendar  year an
amount in excess of 20% of the original  principal  amount of such  subordinated
Debt;  (c) does not permit any holder of such Debt to declare all or any part of
such Debt to be due and  payable,  or to  require  (upon the  occurrence  of any
contingency  or otherwise)  all or any part of such Debt to be paid,  before its
expressed  maturity  for any reason  other than the  occurrence  of a default in
respect  thereof;  and  (d) is  created  under  or  evidenced  by an  instrument
containing  provisions for the  subordination of such Debt to senior Debt of the
Company  on a basis  either on a parity  with or junior and  subordinate  to the
Notes.

                  PERSON:  a corporation,  an  association,  a  partnership,  an
organization,  a business, an individual,  a government or political subdivision
thereof or a governmental  agency.

                  PLAN:  an  "employee  pension  benefit  plan" (as  defined  in
section 3 of ERISA) which is or has been established or maintained,  or to which
contributions  are or have  been  made,  by the  Company  or any of its  Related
Persons,  or an employee  pension benefit plan as to which the Company or any of
its Related  Persons  would be treated as a  contributory  sponsor under section
4069 of ERISA if it were to be terminated.

                  POTENTIAL EVENT OF DEFAULT:  any condition or
event which, with notice or lapse of time or both, would
become an Event of Default.
                                       48

                                      205
<PAGE>
                  RELATED  PERSON:  any  trade  or  business,   whether  or  not
incorporated,  which,  together with the Company,  is under common  control,  as
described in section 414(b) or (c) of the Code.

                  RESTRICTED  INVESTMENT:   the  meaning  specified  in  section
10.3(vi).

                  RESTRICTED  PAYMENT:  (a) any dividend or other  distribution,
direct  or  indirect,  on  account  of any  shares  of any class of stock of the
Company now or hereafter outstanding, except a dividend payable solely in shares
of Common Stock or  nonredeemable  preferred  stock of the Company;  and (b) any
redemption,  retirement,  purchase or other acquisition,  direct or indirect, of
any shares of any class of stock of the Company now or hereafter outstanding, or
of any  warrants,  rights or options to acquire any such  shares,  except to the
extent  that the  consideration  therefor  consists  of  shares  of stock of the
Company.

                  SECURITIES  ACT: the  Securities  Act of 1933, as amended from
time to time.

                  SUBSIDIARY:  any corporation at least 50% (by number of votes)
of the Voting  Stock of which is at the time  owned by the  Company or by one or
more Subsidiaries or by the Company and one or more Subsidiaries.

                  VOTING STOCK: with reference to any corporation,  stock of any
class or classes (or equivalent interests),  if the holders of the stock of such
class or classes (or  equivalent  interests) are  ordinarily,  in the absence of
contingencies,  entitled to vote for the election of the  directors  (or Persons
performing similar  functions) of such corporation,  even though the right so to
vote has been suspended by the happening of such a contingency.

                  WARRANTS:  the meaning specified in section 1.

                  WHOLLY-OWNED:  as applied to any Subsidiary,  a Subsidiary all
the outstanding shares (other than directors'  qualifying shares, if required by
law) of every class of stock of which are at the time owned by the Company or by
one  or  more  Wholly-Owned  Subsidiaries  or by the  Company  and  one or  more
Wholly-Owned Subsidiaries.
                                       49

                                      206
<PAGE>
                  15.  REGISTRATION,  TRANSFER AND SUBSTITUTION OF NOTES; ACTION
BY NOTEHOLDERS.

                  15.1. NOTE REGISTER; OWNERSHIP OF NOTES. The Company will keep
at its  principal  office a register in which the Company  will  provide for the
registration of Notes and the  registration  of transfers of Notes.  The Company
may treat the Person in whose name any Note is  registered  on such  register as
the owner  thereof for the purpose of receiving  payment of the principal of and
the  premium,  if any,  and  interest  on such Note and for all other  purposes,
whether or not such Note shall be overdue, and the Company shall not be affected
by any notice to the contrary. All references in this Agreement to a "holder" of
any Note shall mean the Person in whose name such Note is at the time registered
on such register.

                  15.2.  TRANSFER AND EXCHANGE OF NOTES.  Upon  surrender of any
Note  for  registration  of  transfer  or for  exchange  to the  Company  at its
principal  office,  the  Company at its  expense  will  execute  and  deliver in
exchange  therefor a new Note or Notes in  denominations  of at least $1,000,000
(except  one Note may be  issued  in a lesser  principal  amount  if the  unpaid
principal  amount of the surrendered Note is not evenly divisible by, or is less
than $1,000,000), as requested by the holder or transferee,  which aggregate the
unpaid principal amount of such surrendered  Note,  registered as such holder or
transferee may request,  dated so that there will be no loss of interest on such
surrendered Note and otherwise of like tenor.

                  15.3.   REPLACEMENT   OF  NOTES.   Upon  receipt  of  evidence
reasonably  satisfactory  to the  Company  of the loss,  theft,  destruction  or
mutilation of any Note and, in the case of any such loss,  theft or  destruction
of any Note, upon delivery of an indemnity bond in such reasonable amount as the
Company  may  determine  (or,  in the  case of any Note  held by you or  another
institutional  holder or your or its nominee, of an indemnity agreement from you
or such other holder) or, in the case of any such mutilation, upon the surrender
of such Note for  cancellation  to the  Company  at its  principal  office,  the
Company at its expense will execute and deliver,  in lieu thereof, a new Note in
the unpaid principal amount of such lost,  stolen,  destroyed or mutilated Note,
dated so that there will be no loss of  interest on such Note and  otherwise  of
like tenor. Any Note in lieu of which any such new Note has been so executed and
delivered by the Company shall not be deemed to be an  outstanding  Note for any
purpose of this Agreement.
                                       50

                                      207
<PAGE>
                  15.4. NOTES HELD BY COMPANY, ETC., DEEMED NOT OUTSTANDING. For
the purposes of  determining  whether the holders of the Notes of the  requisite
principal  amount at the time  outstanding  have taken any action  authorized by
this  Agreement  with  respect to the giving of  consents or  approvals  or with
respect  to  acceleration  upon an Event  of  Default,  any  Notes  directly  or
indirectly  owned by the Company or any of its  Subsidiaries or Affiliates shall
be disregarded and deemed not to be outstanding.

                  16.  PAYMENTS ON NOTES.  16.1.  PLACE OF PAYMENT.  Payments of
principal,  premium,  if any, and interest becoming due and payable on the Notes
shall be made at the principal  office of The Chase Manhattan Bank, N.A., in the
Borough of  Manhattan,  the City and State of New York,  unless the Company,  by
written notice to each holder of any Notes, shall designate the principal office
of another bank or trust  company in such  Borough as such place of payment,  in
which  case the  principal  office of such  other  bank or trust  company  shall
thereafter be such place of payment.

                  16.2.  HOME  OFFICE  PAYMENT.  So long as you or your  nominee
shall be the  holder of any Note,  and  notwithstanding  anything  contained  in
section  16.1 or in such Note to the  contrary,  the  Company  will pay all sums
becoming due on such Note for  principal,  premium,  if any, and interest by the
method and at the address  specified  for such purpose in Schedule A, or by such
other  method  or at such  other  address  as you  shall  have from time to time
specified to the Company in writing for such purpose,  without the  presentation
or surrender of such Note or the making of any notation thereon, except that any
Note  paid or  prepaid  in full  shall  be  surrendered  to the  Company  at its
principal  office or at the place of payment  maintained by the Company pursuant
to section 16.1 for cancellation.  Prior to any sale or other disposition of any
Note held by you or your  nominee you will,  at your  election,  either  endorse
thereon the amount of principal paid thereon and the last date to which interest
has been paid  thereon or  surrender  such Note to the Company in exchange for a
new Note or Notes pursuant to section 15.2. The Company will afford the benefits
of this  section  16.2 to any  institutional  investor  which is the  direct  or
indirect  transferee of any Note purchased by you under this Agreement and which
has made the  same  agreement  relating  to such  Note as you have  made in this
section 16.2.

                  17.   EXPENSES,   ETC.   Whether   or  not  the   transactions
contemplated by this Agreement  shall be  consummated,  the Company will pay all
expenses in connection with such
                                       51

                                      208
<PAGE>
transactions  and in connection  with any amendments or waivers  (whether or not
the same become  effective)  under or in respect of this Agreement or the Notes,
including,  without  limitation:  (a) the cost and  expenses  of  preparing  and
reproducing  this Agreement and the Notes, of furnishing all opinions by counsel
for the Company  (including any opinions requested by your special counsel as to
any  legal  matter  arising  hereunder)  and all  certificates  on behalf of the
Company, and of the Company's  performance of and compliance with all agreements
and  conditions  contained  herein on its part to be performed or complied with;
(b)  the  cost  of  delivering  to  your  principal  office,   insured  to  your
satisfaction,  the Notes sold to you  hereunder  and any Notes  delivered to you
upon any substitution of Notes pursuant to section 15 and of your delivering any
Notes,  insured  to your  satisfaction,  upon  any  such  substitution;  (c) the
reasonable  fees,  expenses  and  disbursements  of one special  counsel for the
holders of the Notes (and,  in addition,  any local  counsel  determined  by the
holders of the Notes to be necessary in the  circumstances)  in connection  with
such  transactions  and any such  amendments or waivers;  and (d) the reasonable
out-of-pocket  expenses incurred by you in connection with such transactions and
any such amendments or waivers. The Company also will pay, and will save you and
each holder of any Notes  harmless  from,  all claims in respect of the fees, if
any,  of brokers and finders  and any and all  liabilities  with  respect to any
taxes (including  interest and penalties) which may be payable in respect of the
execution  and  delivery  of this  Agreement,  the  issue of the  Notes  and any
amendment  or waiver  under or in respect of this  Agreement  or the Notes.  The
obligation of the Company under this section 17 shall survive any disposition or
payment of the Notes and the termination of this Agreement.

                  18.   SURVIVAL  OF   REPRESENTATIONS   AND   WARRANTIES.   All
representations and warranties contained in this Agreement or made in writing by
or on behalf of the Company in connection with the transactions  contemplated by
this Agreement shall survive the execution and delivery of this  Agreement,  any
investigation  at any time made by you or on your  behalf,  the  purchase of the
Notes by you under this  Agreement and any  disposition or payment of the Notes.
All statements  contained in any certificate or other instrument delivered by or
on behalf of the Company  pursuant to this  Agreement or in connection  with the
transactions  contemplated by this Agreement shall be deemed representations and
warranties of the Company under this Agreement.

                                       52

                                      209
<PAGE>
                  19.  AMENDMENTS AND WAIVERS.  Any term of this Agreement or of
the Notes may be amended and the  observance of any term of this Agreement or of
the Notes may be waived (either generally or in a particular instance and either
retroactively or prospectively) only with the written consent of the Company and
the  holders  of more  than 50% in  principal  amount  of the  Notes at the time
outstanding (subject to section 15.4),  PROVIDED that, without the prior written
consent of the  holders  of all the Notes at the time  outstanding  (subject  to
section 15.4),  no such amendment or waiver shall (a) change the maturity or the
principal  amount  of,  or  reduce  the rate or change  the time of  payment  of
interest  on, or change the amount or the time of  payment of any  principal  or
premium  payable  on any  prepayment  of, any Note,  (b)  reduce  the  aforesaid
percentages  of the  principal  amount  of the Notes  the  holders  of which are
required to consent to any such  amendment or waiver,  (c) change the percentage
of the principal  amount of the Notes the holders of which may declare the Notes
to be due and  payable as  provided in section 11, (d) modify the proviso to the
first  sentence of section 11, or (e) decrease the  percentage  of the principal
amount  of the  Notes  the  holders  of which  may  rescind  and  annul any such
declaration  as  provided  in section 11. Any  amendment  or waiver  effected in
accordance with this section 19 shall be binding upon each holder of any Note at
the time outstanding, each future holder of any Note and the Company.

                  20.  Notices,  etc.  Except  as  otherwise  provided  in  this
Agreement,  notices and other  communications  under this Agreement  shall be in
writing  and  shall be  delivered  by hand or  courier  service,  or  mailed  by
registered or certified mail,  return receipt  requested,  addressed,  (a) if to
you,  at the  address  set forth in  Schedule A or at such other  address as you
shall have furnished to the Company in writing,  except as otherwise provided in
section 16.2 with respect to payments on Notes held by you or your  nominee,  or
(b) if to any other  holder of any Note,  at such  address as such other  holder
shall have furnished to the Company in writing,  or, until any such other holder
so furnishes  to the Company an address,  then to and at the address of the last
holder of such Note who has  furnished an address to the  Company,  or (c) if to
the Company, at its address set forth at the beginning of this Agreement, to the
attention  of Chief  Financial  Officer,  or at such  other  address,  or to the
attention of such other officer,  as the Company shall have furnished to you and
each such other holder in writing. Any notice so addressed and delivered by hand
or courier shall be deemed to be given when received, and any notice so

                                       53

                                      210
<PAGE>
addressed and mailed by registered or certified mail shall be deemed to be given
three business days after being so mailed.

                  21.  MISCELLANEOUS.  This Agreement  shall be binding upon and
inure to the benefit of and be  enforceable  by the  respective  successors  and
assigns of the parties hereto,  whether so expressed or not, and, in particular,
shall inure to the benefit of and be enforceable by any holder or holders at the
time of the Notes or any part  thereof.  Except as stated in  section  18,  this
Agreement  embodies the entire agreement and  understanding  between you and the
Company and supersedes all prior agreements and  understandings  relating to the
subject  matter  hereof.  This  Agreement  and the Notes shall be construed  and
enforced in  accordance  with and  governed by the law of the State of New York.
The headings in this  Agreement are for purposes of reference only and shall not
limit or otherwise affect the meaning hereof.  This Agreement may be executed in
any number of counterparts, each of which shall be an original, but all of which
together shall constitute one instrument.

                                       54

                                      211
<PAGE>
                  If you are in agreement  with the  foregoing,  please sign the
form of agreement on the accompanying counterparts of this letter and return one
of the same to the  Company,  whereupon  this  letter  shall  become  a  binding
agreement between you and the Company.

                                Very truly yours,

                              DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK
                                   CORPORATION



                                            By:        /s/ Steve C. Ball
                                                     --------------------------
                           Title: Secretary/Treasurer
                           and Chief Financial Officer


The foregoing Agreement is
hereby agreed to as of the
date thereof.

EQUITABLE CAPITAL PRIVATE INCOME
  AND EQUITY PARTNERSHIP II, L.P.

By:  EQUITABLE CAPITAL MANAGEMENT CORPORATION
       Its General Partner

         By:    /s/  U. Peter C. Gummeson
                -------------------------
            Title: Investment Officer

                                       55

                                      212
<PAGE>

                                                                     SCHEDULE A

                             SCHEDULE OF PURCHASERS

        Name and Address                                   Principal Amount of
          of Purchaser                                      Notes; Number of
                                     Shares


EQUITABLE CAPITAL PRIVATE INCOME AND
EQUITY PARTNERSHIP II, L.P.                              Principal Amount of
                                Subordinated Note
(1) All payments by wire transfer of
immediately available funds to:                              $15,000,000

  The Chase Manhattan Bank, N.A.
  110 West 52nd Street                                    Number of Warrants
  New York, New York 10019
                                  25,000 Shares
  A/C Equitable Capital Private  Income
  and Equity Partnership L.P. Operating
  Account
  Account No. 037-2-415703

Each such wire  transfer  shall set forth the name of the  Company and the CUSIP
number, if applicable, and the due date of the payment being made.


(2) All notices of payment and written confirmation of such wire transfers to be
sent to:

  Equitable Capital Private Income and
  Equity Partnership II, L.P.
  c/o Alliance Corporate Finance Group
  Incorporated
  1285 Avenue of the Americas
  19th Floor
  New York, New York 10019

(3) All other communications to be sent
to:

  Equitable Capital Private Income and
  Equity Partnership II, L.P.
  c/o Alliance Corporate Finance Group
  Incorporated
  1285 Avenue of the Americas
  19th Floor
  New York, New York 10019

  Attention: Corporate Finance
       Department

(4) Securities to be delivered to:

  Alliance Corporate Finance Group
 Incorporated  135 West 50th Street
  5th Floor
  New York, New York 10128

  Attention: Susan Tomaselli


                                      213
<PAGE>

                                                                       EXHIBIT A

                                   DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION

                             11.25% SENIOR SUBORDINATED NOTE DUE JUNE 30, 2004

PPN# 238017 A* 8
R-1                                                           New York, New York
$15,000,000                                                        June 30, 1994


                  DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION,  a Delaware corporation
(the "Company"),  for value received,  hereby promises to pay to , or registered
assigns,  the principal amount of FIFTEEN MILLION DOLLARS  ($15,000,000) on June
30, 2004,  with interest  (computed on the basis of twelve 30-day months) on the
unpaid balance of such principal amount at the rate of 11.25% per annum from the
date hereof,  payable  quarterly on each September 30, December 30, March 30 and
June 30 after the date hereof,  commencing September 30, 1994, until such unpaid
balance shall become due and payable (whether at maturity or at a date fixed for
prepayment or by  declaration  or  otherwise),  and with interest on any overdue
principal  (including  any overdue  prepayment of principal)  and (to the extent
permitted by applicable law) on any overdue interest,  at the rate of 13.25% per
annum until paid, payable quarterly as aforesaid or, at the option of the holder
hereof, on demand. Payments of principal and interest on this Note shall be made
in lawful money of the United States of America at the principal office of Chase
Manhattan  Bank,  N.A., in the Borough of  Manhattan,  the City and State of New
York,  or at such other  office or agency in such  Borough as the Company  shall
have  designated by written notice to the holder of this Note as provided in the
Note and Warrant Purchase Agreement referred to below.

                  This Note is one of the Company's  11.25% Senior  Subordinated
Notes due June 30, 2004 (the "Notes"), originally issued in the aggregate amount
of $15,000,000 pursuant to Note and Warrant Purchase Agreement, dated as of June
30, 1994, as from time to time amended,  among the Company and the institutional
investor named  therein.  The holder of this Note is entitled to the benefits of
such Note and Warrant Purchase Agreement,  as from time to time amended, and may
enforce  the  agreements  of the Company  contained  therein  and  exercise  the
remedies provided for thereby or otherwise available in respect thereof.

                  Payments of principal and interest in respect of the Notes are
subordinate,  to  the  extent  specified  in  such  Note  and  Warrant  Purchase
Agreement,  to all Superior  Debt of the Company as such term is defined in such
Note and Warrant Purchase Agreement.

                                      214
<PAGE>
                  This Note is a registered Note and is  transferable  only upon
surrender  of  this  Note  for  registration  of  transfer,  duly  endorsed,  or
accompanied  by a written  instrument of transfer duly  executed,  by the holder
hereof or such holder's  attorney duly authorized in writing.  Reference in this
Note to a "holder"  shall mean the person in whose name this Note is at the time
registered  on the  register  kept by the  Company as  provided in such Note and
Warrant Purchase Agreement and the Company may treat such person as the owner of
this Note for the purpose of receiving  payment and for all other purposes,  and
the Company shall not be affected by any notice to the contrary.

                  The  Notes  are  under   certain   circumstances   subject  to
prepayment  at the option of the  company or at the  option of the  holders,  in
whole or in part, as specified in such Note and Warrant Purchase Agreement.

                  In case an Event  of  Default,  as  defined  in such  Note and
Warrant Purchase Agreement, shall occur and be continuing, the unpaid balance of
the principal of this Note may become due and payable in the manner and with the
effect provided in such Note and Warrant Purchase Agreement.

                                        2

                                      215
<PAGE>
                  This  Note is made and  delivered  in New York,  NewYork,  and
shall be governed by the laws of the State of New York.


                            DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION


                               By:     /s/ Steve C. Ball
                                      -----------------------------
                               Title: Secretary/Treasurer
                                      Chief Financial Officer


                                        3

                                      216
<PAGE>

                                                                  EXECUTION COPY


- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------







                      DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION







                          COMMON STOCK PURCHASE WARRANT








                             Expiring June 30, 2004







- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

                                      217
<PAGE>

                                TABLE OF CONTENTS



1.  Exercise of Warrant........................................................1
    1.1.    Manner of Exercise.................................................1
    1.2.    When Exercise Deemed Effected......................................2
    1.3.    Delivery of Stock Certificates, etc................................2
    1.4.    Company to Reaffirm Obligations....................................3
    1.5.    Payment by Application of the Notes................................3

2.  Adjustments; Dividends.....................................................4
    2.1.    Number of Shares; Warrant Price....................................4
    2.2.    Adjustment of Warrant Price; Payment of Regular
            Dividends..........................................................4
    2.2.1.  Issuance of Additional Shares of Common Stock
            ...................................................................4
    2.2.2.  Extraordinary Dividends and Distributions..........................5
    2.2.3.  Payment of Regular Dividends.......................................6
    2.3.    Treatment of Options and Convertible Securities....................6
    2.4.    Treatment of Stock Dividends, Stock Splits, etc...................10
    2.5.    Computation of Consideration......................................10
    2.6     Adjustments for Combinations, etc.................................12
    2.7.    Dilution in Case of Other Securities..............................12
    2.8.    Minimum Adjustment of Warrant Price...............................13
 
3.  Consolidation, Merger, Sale of Assets, Reorganization, etc
    ..........................................................................13
    3.1.   General Provisions.................................................13
    3.2.   Assumption of Obligations..........................................16

4.  Other Dilutive Events.....................................................17

5.  No Dilution or Impairment.................................................17

6.  Accountants' Report as to Adjustments.....................................18

7.  Notices of Corporate Action...............................................19

8.  Restrictions on Transfer..................................................20
    8.1.   Restrictive Legends................................................20
    8.2.   Notice of Proposed Transfer; Opinions of Counsel...................20
    8.3.   Termination of Restrictions........................................22

9.  Registration under Securities Act, etc....................................22
    9.1.  Registration on Request.............................................22
    9.2.  Incidental Registration.............................................26
    9.3.  Registration Procedures.............................................28
    9.4.  Underwritten Offerings..............................................34

                                        i

                                      218
<PAGE>
    9.5.  Preparation; Reasonable Investigation...............................36
    9.6.  Rights of Requesting Holders........................................37
    9.7.  Indemnification.....................................................37
    9.8.  Adjustments Affecting Registrable Securities........................41
    9.9.  Registration Rights to Others.......................................42
    9.10. Other Registration of Common Stock..................................42
    9.11. Nominees for Beneficial Owners......................................42
    9.12. Rule 144 and Rule 144A..............................................43

10. Availability of Information...............................................43

11. Reservation of Stock, etc.................................................43

12. Listing on Securities Exchange............................................43

13. Ownership, Transfer and Substitution of Warrants..........................44
    13.1.  Ownership of Warrants..............................................44
    13.2.  Transfer and Exchange of Warrants..................................44
    13.3.  Replacement of Warrants............................................44

14.  Definitions..............................................................45

15.  Remedies.................................................................53

16.  No Rights or Liabilities as Stockholder..................................53

17.  Notices..................................................................53

18.  Expiration; Notice.......................................................54

19.  Miscellaneous............................................................54

                                       ii

                                      219
<PAGE>


                          Common Stock Purchase Warrant
                             Expiring June 30, 2004


                               New York, New York
                                  June 30, 1994

PPN #238017 2* 7
No. W-1


                  DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION,  a Delaware corporation
(the "Company"),  for value received,  hereby  certifies that EQUITABLE  CAPITAL
PRINVATE INCOME AND EQUITY PARTNERSHIP II, or registered assigns, is entitled to
purchase from the Company TWENTY-FIVE THOUSAND duly authorized,  validly issued,
fully paid and nonassessable  shares of Common Stock, par value $.001 per share,
of the Company (the "Common  Stock") at the purchase  price per share of $22.17,
at any time or from time to time prior to 3 P.M.,  New York City  time,  on June
30, 2004, all subject to the terms,  conditions and  adjustments set forth below
in this Warrant.

                  This Warrant is one of the Common Stock Purchase Warrants (the
"Warrants",  such term to include all Warrants issued in substitution  therefor)
originally  issued  in  connection  with the issue  and sale by the  Company  of
$15,000,000  aggregate  principal amount of its 11.25% Senior Subordinated Notes
due June 30, 2004 (together with all notes issued in substitution  therefor, the
"Notes"),  pursuant to the Note and Warrant  Purchase  Agreement  (the "Purchase
Agreement"),   dated  as  of  June  30,  1994,   between  the  Company  and  the
institutional investor named therein (the "Purchaser").  The Warrants originally
so issued  evidence  rights to purchase an aggregate of 25,000  shares of Common
Stock, subject to adjustment as provided herein.  Certain capitalized terms used
in this Warrant are defined in section 14.

                  1. EXERCISE OF WARRANT. 1.1. MANNER OF EXERCISE.  This Warrant
may be  exercised  by the  holder  hereof,  in whole or in part,  during  normal
business  hours on any Business Day prior to the  expiration  of this Warrant by
surrender of this Warrant, with the form of subscription at the end hereof (or a
reasonable  facsimile  thereof) duly executed by such holder,  to the Company at
its  principal  office  (or, if such  exercise  shall be in  connection  with an
underwritten  Public  Offering of shares of Common  Stock (or Other  Securities)
subject to this Warrant,  at the location at which the Company shall have agreed
to deliver  the  shares of Common  Stock (or Other  Securities)  subject to such
offering),  accompanied  by payment,  in cash or by certified  or official  bank
check  payable  to the order of the  Company or by  application  of Notes in the
manner  provided in section 1.5 (or by a combination  of such  methods),  in the
amount obtained by

                                      220
<PAGE>
multiplying  (a) the number of shares of Common Stock (without  giving effect to
any  adjustment  therein)  designated  in such form of  subscription  by (b) the
Warrant Price, and such holder shall thereupon be entitled to receive the number
of duly  authorized,  validly  issued,  fully paid and  nonassessable  shares of
Common Stock (or Other Securities)  determined as provided in sections 2 through
4.

                  1.2.  WHEN  EXERCISE  DEEMED  EFFECTED.  Each exercise of this
Warrant shall be deemed to have been effected  immediately prior to the close of
business on the Business Day on which this Warrant  shall have been  surrendered
to the  Company  as  provided  in  section  1.1,  and at such time the person or
persons in whose name or names any  certificate  or  certificates  for shares of
Common  Stock (or Other  Securities)  shall be  issuable  upon such  exercise as
provided  in section 1.3 shall be deemed to have become the holder or holders of
record thereof.

                  1.3.  DELIVERY  OF  STOCK   CERTIFICATES,   ETC.  As  soon  as
practicable after the exercise of this Warrant,  in whole or in part, and in any
event within ten Business  Days  thereafter  (unless such  exercise  shall be in
connection  with an  underwritten  Public Offering of shares of Common Stock (or
Other Securities) subject to this Warrant, in which event concurrently with such
exercise),  the Company at its expense (including the payment by it of any taxes
(other than transfer  taxes)  applicable to the Company) will cause to be issued
in the name of and delivered to the holder  hereof or,  subject to section 8, as
such holder (upon payment by such holder of any applicable  transfer  taxes) may
direct,

                  (a) a  certificate  or  certificates  for the  number  of duly
         authorized,  validly  issued,  fully paid and  nonassessable  shares of
         Common  Stock (or  Other  Securities)  to which  such  holder  shall be
         entitled upon such exercise  plus, in lieu of any  fractional  share to
         which such holder would otherwise be entitled,  cash in an amount equal
         to the same fraction of the Market Price per share of such Common Stock
         (or Other  Securities)  on the Business Day next  preceding the date of
         such exercise, and

                  (b) in case such  exercise  is in part only,  a new Warrant or
         Warrants of like tenor,  calling in the  aggregate on the face or faces
         thereof for the number of shares of Common Stock equal (without  giving
         effect to any  adjustment  therein) to the number of such shares called
         for on the  face  of this  Warrant  minus  the  number  of such  shares
         designated by the holder upon such exercise as provided in section 1.1.

                                        2

                                      221
<PAGE>
                1.4. COMPANY TO REAFFIRM OBLIGATIONS. The Company will, at the
time of or at any time after each exercise of this Warrant,  upon the request of
the holder hereof or of any shares of Common Stock (or Other Securities)  issued
upon such exercise,  acknowledge in writing its continuing  obligation to afford
to  such  holder  all  rights  (including,  without  limitation,  any  right  of
registration of any shares of Common Stock (or Other  Securities)  issuable upon
exercise  of this  Warrant  pursuant  to section 9) to which such  holder  shall
continue to be entitled after such exercise in accordance with the terms of this
Warrant,  provided  that if any such holder shall fail to make any such request,
the failure shall not affect the continuing  obligation of the Company to afford
such rights to such holder.

                  1.5. PAYMENT BY APPLICATION OF THE NOTES. Upon any exercise of
this Warrant, the holder hereof may, at its option,  instruct the Company, by so
specifying  in the form of  subscription  submitted  therewith  as  provided  in
section 1.1, to apply to the payment  required by section 1.1 all or any part of
the principal  amount then unpaid and of the interest on such  principal  amount
then accrued on any one or more Notes at the time held by such holder,  in which
case the  Company  will accept the  aggregate  amount of  principal  and accrued
interest  on  such  principal   specified  in  such  form  of   subscription  in
satisfaction  of a like  amount of such  payment.  In case less than the  entire
unpaid principal amount of any Note shall be so specified,  the principal amount
so specified  shall be credited,  as of the date of such  exercise,  against the
installments  of principal  then  remaining  unpaid on such Note pro rata to all
such remaining  installments.  Within ten days after receipt of any such notice,
the  Company  will  pay to the  holder  of the  Notes  submitting  such  form of
subscription,  in the manner provided in such Notes and the Purchase  Agreement,
all unpaid  interest  accrued  to the date of  exercise  of such  Warrant on the
principal  amount so specified in such form of subscription  that is not applied
to the payment required by section 1.1 under this section 1.5. In the event that
the  entire  unpaid  principal  amount  of any Note is  applied  to the  payment
required  by section  1.1 under this  section  1.5,  such Note shall be promptly
surrendered  and  cancelled in  accordance  with the Purchase  Agreement.  It is
understood  that  no  prepayment  premium  will be  payable  in  respect  of any
principal  amount of the Notes applied to the payment required by section 1.1 as
contemplated by this section 1.5.

                  2.  ADJUSTMENTS;  DIVIDENDS.  2.1.  NUMBER OF SHARES;  WARRANT
PRICE.  The number of shares of Common  Stock  which the holder of this  Warrant
shall be entitled to receive upon each  exercise  hereof shall be  determined by
multiplying  the number of shares of Common Stock which would otherwise (but for
the
                                        3

                                      222
<PAGE>
provisions of this section 2) be issuable upon such  exercise,  as designated by
the holder  hereof  pursuant  to  section  1.1,  by a fraction  of which (a) the
numerator is $[insert  initial  Warrant  Price] and (ii) the  denominator is the
Warrant Price in effect on the date of such exercise.  The "Warrant Price" shall
initially be $______ per share,  shall be adjusted and  readjusted  from time to
time as provided in this  section 2 and,  as so  adjusted or  readjusted,  shall
remain in effect until a further adjustment or readjustment  thereof is required
by this section 2.

                  2.2.   ADJUSTMENT  OF  WARRANT   PRICE;   PAYMENT  OF  REGULAR
DIVIDENDS.  2.2.1.  ISSUANCE OF ADDITIONAL  SHARES OF COMMON STOCK.  In case the
Company,  at any time or from time to time  after  June 30,  1994 (the  "Initial
Date"),  shall  issue or sell  Additional  Shares  of  Common  Stock  (including
Additional Shares of Common Stock deemed to be issued pursuant to section 2.3 or
2.4) without  consideration or for a consideration  per share less than the Base
Price in effect,  in each  case,  on the date of and  immediately  prior to such
issue or sale, then, and in each such case, subject to section 2.8, such Warrant
Price  shall be  reduced,  concurrently  with  such  issue  or sale,  to a price
(calculated  to the  nearest  .001 of a cent)  determined  by  multiplying  such
Warrant Price by a fraction,

                  (a) the  numerator  of which shall be (i) the number of shares
         of Common  Stock  outstanding  immediately  prior to such issue or sale
         plus (ii) the  number of shares  of Common  Stock  which the  aggregate
         consideration  received  by the  Company  for the total  number of such
         Additional  Shares of Common Stock so issued or sold would  purchase at
         the Base Price, and

                  (b) the  denominator of which shall be the number of shares of
          Common Stock outstanding immediately after such issue or sale,

PROVIDED that, for the purposes of this section 2.2.1 (x) immediately  after any
Additional  Shares of common  Stock are deemed to have been  issued  pursuant to
section 2.3 or 2.4, such  Additional  Shares shall be deemed to be  outstanding,
and (y) treasury shares shall not be deemed to be outstanding.

                  2.2.2. EXTRAORDINARY DIVIDENDS AND DISTRIBUTIONS.  In case the
Company at any time or from time to time after the Initial  Date shall  declare,
order,  pay  or  make a  dividend  or  other  distribution  (including,  without
limitation, any distribution of other or additional stock or other securities or
property or Options by way of dividend or spin-off,

                                        4

                                      223
<PAGE>
reclassification,  recapitalization  or similar corporate  rearrangement) on any
Common Stock,  other than (a) a dividend payable in Additional  Shares of Common
Stock or in  Options  for  Common  Stock or (b) a  dividend  payable in cash and
declared out of the earned surplus of the Company,  then, and in each such case,
subject to section 2.8,  the Warrant  Price in effect  immediately  prior to the
close of business on the record date fixed for the  determination  of holders of
any class of securities  entitled to receive such dividend or distribution shall
be reduced,  effective  as of the close of business  on such record  date,  to a
price  (calculated to the nearest .001 of a cent) determined by multiplying such
Warrant Price by a fraction,

                  (x) the  numerator of which shall be the Current  Market Price
         in effect on such  record  date or, if the  Common  Stock  trades on an
         ex-dividend basis, on the date prior to the commencement of ex-dividend
         trading, less the value of such dividend or distribution (as determined
         in good faith by the Board of Directors of the Company)  applicable  to
         one share of Common Stock, and

                  (y)  the denominator of which shall be such Current
         Market Price.

                  2.2.3.  PAYMENT OF REGULAR  DIVIDENDs.  In case the Company at
         any time or from time to time after the  Initial  Date  shall  declare,
         order,  pay or make a dividend on its Common Stock  payable in cash and
         declared out of the earned  surplus of the Company,  then,  and in each
         such case,  the holder of this Warrant shall be entitled to receive the
         amount in cash to which such holder would  actually  have been entitled
         as a shareholder upon the payment thereof by the Company if such holder
         had exercised this Warrant  immediately  prior to the close of business
         on the  record  date fixed for the  determination  of holders of Common
         Stock entitled to receive such dividend.

                  2.3. TREATMENT OF OPTIONS AND CONVERTIBLE SECURITIES.  In case
the Company at any time or from time to time after the Initial Date shall issue,
sell,  grant or  assume,  or shall fix a record  date for the  determination  of
holders  of any  class  of  securities  entitled  to  receive,  any  Options  or
Convertible  Securities,  then,  and in each such case,  the  maximum  number of
Additional  Shares of Common  Stock  (as set  forth in the  instrument  relating
thereto,  without  regard to any provisions  contained  therein for a subsequent
adjustment of such number) issuable upon the exercise of such options or, in the
case of Convertible  Securities and Options therefor, the conversion or exchange
of such Convertible Securities, shall be deemed to be issued for

                                        5

                                      224
<PAGE>
purposes of section 2.1 as of the time of such issue,  sale, grant or assumption
or,  in case  such a record  date  shall  have  been  fixed,  as of the close of
business on such record date (or, if the Common Stock  trades on an  ex-dividend
basis, on the date prior to the commencement of ex-dividend  trading),  PROVIDED
that such  Additional  Shares of Common  Stock  shall not be deemed to have been
issued unless the consideration  per share (determined  pursuant to section 2.5)
of such shares would be less than the Base Price in effect, in each case, on the
date of and  immediately  prior to such  issue,  sale,  grant or  assumption  or
immediately  prior to the close of  business  on such  record  date (or,  if the
Common  Stock  trades  on an  ex-dividend  basis,  on  the  date  prior  to  the
commencement of ex-dividend trading), as the case may be, and PROVIDED, FURTHER,
that in any such case in which  Additional  Shares of Common Stock are deemed to
be issued,

                  (a) no further  adjustment  of the Warrant Price shall be made
         upon the subsequent issue or sale of Additional  Shares of Common Stock
         or  Convertible  Securities  upon the  exercise of such  Options or the
         conversion or exchange of such Convertible Securities;

                  (b) if such Options or  Convertible  Securities by their terms
         provide, with the passage of time or otherwise, for any increase in the
         consideration  payable to the  Company,  or  decrease  in the number of
         Additional  Shares  of  Common  Stock  issuable,   upon  the  exercise,
         conversion or exchange  thereof (by change of rate or  otherwise),  the
         Warrant  Price  computed  upon  the  original  issue,  sale,  grant  or
         assumption  thereof (or upon the occurrence of the record date, or date
         prior to the commencement of ex-dividend  trading,  as the case may be,
         with respect  thereto),  and any subsequent  adjustments based thereon,
         shall,  upon any such  increase  or  decrease  becoming  effective,  be
         recomputed to reflect such  increase or decrease  insofar as it affects
         such  Options,  or the  rights of  conversion  or  exchange  under such
         Convertible Securities, which are outstanding at such time;

                  (c) upon the  expiration  of any such Options or of the rights
         of conversion or exchange under any such  Convertible  Securities which
         shall not have been  exercised  (or upon  purchase  by the  Company and
         cancellation  or  retirement  of any such Options  which shall not have
         been  exercised  or of any such  Convertible  Securities  the rights of
         conversion or exchange under which shall not have been exercised),  the
         Warrant  Price  computed  upon  the  original  issue,  sale,  grant  or
         assumption  thereof (or upon the occurrence of the record date, or date
         prior to the commencement of ex-dividend  trading,  as the case may be,
         with respect thereto), and any

                                        6

                                      225
<PAGE>
         subsequent  adjustments based thereon,  shall, upon such expiration (or
         such cancellation or retirement,  as the case may be), be recomputed as
         if:

                           (x) in the case of  options  for  Common  Stock or of
                  Convertible  Securities,  the only Additional Shares of Common
                  Stock  issued  or sold  were the  Additional  Shares of Common
                  Stock,  if any,  actually  issued or sold upon the exercise of
                  such Options or the conversion or exchange of such Convertible
                  Securities and the consideration  received therefor was (i) an
                  amount equal to (A) the consideration actually received by the
                  Company for the issue,  sale,  grant or assumption of all such
                  options, whether or not exercised,  plus (B) the consideration
                  actually received by the Company upon such exercise, minus (C)
                  the consideration paid by the Company for any purchase of such
                  Options which were not  exercised,  or (ii) an amount equal to
                  (A) the consideration actually received by the Company for the
                  issue,  sale,  grant or  assumption  of all  such  Convertible
                  Securities  which were actually  converted or exchanged,  plus
                  (B) the additional consideration, if any, actually received by
                  the Company upon such  conversion  or exchange,  minus (C) the
                  consideration  paid by the  Company  for any  purchase of such
                  Convertible  Securities  the rights of  conversion or exchange
                  under which were not exercised, and

                           (y)  in  the   case  of   Options   for   Convertible
                  Securities,  only the Convertible Securities, if any, actually
                  issued or sold upon the  exercise of such  Options were issued
                  at the time of the issue,  sale,  grant or  assumption of such
                  options, and the consideration received by the Company for the
                  Additional  Shares  of Common  Stock  deemed to have then been
                  issued was an amount equal to (i) the  consideration  actually
                  received  by  the  Company  for  the  issue,  sale,  grant  or
                  assumption of all such options, whether or not exercised, plus
                  (ii) the  consideration  deemed to have been  received  by the
                  Company  (pursuant  to section  2.5) upon the issue or sale of
                  the Convertible  Securities with respect to which such options
                  were actually exercised, minus (iii) the consideration paid by
                  the Company for any  purchase of such  Options  which were not
                  exercised;

                  (d) no  readjustment  pursuant to subdivision (b) or (c) above
         shall have the effect of  increasing  the Warrant Price by an amount in
         excess of the amount of the adjustment

                                        7

                                      226
<PAGE>
         thereof  originally  made in  respect  of the  issue,  sale,  grant  or
         assumption of such options or Convertible Securities; and

                  (e) in the  case of any such  Options  which  expire  by their
         terms not more than 30 days  after  the date of issue,  sale,  grant or
         assumption  thereof,  no  adjustment of the Warrant Price shall be made
         until the  expiration or exercise of all such Options,  whereupon  such
         adjustment  shall be made in the manner  provided  in  subdivision  (c)
         above.

          In case at any  time  after  the  Initial  Date the  Company  shall be
required to increase the number of Additional  Shares of Common Stock subject to
any Option or into which any  Convertible  Securities  (other than the Warrants)
are  convertible  or  exchangeable  pursuant to the  operation of  anti-dilution
provisions  applicable  thereto,  such  Additional  Shares shall be deemed to be
issued for purposes of section 2.1 as of the time of such increase.

                  2.4. TREATMENT OF STOCK DIVIDENDS,  STOCK SPLITS, ETC. In case
the  Company  at any time or from time to time  after  the  Initial  Date  shall
declare or pay any dividend or other  distribution  on any class of stock of the
Company  payable  in  Common  Stock,  or  shall  effect  a  subdivision  of  the
outstanding  shares of Common  Stock  into a greater  number of shares of Common
Stock (by  reclassification or otherwise than by payment of a dividend in Common
Stock), then, and in each such case,  Additional Shares of Common Stock shall be
deemed to have been  issued  (a) in the case of any such  dividend,  immediately
after the close of business on the record date for the  determination of holders
of any class of securities entitled to receive such dividend, or (b) in the case
of any such  subdivision,  at the close of business on the day immediately prior
to the day upon which such corporate action becomes effective.

                  2.5.  COMPUTATION OF CONSIDERATION.  For the purposes
of this section 2:

                  (a) The  consideration for the issue or sale of any Additional
         Shares of Common Stock or for the issue,  sale,  grant or assumption of
         any Options or Convertible  Securities,  irrespective of the accounting
         treatment of such consideration, shall

                           (x) insofar as it  consists  of cash,  be computed at
                  the amount of cash received by the Company,  without deducting
                  any   expenses   paid  or  incurred  by  the  Company  or  any
                  commissions or  compensation  paid or concessions or discounts
                  allowed to underwriters, dealers or others

                                        8

                                      227
<PAGE>
                  performing similar services and any accrued interest or
                  dividends in connection with such issue or sale,

                           (y)   insofar  as  it   consists   of   consideration
                  (including  securities)  other than cash,  be  computed at the
                  fair  value  thereof  at the time of such  issue  or sale,  as
                  determined  in good  faith by the  Board of  Directors  of the
                  Company,  without  deducting  any expenses paid or incurred by
                  the  Company  for  any  commissions  or  compensation  paid or
                  concessions or discounts  allowed to underwriters,  dealers or
                  others performing similar services and any accrued interest or
                  dividends in connection with such issue or sale, and

                           (z) in case  Additional  Shares of  Common  Stock are
                  issued or sold or  Convertible  Securities  are issued,  sold,
                  granted or assumed  together with other stock or securities or
                  other assets of the Company for a  consideration  which covers
                  both,  be the  proportion of such  consideration  so received,
                  computed  as  provided  in  subdivisions  (x) and  (y)  above,
                  allocable  to  such  Additional  Shares  of  Common  Stock  or
                  Convertible Securities,  as the case may be, all as determined
                  in good faith by the Board of Directors of the Company.

                  (b) All options issued, sold, granted or assumed together with
         other  stock  or  securities  or  other  assets  of the  Company  for a
         consideration which covers both, all Additional Shares of Common Stock,
         Options or Convertible  Securities issued in payment of any dividend or
         other  distribution  on any  class  of  stock  of the  Company  and all
         Additional Shares of Common Stock issued to effect a subdivision of the
         outstanding  shares of Common Stock into a greater  number of shares of
         Common Stock (by  reclassification  or  otherwise  than by payment of a
         dividend in Common  Stock) shall be deemed to have been issued  without
         consideration.

                  (c)  Additional  Shares  of Common  Stock  deemed to have been
         issued for  consideration  pursuant to section 2.3, relating to Options
         and Convertible  Securities,  shall be deemed to have been issued for a
         consideration per share determined by dividing

                           (x) the total amount, if any, received and receivable
                  by the Company as consideration for the issue,  sale, grant or
                  assumption  of  the  Options  or  Convertible   Securities  in
                  question,  plus the  minimum  aggregate  amount of  additional
                  consideration (as set

                                        9

                                      228
<PAGE>
                  forth in the instruments  relating thereto,  without regard to
                  any provision contained therein for a subsequent adjustment of
                  such  consideration)  payable to the Company upon the exercise
                  in full of such Options or the  conversion or exchange of such
                  Convertible   Securities  or,  in  the  case  of  Options  for
                  Convertible  Securities,  the  exercise  of such  Options  for
                  Convertible  Securities and the conversion or exchange of such
                  Convertible   Securities,   in  each   case   computing   such
                  consideration as provided in the foregoing sub-

                  division (a), by

                           (y) the maximum  number of shares of Common Stock (as
                  set forth in the instruments relating thereto,  without regard
                  to any provision contained therein for a subsequent adjustment
                  of such number)  issuable upon the exercise of such Options or
                  the conversion or exchange of such Convertible Securities.

                  (d) Additional Shares of Common Stock issued or deemed to have
         been  issued  pursuant to the  operation  of  anti-dilution  provisions
         applicable to Convertible Securities (other than the Warrants), Options
         or  other  securities  of  the  Company  (either  as a  result  of  the
         adjustments  provided for by the Warrants or otherwise) shall be deemed
         to have been issued without consideration.

                  2.6.   ADJUSTMENTS   FOR   COMBINATIONS,   ETC.  In  case  the
outstanding  shares  of Common  Stock  shall be  combined  or  consolidated,  by
reclassification  or otherwise,  into a lesser number of shares of Common Stock,
the  Warrant  Price  in  effect   immediately   prior  to  such  combination  or
consolidation shall,  concurrently with the effectiveness of such combination or
consolidation, be proportionately increased.

                  2.7. DILUTION IN CASE OF OTHER  SECURITIES.  In case any Other
Securities shall be issued or sold or shall become subject to issue or sale upon
the conversion or exchange of any stock (or Other Securities) of the Company (or
any issuer of Other  Securities or any other Person referred to in section 3) or
to subscription, purchase or other acquisition pursuant to any Options issued or
granted by the Company (or any such other issuer or Person) for a  consideration
such as to dilute,  on a basis consistent with the standards  established in the
other provisions of this section 2, the purchase rights granted by this Warrant,
then, and in each such case, the  computations,  adjustments  and  readjustments
provided for in this  section 2 with respect to the Warrant  Price shall be made
as nearly as  possible in the manner so provided  and applied to  determine  the
amount of

                                       10

                                      229
<PAGE>
Other Securities from time to time receivable upon the exercise of the Warrants,
so as to  protect  the  holders  of the  Warrants  against  the  effect  of such
dilution.

                  2.8. MINIMUM ADJUSTMENT OF WARRANT PRICE. If the amount of any
adjustment  of the Warrant  Price  required  pursuant to this section 2 would be
less than  one-tenth  of one percent of the Warrant  Price in effect at the time
such  adjustment  is  otherwise  so  required to be made,  such amount  shall be
carried  forward and  adjustment  with  respect  thereto made at the time of and
together with any subsequent adjustment which, together with such amount and any
other amount or amounts so carried  forward,  shall aggregate at least one-tenth
of one percent of such Warrant Price;  PROVIDED that,  upon the exercise of this
Warrant,  all adjustments  carried  forward and not  theretofore  made up to and
including  the  date  of  such  exercise  shall  be  made  to  the  nearest  one
one-hundredth of a cent.

                  3. CONSOLIDATION, MERGER, SALE OF ASSETS, REORGANIZATION, ETC.
3.1. GENERAL PROVISIONS.  In case the Company, after the Initial Date, (a) shall
consolidate  with or merge into any other Person and shall not be the continuing
or surviving  corporation of such  consolidation or merger,  or (b) shall permit
any other Person to  consolidate  with or merge into the Company and the Company
shall be the  continuing  or  surviving  Person  but,  in  connection  with such
consolidation or merger,  Common Stock or Other Securities shall be changed into
or  exchanged  for cash,  stock or other  securities  of any other Person or any
other property, or (c) shall transfer all or substantially all of its properties
and assets to any other Person, or (d) shall effect a capital  reorganization or
reclassification  of  Common  Stock or Other  Securities  (other  than a capital
reorganization or  reclassification  resulting in the issue of Additional Shares
of Common Stock for which adjustment in the Warrant Price is provided in section
2.2.1 or 2.2.2),  then,  and in the case of each such  transaction,  the Company
shall give written notice thereof to each holder of any Warrant not less than 30
days prior to the  consummation  thereof and proper  provision  shall be made so
that, upon the basis and the terms and in the manner provided in this section 3,
the  holder of this  Warrant,  upon the  exercise  hereof at any time  after the
consummation of such transaction, shall be entitled to receive, at the aggregate
Warrant  Price in effect at the time of such  consummation  for all Common Stock
(or other  Securities)  issuable  upon such exercise  immediately  prior to such
consummation,  in lieu of the Common Stock (or Other  Securities)  issuable upon
such  exercise  prior to such  consummation,  either of the  following,  as such
holder  shall  elect by  written  notice to the  Company  on or before  the date
immediately preceding the date of the consumma-

                                       11

                                      230
<PAGE>
tion of such transaction (and, in the absence of such notice,  the provisions of
subdivision (y) below shall be deemed to have been elected by such holder):

                  (x) the highest  amount of cash,  securities or other property
         to which such holder would actually have been entitled as a shareholder
         upon such  consummation  if such  holder  had  exercised  this  Warrant
         immediately prior thereto,  subject to adjustments  (subsequent to such
         consummation)  as nearly  equivalent  as  possible  to the  adjustments
         provided  for in  section  2 and this  section  3,  PROVIDED  that if a
         purchase, tender or exchange offer shall have been made to and accepted
         by the  holders of Common  Stock  under  circumstances  in which,  upon
         completion  of such  purchase,  tender  or  exchange  offer,  the maker
         thereof,  together  with  members of any group  (within  the meaning of
         Section  13(d)(3) of the  Exchange  Act) of which such maker is a part,
         and together  with any affiliate or associate of such maker (within the
         meaning of Rule 12b-2  under the  Exchange  Act) and any members of any
         such group of which any such  affiliate  or  associate  is a part,  own
         beneficially  (within the meaning of Rule 13d-3 under the Exchange Act)
         more than 50% of the  outstanding  shares of Common  Stock,  and if the
         holder  of this  Warrant  so  designates  in such  notice  given to the
         Company,  the holder of this  Warrant  shall be entitled to receive the
         highest  amount of cash,  securities  or other  property  to which such
         holder would actually have been entitled as a shareholder if the holder
         of this Warrant had exercised  this Warrant prior to the  expiration of
         such purchase, tender or exchange offer, accepted such offer and all of
         the Common  Stock held by such  holder had been  purchased  pursuant to
         such purchase,  tender or exchange offer,  subject to adjustments (from
         and after the consummation of such purchase,  tender or exchange offer)
         as nearly  equivalent  as possible to the  adjustments  provided for in
         section 2 and this section 3; or

                  (y) the number of shares of Voting Common Stock (or equivalent
         equity  interests) of the Acquiring  Person or, if the Acquiring Person
         fails to meet, but its Parent meets,  the requirements set forth in the
         proviso below,  of its Parent,  subject to  adjustments  (subsequent to
         such  corporate  action)  as  nearly  equivalent  as  possible  to  the
         adjustments provided for in section 2 and this section 3, determined by
         dividing  (i) the  product  obtained by  multiplying  (A) the number of
         shares of Common  Stock (or Other  Securities)  to which the  holder of
         this Warrant  would have been entitled had such holder  exercised  this
         Warrant  immediately  prior to the  consummation  of such  transaction,
         times (B) the greater

                                       12

                                      231
<PAGE>
         of the  Acquisition  Price and the Warrant  Price in effect on the date
         immediately  preceding  the  date of  such  consummation,  by (ii)  the
         Current  Market  Price  per  share  of  the  Voting  Common  Stock  (or
         equivalent  equity interests) of the Acquiring Person or its Parent, as
         the case may be,  on the date  immediately  preceding  the date of such
         consummation;

PROVIDED that the Company shall not effect any of the transactions  described in
subdivisions  (a) through (d) above  unless,  immediately  after the date of the
consummation of such transaction, the Acquiring Person or its Parent is required
to file,  by virtue of having an  outstanding  class of Voting  Common Stock (or
equivalent equity interests), reports with the Commission pursuant to section 13
or section  15(d) of the  Exchange  Act,  and such Voting  Stock (or  equivalent
equity  interest)  is listed or  admitted  to trading  on a national  securities
exchange or is quoted in the NASD automated  quotation system. In the event that
the Acquiring  Person  fulfills the  requirements  contained in the  immediately
preceding proviso,  then, if the holder of this Warrant shall elect (or shall be
deemed to elect) to receive Voting Common Stock (or equivalent equity interests)
pursuant to  subdivision  (y) above,  such holder  shall be entitled to receive,
upon the basis stated in such  subdivision (y), only the Voting Common Stock (or
equivalent equity interests) of the Acquiring Person.

                  3.2.  ASSUMPTION  OF  OBLIGATIONS.   Notwithstanding  anything
contained in this Warrant or the Purchase Agreement to the contrary, the Company
will not effect any of the  transactions  described in subdivisions  (a) through
(d) of section 3.1 unless, prior to the consummation thereof, each Person (other
than the  Company)  which may be required  to deliver  any cash,  stock or other
securities  or other  property  upon the  exercise  of this  Warrant as provided
herein  shall  assume,  by  written  instrument  delivered  to,  and  reasonably
satisfactory to, the holder of this Warrant,  (a) the obligations of the Company
under this Warrant (and if the Company  shall survive the  consummation  of such
transaction,  such assumption shall be in addition to, and shall not release the
Company from, any continuing  obligations of the Company under this Warrant) and
(b) the  obligation  to  deliver  to such  holder  such  cash,  stock  or  other
securities or other property as, in accordance with the foregoing  provisions of
this  section 3, such holder may be entitled to receive,  and such Person  shall
have  similarly  delivered to such holder an opinion of counsel for such Person,
which counsel shall be reasonably satisfactory to such holder, stating that this
Warrant shall thereafter  continue in full force and effect and the terms hereof
(including, without limitation, all of the provisions of section

                                       13

                                      232
<PAGE>
2 and this section 3) shall be applicable to the cash, stock or other securities
or other property which such Person may be required to deliver upon any exercise
of this Warrant or the exercise of any rights pursuant  hereto.  Nothing in this
section 3 or in section 7 shall be deemed to authorize the Company to enter into
any transaction not otherwise permitted by the Purchase Agreement.

                  4. OTHER DILUTIVE EVENTS.  In case any event shall occur as to
which the  provisions of section 2 or section 3 are not strictly  applicable but
the failure to make any adjustment  would not fairly protect the purchase rights
represented  by this  Warrant  in  accordance  with  the  essential  intent  and
principles of such sections,  then, in each such case, the Company shall appoint
a firm of independent public accountants of recognized  national standing (which
may be the regular auditors of the Company), which shall give their opinion upon
the  adjustment,  if any, on a basis  consistent  with the essential  intent and
principles  established  in sections 2 and 3,  necessary  to  preserve,  without
dilution,  the purchase rights represented by this Warrant. Upon receipt of such
opinion  the Company  will  promptly  mail a copy  thereof to the holder of this
Warrant and shall make the adjustments described therein.

                  5. NO  DILUTION  OR  IMPAIRMENT.  The  Company  will  not,  by
amendment of its  certificate  of  incorporation  or through any  consolidation,
merger,  reorganization,  transfer  of  assets,  dissolution,  issue  or sale of
securities or any other voluntary action,  avoid or seek to avoid the observance
or  performance  of any of the terms of this  Warrant,  but will at all times in
good faith assist in the carrying out of all such terms and in the taking of all
such action as may be necessary or appropriate in order to protect the rights of
the  holder  of this  Warrant  against  dilution  or other  impairment.  Without
limiting the  generality of the  foregoing,  the Company (a) will not permit the
par value of any shares of stock receivable upon the exercise of this Warrant to
exceed the amount payable  therefor upon such  exercise,  (b) will take all such
action as may be necessary or  appropriate in order that the Company may validly
and legally issue fully paid and nonassessable shares of stock upon the exercise
of all of the Warrants from time to time outstanding,  and (c) will not take any
action which results in any  adjustment of the Warrant Price if the total number
of shares of Common Stock (or Other  Securities)  issuable after the action upon
the exercise of all of the  Warrants  would exceed the total number of shares of
Common Stock (or other Securities) then authorized by the Company's  certificate
of incorporation and available for the purpose of issue upon such exercise.

                                       14

                                      233
<PAGE>
                  6. ACCOUNTANTS' REPORT AS TO ADJUSTMENTS.  In each case of any
adjustment or readjustment  in the shares of Common Stock (or Other  Securities)
issuable  upon the  exercise of the  Warrants,  the Company at its expense  will
promptly compute such adjustment or readjustment in accordance with the terms of
the Warrants,  and will prepare a certificate of the chief financial  officer of
the  Company  setting  forth such  adjustment  or  readjustment  and  showing in
reasonable  detail the method of  calculation  thereof  and the facts upon which
such  adjustment  or  readjustment  is based,  including  without  limitation  a
statement of (a) the consideration received or to be received by the Company for
any  Additional  Shares  of Common  Stock  issued or sold or deemed to have been
issued,  (b) the number of shares of Common  Stock  outstanding  or deemed to be
outstanding, and (c) the Warrant Price in effect immediately prior to such issue
or sale and as adjusted  and  readjusted  (if  required by section 2) on account
thereof. The Company will forthwith mail a copy of each such certificate to each
holder of a Warrant and will, upon the written request at any time of any holder
of a  Warrant,  furnish  to such  holder a like  certificate  setting  forth the
Warrant Price at the time in effect and showing in reasonable  detail how it was
calculated.  In addition,  with respect to any fiscal year of the Company during
which any such adjustment or readjustment shall have been made, the Company will
cause the independent public accountants  reporting upon the Company's financial
statements for such fiscal year to verify,  concurrently with their annual audit
of the Company's  financial  statements,  the  computations  made by the Company
during  such  fiscal  year and to prepare  and to  deliver  to each  holder of a
Warrant a report setting forth substantially the information  described above in
this  section 6 with  respect to all such  adjustments  and  readjustments.  The
Company  will  also keep  copies of all such  certificates  and  reports  at its
principal  office and will cause the same to be available for inspection at such
office  during  normal  business  hours  by  any  holder  of a  Warrant  or  any
prospective purchaser of a Warrant designated by the holder thereof.


                  7. NOTICES OF CORPORATE ACTION. In the event of

                  (a) any taking by the  Company  of a record of the  holders of
         any class of  securities  for the  purpose of  determining  the holders
         thereof who are entitled to receive any dividend or other distribution,
         or any right to subscribe for, purchase or otherwise acquire any shares
         of stock of any  class  or any  other  securities  or  property,  or to
         receive any other right, or

                  (b)  any capital reorganization of the Company, any
         reclassification or recapitalization of the capital stock of

                                       15

                                      234
<PAGE>
         the Company or any consolidation or merger involving the
         Company and any other Person or any transfer of all or
         substantially all the assets of the Company to any other
         Person, or

                  (c)  any voluntary or involuntary dissolution,
         liquidation or winding-up of the Company,

the Company  will mail to each holder of a Warrant a notice  specifying  (x) the
date or expected date on which any such record is to be taken for the purpose of
such  dividend,  distribution  or right,  and the amount and  character  of such
dividend,  distribution or right, and (y) the date or expected date on which any
such reorganization, reclassification,  recapitalization, consolidation, merger,
transfer, dissolution,  liquidation or winding-up is to take place and the time,
if any such time is to be fixed,  as of which  the  holders  of record of Common
Stock (or Other Securities) shall be entitled to exchange their shares of Common
Stock (or Other  Securities)  for the securities or other  property  deliverable
upon such  reorganization,  reclassification,  recapitalization,  consolidation,
merger, transfer,  dissolution,  liquidation or winding-up. Such notice shall be
mailed at least 20 days prior to the date therein specified,  in the case of any
date referred to in the foregoing subdivision (x), and at least 30 days prior to
the date therein specified, in the case of the date referred to in the foregoing
subdivision (y).

          8. RESTRICTIONS ON TRANSFER. 8.1. RESTRICTIVE LEGENDS. Except
as  otherwise  permitted  by this  section  8, each  Warrant  originally  issued
pursuant  to the  Purchase  Agreement  and each  Warrant  issued  upon direct or
indirect  Transfer or in  substitution  for any  Warrant  pursuant to section 13
shall be stamped  or  otherwise  imprinted  with a legend in  substantially  the
following form:

         "This Warrant and any shares acquired upon the exercise of this Warrant
         have not been  registered  under the Securities Act of 1933 and may not
         be transferred  except in compliance with such Act and applicable state
         securities  laws.  This  Warrant  and such  shares are also  subject to
         certain  restrictions  on  transferability   imposed  by  Common  Stock
         Purchase Warrants expiring June 30, 2004, a copy of which is on file at
         the offices of the Company."

Except as otherwise  permitted by this  section 8, each  certificate  for Common
Stock (or Other  Securities)  issued  upon the  exercise of any Warrant and each
certificate issued upon the direct or indirect Transfer of any such Common Stock
(or Other Securities)
                                       16

                                      235
<PAGE>
shall be stamped  or  otherwise  imprinted  with a legend in  substantially  the
following form:

         "The shares  represented by this  certificate  have not been registered
         under the Securities  Act of 1933 and may not be transferred  except in
         compliance  with such Act and applicable  state  securities  laws. Such
         shares  are also  subject to certain  restrictions  on  transferability
         imposed by Common Stock  Purchase  Warrants  expiring  June 30, 2004, a
         copy of which is on file at the offices of the Company."

                  8.2. NOTICE OF PROPOSED TRANSFER;  OPINIONS OF COUNSEL.  Prior
to any Transfer of any Restricted  Securities  which are not registered under an
effective registration statement under the Securities Act (other than a Transfer
pursuant to Rule 144 or any comparable  rule under such Act), the holder thereof
will give  written  notice to the Company of such  holder's  intention to effect
such  Transfer and to comply in all other  respects  with this section 8.2. Each
such notice (a) shall  describe  the manner and  circumstances  of the  proposed
Transfer in sufficient  detail to enable counsel to render the opinions referred
to below, and (b) shall designate counsel for the holder giving such notice (who
may be internal  counsel for such  holder).  The holder  giving such notice will
submit a copy thereof to the counsel  designated  in such notice and the Company
will promptly  submit a copy thereof to its counsel.  The  following  provisions
shall then apply:

                  (x) If in the  opinion  of such  counsel  for the  holder  the
         proposed Transfer may be effected without registration (a copy of which
         opinion  shall be  delivered  to the  Company),  and if such opinion is
         reasonably  satisfactory to the Company, such holder shall thereupon be
         entitled to Transfer such Restricted  Securities in accordance with the
         terms of the  notice  delivered  by such  holder to the  Company.  Each
         Warrant or certificate,  if any, issued upon or in connection with such
         Transfer  shall bear the  appropriate  restrictive  legend set forth in
         section 8.1 unless,  in the opinion of such  counsel and the  Company's
         counsel,  such legend is no longer  required to insure  compliance with
         the Securities Act.

                  (y) If the  opinion of such  counsel  for the holder is not to
         the effect that the proposed  Transfer may legally be effected  without
         registration  of such Restricted  Securities  under the Securities Act,
         such  holder  shall  not  be  entitled  to  Transfer  such   Restricted
         Securities  (other  than in a  Transfer  pursuant  to  Rule  144 or any
         comparable   rule  under  the  Securities  Act)  until  the  conditions
         specified in
                                       17

                                      236
<PAGE>
         subdivision (x) above shall be satisfied or until  registration of such
         Restricted Securities under the Securities Act has become effective.

Notwithstanding the foregoing  provisions of this section 8.2, the holder of any
Restricted  Securities  shall be  permitted  to  Transfer  any  such  Restricted
Securities  pursuant to Rule 144A under the Securities  Act,  PROVIDED that each
transferee  agrees in writing to be bound by all the restrictions on transfer of
such Restricted Securities contained in this section 8.2.

                  8.3. TERMINATION OF RESTRICTIONS.  The restrictions imposed by
this section 8 upon the transferability of Restricted Securities shall cease and
terminate as to any particular  Restricted  Securities (a) when such  securities
shall have been effectively  registered under the Securities Act and disposed of
in  accordance  with  the  registration   statement   covering  such  Restricted
Securities, (b) when, in the opinions of both counsel for the holder thereof and
counsel for the Company,  such  restrictions  are no longer required in order to
insure compliance with the Securities Act, or (c) when such securities have been
beneficially owned, by a person who has not been an affiliate of the Company for
at least three months,  for a period of at least three years,  all as determined
under  Rule 144 under the  Securities  Act.  Whenever  such  restrictions  shall
terminate as to any Restricted Securities, as soon as practicable thereafter and
in any event within ten Business  Days,  the holder thereof shall be entitled to
receive from the Company,  without  expense (other than transfer taxes, if any),
new  securities  of like tenor not  bearing the  applicable  legend set forth in
section 8.1 hereof.

                  9. REGISTRATION  UNDER SECURITIES ACT, ETC. 9.1.  REGISTRATION
ON REQUEST.  (a) REQUEST.  At any time and from time to time after  December 30,
1994,  upon the written request of one or more  Initiating  Holders,  requesting
that the Company effect the registration under the Securities Act of all or part
of such Initiating Holders'  Registrable  Securities and specifying the intended
method of disposition  thereof, the Company will promptly give written notice of
such  requested   registration   to  all  holders  of  outstanding   Registrable
Securities,  and thereupon will use its best efforts to effect its  registration
under the Securities Act, including by means of a shelf registration pursuant to
Rule 415 under the  Securities  Act if so  requested in such request (but in the
case of a shelf  registration  only if the Company is then  eligible to use Form
S-2 or S-3 (or any successor forms)), of

                  (x) the Registrable  Securities  which the Company has been so
         requested to register by such Initiating Holder or

                                       18

                                      237
<PAGE>
         Holders for  disposition  in  accordance  with the  intended  method of
         disposition stated in such request, and

                  (y) all other Registrable Securities the Holders of which have
         made written requests to the Company for registration thereof within 20
         Business  Days after the giving of such  written  notice by the Company
         (which  request  shall  specify  the  intended  method  of  disposition
         thereof),

all to the extent  requisite to permit the  disposition  (in accordance with the
intended  methods thereof as aforesaid) of the  Registrable  Securities so to be
registered;  PROVIDED  that the  Company  shall not be  required  to effect  the
registration pursuant to this section 9.1 of any Warrants (but shall be required
to effect the  registration of Registrable  Securities  described in clauses (b)
and (c) of the definition of  Registrable  Securities),  and PROVIDED,  FURTHER,
that  any  holder  of  Registrable   Securities  to  be  included  in  any  such
registration, by written notice to the Company within 10 Business Days after its
receipt of a copy of a notice from the managing  underwriter  delivered pursuant
to section  9.1(g),  may withdraw such request and, on receipt of such notice of
the withdrawal of such request from holders  comprising  the Requisite  Holders,
the Company may elect not to effect such  registration.  Subject to  subdivision
(g) the Company may include in such  registration  other securities for sale for
its own account or for the account of any other Person.

                  (b) NUMBER OF REGISTRATIONS. The Company shall not be required
to effect more than one registration pursuant to this section 9.1, PROVIDED that
such  registration  shall  permit  the  disposition  of  at  least  80%  of  the
Registrable  Securities  which the Company has been so  requested  to  register,
PROVIDED,  FURTHER,  that if one or more such  registrations,  in the aggregate,
shall not permit the disposition of at least 80% of such Registrable Securities,
the Company  shall be required to effect  additional  registrations  pursuant to
this section 9.1 until they have  permitted the  disposition  of at least 80% of
such Registrable Securities.

                  (c) REGISTRATION STATEMENT FORM. The Company may, if permitted
by law, effect any  registration  requested under this section 9.1 by the filing
of a registration  statement on Form S-3 (or any successor or similar short form
registration  statement)  unless the  holders  holding  at least a majority  (by
number of shares) of the  Registrable  Securities as to which such  registration
relates (and, if such registration  involves an underwritten  Public Offering of
such Registrable  Securities,  the managing underwriter of such Public Offering)
shall notify the Company in writing  that, in the judgment of such holders (and,
if

                                       19

                                      238
<PAGE>
applicable,  such  managing  underwriter),  the  use  of a  more  detailed  form
specified in such notice is of material  importance to the success of the Public
Offering of such Registrable  Securities,  in which case such registration shall
be effected on the form so specified.

                  (d) EXPENSES.  The Company will pay all Registration  Expenses
in connection with any registration  and sale effected  pursuant to this section
9.1.

                  (e) SELECTION OF  UNDERWRITERS.  If, in the  discretion of the
holders of a majority (by number of shares) of the Registrable  Securities,  any
offering pursuant to this section 9.1 shall constitute an underwritten offering,
the underwriter or underwriters  thereof shall be selected,  after  consultation
with the Company, by such holders and shall be acceptable to the Company,  which
shall  not   unreasonably   withhold  its  acceptance  of  such  underwriter  or
underwriters.

                  (f) EFFECTIVE REGISTRATION STATEMENT. A registration requested
pursuant to this section 9.1 will not be deemed to have been effected (x) unless
it has become  effective,  provided  that a  registration  which does not become
effective  after the Company has filed a  registration  statement  with  respect
thereto  solely by reason of the  refusal to proceed of the  Initiating  Holders
shall be deemed to have been  effected  by the  Company  at the  request of such
Initiating Holders, unless such Initiating Holders shall have elected to pay all
Registration Expenses in connection with such registration, (y) if, after it has
become  effective,  such  registration  is  interfered  with by any stop  order,
injunction or other order or requirement of the Commission or other governmental
agency or court,  or (z) if the conditions to closing  specified in the purchase
agreement  or  underwriting  agreement  entered  into in  connection  with  such
registration  are not satisfied  other than by reason of some act or omission by
such Initiating Holders.

                  (g)  PRIORITY  IN  REQUESTED  REGISTRATIONS.  If  a  requested
registration pursuant to this section 9.1 involves an underwritten offering, and
the managing  underwriter  shall  advise the Company in writing  (with a copy to
each holder of  Registrable  Securities  requesting  registration)  that, in its
opinion,  the number of securities requested to be included in such registration
(including  securities  of the  Company  which are not  Registrable  Securities)
exceeds the number which can be sold in such offering,  the Company will include
in any such  registration  to the extent of the number  which the  Company is so
advised can be sold in such offering (x) first, Registrable Securities requested
to be included in such registration by the holder or

                                       20

                                      239
<PAGE>
holders of  Registrable  Securities  pro rata among such holders on the basis of
the number of Registrable  Securities  requested to be included by such holders,
and (y) second,  other securities of the Company proposed to be included in such
registration, in accordance with the priorities, if any, then existing among the
Company and the holders of such other securities.

                  (h)  COMPANY  REQUEST  FOR  DELAY.  Except  with  respect to a
registration  statement  covering a shelf  registration,  the  Company  shall be
entitled to postpone  for a  reasonable  period of time (but not  exceeding  180
days) the filing of any registration statement otherwise required to be prepared
and filed by it pursuant to this  section 9.1 if the Board of  Directors  of the
Company  determines,  in its reasonable  judgment,  that such  registration  and
offering   would   interfere   with  any   financing,   acquisition,   corporate
reorganization or other material transaction involving the Company or any of its
affiliates and promptly gives the holders of Registrable  Securities  requesting
registration  thereof  pursuant  to this  section  9.1  written  notice  of such
determination,   containing  a  general   statement  of  the  reasons  for  such
postponement  and  approximation  of the anticipated  delay. The Company may not
postpone a filing under this section  9.1(h) more than once in any  twelve-month
period. If the Company shall so postpone the filing of a registration statement,
holders of Registrable  Securities  requesting  registration thereof pursuant to
section 9.1,  representing not less than 15% of the Registrable  Securities with
respect to which registration has been requested, and constituting not less than
50% of the Initiating Holders,  shall have the right to withdraw the request for
registration  by giving  written  notice  to the  Company  within 30 days  after
receipt of the notice of postponement and, in the event of such withdrawal, such
request  shall not be counted for purposes of the requests for  registration  to
which holders of Registrable Securities are entitled pursuant to section 9.1.

                  (i) SHELF REGISTRATION STATEMENT.  The Company shall be deemed
to have complied  with a request for  registration  made by  Initiating  Holders
pursuant to this section 9.1 if, at the time of such request,  there shall be an
effective shelf registration  statement on file with the Commission  pursuant to
Rule 415 under the Securities Act covering the Registrable Securities which such
holders shall have requested to be registered,  if such  registration  statement
complies  with the  provisions of this section 9.1 and of section 9.3 and if the
Company otherwise fulfills the requirements of section 9.1 and 9.3 in respect of
such registration.
                                       21

                                      240
<PAGE>
                  9.2. INCIDENTAL REGISTRATION. (A) RIGHT TO INCLUDE REGISTRABLE
SECURITIES.  Notwithstanding  any  limitation  contained  in section 9.1, if the
Company at any time on or prior to June 30, 2004 proposes to register any of its
securities under the Securities Act (other than by a registration on Form S-4 or
S-8 or any  successor  or  similar  forms),  whether or not for sale for its own
account, in a manner which would permit  registration of Registrable  Securities
for sale to the public  under the  Securities  Act,  it will each such time give
prompt written notice to all holders of Registrable  Securities of its intention
to do so and of such  holders'  rights under this section 9.2.  Upon the written
request of any such holder made within 20 days after  receipt of any such notice
(which request shall specify the Registrable  Securities intended to be disposed
of by such holder and the intended method of disposition  thereof),  the Company
will use its best efforts to effect the registration under the Securities Act of
all Registrable  Securities  which the Company has been so requested to register
by the holders  thereof,  to the extent  requisite to permit the disposition (in
accordance  with the intended  methods  thereof as aforesaid) of the Registrable
Securities so to be registered,  by inclusion of such Registrable  Securities in
the  registration  statement  which  covers  the  securities  which the  Company
proposes to  register,  PROVIDED  that (x) the Company  shall not be required to
effect the registration  pursuant to this section 9.2 of any Warrants (but shall
be required to effect the  registration of Registrable  Securities  described in
clauses (b) and (c) of the definition of Registrable  Securities) and (y) if, at
any time after giving written notice of its intention to register any securities
and  prior  to  the  effective  date  of the  registration  statement  filed  in
connection  with such  registration,  the Company shall determine for any reason
not to register or to delay registration of such securities, the Company may, at
its  election,  give  written  notice of such  determination  to each  holder of
Registrable Securities and, thereupon, (i) in the case of a determination not to
register,  shall be  relieved of its  obligation  to  register  any  Registrable
Securities in connection with such  registration (but not from its obligation to
pay the  Registration  Expenses in  connection  therewith),  without  prejudice,
however,  to the  rights of any  holder or  holders  of  Registrable  Securities
entitled  to  do  so  to  request  that  such  registration  be  effected  as  a
registration under section 9.1, and (ii) in the case of a determination to delay
registering,  shall be permitted to delay registering any Registrable Securities
for the same  period as the  delay in  registering  such  other  securities.  No
registration  effected  under this section 9.2 shall  relieve the Company of its
obligation to effect any registration  statement upon request under section 9.1.
The Company will pay all Registration

                                       22

                                      241
<PAGE>
Expenses  in  connection  with  each  registration  of  Registrable   Securities
requested pursuant to this section 9.2.

                  (b) PRIORITY IN INCIDENTAL  REGISTRATIONS.  If a  registration
pursuant to this section 9.2 involves an underwritten  offering and the managing
underwriter  advises the Company in writing that, in its opinion,  the number of
securities  requested  to be  included in such  registration  exceeds the number
which  can  be  sold  in  such  offering,  the  Company  will  include  in  such
registration  to the extent of the number which the Company is so advised can be
sold in such offering securities determined as follows:

                  (x) if such registration as initially  proposed by the Company
         was solely a primary  registration  of its securities,  (i) first,  the
         securities proposed by the Company to be sold for its own account, (ii)
         second,  any  Registrable  Securities  requested to be included in such
         registration,  pro rata  among  the  holders  thereof  requesting  such
         registration  on the basis of the  number of shares of such  securities
         requested to be included by such  holders,  and (iii) third,  any other
         securities of the Company proposed to be included in such registration,
         in accordance  with the  priorities,  if any,  then existing  among the
         Company and the holders of such other securities, and

                  (y) if such registration as initially  proposed by the Company
         was in whole or in part  requested  by  holders  of  securities  of the
         Company,  other than  holders of  Registrable  Securities,  pursuant to
         demand  registration  rights,  (i) first,  such  securities held by the
         holders   initiating   such   registration,   in  accordance  with  the
         priorities,  if any, then existing among the Company and the holders of
         such securities,  (ii) second, any Registrable  Securities requested to
         be included in such  registration,  pro rata among the holders  thereof
         requesting  such  registration  on the basis of the number of shares of
         such  securities  requested  to be included  by such  holders and (iii)
         third,  any other  securities of the Company proposed to be included in
         such  registration,  in accordance  with the  priorities,  if any, then
         existing among the Company and the holders of such other securities.

                  9.3. Registration Procedures.  If and whenever (x) the Company
is  required  to  use  its  best  efforts  to  effect  the  registration  of any
Registrable  Securities under the Securities Act as provided in sections 9.1 and
9.2 or (y) there is a Requesting Holder in connection with any other proposed

                                       23

                                      242
<PAGE>
registration  by the Company  under the  Securities  Act,  the  Company  will as
expeditiously as possible:

                  (a)  prepare  and  file  with  the  Commission  the  requisite
         registration  statement (including such audited financial statements as
         may be  required  by the  Securities  Act or the rules and  regulations
         promulgated  thereunder) to effect such  registration  and use its best
         efforts  to cause  such  registration  statement  to become  effective,
         PROVIDED  that  before  filing  such  registration   statement  or  any
         amendments thereto, the Company will furnish to the counsel selected by
         the holders of Registrable  Securities whose Registrable Securities are
         to be  included  in such  registration  copies  of all  such  documents
         proposed to be filed,  which documents will be subject to the review of
         such counsel, and PROVIDED,  FURTHER,  that the Company may discontinue
         any registration of its securities which are not Registrable Securities
         at any time prior to the effective date of the  registration  statement
         relating thereto;

                  (b) prepare and file with the Commission  such  amendments and
         supplements to such  registration  statement and the prospectus used in
         connection  therewith as may be necessary to maintain the effectiveness
         of such registration statement and to comply with the provisions of the
         Securities  Act  with  respect  to the  disposition  of all  securities
         covered by such  registration  statement until the earlier of such time
         as all of such  securities have been disposed of in accordance with the
         intended  methods of disposition  by the seller or sellers  thereof set
         forth in such  registration  statement  and the  expiration  of 90 days
         after  such  registration  statement  becomes  effective,  except  with
         respect to any such  registration  statement filed pursuant to Rule 415
         (or any successor  Rule) under the  Securities  Act, in which case such
         period shall be 2 years;

                  (c) furnish to each seller of Registrable  Securities  covered
         by such  registration  statement and each Requesting Holder such number
         of conformed  copies of such  registration  statement  and of each such
         amendment and supplement thereto (in each case including all exhibits),
         such number of copies of the prospectus  contained in such registration
         statement  (including  each  preliminary  prospectus  and  any  summary
         prospectus)  and any other  prospectus  filed  under Rule 424 under the
         Securities Act, in conformity  with the  requirements of the Securities
         Act, and such other documents, as such seller may reasonably request;

                                       24

                                      243
<PAGE>
                  (d)  use  its  best   efforts  to   register  or  qualify  all
         Registrable   Securities   and  other   securities   covered   by  such
         registration  statement under such other securities or blue sky laws of
         such  jurisdictions  as each seller thereof and each Requesting  Holder
         shall reasonably request, to keep such registration or qualification in
         effect for so long as such  registration  statement  remains in effect,
         and  take  any  other  action  which  may be  reasonably  necessary  or
         advisable to enable such seller to consummate  the  disposition in such
         jurisdictions of the securities  owned by such seller,  except that the
         Company shall not for any such purpose be required to qualify generally
         to do business as a foreign corporation in any jurisdiction  wherein it
         would not but for the requirements of this subdivision (d) be obligated
         to be so qualified  or to consent to general  service of process in any
         such jurisdiction;

                  (e) use its best efforts to cause all  Registrable  Securities
         covered  by  such  registration  statement  to be  registered  with  or
         approved by such other  governmental  agencies or authorities as may be
         necessary  to enable the seller or sellers  thereof to  consummate  the
         disposition of such Registrable Securities;

                  (f) furnish to each seller of Registrable  Securities and each
         Requesting Holder a signed  counterpart,  addressed to such seller (and
         the underwriters, if any), of

                           (x) an opinion of counsel for the Company,  dated the
                  effective date of such  registration  statement  (and, if such
                  registration  includes an underwritten Public Offering,  dated
                  the date of any  closing  under the  underwriting  agreement),
                  reasonably  satisfactory in form and substance to such seller,
                  and

                           (y) a "comfort"  letter,  dated the effective date of
                  such   registration   statement  (and,  if  such  registration
                  includes an underwritten  Public  Offering,  dated the date of
                  any closing under the underwriting  agreement),  signed by the
                  independent   public   accountants   who  have  certified  the
                  Company's  financial  statements included in such registration
                  statement (it being  understood that such letter,  if the cost
                  thereof does not constitute a "Registration Expense", is to be
                  delivered  only at the  request of, and at the expense of, any
                  seller of Registrable Securities or Requesting Holder),

                                       25

                                      244
<PAGE>
         covering   substantially   the  same   matters  with  respect  to  such
         registration  statement (and the prospectus  included  therein) and, in
         the case of the accountants'  letter, with respect to events subsequent
         to the date of such financial statements, as are customarily covered in
         opinions of issuer's counsel and in accountants'  letters  delivered to
         the underwriters in underwritten Public Offerings of securities and, in
         the case of the accountants'  letter,  such other financial matters, as
         such seller (or the underwriters, if any) may reasonably request;

                  (g)  immediately   notify  each  seller  of  such  Registrable
         Securities,  and (if requested by any such seller)  confirm such advice
         in writing,  (w) when the  prospectus or any  prospectus  supplement or
         post-effective  amendment  has been  filed,  and,  with  respect to the
         registration statement or any post-effective  amendment,  when the same
         has  become  effective,  (x)  of any  request  by  the  Commission  for
         amendments  or  supplements  to  the  registration   statement  or  the
         prospectus or for  additional  information,  (y) of the issuance by the
         Commission  of any  stop  order  suspending  the  effectiveness  of the
         registration  statement or the initiation of any  proceedings  for that
         purpose and (z) of the receipt by the Company of any notification  with
         respect  to the  suspension  of the  qualification  of the  Registrable
         Securities  for  sale  in  any   jurisdiction   or  the  initiation  or
         threatening of any proceeding for such purpose;

                  (h) use its  reasonable  best efforts to obtain the withdrawal
         of any order suspending the effectiveness of the registration statement
         at the earliest possible time;

                  (i) immediately  notify each holder of Registrable  Securities
         covered by such registration  statement and each Requesting  Holder, at
         any time when a prospectus relating thereto is required to be delivered
         under the Securities  Act, of the happening of any event as a result of
         which the prospectus included in such registration  statement,  as then
         in effect,  includes an untrue statement of a material fact or omits to
         state any material fact  required to be stated  therein or necessary to
         make  the  statements  therein  not  misleading  in  the  light  of the
         circumstances  under  which they were made,  and at the  request of any
         such holder  promptly  prepare and furnish to such seller a  reasonable
         number of copies of a supplement to or an amendment of such  prospectus
         as may be necessary so that, as thereafter  delivered to the purchasers
         of such  securities,  such  prospectus  shall  not  include  an  untrue
         statement of a material  fact or omit to state a material fact required
         to
                                       26

                                      245
<PAGE>
         be stated  therein or  necessary  to make the  statements  therein  not
         misleading  in the light of the  circumstances  under  which  they were
         made;

                  (j)  otherwise  use  its  best  efforts  to  comply  with  all
         applicable rules and regulations of the commission,  and make available
         to its security holders, as soon as reasonably practicable, an earnings
         statement  covering the period of at least twelve months,  but not more
         than eighteen  months,  beginning  with the first full  calendar  month
         after the effective date of such registration statement, which earnings
         statement  shall  satisfy  the  provisions  of  Section  11(a)  of  the
         Securities  Act,  and not  file any  amendment  or  supplement  to such
         registration  statement or  prospectus  to which any such seller or any
         Requesting  Holder shall have  reasonably  objected on the grounds that
         such amendment or supplement  does not comply in all material  respects
         with  the  requirements  of  the  Securities  Act or of  the  rules  or
         regulations  thereunder,  having been  furnished with a copy thereof at
         least five business days prior to the filing thereof;

                  (k) provide and cause to be  maintained  a transfer  agent and
         registrar for all Registrable  Securities  covered by such registration
         statement  not  later  than  the  effective  date of such  registration
         statement;

                  (l) cooperate with the sellers of such Registrable  Securities
         to  facilitate  the timely  preparation  and  delivery of  certificates
         representing  Registrable Securities to be sold, which securities shall
         not bear any  restrictive  legends and shall be in a form  eligible for
         deposit with The Depository Trust Company;  and enable such Registrable
         Securities to be in such  denominations and registered in such names as
         such sellers may request at least two  business  days prior to any sale
         of Registrable Securities;

                  (m) use its best  efforts  (x) to cause  all such  Registrable
         Securities  covered by such  registration  statement  to be listed on a
         national  securities  exchange (if such Registrable  Securities are not
         already so listed) and on each additional  national securities exchange
         on which similar  securities  issued by the Company are then listed, if
         the listing of such Registrable  Securities is then permitted under the
         rules  of such  exchange,  or (y) to  secure  designation  of all  such
         Registrable  Securities  covered by such  registration  statement  as a
         NASDAQ  "national  market system  security"  within the meaning of Rule
         llAa2-1 of the Commission or, failing that, secure NASDAQ authorization
         for
                                       27

                                      246
<PAGE>
         such Registrable Securities and, without limiting the generality of the
         foregoing,  to arrange  for at least two market  makers to  register as
         such with respect to such Registrable Securities with the NASD;

                  (n)  provide a CUSIP number for all Registrable
         Securities, not later than the effective date of the
         applicable registration statement; and

                  (o) enter into such  agreements and take such other actions as
         the Requisite Holders shall reasonably  request in order to expedite or
         facilitate the disposition of such Registrable Securities.

The Company may require each holder of  Registrable  Securities  as to which any
registration is being effected to furnish the Company such information regarding
such holder and the distribution of such securities as the Company may from time
to time reasonably request in writing.

                  9.4.  UNDERWRITTEN   OFFERINGS.   (A)  REQUESTED  UNDERWRITTEN
OFFERINGS.  If requested by the underwriters  for any  underwritten  offering by
holders of Registrable  Securities pursuant to the registration  requested under
section  9.1, the Company will enter into an  underwriting  agreement  with such
underwriters  for such offering,  such agreement to be satisfactory in substance
and  form  to  each  such  holder  and  the  underwriters  and to  contain  such
representations  and  warranties  by the  Company  and such  other  terms as are
customarily contained in agreements of this type, including, without limitation,
indemnities to the effect and to the extent provided in section 9.7. The holders
of  Registrable  Securities  to be  distributed  by such  underwriters  shall be
parties to such  underwriting  agreement and may, at their option,  require that
any or all of the representations and warranties by, and the other agreements on
the part of, the Company to and for the benefit of such underwriters  shall also
be made to and for the benefit of such  holders of  Registrable  Securities  and
that  any or all  of  the  conditions  precedent  to  the  obligations  of  such
underwriters  under such underwriting  agreement be conditions  precedent to the
obligations of such holders of Registrable Securities.  No holder of Registrable
Securities  shall be required to make any  representations  or  warranties to or
agreements  with the  Company or the  underwriters  other than  representations,
warranties or agreements regarding such holder and such holder's intended method
of distribution and any other representation required by law.

                  (b)  INCIDENTAL UNDERWRITTEN OFFERINGS.  If the Company
at any time proposes to register any of its securities under the

                                       28

                                      247
<PAGE>
Securities  Act as  contemplated  by section 9.2 and such  securities  are to be
distributed by or through one or more underwriters, the Company will, subject to
the  provisions of section  9.2(b),  use its best  efforts,  if requested by any
holder of Registrable  Securities,  to arrange for such  underwriters to include
the  Registrable  Securities  to be offered  and sold by such  holder  among the
securities to be  distributed by such  underwriters.  The holders of Registrable
Securities  to be  distributed  by such  underwriters  shall be  parties  to the
underwriting  agreement  between the Company and such  underwriters  and may, at
their option,  require that any or all of the representations and warranties by,
and the other  agreements  on the part of, the Company to and for the benefit of
such  underwriters  shall also be made to and for the benefit of such holders of
Registrable  Securities and that any or all of the  conditions  precedent to the
obligations of such underwriters under such underwriting agreement be conditions
precedent to the  obligations  of such  holders of  Registrable  Securities.  No
holder of Registrable  Securities shall be required to make any  representations
or warranties to or agreements with the Company or the  underwriters  other than
representations,  warranties  or  agreements  regarding  such  holder  and  such
holder's intended method of distribution and any other  representation  required
by law.

                  (c)  HOLDBACK  AGREEMENTS.  (x)  Each  holder  of  Registrable
Securities agrees, if so required by the managing underwriter, not to effect any
public sale or  distribution  of  securities of the Company of the same class as
the securities  included in such Registration  Statement,  during the seven days
prior to the date on which any underwritten registration pursuant to section 9.1
or 9.2 has become effective and the 90 days  thereafter,  except as part of such
underwritten  registration  or to the extent that such holder is  prohibited  by
applicable law from agreeing to withhold Registrable  Securities from sale or is
acting in its capacity as a fiduciary or an investment adviser. Without limiting
the scope of the term  "fiduciary,"  a holder  shall be deemed to be acting as a
fiduciary or an investment adviser if its actions or the Registrable  Securities
proposed to be sold are subject to ERISA, the Investment  Company Act of 1940 or
the Investment  Advisers Act of 1940 or if such Registrable  Securities are held
in a separate account under applicable insurance law or regulation.

                  (y) The  Company  agrees (i) not to effect any public  sale or
distribution  of  its  equity  securities  or  securities  convertible  into  or
exchangeable  or exercisable  for any of such  securities  during the seven days
prior to the date on which any underwritten registration pursuant to section 9.1
or 9.2 has become effective and the 90 days thereafter, except as part of

                                       29

                                      248
<PAGE>
such underwritten  registration and except pursuant to registrations on Form S-4
or S-8 or any successor or similar forms thereto,  and (ii) to cause each holder
of its equity  securities or of any securities  convertible into or exchangeable
or  exercisable  for any of such  securities,  in each case  purchased  from the
Company at any time  after the date of this  Agreement  (other  than in a Public
Offering),  to agree not to effect any such public sale or  distribution of such
securities,   during  such   period,   except  as  part  of  such   underwritten
registration.

                  9.5. PREPARATION; REASONABLE INVESTIGATION. In connection with
the preparation and filing of each  registration  statement under the Securities
Act,  the Company  will give the holders of  Registrable  Securities  registered
under such registration statement,  their underwriters,  if any, each Requesting
Holder  and  their  respective  counsel  and  accountants,  the  opportunity  to
participate in the preparation of such registration  statement,  each prospectus
included  therein or filed with the  Commission,  and each amendment  thereof or
supplement  thereto,  and will give  each of them  such  access to its books and
records and such  opportunities  to discuss the business of the Company with its
officers and the independent public accountants who have certified its financial
statements  as shall be  necessary,  in the  opinion of such  holders'  and such
underwriters'  respective counsel, to conduct a reasonable  investigation within
the meaning of the Securities Act.

                  9.6. RIGHTS OF REQUESTING  HOLDERS.  The Company will not file
any registration  statement under the Securities Act, whether or not pursuant to
registration  rights  granted to other holders of its  securities and whether or
not for sale for its own account (other than by a registration  on Form S-4, S-8
or any successor form thereto),  unless it shall first have given to each Person
which holds any Registrable  Securities  issued by the Company at least 30 days'
prior written  notice  thereof.  Any such holder who shall so request  within 30
days  after  such  notice (a  "Requesting  Holder")  shall  have the rights of a
Requesting  Holder  provided in sections  9.3, 9.5 and 9.7. In addition,  if any
registration  statement refers to any Requesting  Holder by name or otherwise as
the holder of any  securities  of the  Company,  then such holder shall have the
right to require (a) the  insertion  therein of language,  in form and substance
reasonably satisfactory to such holder, to the effect that, if true, the holding
by such  holder of such  securities  does not  necessarily  make  such  holder a
"controlling person" of the Company within the meaning of the Securities Act and
is not to be  construed  as a  recommendation  by such holder of the  investment
quality of the Company's debt or equity securities covered thereby and that such
holding does not imply that such holder will assist in meeting

                                       30

                                      249
<PAGE>
any future financial  requirements of the Company, or (b) in the event that such
reference to such holder by name or otherwise is not required by the  Securities
Act or any rules and  regulations  promulgated  thereunder,  the deletion of the
reference to such holder.

                  9.7.  INDEMNIFICATION.  (a) The Company will, and hereby does,
indemnify, to the extent permitted by applicable law, each holder of Registrable
Securities and its Affiliates and their  respective  officers and directors,  if
any, and each Person,  if any,  who controls  such holder  within the meaning of
Section  15  of  the  Securities  Act,  against  all  losses,  claims,  damages,
liabilities  (or  proceedings  in  respect  thereof)  and  expenses  (under  the
Securities  Act or common law or  otherwise),  joint or  several,  caused by any
untrue statement or alleged untrue statement of a material fact contained in any
registration  statement or  prospectus  (and as amended or  supplemented  if the
Company shall have  furnished  any  amendments  or  supplements  thereto) or any
preliminary  prospectus  or caused by any omission or alleged  omission to state
therein a material fact  required to be stated  therein or necessary to make the
statements  therein  not  misleading,  except  insofar as such  losses,  claims,
damages,  liabilities (or proceedings in respect thereof) or expenses are caused
by any untrue  statement  or alleged  untrue  statement  contained  in or by any
omission  or  alleged  omission  from  information  furnished  in writing to the
Company by such holder  expressly for use therein.  If the offering  pursuant to
any  registration  statement  provided for under this  Agreement is made through
underwriters,  no  action  or  failure  to act on the part of such  underwriters
(whether  or  not  any  such  underwriter  is an  Affiliate  of  any  holder  of
Registrable Securities) shall affect the obligations of the Company to indemnify
any  holder of  Registrable  Securities  or any  other  Person  pursuant  to the
preceding  sentence.  If the  offering  pursuant to any  registration  statement
provided  for under this  Agreement is made  through  underwriters,  the Company
agrees to enter  into an  underwriting  agreement  in  customary  form with such
underwriters  and the  Company  agrees to  indemnify  such  underwriters,  their
officers  and  directors,  if any, and each  Person,  if any, who controls  such
underwriters  within the meaning of Section 15 of the Securities Act to the same
extent as  hereinbefore  provided  with  respect to the  indemnification  of the
holders  of  Registrable  Securities;  PROVIDED  that the  Company  shall not be
required to indemnify any such  underwriter,  or any officer or director of such
underwriter  or any Person who controls such  underwriter  within the meaning of
Section 15 of the Securities  Act, to the extent that the loss,  claim,  damage,
liability   (or   proceedings   in  respect   thereof)   or  expense  for  which
indemnification  is claimed results from such  underwriter's  failure to send or
give a copy of the amended or
                                       31

                                      250
<PAGE>
supplemented  final  prospectus to the Person  asserting an untrue  statement or
alleged  untrue  statement  or omission  or alleged  omission at or prior to the
written  confirmation  of the sale of  Registrable  Securities to such Person if
such statement or omission was corrected in such amended or  supplemented  final
prospectus  prior to such written  confirmation  and the  underwriter  was given
notice of the availability of such amended or supplemented final prospectus.

                  (b) In connection with any  registration  statement in which a
holder  of  Registrable  Securities  is  participating,  each such  holder  will
indemnify,  to the extent permitted by applicable law, the Company, its officers
and  directors  and each Person,  if any,  who  controls the Company  within the
meaning  of  Section 15 of the  Securities  Act,  against  any  losses,  claims,
damages,  liabilities (or proceedings in respect thereof) and expenses resulting
from any untrue  statement or alleged untrue statement of a material fact or any
omission  or alleged  omission of a material  fact  required to be stated in the
registration  statement or prospectus or preliminary prospectus or any amendment
thereof or supplement  thereto or necessary to make the  statements  therein not
misleading, but only to the extent that such untrue statement is contained in or
such  omission  is from  information  so  furnished  in writing  by such  holder
expressly for use therein,  PROVIDED that such  holder's  obligations  hereunder
shall be  limited  to an  amount  equal to the  proceeds  to such  holder of the
Registrable Securities sold pursuant to such registration statement.

                  (c)  Any  Person   entitled  to   indemnification   under  the
provisions of this section 9.7 shall (x) give prompt notice to the  indemnifying
party of any  claim  with  respect  to which it seeks  indemnification  (but the
failure of any  indemnified  party to give notice as provided  herein  shall not
relieve  the  indemnifying   party  of  its  obligations   under  the  preceding
subdivisions  of this  section 9.7,  except to the extent that the  indemnifying
party is actually prejudiced by such failure) and (y) unless in such indemnified
party's reasonable  judgment a conflict of interest between such indemnified and
indemnifying   parties  may  exist  in  respect  of  such  claim,   permit  such
indemnifying  party to assume the defense of such claim, with counsel reasonably
satisfactory to the indemnified  party; and if such defense is so assumed,  such
indemnifying  party shall not enter into any  settlement  without the consent of
the indemnified party if such settlement attributes liability to the indemnified
party and such indemnifying  party shall not be subject to any liability for any
settlement made without its consent (which shall not be unreasonably  withheld);
and any  underwriting  agreement  entered into with respect to any  registration
statement provided for under this Agreement shall so provide. In the event

                                       32

                                      251
<PAGE>
an  indemnifying  party  shall not be  entitled,  or elects  not,  to assume the
defense of a claim,  such  indemnifying  party shall not be obligated to pay the
fees and  expenses  of more than one  counsel or firm of counsel for all parties
indemnified by such indemnifying  party in respect of such claim,  unless in the
reasonable  judgment of any such  indemnified  party a conflict of interest  may
exist between such indemnified  party and any other of such indemnified  parties
in respect to such claim.  Such indemnity  shall remain in full force and effect
regardless of any investigation  made by or on behalf of a participating  holder
of Registrable  Securities,  its officers,  directors or any Person, if any, who
controls  such  holder as  aforesaid,  and shall  survive  the  transfer of such
securities by such holder.

                  (d) If the  indemnification  provided  for in this section 9.7
shall for any  reason  be held by a court to be  unavailable  to an  indemnified
party under section 9.7(a) or (b) hereof in respect of any loss,  claim,  damage
or liability, or any action in respect thereof, then, in lieu of the amount paid
or  payable  under  section  9.7(a)  or  (b),  the  indemnified  party  and  the
indemnifying party under section 9.7(a) or (b) shall contribute to the aggregate
losses,  claims,  damages and  liabilities  (including  legal or other  expenses
reasonably  incurred in connection  with  investigating  the same),  (x) in such
proportion as is  appropriate  to reflect the relative  fault of the Company and
the prospective  sellers of Registrable  Securities  covered by the registration
statement which resulted in such loss, claim, damage or liability,  or action or
proceeding in respect thereof, with respect to the statements or omissions which
resulted in such loss,  claim,  damage or liability,  or action or proceeding in
respect thereof,  as well as any other relevant equitable  considerations or (y)
if the  allocation  provided by clause (x) above is not  permitted by applicable
law, in such proportion as shall be appropriate to reflect the relative benefits
received by the Company and such  prospective  sellers  from the offering of the
securities covered by such registration  statement,  PROVIDED, that for purposes
of clauses (x) or (y), the relative benefits received by the prospective sellers
shall  be  deemed  not to  exceed  the  amount  of  proceeds  received  by  such
prospective sellers and no holder of Registrable Securities shall be required to
contribute  any  amount in excess of the  amount  such  holder  could  have been
required to pay to an indemnified party if the indemnity under subsection (a) of
this section 9.7 was available. No Person guilty of fraudulent misrepresentation
(within the meaning of Section 11(f) of the Securities Act) shall be entitled to
contribution   from  any  Person   who  was  not   guilty  of  such   fraudulent
misrepresentation.  Such sellers'  obligations to contribute as provided in this
section 9.7(d) are several in proportion to the relative value of their

                                       33

                                      252
<PAGE>
respective Registrable Securities covered by such registration statement and not
joint.  In addition,  no Person shall be obligated to  contribute  hereunder any
amounts in payment for any  settlement of any action or claim  effected  without
such Person's consent, which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld.

                  (e) Indemnification and contribution similar to that specified
in  the   preceding   subdivisions   of  this  section  9.7  (with   appropriate
modifications)  shall be given by the  Company  and each  seller of  Registrable
Securities with respect to any required  registration or other  qualification of
securities  under any  federal or state law or  regulation  of any  governmental
authority other than the Securities Act.

                  (f) An  indemnifying  party shall make payments of all amounts
required to be made pursuant to the foregoing  provisions of this section 9.7 to
or for the  account of the  indemnified  party from time to time  promptly  upon
receipt of bills or invoices relating thereto or when otherwise due or payable.

                  9.8. ADJUSTMENTS AFFECTING REGISTRABLE SECURITIES. The Company
will not  effect or permit to occur any  combination  or  subdivision  of shares
which  would  materially  and  adversely  affect the  ability of the  holders of
Registrable   Securities   to  include  such   Registrable   Securities  in  any
registration   of  its  securities   contemplated  by  this  section  9  or  the
marketability of such Registrable Securities under any such registration.

                  9.9.  REGISTRATION  RIGHTS TO OTHERS.  If the Company shall at
any time after the Initial Date provide to any holder of any  securities  of the
Company rights with respect to the  registration  of such  securities  under the
Securities  Act, (a) such rights shall not be in conflict with any of the rights
provided in this section 9 to the holders of  Registrable  Securities and (b) if
such rights are provided on terms or  conditions  more  favorable to such holder
than the terms and  conditions  provided  in this  section  9 the  Company  will
provide (by way of amendment to this Warrant or otherwise)  such more  favorable
terms or conditions to the holders of Registrable Securities.  The Company shall
provide to the holders of Registrable  Securities copies of any agreements which
purport to grant rights with respect to the registration of any of the Company's
securities to any holder or prospective  holder thereof  promptly upon executing
the same.

                  9.10. Other Registration of Common Stock. If any shares of the
Common Stock  required to be reserved for purposes of issuance  upon exercise of
this Warrant in connection with their sale in a registration pursuant to section
9.1 or 9.2
                                       34

                                      253
<PAGE>
require  registration  with or approval of any governmental  authority under any
federal or state law (other than the  Securities  Act) before such shares may be
issued upon such exercise, the Company will, at its expense and as expeditiously
as possible,  use its best efforts to cause such shares to be duly registered or
approved, as the case may be.

                  9.11.  NOMINEES FOR  BENEFICIAL  OWNERS.  For purposes of this
section 9, in the event that any  Registrable  Securities  are held by a nominee
for the  beneficial  owner  thereof,  the  beneficial  owner thereof may, at its
election,  be treated as the holder of such Registrable  Securities for purposes
of any  request  or  other  action  by any  holder  or  holders  of  Registrable
Securities  pursuant  to this  section 9 or any  determination  of any number or
percentage of shares of Registrable  Securities held by any holder or holders of
Registrable  Securities  contemplated by this section 9. If the beneficial owner
of any  Registrable  Securities  so elects,  the Company may require  assurances
reasonably  satisfactory  to it of such  owner's  beneficial  ownership  of such
Registrable Securities.

                  9.12.  RULE 144 AND RULE  144A.  The  Company  shall  take all
actions reasonably necessary to enable holders of Registrable Securities to sell
such  securities  without  registration  under the  Securities  Act  within  the
limitation of the provisions of Rule 144 and Rule 144A under the Securities Act,
as such  Rules  may be  amended  from  time to  time,  or any  similar  rules or
regulations hereafter adopted by the Commission,  including, without limitation,
filing on a timely  basis  all  reports  required  to be filed  pursuant  to the
Exchange Act.

                  10.  AVAILABILITY OF  INFORMATION.  The Company will cooperate
with each holder of any Restricted  Securities in supplying such  information as
may be necessary for such holder to complete and file any information  reporting
forms  presently or hereafter  required by the  Commission as a condition to the
availability  of an  exemption  from  the  Securities  Act for  the  sale of any
Restricted Securities.  The Company will furnish to each holder of any Warrants,
promptly upon their  becoming  available,  copies of all  financial  statements,
reports,  notices and proxy  statements sent or made available  generally by the
Company to its stockholders,  and copies of all regular and periodic reports and
all  registration  statements  and  prospectuses  filed by the Company  with any
securities exchange or with the commission.

                  11.  RESERVATION OF STOCK,  ETC. The Company will at all times
reserve and keep  available,  solely for issuance and delivery  upon exercise of
the Warrants,  the number of shares of Common Stock (or Other  Securities)  from
time to time issuable
                                       35

                                      254
<PAGE>
upon  exercise  of all  Warrants at the time  outstanding.  All shares of Common
Stock (or Other  Securities) shall be duly authorized and, when issued upon such
exercise,  shall be validly  issued and,  in the case of shares,  fully paid and
nonassessable, with no liability on the part of the holders thereof.

                  12. LISTING ON SECURITIES EXCHANGE.  The Company will (a) list
on each national  securities  exchange on which any Common Stock may at any time
be listed, subject to official notice of issuance upon exercise of the Warrants,
and will  maintain such listing of, all shares of Common Stock from time to time
issuable upon exercise of the Warrants or (b) secure and maintain designation of
all  shares of Common  Stock from time to time  issuable  upon  exercise  of the
Warrants as a NASDAQ  "national  market system  security"  within the meaning of
Rule llAa2-1 of the Commission or, failing that, secure NASDAQ authorization for
such shares of Common Stock.

                  13.  OWNERSHIP,  TRANSFER AND SUBSTITUTION OF WARRANTS.  13.1.
OWNERSHIP  OF  WARRANTS.  The  Company  may treat the  person in whose  name any
Warrant  is  registered  on the  register  kept at the  principal  office of the
Company as the owner and holder  thereof for all purposes,  notwithstanding  any
notice  to the  contrary,  except  that,  if and when any  Warrant  is  properly
assigned in blank,  the Company  may (but shall not be  obligated  to) treat the
bearer  thereof as the owner of such Warrant for all  purposes,  notwithstanding
any  notice to the  contrary.  Subject  to  section  8 a  Warrant,  if  properly
assigned,  may be exercised by a new holder  without  first having a new Warrant
issued.

                  13.2. TRANSFER AND EXCHANGE OF WARRANTS. Upon the surrender of
any Warrant,  properly endorsed, for registration of transfer or for exchange at
the principal office of the Company, the Company at its expense will (subject to
compliance  with  section 8, if  applicable)  execute and deliver to or upon the
order of the  holder  thereof  a new  Warrant  or  Warrants  of like  tenor,  in
denominations  of at least 1,666  shares,  in the name of such holder or as such
holder  (upon  payment  by such  holder of any  applicable  transfer  taxes) may
direct,  calling in the aggregate on the face or faces thereof for the number of
shares  of  Common  Stock  called  for on the face or faces  of the  Warrant  or
Warrants so surrendered.

                  13.3.  REPLACEMENT  OF  WARRANTS.  Upon  receipt  of  evidence
reasonably  satisfactory  to the  Company  of the loss,  theft,  destruction  or
mutilation  of any  Warrant  and,  in  the  case  of any  such  loss,  theft  or
destruction  of any Warrant  held by a Person  other than the  Purchaser  or any
institutional  investor,  upon delivery of indemnity reasonably  satisfactory to
the Company
                                       36

                                      255
<PAGE>
in form and amount or, in the case of any such  mutilation,  upon  surrender  of
such  Warrant for  cancellation  at the  principal  office of the  Company,  the
Company at its expense will execute and deliver,  in lieu thereof, a new Warrant
of like tenor.

                  14.  DEFINITIONS.  As used herein, unless the context
otherwise requires, the following terms have the following
respective meanings:

                  ACQUIRING PERSON: the continuing or surviving corporation of a
consolidation  or merger  with the  Company  (if other  than the  Company),  the
transferee of substantially all of the properties and assets of the Company, the
corporation consolidating with or merging into the Company in a consolidation or
merger in  connection  with which the Common  Stock is changed into or exchanged
for stock or other securities of any other Person or cash or any other property,
or, in the case of a capital reorganization or reclassification, the Company.

                  ACQUISITION  PRICE:  as  applied  to the  Common  Stock,  with
respect to any  transaction to which section 3 applies,  (a) the price per share
equal to the greater of the  following,  determined  in each case as of the date
immediately  preceding the date of  consummation  of such  transaction:  (x) the
Market  Price of the Common  Stock and (y) the  highest  amount of cash plus the
Fair Value of the  highest  amount of  securities  or other  property  which the
holder of this Warrant would have been entitled as a shareholder to receive upon
such  consummation if such holder had exercised this Warrant  immediately  prior
thereto,  or (b) if a  purchase,  tender  or an  exchange  offer  is made by the
Acquiring  Person  (or by any of its  affiliates)  to the  holders of the Common
Stock  and  such  offer  is  accepted  by the  holders  of more  than 50% of the
outstanding  shares of Common Stock,  the greater of (i) the price determined in
accordance  with the  foregoing,  subdivision  (a) and (ii) the  price per share
equal to the greater of the  following,  determined  in each case as of the date
immediately  preceding the  acceptance of such offer by the holders of more than
50% of the  outstanding  shares of Common  Stock:  (A) the  Market  Price of the
Common  Stock and (B) the  highest  amount  of cash  plus the Fair  Value of the
highest  amount of securities or other property which the holder of this Warrant
would be entitled  as a  shareholder  to receive  pursuant to such offer if such
holder had exercised  this Warrant  immediately  prior to the expiration of such
offer and accepted the same.

                  ADDITIONAL  SHARES  OF COMMON  STOCK:  all  shares  (including
treasury shares) of Common Stock issued or sold (or,  pursuant to section 2.3 or
2.4, deemed to be issued) by the Company after the Initial Date hereof,  whether
or not
                                       37

                                      256
<PAGE>
subsequently  reacquired  or  retired by the  Company,  other than (a) shares of
Common  Stock issued upon the exercise of Warrants and (b) not more than 730,000
shares of Common  Stock  issued upon the  exercise of stock  options  granted to
directors, officers and other employees of the Company pursuant to the DTN Stock
Option Plan of 1989, as amended,  and the DTN Non-Employee  Director Option Plan
and (c) 66,550  shares of Common  Stock  issuable  upon the exercise of existing
warrants.

                  BASE PRICE: on any date specified herein, the lesser of
(a) the Current Market Price and (b) the Warrant Price.

                  BUSINESS  DAY:  any day other than a Saturday or a Sunday or a
day on  which  commercial  banking  institutions  in the  City of New  York  are
authorized by law to be closed,  provided that, in determining the period within
which  certificates  or  Warrants  are to be issued and  delivered  pursuant  to
section  1.3 at a time when  shares of Common  Stock (or Other  Securities)  are
listed or  admitted  to trading on any  national  securities  exchange or in the
over-the-counter  market and in  determining  the Market Price of any securities
listed or  admitted  to trading on any  national  securities  exchange or in the
over-the-counter  market,  "Business  Day" shall mean any day when the principal
exchange in which  securities are then listed or admitted to trading is open for
trading or, if such securities are traded in the over-the-counter  market in the
United States, such system is open for trading, and provided,  further, that any
reference to "days"  (unless  Business Days are  specified)  shall mean calendar
days.

                  COMMISSION: the Securities and Exchange Commission or
any other Federal agency at the time administering the Securities
Act or the Exchange Act, whichever is the relevant statute for
the particular purpose.

                  COMMON STOCK:  the Company's common stock, par value $.001 per
share, as constituted on the date hereof, any stock into which such common stock
shall have been changed or any stock resulting from any reclassification of such
common stock, and all other stock of any class or classes  (however  designated)
of the  Company the holders of which have the right,  without  limitation  as to
amount,  either to all or to a share of the  balance  of current  dividends  and
liquidating  dividends after the payment of dividends and  distributions  on any
shares entitled to preference.

                  COMPANY: Data Transmission Network Corporation, a
Delaware corporation.

                  CONVERTIBLE SECURITIES: any evidences of indebtedness,
shares of stock (other than Common Stock) or other securities

                                       38

                                      257
<PAGE>
directly or indirectly convertible into or exchangeable for
Additional Shares of Common Stock.

                  CURRENT MARKET PRICE: on any date specified  herein,  (a) with
respect  to  Common  Stock or to  Voting  Common  Stock  (or  equivalent  equity
interests)  of an Acquiring  Person or its Parent,  (x) the average daily Market
Price during the period of the most recent 20  consecutive  Business Days ending
on such date,  or (y) if shares of Common Stock or such Voting  Common Stock (or
equivalent  equity  interests),  as the case  may be,  are not  then  listed  or
admitted to trading on any national  securities  exchange and if the closing bid
and  asked   prices   thereof   are  not  then  quoted  or   published   in  the
over-the-counter  market, the Market Price on such date; and (b) with respect to
any other securities, the Market Price on such date.

                  EXCHANGE ACT: the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, or
any similar Federal statute, and the rules and regulations of the
commission thereunder, all as the same shall be in effect at the
time of determination.

                  FAIR VALUE:  with respect to any securities or other property,
the fair  value  thereof  as of a date which is within 15 days of the date as of
which the determination is to be made (a) determined by an agreement between the
Company  and the  Requisite  Holders  or (b) if the  Company  and the  Requisite
Holders fail to agree,  determined jointly by an independent  investment banking
firm  retained by the  Company and by an  independent  investment  banking  firm
retained by the Requisite  Holders,  either of which firms may be an independent
investment  banking firm regularly retained by the Company or any such holder or
(c) if the  Company  or such  holders  shall  fail so to retain  an  independent
investment  banking firm within five Business Days of the retention of such firm
by such holders or the  Company,  as the case may be,  determined  solely by the
firm so  retained  or (d) if the firms so  retained  by the  Company and by such
holders shall be unable to reach a joint  determination  within 15 Business Days
of the retention of the last firm so retained, determined by another independent
investment  banking firm which is not a regular  investment  banking firm of the
Company  or any such  holder  chosen by the first  two such  firms.  Each of the
Company and the holders of the Warrants  shall be  responsible  for the fees and
expenses of the  investment  banking firm  retained by them under the  foregoing
clause (b) and shall  share  equally  the fees and  expenses  of any  investment
banking firm retained under the foregoing clause (d).

                  INITIAL DATE: the meaning specified in section 2.2.

                                       39

                                      258
<PAGE>
                  INITIATING  HOLDERS:  any holder or holders of at least 50% of
all outstanding  Registrable  Securities  making a written  request  pursuant to
section 9.1 for the  registration of all or part of the  Registrable  Securities
(but not less than 50% of all outstanding  Registrable  Securities) held by such
holder or holders.

                  MARKET PRICE: on any date specified  herein,  (a) with respect
to Common Stock or to Voting Common Stock (or equivalent equity interests) of an
Acquiring Person or its Parent,  the amount per share equal to (x) the last sale
price of shares of such security,  regular way, on such date or, if no such sale
takes  place on such date,  the  average  of the  closing  bid and asked  prices
thereof on such  date,  in each case as  officially  reported  on the  principal
national  securities  exchange  on which the same are then listed or admitted to
trading,  or (y) if no shares of such  security  are then  listed or admitted to
trading on any national securities exchange but such security is designated as a
national  market  system  security by the NASD,  the last trading  price of such
security on such date, or if such security is not so designated,  the average of
the reported  closing bid and asked prices  thereof on such date as shown by the
NASDAQ  system  or, if no shares  thereof  are then  quoted in such  system,  as
published  by the  National  Quotation  Bureau,  Incorporated  or any  successor
organization,  and in either case as reported by any member firm of the New York
Stock Exchange selected by the Company, or (z) if no shares of such security are
then listed or admitted to trading on any national  exchange or  designated as a
national  market system  security and if no closing bid and asked prices thereof
are then so quoted or published in the  over-the-counter  market,  the higher of
(x) the book value thereof as  determined  by agreement  between the Company and
the  Requisite  Holders,  or if the Company and the  Requisite  Holders  fail to
agree,  by any firm of independent  public  accountants  of recognized  standing
selected by the Board of  Directors  of the  Company,  as of the last day of any
month ending within 60 days preceding the date as of which the  determination is
to be made and (y) the fair value thereof  determined in good faith by the Board
of Directors  of the issuer  thereof as of a date which is within 15 days of the
date as of which the  determination  is to be made;  and (b) with respect to any
other securities,  the fair value thereof  determined in good faith by the Board
of  Directors of the Company as of a date which is within 15 days of the date as
of which the determination is to be made.

                  NASD: the National Association of Securities Dealers.

                  NASDAQ: the Automated Quotation System of the NASD.

                                       40

                                      259
<PAGE>
                  NOTES: the meaning specified in the opening paragraphs
of this Warrant.

                  OPTIONS: rights, options or warrants to subscribe for,
purchase or otherwise acquire either Additional Shares of Common
Stock or Convertible Securities.

                  OTHER  SECURITIES:  any stock  (other than  Common  Stock) and
other  securities  of the Company or any other Person  (corporate  or otherwise)
which the holders of the  Warrants at any time shall be entitled to receive,  or
shall  have  received,  upon  the  exercise  of the  Warrants,  in lieu of or in
addition to Common  Stock,  or which at any time shall be issuable or shall have
been  issued  in  exchange  for or in  replacement  of  Common  Stock  or  Other
Securities pursuant to section 3 or otherwise.

                  PARENT: as to any Acquiring Person,  any corporation which (a)
controls  the  Acquiring  Person  directly  or  indirectly  through  one or more
intermediaries,  (b)  is  required  to  include  the  Acquiring  Person  in  its
consolidated financial statements under generally accepted accounting principles
and (c) is not itself included in the consolidated  financial  statements of any
other Person (other than its consolidated subsidiaries).

                  PERSON: an individual, a partnership, an association, a
joint venture, a corporation, a business, a trust, an
unincorporated organization or a government or any department,
agency or subdivision thereof.

                  PUBLIC OFFERING: any offering of Common Stock to the
public pursuant to an effective registration statement under the
Securities Act.

                  PURCHASE AGREEMENT: the meaning specified in the
opening paragraphs of this Warrant.

                  PURCHASER: the meaning specified in the opening
paragraphs of this Warrant.

                  REGISTRABLE  SECURITIES:  (a) the Warrants,  (b) any shares of
Common  Stock or other  Securities  issued  or  issuable  upon  exercise  of the
Warrants and (c) any  securities  issued or issuable  with respect to any common
Stock  or  Other  Securities  referred  to in  subdivision  (b) by way of  stock
dividend  or  stock  split  or in  connection  with  a  combination  of  shares,
recapitalization, merger, consolidation or other reorganization or otherwise. As
to any particular  Registrable  Securities,  once issued such  securities  shall
cease to be  Registrable  Securities  when  (x) a  registration  statement  with
respect to the sale of
                                       41

                                      260
<PAGE>
such  securities  shall have become  effective under the Securities Act and such
securities  shall have been  disposed of in  accordance  with such  registration
statement,  (y) they  shall have been sold as  permitted  under Rule 144 (or any
successor  provision) under the Securities Act, or (z) they shall have ceased to
be outstanding.

                  REGISTRATION  EXPENSES: all expenses incident to the Company's
performance of or compliance with section 9, including,  without limitation, all
registration,  filing and NASD fees,  all fees and  expenses of  complying  with
securities  or blue sky laws,  all word  processing,  duplicating  and  printing
expenses, messenger and delivery expenses, the fees and disbursements of counsel
for  the  Company  and of its  independent  public  accountants,  including  the
expenses of any special audits or "cold comfort" letters required by or incident
to such performance and compliance  (provided that "Registration  Expenses" will
not  include  any "cold  comfort"  letter  requested  solely by the  holders  of
Registrable  Securities in connection with any registration if the Company shall
not have  elected or been  required  by the  underwriters  with  respect to such
registration  to cause such a letter to be delivered),  the reasonable  fees and
disbursements of a single counsel and single firm of accountants retained by the
holders of the Registrable Securities being registered, premiums and other costs
of policies of insurance against  liabilities arising out of the public offering
of the Registrable Securities being registered and any fees and disbursements of
underwriters customarily paid by issuers or sellers of securities, but excluding
underwriting  discounts and commissions  and transfer  taxes,  if any,  provided
that,  in any  case  where  Registration  Expenses  are not to be  borne  by the
Company,  such  expenses  shall not  include  salaries of Company  personnel  or
general  overhead  expenses of the  Company,  auditing  fees,  premiums or other
expenses  relating  to  liability  insurance  required  by  underwriters  of the
Company, or other expenses for the preparation of financial  statements or other
data normally  prepared by the Company in the ordinary course of its business or
which the Company would have incurred in any event.

                  REQUESTING HOLDER: the meaning specified in section 9.6.

                  REQUISITE HOLDERS: the holders of more than 50% of all
the Warrants at the time outstanding determined on the basis of
the number of shares of Common Stock or Other Securities
deliverable upon exercise thereof.

                  RESTRICTED SECURITIES: (a) any Warrants bearing the
applicable legend set forth in section 8.1, (b) any shares of

                                       42

                                      261
<PAGE>
Common Stock (or Other  Securities)  which have been issued upon the exercise of
Warrants and which are evidenced by a certificate  or  certificates  bearing the
applicable  legend  set  forth  in such  section,  and (c)  unless  the  context
otherwise  requires,  any shares of Common Stock (or Other Securities) which are
at the time  issuable  upon the exercise of Warrants and which,  when so issued,
will be evidenced by a certificate or certificates bearing the applicable legend
set forth in such section.

                  SECURITIES ACT: the Securities Act of 1933, or any
similar Federal statute, and the rules and regulations of the
Commission thereunder, all as the same shall be in effect at the
time of determination.

                  SUBSIDIARY: any corporation, association or other
business entity a majority (by number of votes) of the Voting
Common Stock of which is at the time owned by the Company or by
one or more Subsidiaries or by the Company and one or more
Subsidiaries.

                  TRANSFER:  unless the context  otherwise  requires,  any sale,
assignment,  pledge or other  disposition  of any  security,  or of any interest
therein, which could constitute a "sale" as that term is defined in section 2(3)
of the Securities Act.

                  VOTING  COMMON  STOCK:   with  respect  to  any   corporation,
association  or other  business  entity,  stock  of any  class  or  classes  (or
equivalent  interest) , if the holders of the stock of such class or classes (or
equivalent interests) are ordinarily, in the absence of contingencies,  entitled
to vote for the election of a majority of the directors  (or persons  performing
similar functions) of such corporation,  association or business entity, even if
the right so to vote has been suspended by the happening of such a contingency.

                  WARRANT PRICE: the meaning specified in section 2.1.

                  WARRANTS: the meaning specified in the opening
paragraphs of this Warrant.

                  15. REMEDIES.  The Company stipulates that the remedies at law
of the holder of this Warrant in the event of any default or threatened  default
by the Company in the performance of or compliance with any of the terms of this
Warrant  are not and  will not be  adequate  and  that,  to the  fullest  extent
permitted by law,  such terms may be  specifically  enforced by a decree for the
specific  performance  of any  agreement  contained  herein or by an  injunction
against a violation of any of the terms hereof or otherwise.

                                       43

                                      262
<PAGE>
                  16. NO RIGHTS OR LIABILITIES AS STOCKHOLDER. Nothing contained
in this  Warrant  shall be construed as  conferring  upon the holder  hereof any
voting or other  rights as a  stockholder  of the  Company  or as  imposing  any
liabilities on such holder to purchase any securities or as a stockholder of the
Company, whether such liabilities are asserted by the Company or by creditors or
stockholders of the Company or otherwise.

                  17. NOTICES.  All notices and other  communications under this
Warrant shall be in writing and shall be mailed by registered or certified mail,
return receipt  requested,  addressed (a) if to any holder of any Warrant or any
holder of any Common Stock (or Other  Securities),  at the registered address of
such holder as set forth in the  register  kept at the  principal  office of the
Company,  or (b) if to the  Company,  to the  attention  of its Chief  Financial
Officer at its principal office, provided that the exercise of any Warrant shall
be effected in the manner provided in section 1.

                  18.  EXPIRATION;  NOTICE.  The Company will give the holder of
this  Warrant  no less  than 45 days'  nor  more  than 90  days"  notice  of the
expiration  of the right to exercise  this  Warrant.  The right to exercise this
Warrant  shall  expire  at 3 P.M.,  New  York  City  time,  June 30,  2004.  The
registration  rights provided in section 9 shall expire at 3 P.M., New York City
time, June 30, 2004 with respect to any shares of Common Stock issued previously
to such time upon the exercise hereof.

                  19.  MISCELLANEOUS.  This  Warrant  and any term hereof may be
changed,  waived,  discharged  or  terminated  only by an  instrument in writing
signed by the party against which enforcement of such change, waiver,  discharge
or  termination  is sought.  The  agreements  of the Company  contained  in this
Warrant  other than those  applicable  solely to the  Warrants  and the  holders
thereof  shall  inure to the  benefit  of and be  enforceable  by any  holder or
holders at the time of any Common  Stock (or Other  Securities)  issued upon the
exercise  of  Warrants,  whether so  expressed  or not.  This  Warrant  shall be
construed and enforced in accordance with and governed by the laws of the State

                                       44

                                      263
<PAGE>
of New  York.  The  section  headings  in  this  Warrant  are  for  purposes  of
convenience only and shall not constitute a part hereof.


                            DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION

                            By:______________________
                                     Title:



                                       45

                                      264
<PAGE>


                              FORM OF SUBSCRIPTION


                 (To be executed only upon exercise of Warrant)



To _________________

                  The undersigned registered holder of the within Warrant hereby
irrevocably  exercises  such Warrant for, and purchases  thereunder,  __________
shares of Common  Stock of Data  Transmission  Network  Corporation,  a Delaware
corporation,  and herewith makes payment of $_________  therefor [by application
pursuant to section 1.5 of such Warrant of $ ________ aggregate principal amount
of Notes (as defined in such Warrant) plus $ _______ accrued interest  thereon],
and requests that the certificates for such shares be issued in the name of, and
delivered to ______________, whose address is ______________.


Dated: ________________




                                            ----------------------

                                        (Signature must conform in all respects
                                         to name of holder as specified on the
                                         face of this Warrant)


                                                 [insert address]

                                       46



                                      265
<PAGE>


                               FORM OF ASSIGNMENT


                 (To be executed only upon transfer of Warrant)

                  For value received,  the undersigned  registered holder of the
within  Warrant hereby sells,  assigns and transfers unto  _____________________
the right  represented by such Warrant to purchase  __________  shares of Common
Stock of Data Transmission Network Corporation, a Delaware corporation, to which
such Warrant relates, and appoints ______________ Attorney to make such transfer
on the books of  _____________  maintained for such purpose,  with full power of
substitution in the premises.

Dated: ________________



                                            ----------------------

                                         (Signature must conform in all respects
                                          to name of holder as specified on the
                                          face of this Warrant)

                                                   [insert address]



Signed in the presence of:


- -------------------------

                                       47


                                      266
<PAGE>


                       NOTE AND WARRANT PURCHASE AGREEMENT


         This First  Amendment  to Note and  Warrant  Purchase  Agreement  (this
"First  Amendment") is dated as of April 13,  1995, and entered into by and
among DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION, a Delaware corporation ("Company"),
and THE  NOTEHOLDERS  LISTED ON THE  SIGNATURE  PAGES HEREOF  (collectively  the
"Noteholders").

                                    RECITALS:

         WHEREAS,  Company and the initial  purchaser of the Notes  entered into
that certain Note and Warrant Purchase  Agreement dated as of June 30, 1994 (the
"Purchase  Agreement"),  the terms defined  therein being used herein as therein
defined; and

         WHEREAS, Company and Noteholders desire to amend the Purchase Agreement
as  hereinafter  set  forth to  modify  certain  financial  covenants  contained
therein;

         NOW,  THEREFORE,  subject to the terms and conditions herein contained,
the parties hereto hereby agree as follows:

         Section 1.  AMENDMENTS TO THE PURCHASE AGREEMENT.

         1.1      Subsection 10.5 of the Purchase Agreement hereby is
amended and restated in its entirety to read as follows:

                  "10.5.  Interest Coverage Ratio.  The Company will
         not permit the Interest Coverage Ratio to be less than
         2.0 to 1.0."

         1.2 Section 14 of the Purchase Agreement hereby is amended by adding in
its proper alphabetical order the following definition:

                  "Interest Coverage Ratio: For any calendar quarter,  the ratio
         of (i)  Consolidated  Operating Cash Flow for such calendar  quarter to
         (ii) consolidated interest expense for the Company and its Subsidiaries
         for such  calendar  quarter  determined in  accordance  with  generally
         accepted  accounting  principles;   provided,  however,  such  interest
         expense shall not include  amortization of deferred  offering costs nor
         any fees the  Company  is  obligated  to pay upon the  occurrence  of a
         "Trigger Event" as defined in Section 2.4 of the Bank Loan Agreement."

         1.3      Section 14 of the Purchase Agreement hereby is amended
by deleting in its entirety the definition of Consolidated
Tangible Net Worth.

RCF\64596.1

                                      267
<PAGE>
         Section 2.  COMPANY'S REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES.

         In order to induce the  Noteholders to enter into this First  Amendment
and to amend the  Purchase  Agreement  in the manner  provided  herein,  Company
represents  and warrants to the  Noteholders  that the following  statements are
true, correct and complete:

         2.1 Organization and Powers.  Company has all requisite corporate power
and  authority  to  enter  into  this  First  Amendment  and to  carry  out  the
transactions  contemplated  by, and perform its obligations  under, the Purchase
Agreement as amended by this First Amendment (the "Amended Agreement").

         2.2      Authorization of Agreements.  The execution and
delivery of this First Amendment have been duly authorized by all
necessary corporate action by Company.

         2.3 Binding Obligation.  This First Amendment and the Amended Agreement
are the legally valid and binding  obligations  of Company  enforceable  against
Company in accordance with their respective terms,  except as enforcement may be
limited to bankruptcy,  insolvency,  reorganization,  moratorium or similar laws
relating to or limiting  creditors' rights generally or by equitable  principles
relating to enforceability.

         Section 3.  NOTEHOLDERS' REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES.

         In order to induce  Company to enter into this First  Amendment  and to
amend the Purchase  Agreement in the manner  provided  herein,  the  Noteholders
represent  and warrant to Company  that  collectively  the  Noteholders  are the
holders of more than 50% in  principal  amount of the Notes  outstanding  on the
date of this First Amendment.

         Section 4.  MISCELLANEOUS.

         4.1 Reference to and Effect on the Purchase  Agreement.  From and after
the date of this First  Amendment,  each reference in the Purchase  Agreement to
"this Agreement",  "hereunder",  "hereof", "herein" or words of like import, and
each reference in any other documents relating to the Purchase Agreement,  shall
mean and be a  reference  to the  Purchase  Agreement  as  amended by this First
Amendment.  Except as specifically amended by this First Amendment, the Purchase
Agreement  and the other  documents  relating to the  Purchase  Agreement  shall
remain in full force and effect and are hereby ratified and confirmed.

         4.2 Execution in Counterparts;  Effectiveness. This First Amendment may
be executed in any number of counterparts and by the different parties herein in
separate  counterparts,  each of which when so executed and  delivered  shall be
deemed to be an original and all of which taken  together  shall  constitute but
one and the

RCF\64596.1
                                      268
<PAGE>
same instrument.  This First Amendment shall become effective upon the execution
of a counterpart hereof by each of the parties hereto.

         4.3      Governing Law.  This First Amendment shall be governed
by, and shall be construed and enforced in accordance with, the
laws of the State of New York.

         4.4 Headings.  Section and subsections headings in this First Amendment
are included herein for convenience of reference only and shall not constitute a
part of this First  Amendment for any other purpose or be given any  substantive
effect.

         WITNESS the due  execution  hereof by the  respective  duly  authorized
officers of the undersigned as of the date first above written.

                           COMPANY:

                           DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK
                           CORPORATION, a Delaware
                           corporation



                           By:      /s/  Greg T. Sloma
                                  ------------------------------
                           Title:   Executive Vice President and
                                    Chief Operating Officer
                                  ------------------------------


                           NOTEHOLDERS:

                           EQUITABLE CAPITAL PRIVATE INCOME
                           AND EQUITY PARTNERSHIP II, L.P.

                           By:     EQUITABLE CAPITAL MANAGEMENT
                                   CORPORATION, its General Partner

                           By:     /s/   U. Peter C. Gummeson
                                  -------------------------------
                           Title:  Investment Officer

RCF\64596.1


                                      269
<PAGE>


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                  EXHIBIT 11
DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------


COMPUTATION OF NET INCOME (LOSS) PER SHARE
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------




                                                          Year Ended December 31,
                                             ---------------------------------------------
                                                 1995              1994              1993
                                             ------------      ------------       ---------



Primary

Computation of income
 per common and common
 equivalent share:

<S>                                         <C>               <C>                <C>       
 Net income (loss)                          ($  283,076)      ($1,602,738)       $  663,831
                                            ============      ============       ==========

 Average shares outstanding                   3,302,864         3,253,400         3,195,534

 Add shares applicable to stock
  options & warrants (1)                          -                 -                91,040

 Add shares  applicable to stock
  options & warrants prior to
  conversion,  using average
  market price prior to conversion (1)            -                 -                   276
                                              ----------      ------------       ----------

  Total shares                                3,302,864         3,253,400        3,286,850
                                             ==========      ============       ==========


  Per common share:
   Net income (loss)(1)                         ($0.09)           ($0.49)            $0.20
                                             ==========           =======       ==========


<FN>
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------




(1)      Shares  applicable to warrants and stock options are  antidilutive  for
         the period  ended  December 31, 1995 and 1994,  and thus,  are excluded
         from the calculation of net loss per common share.


</FN>
</TABLE>

                                      270
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>


                                                                           EXHIBIT 11-Pg 2

DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------


COMPUTATION OF NET INCOME (LOSS) PER SHARE
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------





                                                                                                            Year Ended December 31,
                                                1995              1994              1993
                                            ------------      ------------       -------



Fully Dilutive

Computation of income per common
 and common equivalent share:
<S>                                         <C>               <C>                <C>       
 Net income (loss)                          ($  283,076)      ($1,602,738)       $  663,831
                                            ============      ============       ==========

 Average shares outstanding                   3,302,864         3,253,400         3,195,534

 Add shares applicable to stock
  options & warrants (1)                        -                 -                 185,515

 Add shares  applicable to stock options
 & warrants prior to
  conversion,  using average market
  price prior to conversion (1)                 -                 -                   1,048
                                            ------------      ------------       ----------

  Total shares                                3,302,864         3,253,400         3,382,097
                                            ============      ============       ==========


  Per common share:
   Net income (loss)                             ($0.09)           ($0.49)            $0.20
                                            ============      ============       ==========


<FN>
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------


(1)      Shares  applicable to warrants and stock options are  antidilutive  for
         the period  ended  December 31, 1995 and 1994,  and thus,  are excluded
         from the calculation of net loss per common share.
</FN>
</TABLE>

                                      271
<PAGE>

         Data Transmission Network Corporation (DTN), an electronic  information
and  communication  services company  headquartered in Omaha, NE, is a leader in
the electronic  satellite  delivery of  time-sensitive  information  (NEWS...NOT
HISTORY).  DTN is committed to providing our customers with the best information
and analysis  available,  as quickly as possible,  at an affordable  cost.  DTNs
services are tailored to meet our  subscribers  needs and are valuable  tools in
managing business and personal affairs.

        The company began operations in 1984, went public in January,  1987, and
has  continued  to  evolve  into  a   full-service   information   provider  and
communication  network.  DTN  distributes  information  via FM  radio  side-band
channels,   small  dish  Ku-band  satellite,  TV  cable  (VBI-vertical  blanking
interval), FAX, E-Mail and the Internet. Most subscribers utilize a DTN receiver
that captures  information around the clock and converts it into text,  graphics
and audio available at the subscribers convenience.

        Prior to 1992, DTN supported only a monochrome  receiver system with the
capability to receive and display  information.  In 1992, the company introduced
the  Advanced   Communications   EngineSM   (ACE)  receiver  that  expanded  the
information and communications  services provided by the company.  This receiver
has multiple  processors  that capture,  manipulate and display high  resolution
color video pictures,  graphics and text. In addition,  these processors provide
the ability to play audio clips and to utilize a phone  modem.  The ACE receiver
is equipped with an internal hard drive that allows processed  information to be
stored,  archived  and then  displayed by using the built-in  control  panel,  a
keyboard or a mouse at the subscribers convenience.

        DTNs  services  reach 95,900  subscribers  in the U.S.  and Canada.  The
company has services for the agriculture,  automotive,  energy,  farm implement,
financial,  mortgage,  produce  and weather  related  industries.  The  services
include DTN AgDaily, targeted for agribusinesses;  DTN Pro SeriesSM, an advanced
information service for  agribusinesses;  DTNstant/  Knight-Ridder,  a real-time
agriculture  ticker  service;  DTNironSM  for the  farm  implement  dealer;  DTN
PROduceSM for the produce industry; DTN Weather CenterSM, for the golf, aviation
and construction  industries;  DTN Wall Street for the financial  industry;  DTN
SPECTRUMSM,  an enhanced  version of DTN Wall Street on the ACE technology;  DTN
FirstRateSM  for the  mortgage  industry;  DTN  GovRateSM  for  U.S.  government
securities;  DTNergy for the  petroleum  and natural gas  industries;  DTNautoSM
linking auto auctions and auto  dealers;  and joint  ventures in the  electrical
equipment and trucking industries.
                                      272
<PAGE>
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                               TABLE OF CONTENTS
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Financial Highlights ......................................................    2

Five Years in Review ......................................................    2

Letter to Stockholders ....................................................    4

Business Review ...........................................................    6

Selected Financial Data ...................................................   16

Management's Discussion and Analysis ......................................   17

Management's Responsibilities .............................................   21

Independent Auditor's Report ..............................................   21

Financial Statements ......................................................   22

Notes to Financial Statements .............................................   26

Quarterly Data ............................................................   31

Trading Information .......................................................   31

Investor Information ......................................................   32

Directors and Officers ....................................................   32

Mission Statement .........................................................   33

                                       1

                                      273
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                          FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

                                                         1995             1994             % Change
For the Year:
                                                    ------------     ------------          ----------
<S>                                                 <C>              <C>                       <C> 
        Revenues ................................   $ 62,287,989     $ 46,109,789              35 %
        Operating cash flow(1) ..................     23,154,402       15,750,727              47 %
        Income (loss) before income taxes .......       (397,076)      (2,422,738)             --
        Net income (loss) .......................       (283,076)      (1,602,738)             --
        Net income (loss) per share .............   $       (.09)    $       (.49)             --


At Year End:
        Total assets ............................   $ 92,672,050     $ 71,459,356              30 %
        Long-term debt and subordinated notes ...     47,020,527       33,982,814              38 %
        Stockholders equity .....................     12,876,965       12,706,978               1 %
        Book value per share ....................   $       3.88     $       3.86               1 %



Key Indicators:
        Total subscribers at year-end ...........         95,900           82,000              17 %
        Subscriber retention rate ...............          91.0%           89.8 %               1 %
        Net development costs(2) ................   $  3,733,530     $  4,334,950             (14)%
        Operating cash flow from core services(3)   $ 26,749,974     $ 20,035,025              34 %

As a percent of revenue:
        Operating cash flow(1) ..................          37.2 %          34.2 %
        Operating cash flow from core services(3)          44.4 %          43.8 %
        Depreciation and amortization ...........          30.2 %          32.7 %
        Interest ................................           7.7 %           6.8 %
        Net income (loss) before income taxes ...           (.6)%          (5.3)%

<FN>
     (1)  Operating income before depreciation and amortization expense.


     (2)  Net  Development  Costs are  defined as the sum of 1) market  research
          activities,  2)  hardware  and  software  engineering,   research  and
          development  and  3)  the  negative  operating  cash  flow  (prior  to
          corporate allocations plus interest) of new services.

     (3)  Core  services  are  services  no  longer in the  initial  development
          process.  Operating  cash  flow  from core  services  as a percent  of
          revenue is calculated on core services revenue.
</FN>
</TABLE>
                                      274
<PAGE>
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                              FIVE YEARS IN REVIEW
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

GRAPHS IN TABULAR FORM:


                              1991      1992      1993      1994      1995
                              ----      ----      ----      ----      ----
Revenues ($ millions)         21.5      26.8      36.0      46.1      62.3


                              1991      1992      1993      1994      1995
                              ----      ----      ----      ----      ----
Operating Cash Flow
     ($ millions)              8.2       9.9      12.9      15.8      23.2



                              1991      1992      1993      1994      1995
                              ----      ----      ----      ----      ----
Operating Cash Flow
     (% of revenue)           38%       37%       36%       34%       37%

                                       2

                                      275
<PAGE>
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                              FIVE YEARS IN REVIEW
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

GRAPHS IN TABULAR FORM:


                              1991      1992      1993      1994      1995
                              ----      ----      ----      ----      ----
Subscribers at Year End
     (thousands)              63.3      67.6      74.1      82.0      95.9




                              1991      1992      1993      1994      1995
                              ----      ----      ----      ----      ----
Subscriber Retention Rate
     (percent)                90.0      88.2      88.8      89.8      91.0



                              1991      1992      1993      1994      1995
                              ----      ----      ----      ----      ----
Net Development Costs
     ($ millions)              0.4       1.1       2.7       4.3       3.7



                              1991      1992      1993      1994      1995
                              ----      ----      ----      ----      ----
Primary Services at Year End   3         3         6         10        14



                              1991      1992      1993      1994      1995
                              ----      ----      ----      ----      ----
Annual Revenue per
  Subscriber ($ based
  on average subscribers)     371       409       507       591       700



                              1991      1992      1993      1994      1995
                              ----      ----      ----      ----      ----
Annual Operating Cash Flow
  per Subscriber ($ based 
  on average subscribers)     141       151       183       202       260

                                       3

                                      276
<PAGE>
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                             LETTER TO STOCKHOLDERS
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         Today is February 24th,  1996, it is Saturday and it is a beautiful day
in Omaha,  Nebraska (clear and about 70 degrees). A particularly  inviting break
in a very cold winter.  So, if this communication  becomes  abbreviated you will
know that temptation bested me.

         Your company  experienced  significant growth in 1995 and the following
highlights speak for themselves.

         -     Revenues rose 35% to $62,288,000.

         -     Operating cash flow  (operating  income before  depreciation  and
               amortization expense) grew 47% to $23,154,000.

         -     Operating cash flow before  expenses and revenue  associated with
               new services was 44.4% of revenue for 1995 vs. 43.8% for 1994.

         -     Total subscribers increased 17% to 95,900.

         -     Subscriber  retention improved to 91.0% in 1995 vs. 89.8% in 1994
               and 88.8% in 1993.

        One of the most important  components of the above financial  highlights
is an increase in our per subscriber,  per month subscription  revenue.  Average
per  subscriber,  per month revenue has increased  from $30.39 in 1993 to $36.14
for 1994 and $43.60 for 1995. The most influential  factor in these  incremental
increases is that the average per subscriber, per month subscription revenue for
new sales  continues to  increase.  For 1995,  this number was over  $61.00.  We
strive to solve more complex  information  needs for the industries we serve and
as such we are able to charge a little more.

         During 1995, the company introduced four new information services:  DTN
Weather Center, DTN Spectrum, DTN GovRate and DAT Transportation  Terminal. (See
Business Review section pages 8 thru 15 for service descriptions). The following
is a chronological list of all current DTN services.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
           Year/Month         Service
           ------------       ----------------------
<S>        <C>                <C>                     
           1984               Dataline/DTN  AgDaily
           1989               DTN Wall Street
           1991               DTNergy
           1993               DTNstant 
           1993               DTNauto 
           1993               DTNiron 
           1994/January       TracElectric
           1994/May           DTN  First  Rate
           1994/June          DTN  Pro  Series
           1994/October       DTN PROduce
           1995/April         DTN Weather Center
           1995/November      DTN Spectrum
           1995/November      DTN GovRate
           1995/December      DAT Transportation Terminal
</TABLE>
                                       4

                                      277
<PAGE>
         Our growth in new services offered is a result of our commitment to new
product research and development.

         Consistent  with our  strategy  to invest in the  future,  the  company
acquired  2,900 Knight Ridder  Commodity  News Service  subscribers  from Knight
Ridder  Financial.  All 2,900  subscribers use instant (vs. delayed) futures and
options quotes,  and, coupled with our DTNstant  subscribers make us the largest
supplier of instant futures and options quotes to the agricultural segment

         Our growth in services  offered  influenced  us to  increase  resources
allocated to our  distribution  capabilities.  As such,  during 1995,  we nearly
doubled  our  field  sales  force,  our  telemarketing   sales  force,  and  our
corresponding support staff. Growth in our distribution capability will continue
to be a high priority in 1996.

         As is  described in greater  detail in the  following  Business  Review
section,  your company uses a variety of technologies to deliver our information
services. Our primary technologies include: FM radio side-band channels, KU-band
satellite  and  TV  cable   (VBI-vertical   blanking   interval).   Lessor  used
technologies  by DTN are FAX and  E-mail,  and  like  virtually  all the rest of
planet  Earth we are  experimenting  with use of the  Internet.  For  1995,  all
communication  cost associated  with the delivery of our information  divided by
our total subscriber days equal $.06 per subscriber per day.

         The math demonstrates the economics of broadcast technology for sending
rapidly  changing  point  to  multi  point  information.  When,  or if,  another
medium/carrier/technology  can  deliver  as  much  information,  as  timely  and
economically, 24 hours per day we will use it.

         Busy people are increasingly seeking  comprehensive  sources of timely,
affordable,  relevant information. We feel we are in the catbirds seat to play a
major role in fulfilling this demand.

         Henry Ford is credited  with saying  enthusiasm is at the bottom of all
progress. If such is the case, we are about to experience considerable progress.
My hats off to our customers, employees, stockholders,  financiers and suppliers
for their loyalty, confidence and support.

                                             Very sincerely yours,

                                             /s/ Roger Brodersen
                                             ------------------------
                                             Chairman and CEO

                                       5

                                      278
<PAGE>
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                BUSINESS REVIEW
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

         Data Transmission  Network Corporation (DTN) began operations in April,
1984. The company is in the business of providing  information and communication
services.  During 1995, four new services were released: DTN Weather Center, DTN
SPECTRUM,  DTN GovRate and a joint  venture  DAT  (Dial-a-Truck)  Transportation
Terminal.  DTNs services reach 95,900 subscribers in the U.S. and Canada. All of
these services are discussed in this report.

         The  companys  subscription  services  are  targeted at niche  business
markets  and  designed to be timely  (NEWS...NOT  HISTORY),  simple to use,  and
convenient.   The  companys  information  distribution  technology  provides  an
efficient means of sending data and information  from point to multi-point.

         The  development  of a  cost-effective  electronic  satellite  delivery
system, plus a total commitment to customer service and information quality, has
enabled the company to become a major player in the communication  industry. The
company  continues  to  make a large  investment  to  develop  and  enhance  its
information distribution technology.  This investment has allowed the company to
take advantage of many engineering and software  advancements in an exciting and
growing industry.

INFORMATION DISTRIBUTION TECHNOLOGY

         The  company  is  committed  to  research  and to  develop  information
distribution  technologies to cost  effectively  deliver the timely  information
(NEWS...NOT  HISTORY) that the companys subscribers demand. DTN supports several
information distribution  technologies allowing the distribution  (transmission)
and  receiving  (capture,   manipulation  and  display)  of  information.  These
technologies  include,  FM radio  side-band  channels  (FM),  small dish Ku-band
satellite (Ku), FAX, E-Mail, TV cable (VBI) (VBI-vertical blanking interval) and
the Internet.

         The first  technology used by the company was FM. The Ku technology was
added in 1989,  providing the ability to reach customers  outside the geographic
territory of the signal of the FM stations.  FAX, TV cable (VBI), E-Mail and the
Internet have since been added to further expand our distribution network.

         The company provides all of the equipment  necessary for subscribers to
receive their  service based on FM, Ku, TV cable (VBI) and E-Mail  technologies.
This equipment includes a receiver,  specifically built for the company, a video

                                       6

                                      279
<PAGE>
monitor,  an FM antenna or a small 30 Ku-band satellite dish. A keyboard,  mouse
and printer may be provided depending on the service. DTN is responsible for the
normal maintenance and repair of the subscriber equipment.

         Prior  to  1992,  the  company  utilized  a  page-based   receiver  and
monochrome  system.  The monochrome  system  translates the companys data stream
into text and has the capability,  depending on capacity, to receive and display
from 126 to 246 different pages of information.  The monochrome receiver has the
capability to download information to a printer or computer.

         In 1992, the company introduced the Advanced  Communications  Engine SM
(ACE) receiver,  a color graphics receiver system,  that expanded the ability to
provide  information  and  communications  services.  This receiver has multiple
processors that capture,  manipulate and display high resolution color pictures,
graphics and text. A separate processor provides the ability to play audio clips
such as weather  forecasts,  voice  advertisements  or audio  alarms used when a
futures contract  reaches a pre-set price. In addition,  this processor may send
and retrieve information by using an internal modem.

         The  receiver has the ability to download  information  to a printer or
computer.  This  receiver  is equipped  with an internal  hard drive that allows
processed  information to be stored,  archived (versus frequent  rebroadcasting)
and then displayed using the receivers  built-in  control panel, a keyboard or a
mouse at the subscribers convenience.

         One of the unique  aspects  of the  companys  information  distribution
technology is the computer  software  developed by the company  specifically for
use with the DTN receivers.  This software manages information from a wide array
of  input   sources,   runs  routines,   sets   priorities  and  then  initiates
transmissions  to  the  satellite.  The  software  provides  the  capability  to
individually address each receiver unit placed with a subscriber, permitting the
company to transmit specific information to a specific subscriber(s).

         The company leases FM radio side-band channels,  satellite channels and
TV cable (VBI) to deliver the information to the companys  receivers used by its
subscribers.  All  information is up-linked from Omaha to satellite  (except FAX
and other telephone  delivery  technology) and down-linked from the satellite to
the subscriber based on the distribution technology.

         The FM monochrome  subscribers  receive their  information  using an FM
antenna that receives the information via the side-band signal  transmitted from
the radio stations.  On December 31, 1995, 19,000 subscribers were receiving the
companies services via FM distribution technology.  The Ku subscribers utilize a
30 satellite dish, a direct down-link, to receive their information. On December
31, 1995,  74,400  subscribers  were  receiving  the  companies  services via Ku
distribution technology.

                                      280
<PAGE>
         Early in 1994,  the  company  began  using a new TV cable  distribution
technology   involving  vertical  blanking  intervals  (VBI).  The  company  has
contracted with a major cable TV superstation to transmit information along with
the stations TV signal. This technology eliminates the need for an FM antenna or
satellite  dish and is available to businesses or residences  that are wired for
cable TV and receive the  superstations  service.  On December 31,  1995,  2,500
subscribers   were  receiving  the  companies   services  by  VBI   distribution
technology.

         The company has approximately 8,000 FAX customers receiving information
using FAX  technology.  The E-Mail business is primarily a subscriber (an E-Mail
source)  communicating  specific messages to a group of subscribers.  Currently,
there are over 200 E-Mail sources  delivering over 1,000 pages of information to
subscribers.  The company began to deliver  services on the Internet in 1995 and
plans to continue researching this information distribution technology.

SERVICES OFFERED

         The  companys  revenue  is derived  mainly  from five  categories:  (1)
monthly, quarterly or annual subscriptions,  (2) optional service subscriptions,
(3) communication services, (4) advertising and (5) service initiation fees.

         The  percentage  of total revenue for each category over the last three
fiscal years was:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                   1995      1994      1993
                                   ----      ----      ----
<S>                                 <C>       <C>       <C>
Subscriptions                       74%       73%       72%
Optional services                    6%        8%        7%
Communication services              11%       10%        9%
Advertising                          3%        5%        7%
Service Initiation Fees              6%        4%        5%
</TABLE>


         The subscription  revenue is monthly,  quarterly or annual subscription
fees for one of the companys services. A more detailed review of each service is
found later in this report.

         Optional  services are offered to  subscribers  on an a la carte basis,
similar to premium  channels on cable TV. The  information for these services is
primarily  provided  by a  third  party  with  DTN  receiving  a  share  of  the
subscription revenue paid by the subscriber. Optional services revenue continues
to grow but has decreased as a percentage of total revenue  primarily due to the
growth in subscriptions revenue.

         The  company  sells  communication  services  that allow  companies  to
cost-effectively  communicate  a  large  amount  of  time-sensitive  information
                                       7

                                      281
<PAGE>
(NEWS...NOT HISTORY) to their customers or field offices. This category includes
revenue generated from FAX and E-Mail services.

         The company sells  advertising  space  interspersed  among the pages of
news and  information,  similar to a newspaper or magazine.  The advantage of an
electronic   advertisement  over  typical  print  media  is  the  time-sensitive
(NEWS...NOT  HISTORY)  delivery  of the ad, as well as the ability to change the
advertising  message  quickly  and as  frequent  as market  conditions  dictate.
Advertising revenue continues to grow but has decreased as a percentage of total
revenue primarily due to the growth in subscriptions revenue.

         Service  initiation  fees  are  one-time  charges  to  new  subscribers
depending on the service and the information distribution  technology.  DTN also
charges an initiation fee for those  subscribers  who convert to another service
(ie: from a monochrome FM to a Ku color service)

DTN AGRICULTURAL SERVICES

        The   DTN   Agricultural   related   services   include   DTN   AgDaily,
DTNstant/Knight-Ridder, DTNironSM, DTN Pro Series, DTN PROduceSM and DTN Weather
CenterSM.


GRAPH IN TABULAR FORM:

                              1991      1992      1993      1994      1995
                              ----      ----      ----      ----      ----
DTN Ag Services Revenue
     ($ million)              18.8      20.6      27.0      33.7      45.0


DTN AGDAILY SERVICE

SERVICE REVIEW
         The companys  first service,  DTN AgDaily,  is an  agricultural  market
information and quotes service.  Monochrome (FM and Ku) DTN AgDaily  subscribers
receive  delayed  commodity  futures  and options  quotes;  local cash grain and
livestock prices;  selected regional and world weather updates; and a variety of
daily analysis, commentary and news that affects grain and livestock prices.

        The DTN AgDaily color Ku graphics  system  includes an advanced  weather
segment  with  national  and  regional  radar maps  (updated  every 15 minutes),
satellite cloud cover maps,  precipitation  and temperature  maps and much more.
The  subscriber  can custom design high  resolution  charts and/or select from a
library that holds over 1,000 charts. Subscribers can custom program the futures
quotes pages to display only the quotes they desire.  The service also  includes
information segments for specific crop and livestock enterprises.

         Subscribers can select from more than 100 different  optional services.
The majority of these  services have  information  provided by third parties and
range from more advanced weather  information to advisory  services for specific
commodities.
                                      282
<PAGE>
         Approximately 80% of the services  subscribers are farmers or livestock
producers   with  the  balance   consisting   primarily   of  grain   elevators,
agribusinesses,  and financial  institutions.  DTN AgDaily  subscribers farm one
quarter of the nations total  cropland and market 50% of the nations  cattle and
hogs. This service has approximately  70% of the market for  satellite-delivered
agricultural news and information services.  Subscribers can be found all across
the U.S and Canada.

         The  biggest  competitors  to this  service  are  considered  to be the
combination of printed advisory services,  radio, television,  telephone,  other
satellite  information  services,  on-line  services  and  the  changing  of old
information  gathering  habits.  The  company  believes  it  provides a superior
service compared to the services available by its leading competitors.

        New  subscriptions  are  primarily  sold by a sales  force  of  employee
district sales representatives as well as by independent,  commission-only sales
representatives.   The  company  obtains  leads  for  the  sales  force  through
telemarketing,  direct mail, print media advertising and customer referrals. The
price of the  monochrome  FM service  is $25.99 per month,  $32.99 per month for
monochrome  Ku service  and $45.99 per month for color Ku  service.  The company
offers a discount to subscribers who pre-pay their subscriptions annually.

1995 HIGHLIGHTS
         DTN  AgDaily  remains  the  companys   largest  service  and  its  1995
performance  met  managements  expectations.  Twenty percent  operating  revenue
growth  (total  revenue less service  initiation  fees) and over six percent net
subscriber  growth  demonstrated   acceptance  of  higher-priced   services  and
increased subscriptions to optional services. Subscribers continue to convert to
the color system and represent 60% of the services total subscribers compared to
50% in 1994.

         The company  doubled the number of the district sales  representatives,
positioning the company to cover more territory within the U.S. and Canada.  The
                                       8

                                      283
<PAGE>
number  of  subscribers  in  Canada  increased  61% in 1995  compared  to  1994.
Management  will  continually  analyze  the  markets  in the U.S.  and Canada to
determine   the   optimum   district   sales   representatives    necessary   to
cost-effectively maximize sales.

         DTN AgDaily  introduced a number of  enhancements to the service during
1995.  The  service  began  offering  crop  liability  insurance  and  livestock
profitability  calculators  by using the  inter-activity  feature  that allows a
subscriber  to  search a  comprehensive  database.  This  feature  also  allowed
subscribers  to  search  a  comprehensive  seed  catalog.   Weather  information
advancements  increased the  sensitivity of radar maps,  increased the number of
weather reporting stations and added new maps for 30 and 90 day forecasts.

         In 1995, the ag related  services sold over $1.9 million in advertising
space. The companies purchasing  advertising are considered major players in the
agriculture,  ag chemicals,  seeds, equipment and finance businesses.  The color
system  capabilities,  such as inter-activity and animation,  continue to entice
new  advertisers.  Advertising  research in 1995  confirmed that the company has
become a major player in the farm media field.

         DTN AgDaily  management  believes the trend toward  consolidation  into
larger farms is expanding the market for agricultural information services. This
expansion  should  provide  steady  growth  for DTN  AgDaily  as well the  other
agricultural related services; DTN Pro Series, DTNstant/Knight-Ridder,  DTNiron,
DTN PROduce, and DTN Weather Center.


DTNSTANT/KNIGHT-RIDDER SERVICE

SERVICE REVIEW
         DTNstant/Knight-Ridder(formerly  DTNstant)  is  a  color  service  that
provides a selection  of  real-time  futures  and options  quotes from the major
commodity  exchanges.  The service also provides headline commodity news, market
leading  cash  information,   in-depth   charting   capabilities  plus  all  the
information  available on the DTN AgDaily color service. The primary subscribers
are commercial grain companies and elevators,  feedlots,  commodity  brokers and
commodity  speculators.  Due to the  character  of this  industry,  the  company
provides on-site service and installation by professional service technicians.

         DTNstant/Knight-Ridder  operates  in a  very  competitive  market  with
numerous  national and  regional  providers of instant  commodity  quotes.  This
service is the leader in the satellite  delivery of instant  futures and options
quotes.  New  subscriptions are primarily sold by the district sales force which
is  supported  by  telemarketing  and direct  mail  campaigns.  This  service is
available only by color Ku-band satellite  transmission and is priced at $160.00
a month.

1995 HIGHLIGHTS
         In  July  of  1995,   the   acquisition  of  2,900   subscribers   from
Knight-Ridder  Commodity  Center  made the  DTNstant/Knight-Ridder  service  the
leader in the instant commodity information industry. This acquisition more than
doubled the  subscriber  base with revenue  increasing  84% in 1995  compared to
1994.  The  transition  of the acquired  subscribers  to the DTN ACE receiver is
moving forward as planned.

                                      284
<PAGE>
         As a result of the  Knight-Ridder  acquisition,  subscribers  have seen
several  notable  enhancements  to the service.  The addition of the  Associated
Press,  Futures World News,  Knight-Ridder and DTN news services are among these
enhancements.  This service also provides  information  for the energy,  metals,
softs (ie: orange juice, coffee,  cocoa),  transportation and lumber industries.
There are no other services in the industry offering a more  comprehensive  news
and information source.

DTNIRON SERVICE

SERVICE REVIEW
        DTNiron is a color  service  providing  a  cost-effective  communication
resource for the farm implement  industry.  DTNiron is an equipment  locator and
inventory  management  service  providing  a  communication  tool  for the  farm
implement dealers  throughout the U.S and Canada.  The service allows dealers of
all makes of farm implement equipment to work together to manage their inventory
resulting in increased sales and  profitability.  This service provides valuable
information on the national outlook for farm equipment sales.
                                       9

                                      285
<PAGE>
         DTNiron provides detailed listings of farm implement equipment for sale
by dealers as well as equipment  needed by other  dealers.  Subscribers  receive
industry news, financial  information,  economic indicators and information from
the DTN AgDaily color  service.  This service is only available by color Ku-band
satellite transmission and costs $94.50 a month.

1995 HIGHLIGHTS
         The  subscriber  growth for 1995 was a 44%  increase  over 1994.  Total
implement and equipment  listings on the service reached a record high of 11,000
at year end, and averaged  2,500-3,500  new listings each month. A listing stays
on the system for a minimum of 30 days, renewable at the dealers request.

         The DTNiron  service  opened its  listings to  construction  equipment,
trucks,  trailers and other equipment that is found in the agriculture industry.
The service also started  providing  listings for implement and equipment parts,
especially  hard to find  parts.  In  addition,  the  service  regionalized  the
listings  and  started  hourly  updates  to keep the  information  as current as
possible. All of these new features have been well received.

DTN PRO SERIES SERVICE

SERVICE REVIEW
         The DTN Pro Series services are an advanced information source designed
for agricultural  subscribers who require more extensive information that can be
customized for their specific needs and operations. The Pro Series includes five
services: Weather Pro, News Pro, Chart Pro, Intraday Pro and Stock Pro.

         Weather Pro is the meteorological connection to the most complete array
of current  weather,  forecast and  satellite  radar  information.  This service
allows the subscriber to choose from over 70 new weather maps including detailed
regional, state and zone forecasts. The Weather Pro service gives the subscriber
32 programmable pages to create their own unique weather information chapter.

         News Pro is the  broadcast  connection  to the most timely  (NEWS...NOT
HISTORY) business,  sports,  entertainment,  financial,  and general news of the
day. The service also provides an audio summary of the days  agricultural  news.
News Pro subscribers  receive AP Online, a service of the Associated Press, as a
news source.
                                      286
<PAGE>
         Chart Pro is the graphic  connection  bringing a variety of information
to the screen in an organized  format to allow the subscriber to analyze trends,
patterns and cycles.  This  service  includes 40 pages for  programmable  charts
allowing the subscriber to create an extensive chart book.

         Intraday Pro is the trading  connection  to the first  low-cost  system
with the ability to chart market  sessions  minute-by-minute  during the trading
day. This service allows the subscriber to choose the time intervals they desire
to chart and keep them abreast of the markets.

         Stock Pro is the market connection  providing access to prices for over
50,000 issues of stocks,  bonds and funds.  This service  includes  stock quotes
using  either  the  quick  quote  feature  or  the  programmable  quotes  pages.
Additional  features are the personal library used to store news and information
and the high interest  windows that allows the subscriber to constantly  monitor
up to six futures, options, stock or bond quotes.

         The individual Pro Series services are bundled with DTN Ag Daily.  Each
individual  Pro Series service is $58.99 per month except the Stock Pro which is
$66.00 a month.  DTN Premier is the package of Weather Pro, News Pro,  Chart Pro
and Intraday  Pro,  priced at $73.99 per month.  DTN Premier Plus is the package
DTN  Premier  and Stock  Pro,  priced at $78.00 a month.  This  service  is only
available by color Ku-band satellite transmission.

1995 HIGHLIGHTS
         The DTN Pro Series had a very successful 1995. The number of Pro Series
subscribers  more than doubled  during the year due to excellent  sales combined
with upgrades from lower priced services, primarily color DTN AgDaily. The Stock
Pro service was released late in the year, therefore,  it is too soon to measure
customer acceptance.
                                       10

                                      287
<PAGE>
         Our research  shows that  customer  satisfaction  for the Pro Series is
very  favorable.  This  research is  confirmed  by the fact that our  subscriber
retention rate for these services is very high.

DTN PRODUCE SERVICE

SERVICE REVIEW
         DTN PROduce is the authority in providing the produce industry with the
most timely weather,  prices,  transportation  and news  information  available.
There are four major  components  to the DTN PROduce  service.  First is weather
information, providing the single most important piece of information for anyone
in the produce  business.  Second is pricing  information,  providing  immediate
updates upon release  formatted by commodity,  growing area and terminal market.
Third is  transportation  information,  providing  freight rates and daily truck
availability  by  the  major  growing  areas.   Finally,  the  service  provides
comprehensive industry specific and general news.

         The market for the service is the entire produce food chain of growers,
shippers,  packers,  brokers,  retailers and institutions.  This service is only
available via color Ku-band satellite and is priced at $84.50 per month.

1995 HIGHLIGHTS
         DTN PROduce has incurred  better than expected  acceptance  relative to
sales  and  marketing  resources  devoted  to this  service.  This  service  has
attracted a high  percentage of the major players in this  industry,  yielding a
very impressive subscriber list.
                                      288
<PAGE>
         DTN PROduce developed a price discovery network,  the DTNdex,  that has
been  accepted as an industry  standard.  Competition  in this industry is still
focused on older technology, such as FAX machines.

DTN WEATHER CENTER (NEW SERVICE)

SERVICE REVIEW
         DTN Weather Center was unveiled at the corporations annual meeting held
in April 1995. This service  combines many of DTNs most popular weather features
with several new features  that allow the service to be marketed to a variety of
industries, such as golf course management,  construction, emergency management,
aviation and public  works.  This service can be sold to virtually  any industry
where timely (NEWS...NOT  HISTORY),  accurate,  accessible  weather  information
would cause a decision to be made concerning the deployment of manpower.

         DTN Weather Center provides 80 weather maps, 20 regional radar maps and
four satellite maps. The service provides  short-range  (24-48 hours) forecasts,
long-range  (3-10 day)  outlooks,  and  five-day  city  forecasts  in three hour
intervals for 223 different  cities in the U.S. and Canada.  DTN Weather  Center
features  the new  Insta-Rad  radar  maps that  allow the  company  to send this
information within five minutes to the subscriber.

         This service is available only via color Ku-band satellite transmission
and is priced at $68.00 per month.

1995 HIGHLIGHTS
         DTN Weather  Center  exceeded the sales goals for 1995. The progress in
1995  suggests  that  this  could be a very  successful  service  and led to the
decision to double the size of the sales and  marketing  staff for this service,
including  the  addition  of sales  coordinators  for the turf and  construction
industries.

         DTN Weather  Center has been well  received by the  aviation  industry.
These subscribers  account for more than 25% of the services total  subscribers.
Government (public works,  transportation and emergency  management) offices are
showing  interest  in this  service  and now  rank  second  on the list of total
subscribers to the service. A contract in the fourth quarter of 1995 placed over
100 units with the Iowa Department of Transportation.

                                       11

                                      289
<PAGE>
OPTIONAL SERVICES

SERVICE REVIEW
         Optional Services include advisory, educational and other informational
services offered to DTN subscribers on an a la carte basis.  Additional Services
are marketed by advertising on DTN services,  direct mail,  invoice stuffers and
free trials. An Additional  Service is featured on a regular basis providing all
subscribers  a  three-day  free  trial.  Subscribers  can  request and receive a
two-week free trial of any Additional Service.

         New  Additional  Services  are  developed  and  added to meet  customer
requests for information. Additional Services range in price from $6 to $300 per
quarter depending on the service.

1995 HIGHLIGHTS
         The total number of additional services grew to over 100 compared to 80
in 1994.  Subscription  sales,  revenue and the number of  services  offered all
increased to make 1995 a positive year compared to 1994.


                                      290
<PAGE>
DTN FINANCIAL SERVICES

         DTN  Financial  Services has grown from a single  service in 1989,  DTN
Wall Street, to four services, DTN Wall Street, DTN SPECTRUMSM,  DTN FirstRateSM
and DTN  GovRateSM.  DTN Financial  Services also includes a variety of optional
advisory and fundamental market information services.

GRAPH IN TABULAR FORM:


                              1991      1992      1993      1994      1995
                              ----      ----      ----      ----      ----
DTN Financial Services
  Revenue ($ million)          1.9       3.3       4.1       5.1       6.1


         The  financial  services  compounded  revenue  growth for the past five
years was a very bullish 41%. The financial  services  objective is to provide a
comprehensive  in-depth  service at an affordable cost to the  subscriber.  This
objective  will remain very  important due to the highly  competitive  nature of
this business. The a la carte optional services are offered to the subscriber to
give  them an even  larger  variety  of  information.  The  contents  of all DTN
Financial  Services  are  broader  in scope  and cost  less per  month  than the
services  offered  by  competitors.  This  combination  allows the  services  to
maintain a competitive advantage.

1995 HIGHLIGHTS
         In November  1995,  DTN  Financial  Services  released  the service DTN
Spectrum,  an extensive  enhanced  version of DTN Wall Street  utilizing the ACE
technology.  This service was in  development  for three years to ensure that it
was as  comprehensive  as  subscribers  have come to demand and at an affordable
price.  This service has been well  received by the market  during it brief time
since release.

         DTN  Financial  Services  expanded  sales and  marketing  operations by
opening  an office in Salt Lake  City,  Utah.  This  expansion  accompanied  the
establishment of a new business  relationship  with Zions First National Bank to
offer  executable U.S.  government  security  quotes through a new service,  DTN
GovRate.

DTN WALL STREET SERVICE

SERVICE REVIEW
         DTN Wall Street  provides  exchange  delayed  quotes on stocks,  bonds,
mutual and money market funds, futures, interest rates, currencies and real-time
index  quotes.  This service also  provides  in-depth  economic,  financial  and
business news and other  time-sensitive  (NEWS...NOT  HISTORY)  financial market
information  such as  company-specific  news and  earnings.  The service  allows
subscribers to custom  program the system to track their  selection of financial
quotes.

         The subscribers to DTN Wall Street have a variety of optional  services
from which to choose providing stock selection and timing advice, U.S. Treasury,
Agency, mortgage-backed securities quotes and other financial related services.

         The  majority of  subscribers  are  individual  investors,  independent
brokers, financial advisors and financial institutions.  The primary competition
for DTN Wall Street are  satellite,  TV cable (VBI) and dial-up quote  services.
New subscribers to this service are obtained through direct response  marketing,
primarily print media, television advertising and telemarketing.

         This service is available by monochrome  Ku-band satellite and TV cable
(VBI) and is priced at $41.95 per month.
                                       12

                                      291
<PAGE>
1995 HIGHLIGHTS
         During 1995,  an effort was made to increase the  subscriber  retention
rate through improved content and customer service  resulting in an 11 % decline
in the  cancellation  rate of the DTN  Wall  Street  service.  The  content  and
customer service will continue to be a focus area in 1996.

         Total  revenues  for DTN Wall  Street  service  grew nearly 20% in 1995
compared to 1994.  Optional  services revenue  increased 18% in 1995 compared to
1994.

         In May,  1995, DTN Wall Street became  available on the Internet.  This
information  distribution technology will allow millions of on-line users access
to 15 independent  information  segments priced from $12.00 to $40.00 per month.
The company continues to research the Internet for additional applications.

DTN SPECTRUM  (New Service)

SERVICE REVIEW
         DTN SPECTRUM was an important focus of the new service development team
at DTN during 1995. This service was released during  November,  1995, and is an
enhanced  version of DTN Wall Street  utilizing the ACE technology.  The service
provides many  additional  features and functions that appeal to a wider market.
This service provides advanced quote selection and custom programming along with
alarms and charting capability.  The service will continue to be enhanced during
1996.

         This  service  was well  received  in the short  time it was  available
during 1995. All indications are that subscription sales will be strong in 1996.

         An extension  of DTN  SPECTRUM is the DTN  SPECTRUM  R-T service.  This
marks the entry by the DTN Financial  Services into the real-time quotes market.
The  service  will  provide  a mix of  exchange-delayed  quotes  along  with the
subscribers choice of real-time  commodities and futures quotes. This service is
expected to be well received by the market in 1996.

         The DTN SPECTRUM  and DTN  SPECTRUM R-T services are only  available by
color  Ku-band  satellite  and are  priced  at $68.00  and  $118.00  per  month,
respectively.  These  services  will become  available  by TV cable (VBI) during
1996.

DTN FIRSTRATE SERVICE

SERVICE REVIEW
         DTN  FirstRate  is  a  service  for  the  mortgage  industry  providing
wholesale  price  information  in an  easy-to-use  standard  format and intraday
interest rate  information to indicate the direction of wholesale  prices.  This

                                      292
<PAGE>
service also provides  subscribers  with business,  economic and financial news,
analysis, and commentary including leading economic indicators, employment rates
and government economic reports and trend analysis.

         Sales for DTN FirstRate are slow.  Company research  suggests we should
expect modest success with this service;  however, the company is continuing the
search for more cost effective sales and marketing programs.

         This service is available by monochrome  Ku-band  satellite or TV cable
(VBI) and is priced at $111.95 per month.

DTN GOVRATE  (NEW SERVICE)

SERVICE REVIEW
         DTN GovRate provides  executable U.S.  government  security quotes from
Zions First  National  Bank.  The  real-time  prices are provided from a primary
dealer,  the former Discount  Corporation of New York (DCNY), now operating as a
division of Zions First National Bank.

         The  company  views  this  service  as  an  important  development  for
financial institutions.  The service will provide the ability for more than just
large, money-center banks and institutions to have access to competitive pricing
of U.S. government securities.

         DTN GovRate will open  opportunities  for smaller to  mid-sized  banks,
public and corporate treasurers,  and independent brokerage firms to participate
in the trading of U.S.  government  securities.  Zions First  National Bank will
facilitate this by offering odd lot trading and repurchase agreements.

         This service is available by monochrome  Ku-band  satellite or TV cable
(VBI) transmission for $34.95 per month. The service is also currently available
on color Ku-band satellite for $68.00 per month.

DTN ENERGY SERVICES


GRAPH IN TABULAR FORM:

                              1991      1992      1993      1994      1995
                              ----      ----      ----      ----      ----
DTN Energy Services
  Revenue ($ million)          0.8       2.9       4.9       7.2      10.0

                                       13

                                      293
<PAGE>
The energy related  services  include  DTNergy for the refined fuels and natural
gas industries.

DTNERGY SERVICE

SERVICE REVIEW
        DTNergy is a service  providing pricing  information and  communications
services for the petroleum  industry.  This service consists of several pages of
delayed  energy  futures and options  quotes plus  selected  news and  financial
information.  DTNergy is  designed  to connect  refiners  (producers  of refined
fuels) to wholesalers  (distributor of refined fuels). The refiner sends refined
fuel prices to wholesalers they have authorized to receive this information. The
refiner  also has the  capability  to send  terminal  alerts,  electronic  funds
transfer  notifications,  invoices,  and other communications to the wholesaler.
DTNergy  subscribers can select from a variety of optional services to give them
even more prices or news related to the petroleum industry.

         The strength of the DTNergy  service is the ability to deliver,  within
seconds,  accurate refiner terminal prices and other vital communications to the
wholesalers.  This service is more reliable,  timely and less expensive than the
competition,  which utilize  telephone  delivered  printer-only  systems and FAX
services.

         DTNergy generates revenue from two primary sources,  the wholesaler and
the refiner.  The wholesaler pays a monthly  subscription  fee of $36.00 for the
monochrome  Ku-band  satellite  service.  The  refiner  pays fees based upon the
number and length of communications sent to wholesalers.

         DTNergy  developed a service for the natural gas industry.  Subscribers
receive  natural  gas flow data,  instant or delayed  NYMEX  energy  options and
futures  quotes,  weather and  industry  specific  information.  This service is
marketed to natural gas producers, distributors and large consumers. The service
is only  available by color Ku-band  satellite and is priced at $129 a month for
30-minute delayed quotes and $160 a month for real-time quotes.

1995 HIGHLIGHTS
         The DTNergy  services had another very good year in 1995.  This service
reaches an estimated 90% of the major U.S. petroleum industry wholesalers. These
wholesalers receive direct communication from 120 refiners, including nearly all
the major U.S. oil refiners.  The number of wholesalers showed modest growth but
the number of other customers (FAX, Printer,  E-Mail and the Internet) increased
to 8,500 in 1995 compared to 7,500 in 1994.

         Total  revenue  grew 38% and  communication  revenue grew nearly 50% in
1995  compared to 1994.  The  company  expects  wholesaler/subscriber  growth to
decline but expects communications revenue to continue to grow in 1996.

                                      294
<PAGE>
         DTNergy  continued  to develop the service  targeted at the natural gas
and electric  power  industries,  which are dependent on current  information to
make daily operating decisions.  This service showed only moderate growth during
1995.  During 1995,  DTNergy  completed  implementation  of new FAX, Printer and
E-Mail services.

DTN AUTO SERVICES


GRAPH IN TABULAR FORM:



                                   1993      1994      1995
                                   ----      ----      ----
DTN Auto Services Revenue
  ($ millions)                      0.0       0.0       0.7


DTNAUTO SERVICE

SERVICE REVIEW
         DTNauto  (SM)  is a  communication  and  information  service  for  the
automobile   industry.   This  service  offers   automobile   dealers  precision
information to value  trade-ins,  locate used car inventory plus a host of other
information  and  convenient   features.   Automobile   auction   companies  and
manufacturers are able to communicate directly with the dealers.

         DTNauto  provides  information  on  pre-auction   automobile  listings,
results of past  auctions,  new and used car  industry  news,  weather and other
news.  The  service  allows  subscribers  to  perform  searches  of the  auction
listings, upcoming and past, for specific automobile information.

         The service offers a variety of optional services providing information
on credit reporting (CREDCO),  vehicle histories (CARFAX),  warranty information
(The Warranty Guide) and residual value of leased  vehicles  (Lease Guide).  The
CARFAX and CREDCO optional  services  extensively  utilize the internal modem to
send  and  receive  information.  These  services  create  a more  comprehensive
information service that puts the subscriber in the drivers seat.

                                       14

                                      295
<PAGE>
         This service is being marketed by the DTNauto sales force to automobile
dealers  across the United  States.  This  service  is only  available  by color
Ku-band satellite transmission and is priced at $98.00 per month.

1995 HIGHLIGHTS
         The  driving  force  that  fuels  the  DTNauto   service   remains  the
pre-auction  listings of used cars at more than 125 auctions  across the country
and  AuctionNet,  a wholesale  pricing  service.  In 1995,  DTNauto  established
remarketing and  communication  networks giving the manufacturers the ability to
communicate with the dealers.  These networks included Lexus,  Mazda,  Chrysler,
American  Honda,  Subaru and Kia (added January 1996),  all major players in the
auto  industry.  A  remarketing  segment  was also  established  for  Enterprise
Rent-a-Car.  Additionally,  DTNauto added a damaged  vehicle network serving the
salvage auto industry.

         DTNauto expanded its optional services by adding the Warranty Guide and
Lease Guide to help dealers establish accurate auto values.  Also, by subscriber
demand, the DTN SPECTRUM service was made available to automobile dealers.

JOINT VENTURE SERVICES

         DTN has joined  forces with other  companies to market  their  services
using the companys  technology.  These services are TracElectric,  a service for
the electric equipment industry, and DAT Transportation  Terminal, a service for
the trucking industry.

TRACELECTRIC SERVICE

SERVICE REVIEW
         TracElectric  is  an  equipment  locator  service  for  the  electrical
equipment industry. This service provides over 100 pages of new, remanufactured,
surplus and used electrical equipment listings.  The service connects buyers and
sellers throughout the U.S. and Canada.

         This service is available only by monochrome  Ku-band satellite and DTN
receives a percentage of the revenue.

DAT TRANSPORTATION TERMINAL (NEW SERVICE)

SERVICE REVIEW
         The  DAT  (Dial-A-Truck)  Transportation  Terminal  (DAT)  service  was
introduced  in the fourth  quarter of 1995 and is an  information  communication
system for the trucking  industry.  This service is a joint  venture with DAT in
Beaverton, OR and DTN. The service provides load and truck matching performed on
a database of 25,000 listings updated daily.

         DAT service allows subscribers to input their own listings into the ACE
receiver and send this  information  to the database  using the internal  modem.
This service provides the subscriber the ability to perform  extensive  searches
to locate  loads and  trucks  and set  alarms to alert the user that a match has
occurred.  The service also provides  regional  radar maps of major highways and
interstates,  transportation  news,  diesel  fuel  prices  and  other  financial
information related to the trucking industry.

         The target market includes all freight brokers and carriers  throughout
U.S. and Canada.  This service is only available by color Ku-band  satellite and
DTN receives a monthly fee per receiver.

                                       15

                                      296
<PAGE>
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                            SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

GRAPHS IN TABULAR FORM:


% of Total Revenues:
                              1995      1994      1993
                              ----      ----      ----   
DTN Ag Services                72%       73%       75%
DTN Financial Services         10%       11%       11%
DTN Energy Services            16%       16%       14%
Other Services                  2%        0%        0%


% of Suscribers at Year End:
                              1995      1994      1993
                              ----      ----      ----   
DTN Ag Services                89%       81%       82%
DTN Financial Services         10%       10%       10%
DTN Energy Services             7%        8%        8%
Other Services                  3%        1%        0%


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>


                                        1995            1994            1993           1992            1991
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
For the Year:

<S>                                 <C>             <C>             <C>            <C>            <C>         
Revenues ........................   $ 62,287,989    $ 46,109,789    $ 35,992,754   $ 26,816,254   $ 21,464,580
Operating income ................      4,343,252         694,560       2,408,868      2,995,319      2,658,280
Income (loss) before income taxes       (397,076)     (2,422,738)      1,020,831      2,051,352      1,476,398
Net income (loss) ...............       (283,076)     (1,602,738)        663,831      1,351,352      1,426,398

Net income (loss) per share .....           (.09)           (.49)            .20            .41            .43
Dividends per share .............           --              --              --             --             --


At Year End:

Total assets ....................   $ 92,672,050    $ 71,459,356    $ 57,242,313   $ 38,260,351   $ 30,549,390
Long-term debt and
   subordinated notes ...........     47,020,527      33,982,814      25,375,000     13,677,083      9,719,490
Stockholders equity .............     12,876,965      12,706,978      12,780,477     12,167,584     12,007,741
</TABLE>
                                       16

                                      297
<PAGE>
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                     MANAGEMENTS'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

FINANCIAL CONDITION

         The equipment used by subscribers is a large capital investment for the
company.  This  equipment  accounts for 75% of the companys  total  assets.  The
company  does not have a large  amount of  current  assets  compared  to capital
equipment.

         Net cash  provided  by  operating  activities  in 1995 was  $16,623,300
compared to  $14,376,300  in 1994. The increase was primarily due to an increase
in operating  income.  The increase in operating  income was partially offset by
the increase in interest expense and the change in assets and liabilities.

         Net cash used by investing  activities in 1995 was $29,427,900 compared
to $29,961,200 in 1994. The investment in equipment used by subscribers declined
due to a reduction in color  equipment  inventory that was built up in the later
part of 1994. The  expenditures  on equipment used by subscribers  are primarily
for color  receivers and related  equipment.  In addition,  approximately  4,000
monochrome  system (FM and Ku) subscribers  upgraded to the color Ku-band system
with over 90% of these conversions involving DTN AgDaily subscribers.

         DTN reduced its inventory of color  receivers  and  components to build
color receivers during 1995. At December 31, 1995, the company had approximately
$5,000,000 of inventory  compared to $10,000,000 in 1994. The reduction occurred
in the first half of 1995 and reduced the companys  borrowing  requirements  for
the year.

         The  company  utilizes  monochrome  receiver  equipment  coming in from
conversions  for new DTN AgDaily,  DTN Wall Street or DTNergy  subscribers.  DTN
continues to research new markets for monochrome system services.

         The company had negative working capital of $10,471,900 at December 31,
1995,  compared to $10,237,200 in 1994.  Accounts  payable at December 31, 1995,
included $3,202,600 for the purchase of Knight Ridder Financial  subscribers and
$2,190,600  to vendors for  equipment  used by  subscribers,  compared to $0 and
$1,106,000 at December 31, 1994,  respectively.  This combination  increased the
working capital deficiency from the prior year by $4,287,200.

         An increase of $3,178,800 in accounts receivable from December 31, 1994
to 1995 was primarily the offset for the negative working capital created by the
increase in  accounts  payable.  Accounts  receivable  increased  due to general
business expansion, the acquisition of Knight-Ridder Financial (KRF) subscribers
and a  changing  subscriber  base  due to the  expansion  of  the  companys  new
services.
                                      298
<PAGE>
         Effective July 26, 1995, the company entered into an agreement with KRF
to acquire 2,900 Knight Ridder Commodity News Service  subscribers.  The company
agreed to pay KRF approximately $4,970,000 over two years, made up of $3,000,000
for the  subscribers and $1,970,000 for future revenue  sharing.  The $3,000,000
for the  subscribers  is to be paid  one-half at the  closing and the  remaining
one-half  due one year from the  closing.  The  $1,970,000  for  future  revenue
sharing is based on a company estimate and is paid quarterly. The purchase price
is being  capitalized  as an intangible  asset and amortized  using the straight
line method over eight years.

         Net cash provided by financing activities of $12,864,300 was the result
of an increase in total debt outstanding (current and long-term) of $12,531,300.
The increase in debt  outstanding was used to fund capital  expenditures and the
acquisition of subscribers. The company made principal payments of $8,718,800 on
bank term debt during 1995.

         DTN anticipates that the internally generated cash flow and bank credit
lines will be sufficient to fund operating activities,  capital expenditures and
principle payments on long-term debt.

         The company believes that inflationary  trends have a limited affect on
the  business.  However,  since the  majority of the  companys  subscribers  and
revenues are related to the ag industry,  the general state of the  agricultural
economy may impact the companys business.

RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

         In many  respects,  the  financial  dynamics  of DTN are similar to the
cable TV industry.  The financial dynamics are similar due to the requirement of
an initial  investment of variable marketing costs to obtain new subscribers and
capital expenditures to provide them with the necessary equipment to receive the
companys services.

         In  addition,  DTN  has a  level  of  fixed  costs,  such  as FM and KU
satellite leases,  news and quote providers,  and administrative  expenses,  not
directly affected by the number of subscribers receiving the companys services.

GRAPH IN TABULAR FORM:

                              1991      1992      1993      1994      1995
                              ----      ----      ----      ----      ----
Operating Cash Flow
  ($ million)                  8.2       9.9      12.9      15.8      23.2

                                       17

                                      299
<PAGE>
         DTNs operating cash flow, a key indicator  monitored by DTN management,
has increased at a compounded  growth rate of 28% from 1991 to 1995.  This trend
is primarily the result of a growing base of  subscribers  covering the companys
fixed expenses.

         The  company  has  operating  leverage  due to low  variable  costs per
subscriber.  This leverage is present when a growth in  subscribers  and related
revenue has a direct impact on operating cash flow. This leverage appeared to be
declining  from 1992 through 1994 as operating cash flow as a percent of revenue
was declining.  The following graph details this trend.  The declining trend was
primarily  due to the company  spending  an  increasing  amount on research  and
development activities.

GRAPHS IN TABULAR FORM:


                              1991      1992      1993      1994      1995
                              ----      ----      ----      ----      ----
Operating Cash Flow
  (percent of revenue)        38%       37%       36%       34%       37%


         DTN accumulates research and development  activities as Net Development
Costs.  The  company  defines  Net  Development  Costs  as  1)  market  research
activities, 2) hardware and software engineering,  research and development, and
3) the  negative  operating  cash flow  (prior  to  corporate  allocations  plus
interest)  of new  services.  The  company  includes  new  services  in the  Net
Development  Costs  classification  until the service  shows  positive cash flow
prior to corporate  allocations  plus interest for a full  quarter.  The service
becomes a core service  after  reaching this level in the  development  process.
During the 1992 through 1995 time period, the company was expanding  development
activities (see chart on page 3) therefore  negatively  impacting operating cash
flow both on a total and percentage of revenue basis.

         During 1995, the success of subscription sales of the new developmental
services decreased net development costs. While the overall development expenses
increased,  the growth rate of  development  related  expenses  declined in 1995
compared  to 1994.  The  result,  operating  cash flow as a percent  of  revenue
increased to 37% in 1995 compared to 34% in 1994.  Another  contributing  factor
for the rise was operating  cash flow from core services as a percentage of core
service revenue improved to 44.4% in 1995 compared to 43.8% in 1994.

1995 COMPARED TO 1994

         The growth in  subscribers,  revenues and  operating  cash flow,  three
major  indicators  used  by  DTN  management  to  monitor  company  performance,
highlighted an outstanding  year.  Operating  income improved  dramatically  but
higher interest expense led to a net loss for the year.

                                      300
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
(In thousands)

                         1995           1994           % Change
                      --------        --------         -------- 
<S>                   <C>             <C>                <C>
Subscribers              95.9            82.0             17%
Revenues              $62,288         $46,110             35%
Operating cash flow    23,154          15,751             47%
Operating income        4,334             695            524%
Net loss                 (283)         (1,603)            82%

</TABLE>

Total  revenue  increased  35% in 1995  compared  to 1994 due to  growth  in all
operating revenue  categories.  Operating revenues  consisting of subscriptions,
additional  services,  communications  and  advertising  increased to $55.70 per
subscriber per month in 1995 compared to $46.74 in 1994.

         A 17% growth in total subscribers  combined with subscribers  upgrading
to higher priced services led to a 36% growth in subscription  revenue.  In July
1995, the company acquired  approximately 2,900 subscribers  receiving real-time
futures and option  quotes from Knight Ridder  Financial  Commodity  Center.  At
December 31, 1995, 77% of total  subscribers were receiving  service via Ku-band
satellite  transmission  compared to 72% in 1994.  Subscription revenue on a per
subscriber per month basis increased to $43.60, compared to $36.14 in 1994.

         The price of Ku-band  satellite  delivered  services ranged from $32.99
for  monochrome  DTN AgDaily to $159.99 for the color  DTNstant  service  during
1995. The price of Ku-band satellite  delivered  services ranged from $30.99 for
monochrome  DTN AgDaily to $159.99 for the color  DTNstant  service during 1994.
The price of the  monochrome  FM delivered DTN AgDaily (the only FM service) was
$25.99 in 1995 and $23.99 in 1994.

         The subscribers converting to higher priced services primarily switched
from the  monochrome FM or Ku-band  satellite  DTN AgDaily  service to the color
Ku-band  satellite DTN AgDaily,  priced at $45.99 in 1995 and 1994 ($43.99 prior
to August 15,  1994).  Subscribers  continued to convert from the color  Ku-band
satellite  DTN AgDaily  service to the color  Ku-band  satellite  DTN Pro Series
which ranged in price from $58.99,  for one Pro Series services,  to $73.99, for
all four Pro Series  services (DTN  Premier),  in 1995 and 1994. The DTN Premier
and Stock Pro, DTN Premier Plus, was priced at $78.00 a month in 1995.

                                       18

                                      301
<PAGE>
         The company continued to increase the offering of information  services
through a la carte optional services (100 in 1995 versus 80 in 1994). The growth
in services  combined  with the growth of total  subscribers  resulted in an 11%
growth  in  additional  services  revenue  to  $3,917,600  in 1995  compared  to
$3,526,300 in 1994. The Ag, Wall Street and Energy  services all  contributed to
this growth.  The revenue decreased on a per subscriber per month basis to $3.70
in 1995 compared to $3.76 in 1994.

         The growth in  communications  revenue  was  primarily  in the  DTNergy
service.  The DTNergy service  transmits  refiner prices and  communications  to
wholesalers/subscribers.  The  number of  refiner  communications  continued  to
increase in 1995.  The revenue  increased on a company wide per  subscriber  per
month basis to $6.49 in 1995, up from $4.99 in 1994.

         Advertising  revenue  grew  16%  to  $2,022,500  in  1995  compared  to
$1,738,800 in 1994. The growth was due to increased  acceptance of the DTN color
receiver system as a medium for advertising  agricultural products and services.
Other contributing  factors were a positive agriculture economy and modest price
increases for advertising on the color system.

         Service  initiation fees, the companys up-front one-time charges to new
subscribers  ranged from $150 to $295  depending on the service and  information
distribution  technology in 1994 and 1995.  Initiation fees for subscribers that
convert to another service or change delivery  technology (FM to Ku) ranged from
$50 to $100  depending on the service in 1994 and 1995. The total fees collected
increased 51% in 1995 to $3,357,300 compared to $2,227,500 in 1994. The increase
was  primarily  due to an  increase  in new  subscription  sales.  The  companys
discounting of initiation  fees to respond to competition or slower sales in the
ag market during the seasonally slower summer months was consistent with 1994.

         Total operating expenses increased 28% in 1995 over 1994. This increase
was due to a 27% increase in selling,  general and  administrative  costs, a 46%
increase in sales commissions and a 25% increase in depreciation. These expenses
(excluding the sales  commission  costs) increased on a per subscriber per month
basis to $49.75 in 1995 compared to $44.49 in 1994.

         Selling,  general and  administrative  expenses on a per subscriber per
month basis  increased  to $31.97,  up from $28.45 in 1994.  This  increase  was
primarily the result of the increase in variable costs to support a 17% increase
in subscribers,  sales force expansion and teleservices  support  (telesales and
customer  service),  internal  administrative  enhancements  and net development
costs  related  to new  service  development.  All of  these  expenditures  were
important for the company to accomplish the  aggressive  sales growth planned in
1995 and beyond.

         Sales commissions are generated from increased subscribers and revenues
in the DTNergy service.  Sales commissions increased 46% during 1995 compared to
1994. This increase is due to higher  subscription  sales,  continued  incentive
programs to the sales force and 39% higher  revenues in DTNergy.  DTNergy  sales
commissions are based on a combination of total subscribers and revenues.

         Depreciation and amortization  expense  primarily  increased due to the
purchase of over  $23,700,000 of new equipment used by subscribers.  The company
began using a six year life for  depreciation  purposes in July of 1992 compared
to an eight year life prior to the change.

                                      302
<PAGE>
         Operating income increased  significantly due to the companys growth in
total revenues and a declining growth rate in the operating  expenses  discussed
above. Operating cash flow grew 47% to $23,154,400, up from $15,750,700 in 1994.

         Interest  expense  increased  52% in  1995  over  1994.  The  rise  was
primarily due to borrowings  necessary to finance the purchase of new subscriber
equipment,  an  increase  in the prime rate  during 1994 and 1995 along with the
addition of $15,000,000 of 11.25% subordinated debt in July of 1994.

         The companys  federal and state effective tax rate was 29% for 1995 and
35% for 1994.

1994 COMPARED TO 1993

         Growth in revenue,  operating cash flows and total  subscribers,  which
are three major  indicators  used to monitor the financial  performance  of DTN,
highlighted a year of good performance.  Due to the continued  investment in new
service  development,  enhancements in transmitting  technology,  administrative
computer  information  systems,  equipment  used by our  subscribers  and higher
interest expense, the companys operating and net taxable income were lower.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
(In thousands)
                         1994          1993    % Change
                      --------      --------   ---------
<S>                   <C>           <C>         <C> 
Total subscribers        82.0          74.1       11 %
Revenues              $46,110       $35,993       28 %
Operating cash flow    15,751        12,940       22 %
Operating income          695         2,409      (71)%
Net income (loss)      (1,603)          664     (342)%
</TABLE>

         Total revenue  increased 28% in 1994 over 1993 due to continued  growth
in all  operating  revenue  categories.  Operating  revenues  which  consist  of
subscriptions,  additional  services,  communications  services and advertising,
increased to $46.74 per subscriber per month in 1994 up from $39.06 in 1993.

         The 11% growth in total subscribers and subscribers upgrading to higher
priced services  resulted in a 31% growth in subscription  revenue.  At December
31, 1994, 72% of total  subscribers were receiving service via Ku-band satellite
transmission  compared to 61% in 1993.  Subscription revenue on a per subscriber
per month basis increased to $36.14, up from $30.39 in 1993.

                                       19

                                      303
<PAGE>
         The  price of the  Ku-band  satellite-delivered  services  ranged  from
$30.99 for  monochrome  DTN  AgDaily to $159.99 for the color  DTNstant  service
during  1994 and 1993.  The price of the  monochrome  FM-delivered  DTN  AgDaily
service  was  $23.99  during  1994  and  1993.  The  subscribers   switching  to
higher-priced  services  primarily  switched  from the  monochrome FM or Ku-band
satellite DTN AgDaily service to the color Ku-band satellite DTN AgDaily,  which
was priced at $45.99 in 1994  ($43.99  prior to August  15,  1994) and $43.99 in
1993.

         The company continued to increase the offering of information  services
through a la carte  additional  services  (80 in 1994  versus  55 in 1993).  The
growth of services combined with the growth of total subscribers  provided a 42%
growth in additional  services revenue to $3,526,000 in 1994, up from $2,485,000
in 1993. The Ag, Wall Street and Energy services all contributed  solid gains to
achieve this  outstanding  growth.  On a per  subscriber  per month basis,  this
revenue increased to $3.76, up from $2.91 in 1993.

         The 45% increase in communication services revenue was primarily due to
the DTNergy service.  DTNergy transmits refiner prices and other  communications
to   wholesalers/subscribers.   The  refiner   communication   volume  increased
significantly  and provided on a company wide basis a revenue  increase to $4.99
per subscriber per month in 1994, up from $3.78 in 1993.

         Advertising  revenue showed a marginal  increase in 1994 over 1993. The
company believes that competition from other  communication  companies  affected
the growth in advertising.  The company also believes  advertising revenues will
grow as subscriptions to the color services increase.

         Service  initiation fees, the companys up-front one-time charges to new
subscribers  ranged from $150 to $295  depending on the service and  information
distribution  technology in 1994 and 1993.  Initiation  fees to subscribers  who
change their service or delivery  technology  (FM to Ku) ranged from $50 to $100
depending on the service in 1995 and 1994. The total fees collected  declined in
1994  compared to 1993.  The decline was  primarily  due to an increase in sales
promotions reducing the fees to attract new subscribers.  This strategy was used
to keep new sales  strong  during the  seasonally  slow  months of summer and to
answer competitive pressures.

         Total operating expenses increased 35% over 1993. This increase was due
to a 30% increase in selling,  general and administrative  costs, a 49% increase
in sales commissions and a 43% increase in depreciation. On a per subscriber per
month basis, these expenses  (excluding the sales commission costs) increased to
$44.49, up from $36.51 in 1993.

         Selling,  general and  administrative  expenses on a per subscriber per
month basis  increased  to $28.45,  up from $24.16 in 1993.  This  increase  was
primarily  due to the  expenses  related to new  product  development,  internal
administrative  enhancements,  fixed costs related to enhancing current services
and  variable  costs  to  support  the  11%  increase  in   subscribers.   These
expenditures  are  important for the company to remain a leader in providing new
communication and information services.

                                      304
<PAGE>
         Sales  commissions  are a direct  result of increased  subscribers  and
revenues in the DTNergy service. DTNergy sales commissions are based on a mix of
total  subscribers and revenues.  Total sales  commissions  rose 49% during 1994
from 1993.  This  increase  is due to  increased  subscription  sales along with
incentive programs to the sales force to keep sales strong during the seasonally
slower summer months and significant increases in DTNergy revenues.

         Depreciation  expense increased due to the purchase of over $27,000,000
of new equipment  used by  subscribers.  The company began using a six year life
for  depreciation  purposes in July of 1992 compared to an eight year life prior
to the change.

         Operating  income declined by 71%,  primarily due to the investments in
new  services,  internal  operations  improvements  and  increased  depreciation
expense.  Operating cash flow grew 22% over 1993.  Interest expense rose 122% in
1994 over  1993.  This  significant  increase  was due to  borrowings  needed to
finance the purchase of new  subscriber  equipment,  a 42% increase in the prime
rate during 1994 and the addition of $15,000,000 of 11.25% subordinated debt.

         The company  federal and state effective tax rate for 1994 and 1993 was
35%.
                                       20

                                      305
<PAGE>
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                RESPONSIBILITIES
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Managements Responsibility for Financial Statements

To Our Stockholders:

         The management of Data Transmission  Network Corporation is responsible
for the  preparation,  integrity and objectivity of the  accompanying  financial
statements  and related  notes.  To meet these  responsibilities,  we maintain a
system of internal  controls  to provide  reasonable  assurance  that assets are
safeguarded and transactions are properly authorized and recorded.
         The  financial   statements  have  been  prepared  in  conformity  with
generally  accepted  accounting  principles  and include  amounts based upon our
estimates and judgments, as required. The financial statements have been audited
by Deloitte & Touche LLP who have expressed their opinion, presented below, with
respect to the fairness of the statements.  Their audit included a review of the
system  of  internal  control  and  tests of  transactions  to the  extent  they
considered necessary to render their opinion.
         The Audit  Committee of the Board of  Directors  is composed  solely of
outside  directors.  The Audit Committee meets periodically with our independent
auditors and management to review  accounting,  auditing,  internal  control and
financial reporting matters.




/s/ Roger R. Brodersen                 /s/ Brian L. Larson
    Chairman of the Board                  Vice President
    Chief Executive Officer                Chief Financial Officer
                                           Secretary and Treasurer

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Independent Auditors' Report

Board of Directors and Stockholders
Data Transmission Network Corporation

         We have audited the  accompanying  balance sheets of Data  Transmission
Network Corporation as of December 31, 1995 and 1994, and the related statements
of operations,  stockholders'  equity and cash flows for each of the three years
in the period ended  December  31,  1995.  These  financial  statements  are the
responsibility of the Company's management.  Our responsibility is to express an
opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.
         We conducted our audits in accordance with generally  accepted auditing
standards.  Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material
misstatement.  An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting
the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements.  An audit also includes
assessing the  accounting  principles  used and  significant  estimates  made by
management,  as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation.
We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

                                      306
<PAGE>
         In our  opinion,  such  financial  statements  present  fairly,  in all
material  respects,   the  financial  position  of  Data  Transmission   Network
Corporation  as of December 31, 1995 and 1994, and the results of its operations
and its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended  December 31,
1995, in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles.




January 30, 1996                        /s/ Deloitte and Touche LLP
Deloitte and Touche LLP                     Omaha, Nebraska


                                       21

                                      307
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
Balance Sheets
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
As of December 31,                                                     1995            1994
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
ASSETS
<S>                                                              <C>             <C>         
Current Assets:
        Cash .................................................   $    780,018    $    720,343
        Accounts receivable, net of allowance for
                doubtful accounts of $300,000 and $220,000 ...      6,476,576       3,297,773
        Prepaid expenses .....................................        474,135         189,332
        Deferred commission expense ..........................      2,076,262         629,925
                                                                 ------------    ------------
                Total Current Assets .........................      9,806,991       4,837,373

Equipment Used By Subscribers, net of accumulated depreciation
        of $60,622,532 and $43,710,079 .......................     69,644,260      61,449,931

Equipment and Leasehold Improvements, net of accumulated
         depreciation of $7,286,887 and $4,729,831 ...........      6,665,286       4,666,742

Intangible Asset, net of accumulated amortization 
         of $258,850 .........................................      4,711,150            --

Other Assets .................................................      1,844,363         505,310
                                                                 ------------    ------------
                                                                 $ 92,672,050    $ 71,459,356
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS EQUITY
Current Liabilities:
        Accounts payable .....................................   $  9,385,812    $  4,493,796
        Accrued expenses .....................................      1,856,659       1,117,206
        Current portion of long-term debt ....................      9,036,458       9,463,541
                                                                 ------------    ------------
                Total Current Liabilities ....................     20,278,929      15,074,543

Long-Term Debt ...............................................     32,536,457      19,578,124
Subordinated Long-Term Notes, net of unamortized
        discount of $515,930 and $595,310 ....................     14,484,070      14,404,690
Equipment Deposits ...........................................        541,720         542,102
Unearned Revenue .............................................     11,953,909       9,152,919

Stockholders Equity:
        Common stock, par value $.001, authorized
                20,000,000 shares, issued 3,375,408 ..........          3,375           3,375
        Paid-in capital ......................................     14,422,689      14,302,689
        Retained earnings (deficit) ..........................       (497,687)       (217,501)
        Treasury stock, at cost, 60,315 and 83,723 shares ....     (1,051,412)     (1,381,585)
                                                                 ------------    ------------
                Total Stockholders Equity ....................     12,876,965      12,706,978
                                                                 ------------    ------------
                                                                 $ 92,672,050    $ 71,459,356
<FN>
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.
</FN>
</TABLE>
                                       22

                                      308
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
Statements of Operations

Years Ended December 31,                          1995            1994            1993
                                              -------------   -------------  --------------
REVENUES:
<S>                                           <C>             <C>             <C>         
        Subscriptions .....................   $ 46,126,332    $ 33,936,160    $ 25,924,520
        Additional services ...............      3,917,631       3,526,295       2,484,675
        Communication services ............      6,864,275       4,680,987       3,227,881
        Advertising .......................      2,022,440       1,738,830       1,673,075
        Service initiation fees ...........      3,357,311       2,227,517       2,682,603
                                              -------------   -------------  --------------
                                                62,287,989      46,109,789      35,992,754
EXPENSES:
        Selling, general and administrative     33,827,282      26,715,251      20,602,329
        Sales commissions .................      5,306,305       3,643,811       2,450,718
        Depreciation and amortization .....     18,811,150      15,056,167      10,530,839
                                              -------------   -------------  --------------
OPERATING INCOME ..........................      4,343,252         694,560       2,408,868

        Interest expense ..................      4,798,112       3,158,106       1,421,299
        Other income, net .................         57,784          40,808          33,262
                                              -------------   -------------  --------------
INCOME (LOSS) BEFORE INCOME TAXES .........       (397,076)     (2,422,738)      1,020,831

        Income tax (benefit) provision ....       (114,000)       (820,000)        357,000

NET INCOME (LOSS) .........................   $   (283,076)   $ (1,602,738)   $    663,831


EARNINGS (LOSS) PER SHARE .................   $      (0.09)   $      (0.49)   $       0.20


Weighted Average Number of Shares
        Outstanding .......................      3,302,864       3,253,400       3,286,850

<FN>
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.
</FN>
</TABLE>
                                       23

                                      309
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
Statements of Stockholders Equity
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Years Ended December 31, 1995, 1994 and 1993
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                             Retained                         Total
                                                Common      Paid -in         Earnings        Treasury      Stockholders
                                                 Stock       Capital         (Deficit)         Stock          Equity
                                           ------------   -------------    -----------    ------------    -------------
<S>                                        <C>            <C>              <C>            <C>             <C>         
Balance, January 1, 1993 ...............   $      3,375   $ 13,493,689     $   855,635    $ (2,185,115)   $ 12,167,584

Treasury stock issued on exercise of
     employee stock options and warrants           --           12,195            --           147,621         159,816

Tax benefit related to exercise of
     employee stock options and warrants           --           20,000            --              --            20,000

Purchase of treasury stock .............           --             --              --          (230,754)       (230,754)

Net income .............................           --             --           663,831            --           663,831
                                           ------------   -------------    -----------    ------------    -------------
Balance, December 31, 1993 .............          3,375     13,525,884       1,519,466      (2,268,248)     12,780,477

Treasury stock issued on exercise of
     employee stock options and warrants           --          (12,195)       (134,229)      1,420,663       1,274,239

Tax benefit related to exercise of
     employee stock options and warrants           --          154,000            --              --           154,000

Purchase of treasury stock .............           --             --              --          (534,000)       (534,000)

Issuance of warrants in connection
     with subordinated debt ............           --          635,000            --              --           635,000

Net loss ...............................           --             --        (1,602,738)           --        (1,602,738)
                                           ------------   -------------    -----------    ------------    -------------
Balance, December 31, 1994 .............          3,375     14,302,689        (217,501)     (1,381,585)     12,706,978

Treasury stock issued on exercise of
     employee stock options and warrants           --             --             2,890         330,173         333,063

Tax benefit related to exercise of
     employee stock options and warrants           --          120,000            --              --           120,000

Net loss ...............................           --             --          (283,076)           --          (283,076)

                                           ------------   -------------    -----------    ------------    -------------
Balance, December 31, 1995 .............   $      3,375   $ 14,422,689    $   (497,687)   $ (1,051,412)   $ 12,876,965

<FN>
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.
</FN>
</TABLE>
                                       24

                                      310
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
Statements of Cash Flows
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Years Ended December 31,                                                           1995           1994             1993
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Cash Flows From Operating Activities:
<S>                                                                          <C>             <C>             <C>         
        Net income(loss) .................................................   $   (283,076)   $ (1,602,738)   $    663,831
        Adjustments to reconcile net income(loss) to
          net cash provided by operating activities:
          Depreciation and amortization ..................................     18,811,150      15,056,167      10,530,839
          Amortization of debt issue costs and discount ..................        128,760          64,380            --
          Deferred income taxes ..........................................       (239,000)       (802,000)        332,000
          Change in assets and liabilities:
            Accounts receivable ..........................................     (3,178,803)     (1,003,263)       (731,281)
            Prepaid expenses .............................................       (284,803)        (58,262)       (311,418)
            Deferred commission expense ..................................     (1,446,337)        (22,215)       (119,593)
            Deferred debt issuance costs .................................           --          (395,000)           --
            Other assets .................................................     (1,029,433)           --              --
            Accounts payable .............................................        604,791       1,183,434         668,794
            Accrued expenses .............................................        739,453         143,249         247,994
            Equipment deposits ...........................................           (382)        (37,269)        (60,618)
            Unearned revenue .............................................      2,800,990       1,849,771       2,047,982

          Net Cash Provided By Operating Activities ......................     16,623,310      14,376,254      13,268,530

Cash Flows From Investing Activities:

        Capital expenditures:
          Equipment used by subscribers ..................................    (23,746,086)    (27,354,107)    (24,175,363)
          Equipment and leasehold improvements ...........................     (3,914,442)     (2,607,100)     (2,040,607)
        Acquisition of Subscribers .......................................     (1,767,420)           --              --

          Net Cash Used By Investing Activities ..........................    (29,427,948)    (29,961,207)    (26,215,970)

Cash Flows From Financing Activities:

        Proceeds from long-term debt .....................................     21,250,000      20,250,000      16,000,000
        Principal payments on long-term debt .............................     (8,718,750)    (20,333,334)     (3,052,083)
        Proceeds from subordinated long-term notes .......................           --        15,000,000            --
        Proceeds from the exercise of stock options and warrants .........        333,063       1,274,239         159,816
        Purchase of treasury stock .......................................           --          (534,000)       (230,754)

          Net Cash Provided By Financing Activities ......................     12,864,313      15,656,905      12,876,979

Net Increase (Decrease) in Cash ..........................................         59,675          71,952         (70,461)

Cash at Beginning of Period ..............................................        720,343         648,391         718,852

Cash at End of Period ....................................................$       780,018 $       720,343 $    648,391
<FN>
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements 
</FN>
</TABLE>
                                       25

                                      311
<PAGE>
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                         NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995, 1994 AND 1993
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1.      SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

REVENUE  RECOGNITION - The company  provides its  subscribers  with equipment to
receive  information  and  communications  services.  DTN  charges  a  recurring
subscription  fee and in most instances a one-time  service  initiation fee. The
subscriptions are contracted for an initial period of one year and are generally
billed quarterly in advance.  Accounts  receivable  consists  primarily of these
advance  billings.  Payments received in advance for  subscriptions,  additional
services  and  advertising  are  deferred  and  recognized  as the  services are
provided to the  subscribers.  Service  initiation fees in excess of the related
marketing  and set-up  costs,  excluding  sales  commissions,  are  deferred and
recognized into income over the initial twelve-month  subscription period. These
revenues  no longer  exceed the costs and  therefore  beginning  in 1995 are not
being deferred.  Communication  services are generally billed monthly in arrears
based on the number and length of communications to subscribers.

DEFERRED COMMISSION EXPENSE - Commissions and bonuses which are paid at the time
of the initial  subscription  to sales  representatives  or to  subscribers  for
successful  customer  referrals,  are  deferred  and  expensed  over the initial
twelve-month subscription period.

EQUIPMENT  USED BY  SUBSCRIBERS  -Equipment  used by  subscribers to receive the
company's electronically  transmitted information service is stated at cost less
accumulated  depreciation.  Depreciation is calculated  using the  straight-line
method over a useful  life of three to eight years for assets  placed in service
prior to July 1,  1992,  and  three to six years for  assets  placed in  service
subsequent to July 1, 1992.

EQUIPMENT AND LEASEHOLD  IMPROVEMENTS - Equipment and leasehold improvements are
stated at cost less accumulated  depreciation.  Depreciation is calculated using
the  straight-line  method over the estimated useful lives of the assets,  which
range from two to seven years,  or the related  lease,  which range from five to
ten years.

INTANGIBLE  ASSETS - Intangible assets for acquisition of subscribers are stated
at cost less  accumulated  amortization.  These  costs are  amortized  using the
straight-line method over eight years.

INCOME TAXES - Income taxes are computed in  accordance  with the  provisions of
Statement of Financial  Accounting  Standard 109,  "Accounting for Income Taxes"
(SFAS 109).  The  objective of the statement is to recognize the amount of taxes
payable  or  refundable  in the  current  year  and to  recognize  deferred  tax
liabilities and assets for the future tax  consequences of events that have been
recognized in the financial statements or tax returns.

EARNINGS  PER  SHARE -  Earnings  per  share is  calculated  on the basis of the
weighted  average   outstanding  common  shares  and,  when  applicable,   those
outstanding options and warrants that are dilutive.

                                      312
<PAGE>
STATEMENT  OF CASH FLOWS - For  purposes of the  statement  of cash  flows,  the
company  considers all highly liquid  investments  purchased  with a maturity of
three months or less to be cash  equivalents.  During the periods ended December
31, 1995,  1994 and 1993,  the company  made  interest  payments of  $4,386,000,
$3,165,000 and $1,493,000,  respectively.  Capital  expenditures  for subscriber
equipment  included  in  accounts  payable  at  year  end  totalled  $2,191,000,
$1,106,000 and $3,455,000 at December 31, 1995, 1994 and 1993, respectively. The
company paid  $1,146,000 of federal income taxes in 1995 relating to recoverable
Alternative  Minimum  Taxes (AMT) for prior  periods  which is included in other
assets.  The  company  paid no federal  income  taxes  during  1994 or 1993.  At
December 31, 1995, $3,202,580 of the purchase price for the subscribers acquired
was not yet paid and is included in accounts payable.

RESEARCH  AND  DEVELOPMENT  -  Research  and  development  costs are  charged to
earnings as incurred and  approximated  $1,596,000,  $1,493,000 and $899,000 for
the periods ended December 31, 1995, 1994, and 1993.

ESTIMATES - The preparation of financial statements in conformity with generally
accepted  accounting  principles  requires  management  to  make  estimates  and
assumptions  that  affect the  reported  amounts of assets and  liabilities  and
disclosure of  contingent  assets and  liabilities  at the date of the financial
statements  and the  reported  amounts  of  revenues  and  expenses  during  the
reporting period. Actual results could differ from these estimates.

ACCOUNTING  PRONOUNCEMENTS - In March 1995, the Financial  Accounting  Standards
Board (FASB)  issued  Statement of Financial  Accounting  Standards  (SFAS) 121,
Accounting for the Impairment of Long Lived Assets.  SFAS 121 required that long
lived assets and certain identifiable  intangibles held and used by an entity be
reviewed for impairment. The Company will adopt SFAS 121 as required in 1996 but
does not expect any  adjustments  to the value of long lived assets.

                                       26

                                      313
<PAGE>
In October 1995, FASB issued SFAS 123,  Accounting for Stock Based Compensation.
Beginning  in 1996,  SFAS  123  requires  expanded  disclosures  of  stock-based
compensation  arrangements with employees and encourages,  but does not require,
the recognition of employee  compensation  expense related to stock compensation
based on the fair value of the equity instrument granted.  Companies that do not
adopt the fair value  recognition  provisions of SFAS 123 and continue to follow
the existing APB Opinion 25 rules to recognize and measure compensation, will be
required to disclose the pro forma  amounts of net income and earnings per share
that would have been  reported had the company  elected to follow the fair value
recognition of SFAS 123.  Management  has  determined  that the Company will not
adopt  the  fair  value  recognition  provisions  of SFAS 123 so the  impact  of
adopting this statement  beginning in 1996 will only be the expanded  disclosure
requirements.

2.      ACQUISITIONS

Effective   July  26,  1995,   the  Company   entered  into  an  agreement  with
Knight-Ridder  Financial  (KRF) to acquire 2,900  Knight-Ridder  Commodity  News
Service Subscribers.  The Company will pay KRF approximately $4,970,000 over two
years,  made up of $3,000,000  for the  subscribers  and  $1,970,000  for future
revenue  sharing.  The $3,000,000 for the  subscribers is to be paid one-half at
closing and the remaining one-half due one year from closing. The $1,970,000 for
future  revenue  sharing  is based  upon a  company  estimate  and is to be paid
quarterly.

3.      LONG-TERM DEBT AND LOAN AGREEMENTS
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                               December 31,
                                     --------------------------------
                                         1995                1994
                                     ------------         -----------
<S>                                  <C>                 <C>  
Bank operating line     
        agreement                    $21,250,000         $ 2,250,000
Term notes, due in monthly
        installments thru October
        1998 at 6.75% to 9.25%        19,322,915          25,291,665
Stock repurchase term
        notes, due in quarterly
        installments from
        January 1994 thru December
        1997, 7.69% to 8.0%            1,000,000           1,500,000
                                     ------------         -----------
                                      41,572,915          29,041,665
Less current portion                   9,036,458           9,463,541
                                     ------------         -----------                         
Total Long-Term Debt                 $32,536,457          $19,578,124
                                     ============         ===========

</TABLE>

                                      314
<PAGE>
The company has a senior loan  agreement  with a group of seven  regional  banks
(the "senior loan agreement"). The senior loan agreement, which expires June 30,
1996 unless  extended,  provides for a total  commitment of up to $34,500,000 in
new borrowings. As of December 31, 1995, $21,250,000 of the total commitment had
been borrowed,  with the remaining  $13,250,000 available to the company subject
to certain restrictions as discussed below.

Additional  borrowings  under the senior loan  agreement  are  available  to the
company,  as long as at the time of the  advance,  no default  exists  under the
senior loan agreement or under the  subordinated  notes  agreement (see Note 3),
and total debt  outstanding  (including  term notes  outstanding  but  excluding
long-term  subordinated debt) does not exceed thirty-six times monthly operating
cash flow as defined.  As of December 31, 1995 based on current  operating  cash
flow,  the  company  would be able to borrow  all of the  $13,250,000  remaining
commitment available.

Substantially  all of the company's  assets are pledged as collateral  under the
senior loan  agreement.  In addition to the  restrictions  mentioned  above with
respect to advances,  total debt outstanding  (excluding long-term  subordinated
debt) is limited to forty-eight  times monthly  operating cash flow or three and
one-half times stockholders'  equity (defined to include long-term  subordinated
debt),  whichever  is less.  Additionally,  total  debt  outstanding  (including
subordinated  debt) is limited to sixty times monthly  operating  cash flow. The
company is also  required to  maintain  total  stockholders'  equity of at least
$11,000,000  through June 30, 1996 and, a ratio of quarterly operating cash flow
to interest expense (as defined) of at least 2.25 to 1. The company is currently
restricted to paying no cash dividends.

Interest on the outstanding  borrowings  (prior to when the borrowings  might be
converted to term loans, as discussed below) is at a variable rate, depending on
the ratio of the company's total borrowings  (excluding  long-term  subordinated
debt) to  stockholders  equity  (including  long-term  subordinated  debt)  (the
"Ratio"). So long as the Ratio is below 2.0 to 1, interest is at prime. When the
Ratio is  between  2.0 to 1 and 2.49 to 1, the  interest  rate is at prime  plus
1/4%. When the Ratio is between 2.50 to 1 and 2.99 to 1, the interest rate is at
prime plus 3/4%. When the Ratio is at or above 3.0 to 1, the interest rate is at
prime plus 1 1/4%.  The prime rate is adjusted  monthly,  with the interest rate
adjustment (as defined above)  changed  quarterly.  As of December 31, 1995, the
variable rate borrowings  outstanding are accruing interest at the prime rate of
8.75%.

The company has the option to convert the  outstanding  borrowings to term loans
at any time, payable in forty-eight equal principal installments, plus interest.
Interest on the converted term loans is at a variable interest rate of 1/4% over
the base rate (as  determined in the preceding  paragraph)  or, at the company's
option,  may be at a fixed rate of 3/4% over the base rate,  or,  2.50% over the
average of the 3 and 5 year U. S. treasury securities,  whichever is greater. As
of December 31, 1995,  $21,250,000 of the total  borrowings  outstanding had not
been converted to term loans.  The remainder of the  borrowings  were term loans
with interest rates ranging from 6.75% to 9.25%.

                                       27

                                      315
<PAGE>
The company  pays a  commitment  fee of 1/4% on the unused  portion of the total
commitment.  Additionally, once the Ratio (as described previously) reaches 2.50
to 1, the  company  will be  required  to pay a  closing  fee of 1/2% on all new
borrowings made after that point in time.

During 1992, the company entered into a loan agreement to be used solely for the
repurchase of the  company's  outstanding  common stock (the "Stock  Repurchase"
line).  The company  borrowed  $2,000,000  of this Stock  Repurchase  commitment
during 1992.

For the first year  after  each  Stock  Repurchase  advance,  the  company  pays
interest  only.  After the first year,  each  advance  will be repaid in sixteen
equal quarterly  principal payments plus interest.  Interest will accrue for the
first three years of each advance at a fixed rate equal to the quoted  Five-Year
Treasury  Note Rate on the date of the advance,  plus 2%. For the last two years
interest will accrue at either a floating rate of national  prime plus 3/4% or a
fixed rate of the then current Five-Year Treasury Note Rate plus 2%. The company
has the option of determining  which rate will apply.  The  $2,000,000  borrowed
under this Stock Repurchase line, is accruing interest at 7.69% and 8.00%.

The minimum  principal  maturities of long-term  debt,  excluding bank operating
line  agreement,  are  as  follows:  1996 - $9,036,000;1997  - $7,010,000;  1998
- - $4,229,000; 1999 - $47,000.

4.      SUBORDINATED LONG-TERM NOTES

On June 30, 1994,  the company sold to one  investor  $15,000,000  of its 11.25%
subordinated   long-term  notes  in  a  private   placement   transaction   (the
"subordinated  debt"). The subordinated debt is subordinated in right of payment
to all current and future senior debt.  Interest on the subordinated  debt is to
be  paid  quarterly,  with  principal  due in  five  equal  annual  installments
beginning on June 30, 2000.

The  company  has the option to prepay the  subordinated  debt on any date after
June 30,  1997 at a premium  beginning  at 7.5% of the  principal  prepaid,  and
decreasing  by 1.5% per year  until June 30,  2002 when no premium is  required.
There are provisions for mandatory prepayment upon a change in ownership control
(as defined),  at a premium  beginning at 12.0% of the principal  prepaid during
the period  ended June 30, 1995 and  decreasing  by 1.5% per year until June 30,
2002 when no premium is required.  The  subordinated  debt agreement  contains a
cross-acceleration clause, whereby the subordinated debt will become immediately
due and  payable  upon a payment  default on the senior debt  outstanding  Other
subordinated  debt  financial  covenants and  restrictions  are  generally  less
restrictive than those of the senior loan agreement.

The company also issued a warrant to the investor to purchase  25,000  shares of
the company's $.001 par value common stock at $22.17 per share on or before June
30, 2004.  In  connection  with the  issuance of the warrant to purchase  common
stock,  the company recorded a $635,000 credit to additional paid in capital and
a related debt discount,  which  represents an estimate of the fair value of the
warrant issued. Expenses of the subordinated debt offering of $395,000 have been
capitalized as deferred debt issuance costs,  and will be amortized,  along with
the debt discount,  over the life of the  subordinated  debt using a level-yield
method.  The  unamortized  portion of the debt issue  costs  were  $321,000  and
$370,000 for 1995 and 1994, respectively.

                                      316
<PAGE>
5.      INCOME TAXES

Components of the income tax (benefit) provision are as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                               1995                  1994              1993
                           ------------         -------------      ------------
<S>                        <C>                  <C>                 <C>   
Current tax expense  
        (benefit)          $   125,000          $    (18,000)       $   25,000

Deferred tax expense
        (benefit)             (239,000)             (802,000)          332,000
                           ------------         -------------      ------------
                           $  (114,000)         $   (820,000)       $  357,000
                           ============         =============      ============
</TABLE>
The income tax  (benefit)  provision  differs  from the  (benefit)  provision at
federal statutory rates for the following reasons:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                    1995            1994             1993
                                 ----------      ----------       ---------
<S>                              <C>             <C>              <C>      
Tax expense (benefit) at
   federal statutory rate        $(139,000)      $(824,000)       $ 347,000

State taxes                          1,000         (24,000)          10,000

Other                               24,000          28,000            --
                                 ----------      ----------       ---------
                                 $(114,000)      $(820,000)       $ 357,000
                                 ==========      ==========       =========
</TABLE>
The components of deferred tax liability (asset) are as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                  1995          1994
                             ------------   ------------
<S>                          <C>            <C>        
Depreciation                 $ 4,880,000    $ 2,958,000

Net operating
   loss carryforwards         (5,383,000)    (3,093,000)

Other                              9,000           --
                             ------------   ------------
Net Deferred Asset           $  (494,000)   $  (135,000)
                             ===========    ============
</TABLE>
The Company had  approximately  $15,000,000  of unused net operating  loss (NOL)
carryforwards  at December 31,  1995.  The NOLs will expire in the years 2002 to
2010. In addition,  the Company is reflecting in the Other Assets  approximately
$1,029,000 relating to pending IRS refund claims.

                                       28

                                      317
<PAGE>
6.      CAPITAL STOCK

The  company's  articles  of  incorporation  provide  for the  authorization  of
1,000,000  shares of $.50 par value per share  preferred  stock.  The  preferred
stock,  none of which has been issued,  presently  has no voting rights or other
features,  although the articles of  incorporation  contain  provisions to adopt
various features or privileges at the discretion of the Board of Directors.

In September 1992, the company's Board of Directors authorized the repurchase of
up to 350,000 shares of the company's  outstanding  common stock.  The purchases
are to be made from time to time in the open market or in arranged  transactions
at such price or prices as company officers may deem advisable. The common stock
repurchased  may be used to provide  shares  for the  company's  existing  stock
options and warrants  outstanding.  During 1994, the company  repurchased 24,000
shares of its common stock.

7.      COMMON STOCK WARRANTS

In conjunction with a private placement offering of Subordinated Long-Term Notes
in 1988, the company granted  warrants to purchase 80,325 shares of common stock
at a price  of  $10.00  per  share.  These  warrants  were  exercisable  through
September 30, 1994. During 1992, 7,500 of these warrants were exercised.  During
1994, all of the remaining warrants granted were either exercised or expired.

In conjunction with a private placement offering of subordinated Long-Term Notes
in June 1994, the company granted warrants,  to the single investor, to purchase
25,000 shares of common stock at a price of $22.17 per share. These warrants are
exercisable through June 30, 2004.

8.      STOCK OPTION PLANS

The company has employee and director stock option plans with  aggregate  limits
of 700,000  shares for the employee plan and 70,000 shares for the  non-employee
director  plan.  The exercise  price of the stock options is equal to the market
value of the  company's  common  stock on the date of  grant.  The  options  are
exercisable  for a period  of up to ten  years  from the date of grant  and vest
equally over a period of up to four years.



                                      318
<PAGE>
The following  table  summarizes the stock options as of December 31, 1995, 1994
and 1993:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                     Option Price
                                        Shares        Per Share
                                      ---------     --------------
<S>                                    <C>          <C>     
Balance at
Jan. 1, 1993                           213,506      11.75 - 18.00

Granted                                114,950      13.50 - 15.50
Exercised                              (11,818)     11.75 - 14.50
Cancelled                              (24,561)     11.75 - 18.00

Balance at
Dec. 31, 1993                          292,077      11.75 - 18.00

Granted                                 91,250      22.00 - 29.15
Exercised                              (43,142)     11.75 - 18.00
Cancelled                              (10,790)     12.00 - 26.50

Balance at
Dec. 31, 1994                          329,395      11.75 - 29.15

Granted                                133,750      16.50 - 35.75
Exercised                              (23,408)     11.75 - 26.50
Cancelled                              (14,084)     12.00 - 26.50
 
Balance at
Dec. 31, 1995                          425,653      11.75 - 35.75
                                      =========
Exercisable at
Dec. 31, 1995                          209,937      11.75 - 29.15
                                      =========
</TABLE>
At December 31,  1995,  shares of the Companys  authorized  but unissued  common
stock were reserved for issuance as follows:
                                             Shares
                                           -----------
Employee stock option plan                   217,936
Non-employee director plan                    47,001
                                           -----------
Total                                        264,937
                                           ===========

9.      LEASES

The company leases the right to subsidiary channel  authorizations from FM radio
stations and satellite network transmission  capacity to broadcast the company's
information  service  to its  subscribers.  These  leases are  accounted  for as
operating  leases and are for  varying  periods of one to ten years and  contain
annual renewal options for periods of up to five years.

                                       29

                                      319
<PAGE>
The  company  also has  various  operating  leases for office  space,  warehouse
facilities and equipment.  These leases expire on various dates through 2005 and
generally  provide for renewal  options at the end of the lease.  The company is
generally obligated to pay the cost of property taxes, insurance,  utilities and
maintenance on the leases.

Future  minimum lease  payments  under all  non-cancelable  operating  leases at
December 31, 1995 are as follows:

Year Ending December 31,                   Amount
- ------------------------                ------------
        1996                             $2,664,000
        1997                              2,319,000
        1998                              2,026,000
        1999                              1,703,000
        2000                              1,507,000
        2001 and after                    5,328,000
                                        ------------
Total future minimum lease payments     $15,547,000
                                        ============

Total  rent  expense on all  operating  leases was  $2,712,000,  $2,369,000  and
$1,856,000 for the years ended December 31, 1995, 1994 and 1993, respectively.

10.     BENEFIT PLAN

The company has a defined contribution plan under provisions of Internal Revenue
Code  Section  401(k).  All  employees  with at least  one year of  service  may
participate in the plan. The company  matches the employee's  contribution up to
4% of  the  employee's  compensation,  and  may  make  additional  discretionary
contributions.  During 1995,  1994 and 1993, the company  contributed  $482,000,
$344,000 and $236,000, respectively, to the plan as matching contributions.


- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                     NOTES
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------



                                       30

                                      320
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                       QUARTERLY DATA (UNAUDITED)
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                         Net Income (loss)
                                       Operating      Pre-Tax          --------------------       Total
                         Revenues      Cash Flow(1)   Income (loss)    Amount   Per Share(2)   Subscribers
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                     <C>           <C>            <C>             <C>           <C>            <C>   
Fiscal 1995
        First           $13,617,210   $ 4,967,889    $  (426,972)    $  (272,972)  $  (.08)       84,600
        Second           14,739,450     5,591,904         51,802          32,802       .01        86,700
        Third            16,168,251     6,173,867        150,556          96,556       .03        92,400
        Fourth           17,763,078     6,420,742       (172,462)       (139,462)     (.04)       95,900
                        -----------   -----------    ------------    ------------  --------       ------
Year .........          $62,287,989   $23,154,402    $  (397,076)    $  (283,076)  $  (.09)       95,900
                        -----------   -----------    ------------    ------------   --------       ------
Fiscal 1994
        First           $10,548,771   $ 3,951,157    $    56,485     $    36,485   $   .01        76,500
        Second           11,396,005     3,865,963       (430,472)       (279,472)     (.09)       78,300
        Third            11,684,670     3,516,059     (1,295,675)       (842,675)     (.26)       80,200
        Fourth           12,480,343     4,417,548       (753,076)       (517,076)     (.16)       82,000
                        -----------   -----------    ------------    ------------  --------       ------
Year .........          $46,109,789   $15,750,727    $(2,422,738)    $(1,602,738)  $  (.49)       82,000
                        -----------   -----------    ------------    ------------  --------       ------
<FN>
(1) Operating income before depreciation and amortization expense.
(2) Net  income  per  share for each of the four  quarters  may not agree to net
income per share for the year due to rounding.
</FN>
</TABLE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
TRADING INFORMATION
                              Market Price 1995                  Market Price 1994
                        ----------------------------       -------------------------------
Quarter Ended           High        Low        Last         High        Low        Last
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                     <C>        <C>         <C>         <C>          <C>         <C>
        March 31....... 25         16 1/2      24 3/4      27 1/2       21          21

        June 30........ 26         23 3/4      25 1/2      24 1/2       20          22 1/2

        September 30... 36 3/4     25 1/2      35 3/4      22 1/2       18 1/2      18 1/2

        December 31.... 50 1/4     33 1/8      49 1/4      18 3/4       16 1/8      17
</TABLE>

The  companys  common  stock  trades on the Nasdaq  National  Market tier of the
Nasdaq Stock MarketSM under the symbol:  DTLN. On December 31, 1995,  there were
approximately 525 stockholders of record, not including beneficial holders whose
shares are held in names other than their own.

                                       31

                                      321
<PAGE>
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                              INVESTOR INFORMATION
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

CORPORATE HEADQUARTERS:
        9110 West Dodge Road, Suite 200
        Omaha, NE 68114
        (402) 390-2328

INDEPENDENT AUDITORS:
        Deloitte & Touche LLP

STOCK TRANSFER AGENT:
        First National Bank of Omaha
        Attn: Corporate Trust Services
        One First National Center
        Omaha, Nebraska 68102

ANNUAL STOCKHOLDERS MEETING:
     The annual stockholders  meeting will be held on Wednesday,  April 24, 1996
     at 10:00 A.M.,  at the Holiday  Inn-Old Mill,  655 N. 108th Avenue,  Omaha,
     Nebraska.

FORM  10-K:
     A COPY OF THE  COMPANYS  FORM 10-K FILED WITH THE  SECURITIES  AND EXCHANGE
     COMMISSION IS AVAILABLE WITHOUT CHARGE UPON WRITTEN REQUEST TO:

     Secretary
     Data Transmission Network Corporation
     9110 West Dodge Road, Suite 200
     Omaha, Nebraska 68114

DIVIDENDS:
     The Company has never paid any dividends and has no present intention of so
     doing.  Payment of cash dividends in the future, if any, will be determined
     by the Board of  Directors  in light of the  companys  earnings,  financial
     condition and other relevant considerations.


                                      322
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                           DIRECTORS AND OFFICERS
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Board of Directors:                        Corporate Officers:
- --------------------------------           ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                        <C>                                        <C>
Roger R. Brodersen                         Roger R. Brodersen                          Keith A. Cook
  Chairman of the Board                      Chairman of the Board                       Vice President
  Chief Executive Officer                    Chief Executive Officer                     President, Auto Services
  Data Transmission Network Corp.
                                           Greg T. Sloma                               H. Wade German
Robert S. Herman                             President                                   Vice President
  Senior Vice President                      Chief Operating Officer                     Business Research
  Data Transmission Network Corp.
                                           Robert S. Herman                            Brian L. Larson
David K. Karnes                              Senior Vice President                       Vice President
  President                                  Research and Technology                     Chief Financial Officer
  Chief Executive Officer                                                                Secretary and Treasurer
  The Fairmont Group Inc.                  Roger W. Wallace
  Of Counsel, Kutak Rock law firm            Senior Vice President                     Gordon R. Lundy
                                             Co-President, Ag Services                   Vice President
J. Michael Parks                                                                         President, Energy Services
  Former President                         James J. Marquiss
  Former Chief Operating Officer             Senior Vice President                     Charles E. McQuinn
  First Data Resources, Inc.                 Co-President, Ag Services                   Vice President
                                                                                         President, West Financial Services    
Jay E. Ricks                               Charles R. Wood
  Chairman of the Board                      Senior Vice President                     James G. Payne
  Douglas Communications Corp.               President, Financial Services               Vice President
                                                                                         Administrative Operations Manager   
Greg T. Sloma
  President
  Chief Operating Officer
  Data Transmission Network Corp.

Roger W. Wallace
  Senior Vice President
  Data Transmission Network Corp.
</TABLE>
                                       32

                                      323
<PAGE>
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                               MISSION STATEMENT
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

     Led  by  customer  suggestions  and  demands,   Data  Transmission  Network
Corporation  has  engineered  growth and  evolution  from what we werethe  first
low-cost,   electronically   delivered  agricultural   commodities   information
serviceto  what we are todaya  multi-faceted  information  provider  utilizing a
full-service  communication  technology  system to deliver that most valuable of
all commodities, timely information (NEWS...NOT HISTORY).

     We are committed to providing the best information and analysis  available,
as quickly as possible,  at an affordable cost to our customers.  Among the many
things that are critical to successfully  meeting those  commitments,  the three
most important are customer service,  customer service, and customer service!

     As fellow  shareholders of the company,  DTN employees have as their number
one goal the long-term enhancement of the value of our company.


                                       33

                                      324
<PAGE>


INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' CONSENT

We consent to the  incorporation  by reference in  Registration  Statements  No.
33-50406 and No. 33-50412 of Data Transmission  Network Corporation on Forms S-8
of our report dated January 30, 1996, appearing in the 1995 Annual Report to the
Stockholders of Data Transmission  Network  Corporation which is incorporated by
reference in this Form 10-K of Data  Transmission  Network  Corporation  for the
year ended December 31, 1995.


/s/  Deloitte & Touche  LLP
- ---------------------------

DELOITTE & TOUCHE  LLP


Omaha, Nebraska
January 30, 1996


                                      325
<PAGE>

<TABLE> <S> <C>

<ARTICLE>                     5
       
<S>                             <C>
<PERIOD-TYPE>                   12-MOS
<FISCAL-YEAR-END>                              DEC-31-1995
<PERIOD-START>                                 JAN-01-1995
<PERIOD-END>                                   DEC-31-1995
<CASH>                                           780,018
<SECURITIES>                                           0
<RECEIVABLES>                                  6,776,576
<ALLOWANCES>                                     300,000
<INVENTORY>                                            0
<CURRENT-ASSETS>                               9,806,991
<PP&E>                                       144,218,965  
<DEPRECIATION>                                67,909,419
<TOTAL-ASSETS>                                92,672,050
<CURRENT-LIABILITIES>                         20,278,929 
<BONDS>                                       47,020,527
                                  0
                                            0
<COMMON>                                           3,375
<OTHER-SE>                                    12,873,590
<TOTAL-LIABILITY-AND-EQUITY>                  92,672,050
<SALES>                                       62,287,989 
<TOTAL-REVENUES>                              62,287,989
<CGS>                                                  0
<TOTAL-COSTS>                                 57,944,737
<OTHER-EXPENSES>                                       0
<LOSS-PROVISION>                                       0
<INTEREST-EXPENSE>                             4,798,112 
<INCOME-PRETAX>                                 (397,076)
<INCOME-TAX>                                    (114,000) 
<INCOME-CONTINUING>                             (283,076)
<DISCONTINUED>                                         0
<EXTRAORDINARY>                                        0
<CHANGES>                                              0
<NET-INCOME>                                    (283,076)
<EPS-PRIMARY>                                      (0.09)
<EPS-DILUTED>                                      (0.09)
        


</TABLE>

Securities and Exchange Commission
Division of Corporation Finance
450 Fifth Street,  N.W.
Wachington, DC  20549

Re:  Data Transmission Network Corporation

Ladies and Gentlemen:

     Accompanying  this letter are definitive  copies of the proxy statement and
form of proxy for the annual meeting of shareholders of Data Transmisisn Network
Corporation to be held April 24, 1996. This  registrant  intends to release this
material to its shareholders on or about March 15, 1996.

     The $125.00 filing fee payable to the Securities and Exchange Commission is
being submitted to the lockbox  depository as provided in the Commission's  Rule
3a. Please file the proxy  statement  and form of proxy in  accordance  with the
Securities and Exchange Act of 1934.

                                   DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION

                                   By:

                                        Brian Larson, Secretary





                                      327
<PAGE>

                            SCHEDULE 14A INFORMATION
                Proxy Statement Pursuant to Section 14(a) of the
                        Securities Exchange Act of 1934

Filed by the Registrant  [ x ]

Filed by a Party other than the Registrant  [   ]

Check the appropriate box:

[   ]   Preliminary Proxy Statement
[ x ]   Definitive Proxy Statement
[   ]   Definitive Additional Materials
[   ]   Soliciting  Material  Pursuant to  ss.240.14a-11(c)  or  ss.240.14a-12
[   ]   Confidential, for Use of the Commission Only (as permitted by Rule
        14a-6(e)(2))

                     DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION
                (Name of Registrant as Specified in its Charter)
                -----------------------------------------------
                   (Name of Person(s) Filing Proxy Statement
                         if other than the Registrant)

Payment of Filing Fee (Check the appropriate box):

[ x ] $125 per Exchange Act Rules 0-11(c)(1)(ii), 14a-6(i)(1), 14a-6(i)(2)
       or Item 22(a)(2) of Schedule 14A.

[   ] $500 per each party to the  controversy  pursuant to Exchange Act Rule
       14a-6(i)(3).

[   ]  Fee computed on table below per Exchange Act Rules 14a-6(i)(4) and 0-11.

        1)     Title of each class of securities to which transaction applies:

               ----------------------------------------------------------------
        2)     Aggregate number of securities to which transaction applies:

               ----------------------------------------------------------------
        3)     Per unit price or other underlying value of transaction  computed
               pursuant to Exchange Act Rule 0-11 (Set forth the amount on which
               the filing fee is calculated and state how it was determined):

               ----------------------------------------------------------------
        4)     Proposed maximum aggregate value of transaction:

               ----------------------------------------------------------------
        5)     Total fee paid:

               ----------------------------------------------------------------

[   ]   Fee paid previously with preliminary materials.

[   ]   Check box if any part of the fee is offset as provided by Exchange Act
        Rule 0-11(a)(2) and identify the filing for which the offsetting fee was
        paid previously.  Identify the previous filing by registration statement
        number, or the Form or Schedule and the date of its filing.
             1)      Amount Previously Paid:
                                            ---------------------------------
             2)      Form, Schedule or Registration Statement No.: 
                                                                   -----------
             3)      Filing Party:
                                   ------------------------------------------
             4)      Date Filed:
                                   ------------------------------------------

                                       328
<PAGE>
                     DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION
                        9110 West Dodge Road, Suite 200
                             Omaha, Nebraska 68114
                                 (402) 390-2328


                    NOTICE OF ANNUAL MEETING OF STOCKHOLDERS
                          TO BE HELD ON APRIL 24, 1996



        NOTICE IS HEREBY GIVEN that the Annual Meeting of  Stockholders  of Data
Transmission Network Corporation,  a Delaware corporation (the Company), will be
held at the Holiday Inn - Old Mill, 655 North 108th Avenue,  Omaha,  Nebraska on
Wednesday,  April 24, 1996 at 10:00 A.M. Omaha time for the following  purposes,
as more fully described in the accompanying Proxy Statement:

1.      To elect seven directors to the Board of Directors.

2.   To consider and vote upon a proposal to ratify the  appointment of Deloitte
     & Touche LLP independent auditors for the Company for the 1996 fiscal year.

3.   To transact such other  business as may properly come before the meeting or
     any adjournments thereof.

        Any action  may be taken on any one of the  foregoing  proposals  at the
meeting  on the date  specified  above,  or on any  date or  dates to which  the
meeting may be  adjourned.  The Board of  Directors of the Company has fixed the
close of business on March 1, 1996, as the record date for  determination of the
stockholders of the Company entitled to notice of and to vote at the meeting.

        All stockholders are cordially  invited to attend the meeting in person.
However, to assure your representation at the meeting, please complete, date and
sign the enclosed proxy card and mail it promptly in the self-addressed envelope
provided.  The giving of such proxy does not affect your right to vote in person
in the event you attend the meeting.

                                   BY ORDER OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS





Omaha, Nebraska                    Brian L. Larson
March 11, 1996                     Secretary

IMPORTANT:  THE PROMPT  RETURN OF PROXIES  WILL SAVE YOUR COMPANY THE EXPENSE OF
FURTHER REQUESTS FOR PROXIES IN ORDER TO INSURE A QUORUM. AN ADDRESSED  ENVELOPE
IS ENCLOSED FOR YOUR CONVENIENCE. NO POSTAGE IS REQUIRED IF MAILED IN THE UNITED
STATES. 

                                       329
<PAGE>
                     DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION
                                Proxy Statement


                                     Index                                 Page
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Proxy Statement ...........................................................    1

Proxies ...................................................................    1

Voting Securities .........................................................    1

Election of Directors .....................................................    2

Ownership By Certain Beneficial Owners and Management .....................    4

Executive Compensation ....................................................    6

Compensaton Committee Report of Executive Compensation ....................   10

Transactions with Management ..............................................   11

Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation ...............   11

Approval of Appointment of Auditors .......................................   11

Stockholder Proposals for 1997 Annual Meeting .............................   11

Compliance With Section 16(a) of the Exchange Act .........................   11

Other Matters .............................................................   12

Miscellaneous .............................................................   12











                                       330
<PAGE>
                                PROXY STATEMENT

                         ANNUAL MEETING OF STOCKHOLDERS
                           TO BE HELD APRIL 24, 1996

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

        This Proxy Statement is furnished in connection with the solicitation of
proxies by the Board of Directors of Data Transmission  Network  Corporation,  a
Delaware  corporation  (the  Company),  to be  used  at the  Annual  Meeting  of
Stockholders  (the Meeting) to be held at the Holiday Inn - Old Mill,  655 North
108th Avenue, Omaha, Nebraska on Wednesday,  April 24, 1996, at 10:00 A.M. Omaha
time.  Stockholders  of  record at the  close of  business  on March 1, 1996 are
entitled  to  notice  of and to  vote at the  Meeting.  The  Companys  principal
executive  offices  are  located at 9110 West  Dodge  Road,  Suite  200,  Omaha,
Nebraska 68114.

                                    PROXIES

        Proxies are being  solicited  by the Board of  Directors  of the Company
with  all  costs  of  the  solicitation  to be  paid  by  the  Company.  If  the
accompanying proxy is executed and returned, the shares represented by the proxy
will be voted as specified  therein.  A  stockholder  may revoke any proxy given
pursuant to this  solicitation  by delivering to the Company prior to the Annual
Meeting a written notice of revocation or by attending the Meeting and voting in
person.  This notice of Annual  Meeting of  Stockholders,  proxy  statement  and
accompanying proxy card are first being mailed to stockholders on or about March
15, 1996.

                               VOTING SECURITIES

        At March 1, 1996,  the  Company  had issued  and  outstanding  3,327,530
shares of the Companys  $.001 par value common  stock.  The Company has no other
class of voting securities outstanding.  Each stockholder voting in the election
of  directors  may cumulate  such  stockholders  votes and give one  candidate a
number of votes equal to the number of directors to be elected multiplied by the
number  of  votes  to  which  such  stockholders  shares  are  entitled,  or may
distribute  such votes on the same  principle  among as many  candidates  as the
stockholder chooses,  provided that votes cannot be cast for more than the total
number of directors to be elected at the Meeting.  The seven nominees  receiving
the most votes at the Meeting will be elected as  directors.  Each share has one
vote on all other  matters.  An  affirmative  vote of a  majority  of the shares
present in person or by proxy at the  meeting is  required  for  approval of all
items being submitted to the stockholders for their consideration.

        In accordance with Delaware law, a shareholder  entitled to vote for the
election of  directors  can  withhold  authority to vote for all nominees or for
certain  nominees  for  directors.  Abstentions  from voting on the  proposal to
ratify the  appointment  of auditors are treated as votes against such proposal.
Broker  non-votes  on the  proposal to ratify the  appointment  of auditors  are
treated as shares as to which voting power has been  withheld by the  beneficial
holders of those shares and,  therefore,  as shares not entitled to vote on such
proposal.

                                        1

                                      331
<PAGE>
                             ELECTION OF DIRECTORS

     At the Meeting,  the stockholders will elect a board of seven directors for
a term extending  until the 1997 annual meeting of  stockholders  of the Company
and until their respective  successors have been elected and qualify.  The Board
of Directors has nominated for election or  re-election  as directors:  Roger R.
Brodersen,  Robert S. Herman,  David K. Karnes,  J. Michael Parks, Jay E. Ricks,
Greg T. Sloma and Roger W. Wallace. All of the nominees presently are serving as
directors of the Company. Proxies may be voted for seven directors.

     If any  nominee  is unable to serve,  the shares  represented  by all valid
proxies  will be voted  for the  election  of such  substitute  as the  Board of
Directors  may  recommend  or the Board of  Directors  may amend the By-Laws and
reduce the size of the Board. At this time, the Board knows of no reason why any
nominee might be unavailable to serve.

     Set forth below is certain information as of March 1, 1996, with respect to
the nominees for election as directors of the Company.  The information relating
to their  respective  business  experience  was furnished to the Company by such
persons.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                   Position and Office                  Director                          
  Nominee              Age           with the Company                     Since
- ------------------     ---       ------------------------------------   -------- 
<S>                    <C>                                                 <C> 
Roger R. Brodersen     50        Chairman of the Board,                    1984
                                 Chief Executive Officer and Director

Robert S. Herman       43        Senior Vice President and Director        1984

David K. Karnes        47        Director                                  1989

J. Michael Parks       45        Director                                  1990

Jay E. Ricks           63        Director                                  1995

Greg T. Sloma          44        President, Chief Operating Officer,       1993
                                 and Director

Roger W. Wallace       39        Senior Vice President and Director        1984

</TABLE>


     Mr.  Brodersen  has  served as  Chairman  of the Board and Chief  Executive
Officer of the Company  since 1984.  Mr.  Brodersen  served as  President of the
Company from 1984 to 1995.

     Mr.  Herman has served as Senior Vice  President of the Company since 1989.
He served as Vice President of the Company from 1984 to 1989.

     Mr.  Karnes  has served as  President  and Chief  Executive  Officer of The
Fairmont Group,  Inc., a financial  services and consulting firm, since 1989. He
also has served as Chairman of the Federal  Home Loan Bank of Topeka since 1989.
Mr. Karnes served as a United States Senator from 1987 to 1989.

     Mr.  Parks served as President  and Chief  Operating  Officer of First Data
Resources Inc. from November 1993 to December 1994 and President of the Merchant
Services Group of First Data Resources Inc. from December 1991 to November 1993.
He also served as President and Chief Executive Officer of Call Interactive,  an
affiliate of First Data Resources  Inc.,  from 1989 to 1991.  From 1976 to 1989,
Mr.  Parks served as  President  or Senior Vice  President  of various  American
Express Information Services Companies or their subsidiaries.

                                        2

                                       332
<PAGE>
     Mr. Ricks has served as Chairman of Douglas Communications  Corporation, an
operator of cable  television  systems,  since 1990. He was a partner in the law
firm of Hogan & Hartson in Washington,  D.C.,  from 1970 to 1990. Mr. Ricks is a
director of Intelcom Group,  Inc., a competitive access provider and operator of
several satellite teleports, since 1992.

     Mr.  Sloma was elected  President  of the Company in January  1996.  He has
served as Chief  Operating  Officer of the Company since January 1994. Mr. Sloma
served as Executive  Vice President of the Company from January 1994 to December
1995 and as Chief Financial  Officer from April 1993 to December 1993. From 1983
to 1993, Mr. Sloma was a Tax Partner at Deloitte & Touche.

     Mr.  Wallace has served as Senior Vice President of the Company since 1989.
He served as Vice President of the Company from 1984 to 1989.

BOARD MEETINGS AND COMMITTEES

     The Board of  Directors  met three  times  during  the  fiscal  year  ended
December  31,  1995.  During  fiscal  1995,  all  directors  attended all of the
meetings of the Board of Directors and related  committees on which they served.
The Company does not have a Standing Nominating Committee.

     The Audit Committee  recommends the selection of the independent  auditors,
reviews the scope of the audits performed by them and reviews their audit report
and any recommendations made by them relating to internal financial controls and
procedures.  Members of the Audit Committee, which met twice during fiscal 1995,
are David K. Karnes, J. Michael Parks and Jay E. Ricks.

     The Compensation  Committee reviews and makes  recommendations to the Board
of Directors  regarding officers  compensation and the Companys employee benefit
plans;  provided,  however, the Compensation  Committee administers the Companys
Stock Option Plan of 1989 through its Stock Option Plan Subcommittee, consisting
of all members of the Compensation  Committee other than Greg Sloma.  Members of
the  Compensation  Committee,  which met once during  fiscal 1995,  are David K.
Karnes, J. Michael Parks, Jay E. Ricks and Greg T. Sloma.

DIRECTORS COMPENSATION

     During  fiscal 1995,  each member of the Board of Directors  who was not an
employee  of the  Company  received  $700 for each  Board of  Directors  meeting
attended  and $400 for each Board  committee  meeting  attended.  In 1995,  each
director  who was not an  employee  of the Company  received  options  under the
Non-Employee  Directors  Stock  Option  Plan to  purchase  2,500  shares  of the
Companys  common stock.  On January 4, 1995 David K. Karnes and J. Michael Parks
each received  options to purchase  1,000 shares at an exercise  price of $16.50
per share and on April 26, 1995 each received  options to purchase  1,500 shares
at an  exercise  price of $25.50  per  share.  On April 26,  1995,  Jay E. Ricks
received  options to purchase  2,500  shares at an exercise  price of $25.50 per
share.

                                        3

                                       333
<PAGE>
OWNERSHIP BY CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT

        The  following  table  sets  forth  information  as  to  the  beneficial
ownership of the Companys  common stock by each person or group who, as of March
1, 1996, to the knowledge of the Company, beneficially owned more than 5% of the
Companys common stock:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
  Name and Address of                Amount and Nature       Percent of
   Beneficial Owner                    of Ownership             Class
- -------------------------          ------------------       -------------  
<S>                                      <C>                    <C>  
Roger R. Brodersen                       539,128                16.2%
16705 Ontario Plaza
Omaha, NE 68130

Furman Selz Incorporated                 360,170                10.8%
230 Park Avenue
New York, NY 10169

Peter H. Kamin and Peak Investment       231,500                 7.0%
Limited Partnership as a group
One Financial Center, Suite 1600
Boston, MA 02111

Wasatch Advisors, Inc.                   168,270                 5.1%
68 South Main
Salt Lake City, UT 84101
<FN>

(1)  This  includes  13,050  shares  held in a  trust  for  the  benefit  of Mr.
     Brodersens  children,  9,100 shares  beneficially  owned by Mr.  Brodersens
     spouse,   and  5,955  shares  allocated  to  Mr.   Brodersen   through  his
     participation in the Companys 401(k) Savings Plan.

(2)  According  to  a  Schedule  13G  dated   January  16,  1996,   Furman  Selz
     Incorporated has sole voting and sole dispositive power over such shares.

(3)  According to a Schedule  13D,  amended  through  December  30, 1994,  and a
     telephone  conversation by the Secretary of the Company with Peter H. Kamin
     on February 1, 1996,  Peak  Investment  Limited  Partnership  (Peak) is the
     beneficial  owner of 213,500 of these  shares for which it has sole  voting
     and sole dispositive  power.  Peter H. Kamin is the sole general partner of
     Peak with sole voting and sole  dispositive  power over the shares owned by
     Peak and therefore  also may be deemed to be the  beneficial  owner of such
     213,500  shares.  According  to the  Schedule  13D,  as  modified  by  such
     telephone  conversation,  Mr.  Kamin  also is the  beneficial  owner  of an
     additional  18,000 shares for which he has sole voting and sole dispositive
     power.

(4)  According to a Schedule 13G dated February 12, 1996, Wasatch Advisors, Inc.
     has sole voting and sole dispositive power over such shares.
</FN>
</TABLE>

                                        4

                                       334
<PAGE>
     The following table sets forth information as to the shares of common stock
of the Company  beneficially  owned as of March 1, 1996, by each director of the
Company,  by each nominee for election as a director of the Company,  by each of
the executive officers named in the Summary Compensation Table beginning on page
6, and by all directors and executive officers of the Company as a group:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                         Amount
                                       and Nature                 Percent of
  Beneficial Owner                    of Ownership (1)             Class (2)
- --------------------                 ------------------          ------------
<S>                                     <C>                          <C>  
Roger R. Brodersen                      539,128 ( 3)                 16.2%

Robert S. Herman                        146,831 ( 4)                  4.4%

David K. Karnes                          18,645 ( 5)                   *

James J. Marquiss                        47,766 ( 6)                  1.4%

J. Michael Parks                         11,333 ( 7)                   *

Jay E. Ricks                              3,500 ( 8)                   *

Greg T. Sloma                            37,482 ( 9)                  1.1%

Roger W. Wallace                         87,768 (10)                  2.6%

All directors and executive officers
as a group (15 persons)                 939,083 (11)                 28.2%

<FN>

     * Less than 1.0%

     ( 1) The  number  of shares in the  table  include  interests  of the named
     persons,  or of members of the directors and executive officers as a group,
     in shares held by the trustee of the  Companys  401(k)  Savings  Plan.  The
     beneficial  owners have sole investment  power over these shares but do not
     have sole voting power.

     ( 2) Shares subject to options  exercisable within 60 days of March 1, 1996
     are deemed to be  outstanding  for the purpose of computing the  percentage
     ownership  of persons  beneficially  owning such  options but have not been
     deemed to be  outstanding  for the  purpose  of  computing  the  percentage
     ownership of any other person.

     ( 3)  Includes  13,050  shares  which are held in trust for Mr.  Brodersens
     children,  9,100 shares  beneficially  owned by Mr. Brodersens  spouse, and
     5,955 shares  allocated to Mr. Brodersen  through his  participation in the
     Companys 401(k) Savings Plan.

     ( 4) Includes 26,515 shares subject to options  exercisable  within 60 days
     of March 1, 1996,  9,600 shares  beneficially  owned by Mr. Hermans spouse,
     and 4,822 shares  allocated to Mr. Herman through his  participation in the
     Companys 401(k) Savings Plan.

     ( 5) Includes 8,833 shares subject to options exercisable within 60 days of
     March 1, 1996

     ( 6) Includes 18,291 shares subject to options  exercisable  within 60 days
     of March 1, 1996 and 4,475  shares  allocated to Mr.  Marquiss  through his
     participation in the Companys 401(k) Savings Plan.

                                        5

                                       335
<PAGE>
     ( 7) Includes 8,333 shares subject to options exercisable within 60 days of
     March 1, 1996.

     ( 8) Includes 2,500 shares subject to options exercisable within 60 days of
     March 1, 1996.

     ( 9) Includes 28,500 shares subject to options  exercisable  within 60 days
     of March 1, 1996, 940 shares  beneficially owned by Mr. Slomas children and
     5,942  shares  allocated  to Mr.  Sloma  through his  participation  in the
     Companys 401(k) Savings Plan.

     (10) Includes 26,517 shares subject to options  exercisable  within 60 days
     of March 1, 1996, 1,500 shares  beneficially  owned by Mr. Wallaces spouse,
     and 4,821 shares allocated to Mr. Wallace through his  participation in the
     Companys 401(k) Savings Plan.

     (11) Includes 159,789 shares subject to options  exercisable within 60 days
     of March 1, 1996, 13,050 shares held in trust for the children of executive
     officers and  directors,  21,140  shares owned  beneficially  by spouses or
     children of executive  officers and directors,  and 31,900 shares allocated
     to executive  officers  through their  participation in the Companys 401(k)
     Savings Plan.
</FN>
</TABLE>

                             EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

     The  following  table  sets  forth  information  with  respect to the Chief
Executive  Officer  and the four  remaining  most highly  compensated  executive
officers of the Company for the fiscal year ended December 31, 1995.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                          Summary Compensation Table
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                              Long Term
                                           Annual Compensation               Compensation
                                        ------------------------             -------------
       (a)                    (b)           (c)          (d)          (e)          (f)               (g)
- -------------------------   ------      ---------    ---------    ---------- --------------     ----------------
                                                                   Other       Securities
                                                                   Annual      Underlying 
Name and Principal                                                 Compen-      Options           All Other
    Position                 Year         Salary        Bonus      sation(1)    (shares)        Compensation (2)
- -------------------------   ------      ---------    ---------    ---------- --------------     ----------------
<S>                          <C>        <C>          <C>              <C>           <C>              <C>    
Roger R. Brodersen           1995       $ 172,000    $ 147,897        $0            10,000           $ 9,240
Chairman, President          1994         165,000       80,217         0            10,000             9,240
& Chief Executive Officer    1993         157,500       79,497         0             6,000             8,994

Greg T. Sloma                1995         140,000      131,466         0             6,000             9,240
Chief Operating Officer &    1994         135,000       65,712         0             6,000             2,464
Executive Vice President     1993          93,462       35,360         0            30,000                 0

Robert S. Herman             1995         115,000      131,466         0             5,000             9,240
Senior Vice President        1994         110,000       71,304         0             5,000             6,160
                             1993         104,000       70,922         0             4,500             6,165

Roger W. Wallace             1995         115,000      126,227         0             5,000             9,240
Senior Vice President        1994         110,000       70,108         0             5,000             7,204
                             1993         104,000       70,970         0             4,500             6,998

James J. Marquiss            1995         115,000      125,843         0             4,000             9,240
Vice President               1994         110,000       62,540         0             3,000             6,902
                             1993          80,000       87,889         0             3,000             7,027


                                        6

                                       336
<PAGE>

<FN>
 
(1)  Excludes  perquisites  and other  benefits  because the  aggregate  of such
     compensation  was less than  either  $50,000  or 10% of the total of annual
     salary and bonus reported for the named executive officer.

(2)  The amounts included in the All Other Compensation  column represent 401(k)
     matching contributions made by the Company.
</FN>
</TABLE>

 
The  following  table  shows,  as to the Chief  Executive  Officer  and the four
remaining most highly compensated executive officers of the Company, information
about stock option  grants in fiscal 1995.  The Company does not grant any Stock
Appreciation Rights.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                Option Grants In Last Fiscal Year
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                        Individual Grants
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

      (a)                   (b)            (c)             (d)            (e)           (f)
- -------------------    ------------  --------------    -----------     ----------    ----------

                        Number of
                        Securities     Percent of
                        Underlying   Total Options
                        Options        Granted to        Exercise                    Grant Date
                        Granted       Employees In       Price         Expiration      Present
     Name              (shares) (1)   Fiscal 1995      (Per share)        Date        Value (2)
- -------------------    ------------  --------------    -----------     ----------    ----------

<S>                      <C>              <C>            <C>            <C>            <C>    
Roger R. Brodersen       10,000           7.9%           $ 18.15        1-04-00        $66,900

Greg T. Sloma             6,000           4.8%             16.50        1-04-05         40,900

Robert S. Herman          5,000           4.0%             16.50        1-04-05         34,100

Roger W. Wallace          5,000           4.0%             16.50        1-04-05         34,100

James J. Marquiss         4,000           3.2%             16.50        1-04-05         27,300


<FN>
(1) The options  listed above were granted on January 4, 1995 under the Companys
Stock Option Plan of 1989.

(2) As permitted by the Securities and Exchange  Commissions rules on disclosure
of  executive  compensation,  the Company has elected to use a valuation  method
other  than the value at 5% and 10%  annual  appreciation  or the  Black-Scholes
valuation  method.  The  Company  has on its  staff Dr.  H.  Wade  German,  Vice
President of Business Research, an experienced business economist with more than
25 years experience  building  industry price indexes and short term forecasting
models.  Dr. German holds the BA, MA and CAS Degrees in Economics and a Ph.D. in
Sociology.
</FN>
</TABLE>

Dr. German has constructed a stock option valuation method  (DTN-SOVM) which the
Company believes provides a more realistic  measure of stock option values.  The
DTN-SOVM is determined as follows:

          Using the well-known  Census Bureau Seasonal  Adjustment  Program,  an
          autoregressive integrated moving average technique (referred to as the
          X-11 program), the Company has:

                                        7

                                      337
<PAGE>

          Isolated  the long  term  trend  and the  intermediate  term  cyclical
          effects  impacting the Companys stock price. This is done on a monthly
          average basis.

          Isolated the  seasonality  and the irregular  component of the monthly
          average  stock  price  over the  calendar  years  1991  through  1995,
          inclusive .

          Quantified on a monthly  basis the four major  components of its stock
          price  movement.   These  components  are  (1)  long  term  trend  (2)
          intermediate term cyclical component (3) short term seasonal component
          and (4) the  irregular  or  exogenous  element of the monthly  average
          stock price.

     Since the Companys  stock  options  will only have a positive  value if the
     long term  outlook for the stock is  positive,  it is necessary to estimate
     the long term underlying  value of the stock,  after removing any irregular
     effects from the data. The DTN-SOVM accomplishes this by:

          Regressing the trend-cycle  component of the Companys  monthly average
          stock price on alternative time trends, over alternative time periods,
          to determine  which  provides  the most  realistic  assessment  of the
          future   trend-cycle   estimate  of  the  Companys  stock.  Since  the
          trend-cycle  data from the X-11  program is  monthly,  the  regression
          analysis of the  Companys  trend-cycle  on the time trend  provides an
          equation  that  enables  the Company to  estimate  future  trend-cycle
          values  on a monthly  basis.  This is  conducted  over a ten year time
          period; from January, 1996 through December, 2005.

          Once  the  appropriate  future  values  of  the  Companys  trend-cycle
          estimates are constructed, the next steps are to:

               Determine  the  weighted   average   exercise  time  period  from
               historical  data with respect to the Companys  stock options over
               the seven year time period from  January 1, 1989 to December  31,
               1995.

               Assuming the historical  experience regarding the exercise of the
               Companys  stock  options  will be  repeated  in the  future,  the
               DTN-SOVM determines the estimated trend- cycle value.

               Subtract  the exercise  price of the option from the  trend-cycle
               value of such option,  and then discount to present value using a
               discount  rate equal to the annual yield on a U.S.  Treasury Note
               having a maturity date closest to the end of the exercise  period
               of such option.

                                        8

                                       338
<PAGE>
     The following table provides information on option exercises in fiscal 1995
and the  value of  unexercised  options  at  December  31,  1995  for the  Chief
Executive  Officer  and the four  remaining  most highly  compensated  executive
officers.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                          Aggregated Option Exercises In Last Fiscal Year
                                 and Fiscal Year End Option Values
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                 Number of Securities
                                                Underlying Unexercised      Value of Unexercised
                       Shares                      Options at Fiscal        In-the-Money Options
                      Acquired                     Year End (shares)        At Fiscal Year End(1)
                         On       Value      --------------------------  ---------------------------
     Name             Exercise   Realized    Exercisable  Unexercisable  Exercisable   Unexercisable
- -------------------   --------  ---------    -----------  -------------  -----------   -------------
<S>                     <C>     <C>             <C>           <C>         <C>            <C>       
Roger R. Brodersen      2,769   $ 31,428        20,666        18,667      $ 668,400      $  498,700

Greg T. Sloma            --            0        17,000        25,000        569,000         805,000

Robert S. Herman         --            0        21,683         9,833        748,500         285,100

Roger W. Wallace         --            0        21,683         9,833        748,500         285,100

James J. Marquiss        --            0        14,958         7,000        517,100         206,500

<FN>
(1)  The closing bid price of the  Companys  common stock as quoted by NASDAQ on
     December 31, 1995 was $48.50.  The values shown are computed based upon the
     difference  between  this price and the  exercise  price of the  underlying
     options.
</FN>
</TABLE>

PERFORMANCE GRAPH

     The following  performance  graph compares the  performance of the Companys
common stock to the Center for Research in Securities Prices (CRSP) Total Return
Index for the NASDAQ Stock Market (U.S.  Companies) and to the CRSP Total Return
Industry Index for NASDAQ Telecommunications  Stocks. The graph assumes that the
value of the investment in the Companys  Common Stock and each index was $100 at
December 31, 1990.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                       Performance Graph in Tabular Form


                   Comparison of Five Year Cumulative Return
                   -----------------------------------------

                               1990     1991     1992     1993     1994     1995
                               ----     ----     ----     ----     ----     ----
<S>                            <C>      <C>      <C>      <C>      <C>      <C> 
DTN Common Stock               100      100      118      218      142      410 

NASDAQ Total Return Index      100      161      187      215      210      296

NASDAQ Telecommunication
Industry Index                 100      138      169      261      216      260

</TABLE>

                                        9

                                       339


<PAGE>

                         COMPENSATION COMMITTEE REPORT
                           ON EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

COMPENSATION PHILOSOPHY

     The Company strives to apply a consistent  philosophy on  compensation  for
all  employees,  including  senior  management.  The  goals of the  compensation
program are to directly link compensation  with corporate  profitability and the
enhancement  of the  underlying  value of the Companys  business.  The following
objectives are used by the Company and the Compensation  Committee as guidelines
for compensation decisions:

     Provide a competitive total compensation package that allows the Company to
     attract and retain the best people possible.

     The  Company  pays for  performance.  Employees  are  rewarded  based  upon
     corporate   performance,   business   unit   performance   and   individual
     performance.

     Provide variable compensation programs that are linked with the performance
     of the Company and that align executive  compensation with the interests of
     shareholders.

COMPENSATION PROGRAM COMPONENTS

     The Committee annually reviews the Companys  compensation program to ensure
that pay levels and  incentive  opportunities  are  competitive  and reflect the
performance  of the Company.  The  components  of the  compensation  program for
executive  officers,  which are comparable to those used for all employees,  are
outlined below.

     Base  Salary - Base pay  levels are  determined  by  reviewing  competitive
positions in the market,  including  comparisons with companies of similar size,
complexity and growth rates. Modest increases in base salary were recommended by
senior  management for fiscal 1995 for the Chief Executive Officer and the other
executive  officers named in the Summary  Compensation  Table, and the Committee
acted in accordance with this recommendation.

     Annual  Incentive  Compensation  -  The  large  majority  of  the  Companys
employees,  including the  executive  officers,  participate  in an annual bonus
plan.  For fiscal 1995, the bonus pool amounted to eight percent of the Companys
income before income taxes and depreciation and amortization  expenses. The five
executive   officers   named  in  the  Summary   Compensation   Table   received
approximately forty percent of this bonus pool.

     Stock Option  Program - The purpose of this program,  which is available to
the  large  majority  of  employees,  is to  provide  additional  incentives  to
employees to work to maximize long-term  shareholder value. It also uses vesting
periods to encourage key employees to continue in the employ of the Company. The
number of stock options  granted to executive  officers is based on  competitive
practices.

                             COMPENSATION COMMITTEE
                           OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS
                                David K. Karnes
                                J. Michael Parks
                                  Jay E. Ricks
                                 Greg T. Sloma

                                       10

                                       340
<PAGE>
                          TRANSACTIONS WITH MANAGEMENT

     No reportable  transactions occurred during fiscal 1995 between the Company
and its officers and directors.


          COMPENSATION COMMITTEE INTERLOCKS AND INSIDER PARTICIPATION

     The  following  directors  served  on  the  Compensation  Committee  of the
Companys Board of Directors: David K. Karnes, J. Michael Parks, Jay E. Ricks and
Greg T. Sloma. Mr. Sloma,  because he is an officer and employee of the Company,
abstains  from all votes  dealing  with  officer  compensation.  Also,  only Mr.
Karnes,  Mr.  Parks  and  Mr.  Ricks  are  members  of  the  Stock  Option  Plan
Subcommittee of the Compensation  Committee which administers the Companys Stock
Option Plan of 1989.


APPROVAL OF APPOINTMENT OF AUDITORS

     The Board of Directors has, upon the recommendation of the Audit Committee,
appointed  the firm of  Deloitte  & Touche LLP to audit the  Companys  financial
statements for the fiscal year ending December 31, 1996, subject to ratification
by the stockholders of the Company. Deloitte & Touche LLP served as the Companys
auditors for the 1995 fiscal year.

     Ratification of the appointment of the  independent  auditors  requires the
affirmative vote of a majority of the shares of Common Stock present,  in person
or by proxy, and voting at the Meeting.  If the  stockholders  should not ratify
the appointment of Deloitte & Touche LLP, the Board of Directors will reconsider
the appointment.

     A representative  of Deloitte & Touche LLP is expected to be present at the
Meeting,  will have an opportunity  to make a statement if desired,  and will be
available to respond to appropriate stockholder questions.

     The  Board  of  Directors  recommends  a  vote  FOR  the  approval  of  the
appointment of Deloitte & Touche LLP as independent auditors for the Company.


                 STOCKHOLDER PROPOSALS FOR 1997 ANNUAL MEETING

     Proposals of stockholders  for which  consideration  is desired at the 1997
Annual  Meeting of  Stockholders  must be  received by the Company no later than
December 31, 1996, in order to be considered for inclusion in the Companys proxy
statement and form of proxy relating to such meeting.  Any such proposals  shall
be subject to the  requirements  of the proxy rules adopted under the Securities
Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.


               COMPLIANCE WITH SECTION 16(a) OF THE EXCHANGE ACT

     Section  16(a) of the  Securities  Exchange  Act of 1934,  as amended  (the
Exchange Act), requires the Companys  directors,  executive officers and holders
of more than 10% of the Companys  common stock to file with the  Securities  and
Exchange  Commission  initial  reports of  ownership  and  reports of changes in
ownership  of common  stock and other  equity  securities  of the  Company.  The
Company  believes  that  during the fiscal year ended  December  31,  1995,  its
executive  officers,  directors  and  holders  of more than 10% of the  Companys
common  stock  complied  with all Section  16(a) filing  requirements,  with the
following  exception.  Jay E. Ricks,  a director of the Company,  filed late his
initial  report on Form 3 due upon his  becoming a director of the  Company.  In
making these statements,  the Company has relied solely upon a review of Forms 3
and 4 furnished  to the  Company  during its most recent  fiscal  year,  Forms 5
furnished  to the Company  with  respect to its most  recent  fiscal  year,  and
written representations from reporting persons that no Form 5 was required.

                                       11

                                       341
<PAGE>
                                 OTHER MATTERS

     The Board of  Directors  is not aware of any  business  to come  before the
Meeting  other  than  those  matters  described  above in the  Proxy  Statement.
However,  if any other  matters  should  properly  come before the meeting,  the
persons  named  in the  accompanying  form  of  proxy  will  have  discretionary
authority  to vote all proxies  with respect  thereto in  accordance  with their
judgement.


                                 MISCELLANEOUS

     The cost of  solicitation  of  proxies  will be borne by the  Company.  The
Company will,  upon request,  reimburse  brokerage  firms and other  custodians,
nominees and  fiduciaries  for reasonable  expenses  incurred by them in sending
proxy  material  to the  beneficial  owners  of Common  Stock.  In  addition  to
solicitations by mail, directors, officers, and regular employees of the Company
may solicit proxies  personally or by telegram or telephone  without  additional
compensation.  The  Company  has  retained  First  National  Bank of Omaha,  the
Companys stock transfer agent, to assist in the distribution and solicitation of
proxies  at a cost of  approximately  $2,500,  including  the  reimbursement  of
certain expenses.

     The Companys Annual Report to Stockholders, including financial statements,
has been  mailed to all  stockholders  of record as of the close of  business on
March 1, 1996. Any stockholder who has not received a copy of such Annual Report
may  obtain a copy by  writing  the  Company.  Such  Annual  Report is not to be
treated  as a part  of this  proxy  solicitation  material  nor as  having  been
incorporated herein by reference.

     Notwithstanding  anything to the  contrary set forth in any of the Companys
previous  filings under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended,  or the Exchange
Act that might incorporate  future filings,  including this Proxy Statement,  in
whole  or in  part,  the  Compensation  Committee  Report  on  page  10 and  the
Performance Graph on page 9 shall not be incorporated by reference into any such
filings.


                                        THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS

Omaha, Nebraska
March 11, 1996



A COPY OF THE FORM 10-K AS FILED WITH THE  SECURITIES  AND EXCHANGE  COMMISSION,
EXCLUDING  EXHIBITS,  WILL BE FURNISHED WITHOUT CHARGE TO STOCKHOLDERS AS OF THE
RECORD DATE UPON WRITTEN  REQUEST TO THE SECRETARY,  DATA  TRANSMISSION  NETWORK
CORPORATION, 9110 WEST DODGE ROAD, SUITE 200, OMAHA, NEBRASKA 68114.

                                       12

                                       342
<PAGE>








                            INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK


 





                                       343
<PAGE>






                     DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION
                        9110 West Dodge Road, Suite 200
                                Omaha, NE 68114





                                       344
<PAGE>

                  DATA TRANSMISSION NETWORK CORPORATION PROXY
            Annual Meeting of Stockholders To Be Held April 24, 1996

          THIS PROXY IS SOLICITED ON BEHALF OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS


The  undersigned  hereby  appoints  Roger R.  Brodersen and Brian L. Larson,  or
either of them, as proxies of the  undersigned,  with full power of substitution
to either of them, and hereby  authorizes  them to vote as designated  below all
shares of common stock of Data Transmission  Network  Corporation held of record
by the  undersigned on March 1, 1996 at the Annual Meeting of Stockholders to be
held on April 24,  1996 and at any  adjournments  thereof  (a) on the  following
matters and (b) on any other  matters that  properly may come before the meeting
or any adjournments thereof:


1.  ELECTION OF DIRECTORS 

          FOR all nominees listed below (except as marked)                     
    -----                        

          WITHHOLD AUTHORITY to vote for all nominees listed below
    -----    


(INSTRUCTIONS: To withhold authority to vote for any individual nominee(s), draw
a line through the nominee's name below.)

    Roger R. Brodersen   Robert S. Herman     David K. Karnes   J. Michael Parks
    Jay E. Ricks         Greg T. Sloma        Roger W. Wallace


2.   RATIFICATION  OF  APPOINTMENT  OF  DELOITTE  &  TOUCHE  LLP as  independent
     auditors of the Corporation for fiscal year ending December 31, 1996

                AGAINST                                 ABSTAIN
          ----                                     ----

This proxy will be voted as specified.  IF NO SPECIFICATION IS GIVEN, THIS PROXY
WILL BE  VOTED  FOR THE  PROPOSALS  SET  FORTH  ABOVE.  The  undersigned  hereby
acknowledges  receipt of the Notice of Annual  Meeting of  Stockholders  of Data
Transmission  Network  Corporation  to be held on April  24,  1996 and the Proxy
Statement for such meeting.

Dated                             , 1996
      ---------------------------          -----------------------------------
 

                                           -----------------------------------
                                                  (Signature of Stockholder)

Note:  Please sign exactly as name appears on stock certificate (as Indicated on
reverse  side).   All  joint  owners  should  sign.  When  signing  as  personal
representative,  executor, administrator,  attorney, trustee or guardian, please
give full title as such. If a corporation,  please sign in full corporation name
by  president  or other  authorized  person.  If a  partnership,  please sign in
partnership name by a partner.





                                       345
<PAGE>




© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission